Adventures in Science Fiction Series
JOURNEY TO INFINITY
Edited by
MARTIN GREENBERG
Introduced
by FLETCHER PRATT
CLEVE
CARTMILL • JACK WILLIAMSON • JOHN D. MACDONALD EDWARD E. SMITH, PH.D. • FREDRIC
BROWN • ISAAC ASIMOV JUDITH MERRIL • A. BERTRAM CHANDLER • FRITZ LEIBER C. L.
MOORE • ERIC FRANK RUSSELL • THEODORE STURGEON
GNOME PRESS
INCORPORATED
Publishers New York
copyright 1951 by martin greenberg.
first edition. All rights reserved. This book, or parts thereof, may not be reproduced in any form without
permission, except for brief quotations in critical articles and reviews.
Acknowledgment
is gratefully made to Astounding
Science Fiction for
use of the following copyrighted material: "False Dawn" by A. Bertram
Chandler, copyright 1946
by Street & Smith
Publications, Inc.; "Letter to a Phoenix" by Fredric Brown, copyright
1949 by Street & Smith Publications, Inc.;
"Unite and Conquer" by Theodore Sturgeon, copyright 1948 by Street & Smith Publications, Inc.; "Breakdown" by Jack
Williamson, copyright 1942
by Street & Smith
Publications, Inc.; "Dance of a New World" by John D. MacDonald,
copyright 1948
by Street & Smith
Publications, Inc.; "Mother Earth" by Isaac Asimov, copyright 1949 by Street & Smith Publications, Inc.; "There Shall Be
Darkness" by C. L. Moore, copyright 1942 by Street & Smith Publications, Inc.; "Taboo" by Fritz
Leiber, copyright 1944
by Street & Smith
Publications, Inc.; "Overthrow" by Cleve Cartmill, copyright 1942 by Street & Smith Publications, Inc.; "Metamorphosite" by
Eric Frank Russell, copyright 1946 by
Street & Smith Publications, Inc.; to Future combined with Science Fiction Stories for use of: "Barrier of Dread" by
Judith Merril, copyright 1950 by
Columbia Publications, Inc.; and to Fantasy Press for use of:
"Atlantis," an extract from the book, Triplanetary, copyright 1948 by Edward E. Smith, Ph.D.
manufactured in the united states of america
colonial press inc., Printers • david kyle, Boo\
Designer
FOREWORD
I |
n the first
Gnome Press anthology in the planned series of "adventures in science
fiction" there was one thought in mind which motivated its publication.
This second book represents a continuation of that idea. The first paragraph of
the Foreword in that first book expressed the purpose so clearly, we believe,
that it is worthy of repetition here. "This book was planned from the very
beginning to be more than just a collection of interesting adventure stories.
It was organized around a central idea, one theme which moves logically from
story to story. By building upon this unifying theme, we who prepared this book
sincerely believe, a new idea in science fiction anthologies has been
developed—a science fiction anthology which, taken in its entirety, tells a complete
story"
The
central idea in this latest book concerns Mankind itself. Whereas the first in
the series dealt with a phase in the life of Man, specifically interplanetary
spaceships and space travel, these stories together consider the development
of humanity and its culture as a whole. Science fiction writers have always
concerned themselves with the direction in which the civilization of Earth is
heading; likewise they have, with imaginative soarings, searched the past for
clues to our inheritance. From their collective minds we have assembled what
may well be called "a future history of Mankind," together with some
appropriate background material to round out the picture.
Fletcher
Pratt, noted as an historian and himself a writer of science fiction, has
contributed an introduction which analyzes and develops the central theme. His
remarks add a great deal to the coherency of this volume. In addition, his
sympathetic discussion of the underlying principles around which science
fiction is written ought to increase understanding among those to whom this is
a new field of literature.
Martin Greenberg
INTRODUCTION
by Fletcher Pratt
S |
cience fiction is unique among the modern groupings of 1 literature in that
the anthology is perhaps its most typical form. Not that there are no
book-length novels in the field. There are some extremely good ones; but the
method and material of science fiction lend themselves peculiarly well to the
short story. The writer of science fiction is and must be concerned with the
reactions of human beings in environments which, either by time or
circumstance, are strikingly different from the world in which we spend our
daily lives. If that writer elaborates the picture of his imagined world in
every last logical detail, he risks losing track of the individual people he is
writing about. That is, he turns out a treatise instead of a story; and in fact
much book-length science fiction is more science than fiction, Bellamy's Looking Backward being a famous example. The writer who is
really telling a story can normally afford only a glimpse of the different
world in which his tale is laid, enough to indicate its main lines and why it
is provided with pleasures, duties and perils unlike those that normally
surround us.
Moreover, science fiction appears largely in
magazines for the first time, and the modern American magazine reader has
established his perfectly reasonable repugnance to being bothered either with
very long stories or losing the thread of a type of story that always requires
rather close reading while waiting for the next issue to come out. The short
story has thus come to dominate the field of science fiction, and it is not
surprising that various people have found many short stories
too
good to be left gathering dust in piles of back number magazines.
But
these same rescuers-from-oblivion generally operate on the theory that it is
enough if a story be both good and science fiction. The collections normally
represent nothing but their editors' preference for a group of wholly unrelated
stories. To this generalization the Spring of 1950 produced a brilliant exception—Men Against the Stars, edited by Martin Greenberg. The same editor now gives us another
anthology with a genuine idea behind it.
This
time it is the history of the world; not the history of the world as dealt with
by the Encyclopaedia
Britannica and
taught in the colleges, but the kind of history we cannot actually know, only
view through the efforts of controlled scientific imagination. Or perhaps
imagination is the wrong word when associating with science. Extrapolation, the
prolonging of a thoroughly established curve to discover the end product of a
known movement is a perfectly legitimate scientific technique.
In
this group of stories, then, the reader is presented with a series of
extrapolations about the history of the Earth. It is by no means entirely
extrapolation into the future, for in the first two stories of the collection
we are living at the end of the curve and the authors have run back along it to
see where we might have come from.
One
rather remarkable fact about these stories is that, although they are the work
of many different hands, they might almost have had their origin in a single
mind—or group of minds in agreement on essentials. One can accept the picture
of the world in any of these stories, one can agree that current progress will
one day carry us to the point at which the story takes place, without
invalidating anything that has gone before in the book or anything that will
come later. No doubt it represents a rather adroit piece of editing for such a
result, but it is rather worth asking whether editing alone is
responsible—whether it is not significant that among practitioners of the
controlled scientific extrapolation there is such general agreement as to the
probable development of the civilization of Man.
We
know that predictors of the future can be as wildly wrong as H. G. Wells when he had the war in the air fought out by gigantic fleets of
hydrogen-filled balloons. But the point is that Wells' balloons were merely a
technical detail; there was a growing accumulation of evidence to indicate that
he may have been quite right about the overall effects of prolonged and
violent aerial warfare. So it may well be with these stories. The exact nature
of an invention cannot usually be
INTRODUCTION 9
predicted,
because if it could be, the thing would be invented instead of extrapolated;
but the precise details are unimportant beside the indicated general trend of
development. If the authors represented in this anthology
have
caught that, then the reader really has here before him something like the
overall history of the world.
CONTENTS
Foreword |
|
5 |
Introduction |
Fletcher Pratt |
7 |
False
Dawn |
A. Bertram Chandler |
i5 |
Atlantis |
Edward E.
Smith, PhD. |
49 |
Letter
to a Phoenix |
Fredric Brown |
63 |
Unite
and Conquer |
Theodore Sturgeon |
7i |
Breakdown |
]ac\ Williamson |
110 |
Dance
of a New
World |
John D. MacDonald |
145 |
Mother
Earth |
Isaac Asimov |
159 |
There
Shall Be
Darkness |
C.
L. Moore |
196 |
Taboo |
Fritz Leiber |
248 |
Overthrow |
Cleve Cartmill |
259 |
Barrier
of Dread |
Judith Merril |
312 |
Metamorphosite |
Eric Fran\ Russell |
324 |
JOURNEY TO INFINITY
Deep
in the debris of time are hidden the forgotten cultures of Man. Only whispered
legends come to us now of the glories of Lur, Candra, Thragan, Kah, Mu, Attrin,
Hyboria and Atlantis. Of these, Attrin is the earliest whose history might be
pieced together, based upon present day evidence indicating its actual
existence. What it was and what happened to it is related here as the first
part of the imaginary history of Mankind.
FALSE DAWN
by A. Bertram Chandler
A ngam Matangu stood with his two mates on the flat roof xjL of his house on the outskirts of Darnala. The
summer air was heavy with the scent of the night-flowering shrubs that grew in
profusion in the garden below, and flaunted their pallid, faintly luminous
blossoms from the plot in the center of the wide expanse of roof. The stars
hung low in the warm sky. To the east was a growing, spreading pallor—a light
wan and ghostly in contrast to the live, pulsing stars, the sparse,
ruddy-burning lamps irregularly spaced along the thoroughfares of the city.
"The dawn," said
Evanee, the younger of the women.
Linith
laughed shortly, scornfully. This was not the first time that she had arisen
early with her mate, left her bed to stand here on the rooftop to await the
rising of Loana. She knew that the eastern light would fade again, that with
its passing what little remained of the dark night would be even darker. Then
would come the real dawn —and Ramanu, Lord of Life, would flood the world with
his golden light.
"The
dawn," said Evanee again, a faint yet sharp edge of irritation in her
voice.
"No,
my dear." It was Angam who spoke, his voice gentle as always. "The
false dawn. But Loana will not be long—"
The
two women seated themselves upon a low seat running the inner perimeter of the
parapet. Angam remained standing, statuesque
15
l6 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
in
the darkness, bulking big in the robe he had donned against the slight morning
chill. Watching him, Linith wondered what strange compulsion it was that
brought him out on these mornings when Loana rose just a little before the sun,
when the little sister world presented only a slim crescent to the eyes of her
watchers. She pondered the essential unwisdom of the male. She was moved to
share her thoughts with the younger woman—then abruptly decided against it.
She, Evanee, would learn. This now was very romantic. Linith had found it so
the first few times. But when you had seen the young Loana, the ghost of the
old Loana clasped in her arms, rise once before the dawn you had seen it for
all time. She stifled a yawn. You could always see the same thing just after
sunset at the beginning of the month—even though the hills inland did shut the
sight from view all too soon.
"Loana!"
said Angam suddenly, a note almost of reverence in his deep voice.
"Loana!"
Evanee jumped to her feet and ran to his
side. Linith rose slowly, not without dignity, her manner conveying just a hint
of boredom. She was almost wishing that she had let Evanee come up here alone
with Angam. Almost— But even the sacrifice of a lazy morning was better than
being relegated to the contemptible status of so many senior wives of her
acquaintance.
And even she had to admit to feeling a faint
thrill as the slender crescent climbed out and up from the low, dark clouds
along the sea's eastern rim, trailing in its wake the first flush of the true
dawn. And even she wondered, for the thousandth time, what was the nature of
the beings who lived in the cities whose twinkling lights were spread in
clusters over the night hemisphere. And she wondered why those lights, year by
year, month by month, were thinning as the leaves of a tree are thinned by the
onset of autumn, the first, chill blasts heralding the coming of winter. From
nowhere a sentence formed itself in her mind—The lights are going out one by one. "The lights are going out one by
one," she said aloud. "Tell me, Angam, shall we see them relit in our
time?"
From the direction of the airport came a
certain noise of shouting, distinctly audible in the still air, the dawn hush.
Presently the northbound mail soared overhead, its gas bag a huge shadow
against the stars, the whine of its turbines, the throb of its propellers
disturbing the birds in the trees below. With its passing they ceased their
in-
FALSE DAWN IJ
dignant
outcry—but before Linith could ask her question again Eva-nee broke the fresh
woven spell of silence.
"I read a story," she said,
"about an airship that was filled with a gas many times lighter than
helium, than hydrogen even. And it went up to Loana—"
Linith, although Angam's face was invisible
to her, could almost see his tolerant smile as he replied to the
feather-brained little fool.
"Just
a story, Evanee. It couldn't be done. It will never be done. Even the heavier
than air flying machine that Mang is working on now could never do it. You see,
between ourselves and Loana there is no atmosphere, no air. And we must have
air so that our balloons may float like corks in water, so that the wings of
the new airships may have something against which to beat. The most we can hope
for is that some day they will answer our light signals. I wonder," he
said slowly, "what they are really like. Are they men and women like us?
Or are they—things? But their life must be grim and hard. Loana has no air, and
so they must live out their lives in their sealed cities under their air-tight
domes." His sweeping gesture included all the world with its fields and
seas, its snow-covered mountains and verdant valleys. "They haven't
anything like this!"
"And their lights are
going out one by one," said Linith.
As he drove to his place of work Angam found
his vague forebodings of the dawn swiftly dispelled by the glory of the
morning. He wondered why he should feel that the fate of his kind was linked up
with that of the unknown, unguessable people of Loana. Their lights were going
out one by one. He remembered the grave intonation of Linith's voice as she
said it, and a shiver ran over his body, made every hair of the ruddy pelt
covering his body stand briefly on end. Absentmindedly he returned the
salutation of the driver of a car bound in the opposite direction, then bent
all his attention to the business of nursing his power. He had let his reserve
fall perilously low.
Yet he could not prevent his attention from
wandering to his surroundings. The wide, clean road, the low houses on either
side, each standing within its own garden, each half hidden by and blending
with the luxuriant trees and shrubs, told him that this was a good world to be
alive in. The throngs of cheerful people, afoot and awheel, confirmed him in
this belief. Ramanu gilded their warm-tinted pelts with his mellow rays, struck
scintillant fire from the jeweled orna-
18 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
merits
worn by men and women alike. Truly, thought Angam, this is a good world and we
are a good people. We—fit. There is no strife among us as among the beasts.
Each has ample. And yet—we are not too far removed from our four-footed
brothers and sisters. Our feet are planted firm on the good earth. We are of
the earth.
Round
the bend of the road glowed the orange pillar of a power station. Angam glanced
at his gauges, cut his engine and silently coasted the last few yards. The
attendant, aproned, gauntleted, hurried out from his little hut at the musical
summons of Angam's horn.
"Angam Matangu!"
he said. "Salutation!"
"Salutation, Morrud. I
have all but exhausted my power."
"Truly,
Angam Matangu, none would guess that you stored power for the city. Many a time
have I had to carry your cylinders a full ten yards from my hut to your car.
Perhaps"—a sly smile flickered over the broad, pleasant
countenance—"you are too interested in the source of your power to care
overmuch for the power itself."
"Perhaps you are
right. Morrud."
Angam
leaned back in his seat, took his ease whilst the other went to the back of the
vehicle, took therefrom the four compressed air cylinders, three empty and one
almost so, that powered the efficient little engine of his car. As he had done
many a time before he wondered whether or not it might be better to utilize
the steam turbine for intramural transport, as already it was used for vehicles
outside the city limits. But perhaps the city fathers were right. The
compressed air motors made up for their minor inconveniences by a complete absence
of smoke, heat or fumes. He tried to imagine what Darnala would be like were
each car a source of such irritations.
Morrud
returned with the fresh cylinders. Deftly he stowed them in their positions,
made the necessary connections.
"Warranted
full pressure," he grinned. "After all, they bear your seal"
Abruptly gravity fell on him like a cloak. "I watched Loana this morning.
The lights are going out one by one. Tell me, Angam Matangu, what is it? Are
they dying up there? Is their power failing fast so that they must economize?
They say that there is no air, no water, that life is possible only in their
sealed cities. And, city by city, the life is going out of Loana. Tell me,
Angam Matangu, will the same fate overtake us in the end?"
"In the end, Morrud. But that will not
be for millions of years. And perhaps we shall have learned some way of holding
off the cold and the dark." He drew a pencil from his pouch, initialed the
slip of
FALSE DAWN 10
paper
that the attendant presented to him, opened his valve and drove off. And it
seemed to him that the death of Loana, whatever that death might be, was
casting its shadow over all the city of Darnala, over all the kindly, happy
land of Attrin.
It was not until he arrived at the power
storage plant that Angam was able to shake off his pointless, uneasy
foreboding. But here, surrounded by the familiar routine of his profession,
the materials and tools of his trade, he was almost able to forget the beings
who, unknown, unknowable close neighbors in space, were face to face with the
doom that must some day overtake all the worlds. He wished briefly that there
were some way of sending the cylinders of compressed air filled by the slow,
inexorable upthrust of the tide-actuated rams—then pushed the impossible desire
out of his mind as he was called to deal with a blown valve at the head of one
of the great cylinders.
But the thought refused to be disposed of so
easily. All the time that Angam was working he was contrasting his lot, cast
among a plenitude of air and water, with that of those who lived—and who were
now dying—upon Loana. He wondered what conditions were like on that little,
senile world. His imagination, vivid though it was, was unequal to the task.
He made the last
connection.
"Shut
her down, Carran," he ordered his subordinate. The master valve atop the
great cylinder head spun rapidly, the noise of escaping air rose octaves in
pitch, from a low whistle to a barely audible hiss, then ceased. Through the
smaller valves the compressed air poured into the bottles. Gauge needles
flickered and crept to their maxima, valves were shut and metal flasks sent to
join the long line of their identical twins on the chute to the warehouse. It
was all part of a normal working day at the Darnala power storage plant. It was
power, it was air compressed by the rising waters. And on the prime source of
that power, on the world whose gravitational pull sent the tidal waves sweeping
from ocean to ocean, the air and water were almost gone.
Angam
dipped his hands into a container of alcohol, agitated them until every trace
of grease was washed from the close, ruddy fur. He dried them upon a clean
piece of fabric. Then, hands clasped behind his back, he padded on broad, bare
feet through his domain. Save for the occasional hiss of escaping air, the
occasional plash of agitated water, it was very quiet. The row of tall, black
cylinders, inside which
20 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
the
rams were rising with the rising tide, dwarfed the workers around their bases.
A man of another age, another species, would have compared the atmosphere with
that of a cathedral—but such a concept would have been incomprehensible to
Angam and his fellows. True— they worshiped Ramanu, Lord of Life, in their
fashion, but it was a fashion that recognized the need for ritual whilst
refusing any belief in the supernatural.
The big clock on the landward wall of the
plant, its polished weights gleaming dully in the subdued light, marked the
tenth hour. Somewhere, somebody pulled a lanyard. A deep, boomingly melodious
whistle told all Darnala that the sun was at the meridian, that this was the
hour of the midday meal. AH but the few who would tend the simple machinery
whilst their workmates dined were streaming from the plant. Angam found Carran,
assured himself that the other was conversant with all that was happening, then
followed his underlings out into the blaze of noonday heat and light. He
paused at the parking lot, undecided whether or not to take his car and run
home, there to enjoy his midday meal with his two wives. He decided against it.
They would not be expecting him. He should have dispatched a messenger earlier
in the forenoon. Which reminded him—his messenger bill for the last month was
far too high.
On
foot he sauntered along the waterfront to the eating house kept by one Lagan.
He
found Mollin Momberig, manager of the pottery, in Lagan's. It was often said
that you would find there the executives of all the industries clustered around
the harbor and the tidal power plants. The cooking was good and the prices were
a little higher than those of the usual run of such places. High enough, in
fact, to discourage those of the lower income levels. Equalitarian though
society was it was recognized that equality of taste, behavior, conversational
standards is impossible of attainment.
Momberig
was seated in one of the little booths, a bowl of soup and a pitcher of light
wine before him. He saw Angam enter, peer around in the rather dim lighting as
he searched for a familiar face. Momberig raised his hand and called in his
rather high pitched voice —"Angam! Angam Matangu! Will you honor me?"
"The honor is mine," replied Angam.
He took his seat opposite the other, looked
with appreciation at the waitress as she brought the bill of fare. He wondered
if that peculiar shade of gold were natural. Natural or not—its effect was
strik-
FALSE DAWN 21
ing.
He watched the girl as she threaded her way among the tables, her muscles
moving smoothly under the blond, silky pelt.
"I must come here more
often, Mollin," he said.
Mollin laughed. "You might get away with
it with Evanee—she doesn't know you yet. But Linith— Oh, by the way, what does Evanee think of your Loana gazing?"
Angam grinned, showing his
big, strong teeth.
"She thinks it very
romantic," he said.
But
his smile wasn't all good humor. There was bitterness there —the bitterness of
a man when he finds that a loved one does not, cannot take seriously those
things which to him are of the utmost importance.
"Of course, she's young—" he concluded.
Mollin
pushed away his empty soup bowl, began vigorously to attack the crusty bread
and strong cheese.
"I
watched Loana this morning," he remarked in a sputter of crumbs. "The
lights are going out, one by one."
"You
know Handrin," said Angam pensively. "What does he make of it?"
"What could he make of it? All that he's concerned with is turning out ephemerae
for the seamen. He wouldn't care if Loana were made of green cheese as long as
she kept to her proper orbit, as long as the bold mariners were able to
navigate their ships with her aid. Talking of mariners . • . ahoy, captain.
Join us in a pitcher of Tiro-nian wine!"
From out the adjoining booth a short, more
than normally thickset figure was making his way to the door. He hesitated,
then retraced his steps to where Angam and Mollin were sitting. Angam studied
him with interest, decided that he liked the man. Two pale-gray eyes from
beneath heavy brows regarded him steadily. The facial hair, and that of the
body, was graying—yet there was an impression of youth. And the heavy gold
bracelet on each wrist denoted the wearer's rank.
"Captain Noab," introduced Mollin.
"Angam Matangu, manager of the power storage plant." The two men
bowed. "You know what we were talking about, captain?" the master
potter went on. "The city lights on Loana. What do you think is
happening?"
The
mariner waited until the blonde had brought him his pitcher of wine. He drank
long and appreciatively. Then—
"I've watched Loana," he rumbled.
"I've looked long at those city
22 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
lights, wondered what it would be like if we
had ships that could get up there. And when those lights started going out one
by one—why, it was like losing old friends." "But what is
happening?"
"I
don't know, gentlemen. But I have my own—theories. Perhaps the people of Loana
are like some of the 'people' aboard our ships. They are not nice people to
know. Now that the air is thin, now that the water can be counted by drops,
they are fighting each other for what little remains."
"Fighting? But that's impossible! They
must be at least as civilized as ourselves. And surely, under those
conditions, they would band together and attempt to stave off doom by common
effort."
"Yes.
If they were like us. But are they ? You landlubbers don't get to know rats as
we seamen do. In spite of all we can do to exterminate them they still infest
our ships. They are not unintelligent. If—Ramanu forbid—they should ever band
together it would go hard with us, the human crew. But they are incurably
vicious. They fight among themselves. They live on a plane of sheer savagery
undreamed of by us or, indeed, by the big majority of our four-footed
brethren."
Mollin's
face was incredulous. "You mean that the people of Loana are—rats?"
he managed at last.
"No.
But I do mean that most of us have been far too prone to think of them as
people like ourselves. But it seems to me that those city lights are going out,
one by one, because those living in the cities are grappled in a dreadful
struggle for the last drop of water, the last lungful of air. Working with one
common end in view they might save themselves. But they are sealing the doom of
themselves and their world."
Angam
looked up at the clock. Its big hand marked one quarter of an hour to the
eleventh hour. He rose to his feet.
"I must go," he said. "My
assistant awaits his relief."
"I
will come with you," said Mollin, He signaled to the blond waitress,
initialed with a pencil from his pouch the bill that she presented. Noab
leading they emerged from the eating house into the early afternoon sunshine.
Angam
had noted the captain's ship on his way to his meal. She could hardly escape
notice. Perhaps to a seaman's practiced eye there were many details in which
she differed from the smaller coastwise craft berthed all around her, but size
alone made her stand out like a mastodon in a herd of bison. Her clean, russet
painted hull and buff-
FALSE DAWN 23
colored
upper-works were pleasing to the eye—yet she was so well designed that even
had she been painted a drab, uniform gray her perfect lines would still have
been a delight.
High above the covered-in bridge towered the
tall funnel, dull crimson, and on it, in gold, a rampant lion. From the lofty
masts depended the derricks, idle now during the meal hour, and piled high
upon the quay, awaiting shipment, were cases and casks and bales of
merchandise.
"You have a fine ship, Captain
Noab," said Angam. "Tell me, when does Arra\ sail?"
"It has not yet been decided. The stores
and cargo should be aboard tomorrow. But I believe there is still some delay in
the selection of the colonists."
"I should have liked to have come with
you. They will need tidal engineers in this new land to the westward. "But—"
"Angam is a much married man,
captain," put in Mollin.
"Yes. You know what
women are."
"I do," replied Noab. "That is
why I have never married. But call aboard, Mollin Momberig, some time when you
are free. And you too, Angam Matangu. We will drink a pitcher of wine together
I"
It was barely four weeks
later.
Angam Matangu stood with his two mates on the
flat roof of his house on the outskirts of Darnala. The summer air was heavy
with the scent of the night-flowering shrubs that grew in profusion in the
garden below, that flaunted their pallid, faintly luminous blossoms from the
plot in the center of the wide expanse of roof. The stars hung low in the warm
sky. To the east was a growing, spreading pallor—a light wan and ghostly in
contrast to the live, pulsing stars, the sparse, ruddy-burning lamps
irregularly spaced along the thoroughfares of the city.
Yet,
in spite of the warmth, there was more than a suggestion of autumn in the air.
Mixed with the scent of the flowers was a subtle hint of overripeness, of sweet
decay. There was the dim foreknowledge that soon would come the cold gales from
the north, that soon the trees and the flowering shrubs would stand stripped to
the cold rains, that the lesser plants would be beaten down to the earth from
which they had sprung.
But this morning the air
was calm.
From the rooftops of
adjoining houses came a whispering, a mur-
24 JOURNEY
TO INFINITY
muring.
Once, almost alone in Darnala, Angam had kept his vigil Now it seemed that all
the city had arisen early to await the rising of Loana.
For
the lights of the little sister world were now almost all gone. But one city
remained—and all along its outskirts flashed and blazed other
lights—evanescent, briefly flaring, somehow menacing.
Angam
thought of Captain Noab and his rats. Once he had visualized the people of
Loana as beings not unlike himself—now he saw them as things small and active
and evil with sharp teeth and rending claws.
But those lights—
The idea of a weapon was foreign to Angam's
people. True— their cattle herders in remote districts carried spears as a
protection for themselves and their charges against the great cats—but beyond
that they had not gone. Vegetarians as they were they were never hunters. Their
herds supplied them with milk and cheese—but meat was an unknown diet to them.
But those lights—
Could it be, thought Angam, that they were
using some kind of blasting powder against their fellows? Once he had seen the
results of a premature burst in a quarry—even now the
memory brought nausea. But his engineer's mind could conceive how—if it were
imperative to kill one's fellows—explosives could be utilized. A metal tube,
for example, sealed at one end and with a little ball or rod working within it
like a piston, expelled by the force of the explosion. Or a metal ball filled with blasting powder and
with a slow-burning fuse. It could be thrown at one's enemies. . • .
Linith rose from her seat on the parapet and
walked to his side. She slipped her arm inside his, said nothing. She was very
comforting.
Evanee got up, too. She hurried across to
where her husband and his first wife were standing, made haste to possess
herself of his free arm.
"Why do you worry about Loana?" she
pouted. "It's miles away. Nothing that happens there can possibly affect us." "Yes, but—"
"What was it that Captain Noab was
saying the night we had dinner aboard Arra\?" interrupted
Linith. "Wasn't it that this was like being aboard a big, well-found ship,
standing by some smaller vessel foundering in a storm and being unable to raise
a finger to help?"
FALSE DAWN 2$
"Yes," replied Angam. "That's
just what it is like, Linith. Can't you see, Evanee? There
are people there. They may be like us—they most probably are not. They have
hopes and fears like us. And loves-"
"And hates," said Linith somberly.
"So you believe in old
Noab's wild theory."
"Don't you?"
From
the airport came a flashing of lights, a shouting, an orderly
confusion. Released from its moorings the northbound mail floated up, a vast,
black bulk against the stars. But there was no whine of turbines, no threshing
of screws. The airship rose almost vertically, a distant splashing noise telling of the jettison of water ballast. It
seemed that her pilots, too, had sensed that this rising of Loana would be
momentous, were determined that neither they nor their passengers would miss
whatever spectacle was to be unfolded before their wondering and horrified
eyes. The people of Attrin could do nothing to help their close, unknown
neighbors in space—but the mere fact that they would be silent, helpless
witnesses of the death of a world gave them the sense of an obligation
fulfilled.
Along
the eastern horizon were low, dense clouds. A slight paling of the blackness
above them gave brief warning of the rising of Loana. The silver crescent
showed first the merest tip of one of its horns, just a single point of light
over the dark sea. The point became a triangle,
the triangle a scimitar. Then Loana in her entirety ruled briefly the eastern
heavens. The ghost of the new Loana shone wanly within the half encircling rim
of brilliance. And this pale, reflected light on the dark side was almost the
only illumination. Just one little cluster of pin points of radiance remained,
lost and lonely in the expanse of darkness.
"The last city," said Linith.
"The last bastion against the everlasting night."
Last
bastion it may have been—and even to these distant watchers it was obvious that
it was suffering assault. Around its perimeter could be seen a continual flickering,
briefly flaring flames that, even at this extreme range, seemed to sear the
retina. Abrupdy fully half of the remaining city lights went out.
Then it happened.
The
tiny luminosities seemed to fuze, to coalesce. For an infinitesimal fraction
of a moment there was complete darkness—and then the whole of Loana spouted
flame. An intolerable radiance swept over
26 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
the
little world. Not one of those watching saw the last act of the distant
tragedy played out to its conclusion. The light was of a brightness too
intense to be borne, brighter than the torrents of fire sweeping down the sky
during a summer thunderstorm, brighter than Ramanu at the meridian. Every
detail of Darnala was thrown into sharp relief. The startled birds in the trees
set up a fear-crazed chattering. And the sea to the east threw back the light
from the sky so that all must either close their eyes or turn their faces
inland.
Evanee
uttered a low cry, a little scream. She fell to the rooftop, heavily. Angam
bent over her, all anxious solicitude. But it was Linith who took charge.
"Can't
you see?" she said. "It was the shock. I'll look after her. Hurry and
get the doctor!"
Angam
straightened. Even now he could not resist the urge to take one last look at
the sky. But there was nothing to be seen. A warm, gusty wind had arisen and
was blustering through the widely spaced houses. The sky was overcast. And from
the southward came a continual flickering of lightning and dull grumbling of
thunder. And it was very hot. His pelt was damp with perspiration, and beneath
it his skin prickled with an almost unendurable irritation.
"Shall I help you down
with her?" he asked.
"No.
I'll manage. But you might put the lights on and start some water heating on
your way to the street."
In
Evanee's bedroom Angam flicked with his thumb the lever of her table lamp. The
spark caught at once, there were a few seconds of hissing and spluttering and then
the incandescent mantle passed swiftly from red heat to a soft, white light. In
the kitchen the boiler gave no trouble. Nevertheless he assured himself, before
going out, that the oil reservoir was full. He felt rather proud of his levelheadedness.
Outside his street door he seized the clapper
of the bell that would summon the messenger for this locality. For a few
seconds the deep note reverberated, then he stopped ringing and waited for the
almost silent approach of the motorcycle, the bright beam of the headlamp
sweeping up the pathway to his door.
Again
he rang, and yet again. But for all the effect his summons had he might just as
well have been upon one of the uninhabited islands to the far east. He guessed
what was wrong. All the messenger boys would be gathered in some quiet corner,
out of the wind,
FALSE DAWN 7TJ
discussing
eagerly the signs and wonders that had blazed so terrify-ingly in the dawn sky.
Grumbling
a little he went to the outhouse in which he kept his car. As he backed out he
saw that, in spite of the heavy overcast and the rain that was beginning to
fall, it was almost light. As he drove down to the road the rain started to
come down in earnest. Even in the gray light it seemed almost luminous, and as
it fell there was a hissing and a crackling and a running of little blue
sparks along the ground.
But
Angam was in no mood to notice these things. He drove as fast as he dared,
peering stolidly ahead through the almost solid sheets of water, his wheels
casting a continuous fountain of spray on either side. At last he found that
for which he was seeking—a column on which was mounted a curiously
conventionalized little piece of statuary depicting a man holding in his hands
a great flask. He turned sharp right, splattered up the drive to the house
among its wet, weather-beaten trees.
At his pull of the lanyard at the door he
heard a gong somewhere within boom sonorously. Impatiently he waited, shifting
from one foot to the other whilst the torrential rain made rivulets down
through the close, thick fur of his body.
It was a woman who answered.
"The doctor," he said, before she
could speak. "It's my wife, Evanee Matangu. It's her first child. It
shouldn't have come for another month. It was the shock of—"
"It was a shock for all of us."
She
turned, called into the house—"Handrin! Another maternity case!"
"Coming!
Has he got a car?" "Yes. You won't need yours."
Little remained for the doctor to do when,
finally, Angam succeeded in navigating the flooded streets to his home. Evanee
was in bed and with her, a tiny morsel of yellow furred humanity, was her first
son. All that remained for Handrin to do was to enter the date and time of the
birth in his book, to act as witness when Angam formally named the child.
Linith
brought wine, poured a flagon for herself, Evanee and each of the men. Mother
and father dipped fingers into each other's flagons,
28 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
then
each, with wine moistened index finger, touched the forehead of the infant.
"I name you
Abrel," said Angam.
"I name you
Abrel," said Evanee.
Then all raised their
flagons.
"To
the new life," they said. "May it be as fair and as good as ours has been!"
"I would sleep," said Evanee.
"Then
sleep," said the doctor. "And you need have no worry abot Abrel.
Perhaps he was a little premature—but that I doubt. As far as I can judge he is quite normal. Feed him as you would any other child*
Sleep well."
They adjourned to the living room. Here
Linith had spread a simple
meal of bread and wine. The doctor needed no urging to stay and break his
fast—outside the wind was howling and driving the rain in streaming sheets
against wall and window.
Normally,
on these occasions, conversation would inevitably have been about the new life
that had come into the world. But on this morning there was only one possible
topic—Loana and the dramatically tragic fate that had overtaken her.
Angam
mentioned the strange prickling he had felt on his skin just after the
disaster.
"Yes," said Handrin, "I felt
it too. And I have felt it before—"
"Where?"
"You know the country around
Boondrom?"
"No.
I have often meant to spend a vacation there—although, they tell me, there is
little to see these days. Boondrom is almost extinct."
"The
volcano is the least interesting thing. A few miles to the west there is a
rocky plain. It is barren, and at night shines with a strange luminescence. Around its outskirts
are stunted, misshapen plants and shrubs. They are pallid, unhealthy, and it is
hard to determine their species. And there is always heat there—a dry,
scorching heat. Although this may be volcanic.
"But if you venture over this plain you
feel the same unpleasant prickling as we all felt when Loana went up in flames.
If you stay there too long it is literally unendurable—and persists. I have
treated too daring, or foolhardy, explorers of this region. Their fur has
fallen out all over their bodies. Their skin has—rotted. They have become
blind."
"And what could you do
for them?"
"What could I do for them ? The sleep of peaces—that is all."
FALSE DAWN 29
"So you think-?"
"I don't know what to think. But it
seems to me that there must be power there—power of some kind. Perhaps power
such as Lingrud, with his zinc plates and jars of acid has discovered—the power
of the lightning. Or perhaps it has other applications. There is heat there— if
that could be harnessed and used to drive a steam turbine, what need for
elaborate oil furnaces ? It would put Mang's heavier than air flying machine
into the realm of practical politics."
"But Loana—"
"I'm coming to that. Suppose the
Loanans—whoever or whatever they were—had this power. Suppose, in their final
struggle for the last air and water, they used this power for weapons to
destroy each other. And suppose, at the finish, it got out of hand—what
then?"
"But such power is
inconceivable, doctor I"
"So was the power that wiped Loana clean
of life—that, for all we know, blew her to fragments."
"Blew her to
fragments? But—the tides!"
Angam
looked at the clock—then remembered that he had forgotten to wind its weights
up the previous night. But, time or no time, his place was at his power storage
plant when anything threatened his source of power. Linith and the doctor heard
the door slam as he hastened out into the storm; faintly, above the wind and
the rain, heard his splashing progress down the pathway to the road.
"I
hope that Loana is still with us," said the doctor. "Otherwise
Lingrud will have to get ahead fast with his experiments—or we shall have to
move Darnala to Boondrom!"
At Boondrom was a small settlement, taking
its name from the volcano. Guides lived there, and a few scientists, and those
who maintained the hostels for tourists. There was railway communication with
Darnala and with Tirona, although most visitors preferred to come by air. The
last few miles of the rail journey were both hazardous and uncomfortable—the
still frequent earth tremors did no good to the permanent way.
But
Boondrom's days of glory were over. The crater was crusted thick with drab
slag, only an occasional wisp of steam from an infrequent crack told of the
fires slumbering quiescent in the depths.
The
sleeping giant no longer attracted the casual sightseer. The arid, sterile
plains to the westward had even less to recommend them to the holiday maker—yet
the hostels of Boondrom were full. Lingrud
30 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
was
there, seeking some connection between the strange powers, sensed rather than
measured, and the half-understood powers he was finding in his jars of acid
with their zinc and carbon plates. Talang, the biologist, was there. It was he
who conceived the idea of inducing a cow and a bull to mate in the middle of
that unhealthy, uncanny expanse of bare rock. The result was even more
grotesque than the examples of plant teratology surrounding the area. And
Talang's fur turned snow white. His assistant was not so lucky. For him—the
sleep of peace.
The
scientists were watching on the summit of Boondrom when the last of Loana's
city lights went out in a blaze of hell fire. Some there were who looked down
to that plain to the westward, saw it flicker with answering, sympathetic
light. Others forced themselves to keep their regard on the eastern heavens,
saw, when the first thin veils of cirrus made vision possible, that the
white-hot sphere was horribly scarred and pitted.
Then,
with the first waves of heat striking the upper atmosphere, the clouds had
swiftly arisen, the winds had striven to duplicate the turbulence of the end of
Loana, and rain and lightning had hidden the sky, with its signs and portents,
from human view.
Long and loud were the conferences held by
the scientists in their hostel on the lower slopes of Boondrom. Long and loud
were their arguments concerning the power that had devastated the sister world.
That this power was man-made—or the work of beings with intelligence
approximating that of humanity—they did not doubt. And the evidence they had
seen of this same power unleashed opened vistas at once exhilarating and
terrifying. The stars were now within reach— unless the world, man's footstool,
were blasted into oblivion.
Power. Power. Power.
What was the power derived from the rise and
fall of the tides, from the burning of mineral or vegetable oil, from litde
glass jars full of acid and zinc and carbon plates, besides this power that
could lick the surface of a world clean of life?
They
did not know the nature of this power. But they had seen it used—and they knew
that what had been done by the ruling species of one world could be done again
by that of another. And with less risk. It seemed obvious that the Loanans had
destroyed themselves by desperate, savage warfare. With the people of Attrin
this could never happen. The race was too kindly, too sane. The only danger
would be unwise, rash experimentation. And surely safeguards could be devised.
In any case it might well be centuries, generations, before the secret of
FALSE DAWN 31
the
Loanans' power was stumbled upon. But it would be a goal to strive for.
It was on the fifth day after the
trans-spacial disaster that the ship came down from Loana.
The sky was still overcast, although the wind
had dropped a little and the rain had ceased. Observers around Mount Boondrom
saw a bright light at their zenith—a light that, although it was high noon, was
almost intolerable to the unshielded eye.
As
it dropped lower it was intolerable. It so happened, however, that in
the village of Boondrom was a fairly large supply of dark spectacles. Those
who investigated the sterile plains to the westward were liable to suffer from
optic disorders—and so it was logical that the local shopkeepers should keep in
stock aids to impaired vision.
The light drifted down very
slowly.
The
watchers on the slopes of the slumbering volcano could, at last, see that it
was under a spindle-shaped structure, metallic, with huge vanes at its lower
end. It was no flying machine such as they had ever seen before. It was no
flying machine such as had ever taken off from the land of Attrin—and to the
north were only the icy, polar wastes, and to the south and west and east were
wild lands peopled only by wild beasts.
This construction, this ship, could be only
one thing.
A
means of escape for some few survivors from Loana, a frail ark in which they
had dared the deeps of space, in which they had defied and conquered the
eternal darkness, escaped the fires of hell that had ravaged their own world.
How it could be done the watchers had no
idea. Of one thing only were they certain—that it would require Power. And that
Loana had possessed such power had been conclusively demonstrated.
Lower
and lower drifted the strange construction, the alien ship. Brighter and
brighter flared the incandescence at its base. Avidly, eagerly, the scientists
scanned the details of its construction, hastily they held the object glasses
of binoculars and telescopes over smoky oil flames, improvised filters that
would enable them to see more than they could hope to see with the naked eye.
Here
was the power of which they had dreamed, drifting down from the storm rent
skies. Here was the power that would give into the hands of their race the keys
to knowledge unguessed, undreamed. Here was the first contact with an alien
folk from an alien world—a contact that could bring nothing good in its wake.
32 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
It seemed at first that the ship from Loana
would fall upon the village of Boondrom—and then that it would fall in the cold
crater of Boondrom itself. But the wind was blowing strong from the eastward,
and it seemed that the strange vessel was making considerable westerly drift.
It may have been that the pilot was avoiding a landing on what, even from the
air, could be identified as the habitation of intelligent beings. And it is
almost certain that he would try to avoid a landing on a mountain peak.
So it was that the alien ship with its tail
of fire dipped behind the shoulder of Boondrom—and with its vanishing it seemed
very dark. And with the abrupt cutting off of the thunder of its passage an ominous
hush fell upon the world.
Some few observers, on the very summit of the
mountain, saw the ship land. They saw the roaring, intolerable flames from its
tail lick the surface of that dead, evil plain—and that is the last that they
ever saw. The instantaneous, searing flare that followed was of too great an
intensity for their minds to register, as was the crash of supernal thunder.
But before the sound waves of the atomic explosion burst their eardrums all
life had been scorched from them.
There were a few survivors in Boondrom
itself. The village collapsed like a pack of cards—those people who were out
of doors were incinerated—those between four walls were crushed by those same
walls. But one or two, those who were under staircases or within doorways,
escaped immediate death. Among these was a pilot of the regular air service to
Darnala. He crawled out of the wreckage almost unhurt. For a while he searched
for others who were still living, tore his hands and broke his nails burrowing
among the wreckage. Those whom he did find— All that he could do was administer
the sleep of peace.
Increasingly
violent earth tremors were completing the destruction caused by the explosion.
From the summit of Boondrom came a growing, expanding pillar of steam, of
smoke, of fire. Then it burst into a shower of debris, a huge mushroom of black
and white and brown vapor that ballooned up to mingle with that of the first
cataclysm. It was then that the pilot realized that he was deaf. He could
see—hazily—but for him the volcano's rebellion and defiance was enacted in
dumb show.
Reeling like one drunken, whimpering a
little, although he did not know it, he made his way to the airport. Most of
the mooring masts were down—and the ships which had swung to them were fast
FALSE DAWN 33
drifting
west, unmanned derelicts destined to fall at last in the sea to the brief wonder of the shark and whale.
One mast remained standing, and to it lay a
little four-passenger ship. The pilot clambered up the ladder to the head of
the mast, swung himself hand over hand to the gondola. He checked his water,
his oil. He worked the lever that would ignite the furnace, looked anxiously at
the gauge that would tell him when he had enough power to get under way.
Already
volcanic debris was falling from the sky. Some of it fell with dull thuds on to
the fabric of the balloon—although the noise he never heard. But he felt the
vibration that trembled through the structure of the ship with every impact.
He thought of cutting adrift—then realized that should he do so the wind would
carry him right over the crater of the furiously erupting Boondrom. And beyond
the volcano— should he survive the passage. The sky was alight with the flaring
incandescence that made the volcanic fires a negation of light by contrast.
The
needle of the gauge quivered, crept with agonizing slowness to the red line. The pilot pulled out the toggle from the eye of his
mooring rope, opened his throtde and fed the steam from his water tube boiler
into the turbines. The screws spun until they became shimmering, transparent
circles. With helm hard over the little airship circled, steadied on a
southeasterly course for Darnala.
When
the man from Boondrom, nursing his battered little ship through the wind, the
lightning and the torrential rain, reached Darnala he found the city in
flames. He was too dazed, too mentally shattered by what he had already
experienced to feel more than a mild surprise. And a dull resentment was there
too, a feeling that it was essentially unfair that he should be the bearer of
unappreciated, almost ignored evil tidings.
When a full twenty miles from the coast he
had become aware that something was wrong. Down the wind came a haze of smoke,
an acrid smell of burning. Sparks glinted and briefly glowed in the gale-driven
murk like evil fireflies. And in the hills to the west of the town a new
volcano spouted lava and boiling mud, so that he was obliged to make a wide
detour to escape being wrecked in the violent updraught.
So
it was that he approached the city from the south. He noted, almost without
interest, the devastation in the harbor. The shipping was lying on its beam
ends, sunk at its moorings with only masts and funnels showing above the heavy
swell that was sweeping in over the
34 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
breakwater.
And surely the breakwater was gone— Certain it was that the watery hosts were
marching in from the east to hurl themselves with unbroken fury upon the quays
and wharves of the port. Only the great Arra\ seemed
undamaged, seaworthy. But she was berthed on the western side of the Dirnig
Mole, partially protected from wind and sea by the low, strong warehouse
running along its length. He could see the little figures of men busy about her
decks, and from her tall smokestack a thin stream of black smoke poured down
wind to mingle with the funeral pall of the doomed city.
Rollers creaked and the ship from Boondrom
lost altitude as the tightening nets compressed the gas in the balloon. The
airport was very close now, and its mooring masts loomed lofty through the
acrid mist. But from each of them swayed and lurched a vast, billowing shape.
Stray mooring lines, flying loose in the gale, coiled and snapped like whips.
On the ground was a crowd of people—dumb, patient, resigned. At a signal from
some official they began to move towards one of the masts. The man from
Boondrom saw the leading trickle of refugees moving up inside the latticework
structure with the slow deliberation of a column of ants on the march.
The little ship circled lower, and still
lower.
At
last one of the airport officials looked up from his work of supervising the
evacuation, raised his megaphone and shouted something. Even if the man from
Boondrom had not been deafened he would never have heard—the shrieking gale,
the whine of giant turbines and the throb of innumerable propellers would have
drowned any sound so puny as that of the human voice.
The
official realized this, and gestured. The meaning of the sweeping motion of
his arm was unmistakable. The incoming ship could not be berthed, would have to
shift for herself as well as she might. The pilot raised his arm in a gesture
of acceptance and farewell. He released the tension on his compressor nets. He
rose swiftly, and the gale took hold of him, drove him down upon the unwieldy
bulk of a ship already more than half loaded with refugees. Putting his helm
hard over, opening the throttle of his starboard engine to its fullest extent,
he strove desperately to avoid collision. He was almost successful, but, as he
swept past and under the big ship's port after power unit, the tips of the
idling propeller blades barely touched the taut upper surface of his gas bag.
He did not fall at once. Even when the gas
was almost gone from the balloon the wind caught him and held him, drove him
parachute-
FALSE DAWN 35
wise
over the burning ruins of the city. And it was on one of the few houses—spared
by some freak of blast—still standing that he finally crashed. His gondola failed
to clear the parapet of the roof, the force of the impact pitched him out and
clear. Had it not been for the plot of soft earth, the roof garden into which
he was thrown, he would have died there and then. As it was, he lay there,
dazed, while above him flapped and crackled the torn rags of silk that had once
been his balloon, while the blazing oil from his engine poured down the side
of the house and was driven by the screaming wind through the already broken
windows.
"He will live, Angam."
The
aviator could not hear the words, but he looked up through his haze of pain,
saw the bearded lips move, dimly guessed what they were saying. The earth
beneath him shook violently—and the stabbing pain from his broken legs and arm,
bound and splinted as they were, made him cry out. Out of the corner of his eye
he saw the shower of sparks as the last ruins of the gutted house collapsed.
"But
to what purpose, Handrin?" demanded the other man. "Attrin is dying.
Those of us still sound may drag out miserable lives for a few more years—or
days. But for him—better the sleep of peace, I say."
"Angam is right,"
said Linith.
Magra,
the doctor's wife, said nothing. And Evanee watched out of wide, fear-crazed
eyes, clutching the infant Abrel to her breast ever more tightly.
"Perhaps
you are right," said Handrin. He fumbled in his pouch, brought out the
little phial in which was the sleep of peace. He withdrew the stopper. His
hand went out, reaching for the aviator's mouth. But the pilot put out a feeble
arm, warded off the merciful oblivion.
"No,"
he gasped, "not yet. I must
tell my story. You must know what happened—"
And
so, slowly, painfully, he told his tale of the disaster at Boon-drom. Told of
the alien ship riding down on its wings of fire and thunder, of the fire and
thunder that had attended its coming to that evil plain to the west of the
volcano. And as he talked, gaspingly, brokenly, the earth tremors grew even
more frequent, the earth tremors and the sensation that the whole world was
tilting beneath them like the deck of a foundering ship.
36 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
When
he had finished he took the deadly draught gladly. His duty was done. He had
told his story, given his unnecessary warning. And it is doubtful if he would
have survived long had he not been given the sleep of peace. But it made his
passing easier.
"So,"
said Handrin, "I think I see. Suppose that there was another deposit of
those same minerals that make the Boondrom plain under the hills to the west of
Darnala— And suppose that by some subterranean vein, the two were connected—
Don't you see ? There is power there—the power that the Loanans used to drive
their ship. And when their ship touched down the fire from the exhausts, the
fire from some strange machine burning that mineral as fuel, touched off the
tons of fuel lying idle at Boondrom. And the spark flashed along the
underground vein, like the little spark along the fuse of a blasting charge.
And the charge was under the hills just inland from the city—"
"But what is happening
now?"
"You should know
better than I, Angam. You are ^n engineer."
"Yes.
Perhaps I should. I know that all Attrin is balanced on the edge of the western
deep like houses on a cliff edge. And I know that there is a line of weakness
in the earth's crust running through Boondrom— And what I know frightens me.
Handrin 1 Attrin is sinking like a great ship!"
"Look!" cried
Linith.
Overhead, rising and falling in their
passage, their line ragged yet, considering the adverse weather conditions,
surprisingly well kept, came a fleet of great ships. The big passenger liners
were there, and the litde freighters, each towing astern its string of
motorless cargo balloons. But the cargo carried on this last occasion was human
lives. Around the fringes of the squadron soared and hovered the tiny pleasure
craft, some so heavily laden as to have the utmost difficulty in maintaining
altitude.
The
leading ship swung as she passed over the center of the city, bore down for the
airport. One by one, sagging to leeward, clawing up into the wind in an attempt
to maintain their line, the rest followed. The throbbing of their propellers
was loud and insistent above the howling of the gale.
"From Tirona,"
said Handrin.
"Tirona is gone,"
replied Angam.
"And they will find no
refuge here.*'
FALSE DAWN 37
They were still sitting in the garden,
finding a little shelter in the lee of the ruins of the house, when the
messenger from the City Fathers found them. His hair was plastered flat against
his body and he was bleeding from a deep cut over his right eye. He accepted
gratefully the flagon of wine passed to him by Linith—she had salvaged some
scraps of food and drink from the wreckage of her home. He drank deeply. Then—
"You are Angam
Matangu?"
•Yes."
"The City Fathers send
you this, Angam Matangu."
Angam
drew the roll of fabric from its cylinder. He read it slowly, his lips
unconsciously shaping the words as his eye ran down the lines of script.
"I
am ordered aboard Arra\"
he said at last. "I
and my family." To the messenger— "Is there any word concerning my
friend Dr. Handrin?"
"I
fear not, Angam Matangu. The City Fathers have drawn up a list—they desire to
save as many representative technicians as possible so that a new civilization
may be set up in the new lands to the east. The quota of physicians and
surgeons is already filled."
"It
is as well," said Handrin. "With Attrin gone—what remains? Magra and
I will sit here among the ruins with our wine and our memories of happiness.
And will you share them?" he asked the messenger.
"It would be an honor—but
I would not intrude."
"Then one last flagon
of wine before we part."
And when Angam and his family trudged down
the long driveway to the road to the port they did not know whether to pity or
envy Handrin and Magra.
Angam was glad that he had not attempted to
make the journey by car. The roads were blocked by piles of wreckage, by fallen
trees. And great crevasses had opened here and there, deep chasms from which
came a sullen rumbling, the acrid fumes of the pit beneath. In one place a
great, roaring geyser was throwing its column of steam and spray high into the
air. Down wind its condensation fell as a scalding rain.
Through
the still smoldering ruins slunk lean, tawny shapes—the beasts from the wild
country driven to the coast by unknown, half-; guessed cataclysms inland. They
saw the half-eaten body of a woman
38 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
with
a lioness crouched over it. The great cat lifted its head and snarled as they
passed. And when they had left the grisly sight behind they heard a great
yelping and snarling—and turned to see a pack of wolves disputing for the
bodies of both hunter and victim.
Evanee
was stumbling and whimpering so, without a word, Angam lifted Abrel from her
grasp. The child set up a thin, dismal howling. "Let me," said
Linith. In her arms the infant was quiet.
Long
before they got to the port the water was over their ankles. As they came down
the broad road to the quays it was knee deep. Some of the smaller craft had
been righted, had been brought far inland. It was fantastic and terrifying to
see ships among what was left of the houses.
But Angam had no eyes for any of these
things. He was trying to follow the once familiar road to the Dirnig Mole—a
road now feet deep beneath the swirling waters. Ahead, her taH funnel a beacon
through the spray and driving rain, lay Arra\. Her
derricks had been lowered; as far as the inexperienced Angam could see at this
distance she was ready for sea. A plume of white steam grew suddenly from her
funnel, but the deep booming note of her whistle was lost in the clamor of wind
and water.
Angam realized that he wanted to be saved.
The drive, the savage will to live, was singularly absent from the make-up of
his race—but now, to him, Arra\ was
Attrin. She was all that remained of the fair civilization that had stood on
the threshold of maturity. She was that
civilization—and would carry its seeds to whatever strange land chance and
storm might bring her.
Putting his head down he waded on stolidly.
Behind him came Evanee, and behind her Linith, the child still in her arms. He
no longer troubled to feel his way with caution—Captain Noab could not afford
to hang on much longer. He had already stayed at his berth far longer than was
prudent. And far more was at stake than his ship, the lives of his passengers
and crew.
Neck
high the water swirled around Angam as he reached for the ropes at the foot of
the gangway. Holding on with his left hand he helped Evanee on to the platform.
Linith handed Abrel up to Evanee, then hoisted herself up after the child. She
and the sailor on duty seized Angam—pulled him up to the grating where he lay
gasping like a landed fish.
An officer came down,
consulted a list.
FALSE DAWN 39
"Twenty more to come," he said,
"but we can't delay much longer."
Together
with his women Angam clambered to the upper deck. The wide expanse was crammed
with refugees. Scorning the warmth and the dryness below they were here to see
the last of their home, their world. The wind buffeted them and the rain stung
and bruised them with its countless driving arrows—yet they could not bring
themselves to seek shelter below decks.
To
the west, beyond the gutted city, the low line of hills spouted flame and
smoke. It seemed that those hills were lower than of old, that they were
sinking, slowly but surely as the land of Attrin foundered and tilted, heeled
to the west as it sank into the unplumbed depths of the western ocean. The
hills were lower—soon the flaring volcanoes were only a
low line of fire along the horizon—red and menacing below the black pall of
smoke.
Some
of the smaller ships, their decks packed tight, cast loose from their
improvised moorings and nosed out to the sea. They passed over the place where
the breakwater had been, turned their blunt noses to meet the steep, vicious
waves. Doggedly they plunged into the weather, spray and green water sweeping
over their superstructures until only their flaring funnels were visible. The
refugees aboard Arra\
watched them go—and watched
with horror the great wall of water that came roaring in from the east.
Steep
it was, and towering high beyond any seaman's experience. The line of foam
along its crest was like the snow along the peaks of some mountain range. The
little ships reared to meet it with the gallantry of the very small—reared and
slid their sterns under.
From
the bridge came a deep and urgent bellowing as Noab shouted orders to his
officers on stations. The wind took his words, shredded them and tossed them
wide in useless, unintelligible fragments. But the crew at bow and stern had
anticipated such an emergency, knew as well as their captain what they must
do. Axes gleamed dully in the lurid light, fell upon the bartaut mooring lines.
Arra\ shuddered and stirred, heaved and lifted to
the smaller seas that were running before the monster sea like foothills before
a mountain range.
Now
only one hawser remained, a rope running aft from the forecastle head, its eye
over a deep submerged bollard on the invisible quay. Noab came ahead on his
engines. Slowly at first, then with increasing speed, the stern came away from
the wharf. Now the on-
40 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
rushing
wall of water was broad on the starboard bow—now it was coming ahead. More
orders from the bridge—and again the axes gleamed. The last rope parted with an
explosive crack, the ends sprang back and cut him who had wielded the ax almost
in two. But Arra\
was free. Using his stern
power Noab swung her to meet the seismic wave.
As had done her sisters—Arra\ reared to meet the monster. Her bows lifted, steeper and ever steeper.
On deck was a scene of terrible confusion as that tightly packed mass of people
fought to keep their footing, slithered helplessly aft on the wet, slippery
planking. Stout rails—designed to stand under almost any weight but this,
snapped under the strain, bodies fell into the sea or tumbled from the upper
deck to crash, maimed and broken, on to the after hatches. From below came the
fear-crazed bellowing of the catde.
But Arra\ fought like a thing alive, her screws bit deep and strong, held the
enormous weight of the ship against that fatal, stern-ward plunge. On her
bridge Noab himself had the wheel, conscious that should he allow Arra\ to sag to port or starboard she would be doomed. As she would be doomed
if one of the two thin pipes running from wheelhouse to steering engine, the
hydraulic system by which the motion of his wheel was imparted to his rudder,
should break or burst.
Over the bow loomed a watery cliff. It broke
and tumbled, surged aft along the foredeck in a boiling cascade. It hit the
bridge structure like something solid—and Noab found himself sprawled, with his
officers and quartermasters, against the after bulkhead of the wheelhouse. The
broken wheel was still in his hands. Before he could regain his feet Arrays bow dipped, sickeningly, dreadfully. Thirty thousand tons deadweight—she
slid down the seaward slope of the ocean mountain with uncontrolled,
uncontrollable acceleration. When she reached the trough it was as though she
had been driven ashore at full speed. Pipes burst, rivets rattled around her
decks and compartments like machine gun fire. To the general tumult was added
the hissing roar of escaping steam.
Only a few of those aft saw the end of
Attrin. The hills to the west of Darnala subsided, and over them poured the
full weight of the western ocean. Seismic wave from the east met seismic wave
from the west—and the pillar of water and steam and wreckage surged bellowing
to the low clouds, locking down such few airships as still hovered over the
scene of the tragedy, as had not been blown west to
FALSE DAWN 41
perish
in the hell of steam and whirlwind and atomic fire over Boon-drom.
And
like a crippled beast Arra\
moved over the face of the
waters —aimless, riding out the storm, a ship without a haven.
In his plain, solidly furnished stateroom
Noab sat at the head of his table. Around him were his officers—reflecting
their master's mood of grave concern. At the lower end of the table were the
representatives of the refugees.
"But where are we, Noab?" It was
Angam who spoke, an Angam much older than the man who had boarded Arra\ on the Day of the Ending. His pelt was liberally sprinkled with
silver—and yet a bare thirty days had passed since he had come aboard the ship.
"I
wish that I knew, Angam Matangu. Since the sky cleared we have obtained
accurate latitudes. As you know—longitude cannot, unless we can devise a clock
that is a perfect timekeeper, be determined. And it has been impossible to
estimate what easting we have made since The End. It is possible that the
indraught into the gulf where Attrin once was has more than canceled the
distance steamed from Attrin.
"But I intend to steer east. We cannot
steer west for obvious reasons—it would mean passing over the grave of our
homeland and, for all we know, the volcanoes are still active. On this course
we must find land sooner or later.
"Now—
Food and water. Regarding these the situation is good. So great has been our
death roll that we have now a bare half of the two thousand originally
provisioned for.
"Fuel—
That is the problem. We have enough for about ten days steaming at reduced
speed. I need hardly tell you gentlemen—most of you are engineers—that the
consumption varies, roughly, as the cube of the speed. To put it crudely I
intend to go a long way in a long time.
"Starting
from tomorrow we shall send the small aircraft we carry on reconnaissance
flights.
"And more than that we
cannot do."
"You
have done more than any other man could have done, Noab." There was a
general murmur of approbation from the foot of the table. "You have
snatched some faint memory of the happiness that was Attrin from the burning,
and you will see the seeds of the new Attrin planted in the islands of the east
I"
42 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
Noab
rose to his feet. He seemed to be deeply moved. He signaled to a girl who was
standing by a locker against the after bulkhead. From it she took jars and
flagons, handed wine to the captain and to each of his guests.
"To
the new Attrin," toasted Angam. "To the new dawn of civilization
besides which this that has just perished will be the false dawn!"
"To the true
dawn!"
Solitary, a ship by herself, Arra\ moved over the face of the waters. Her once clean hull was streaked
with rust, the crimson funnel with its golden lion was salt-caked and dingy. To
the west the afterglow painted the sky with pale fire. Eastward, among the
first, faint stars, was a little light that bobbed and dipped, that wove among
the fixed constellations, that steadily waxed in brightness.
The
whine of an aircraft turbine was heard, the throbbing of aerial propellers. The
little airship circled the surface vessel. It came in from astern, hovered
above the after deck, matched course and speed with its mother ship. From it
snaked down a plummet weighted line. The sailors caught it, took it to a winch.
Swaying on the end of its tether like a child's toy balloon the little airship
was drawn down to the deck. Willing hands seized the lines pendant from its
gondola, threw hasty turns around cleats and bollards. When his craft was
securely moored the pilot clambered down to the gently rising and falling
planking. His keen eyes distinguished in the dusk the one he was looking for.
"Captain Noab! Sir! Land!"
The
cry went round the ship like wildfire. Long before Noab and his aviator in the
chartroom had determined such matters as course and speed every man, woman and
child in the vessel knew that their voyaging was almost ended. Even the
livestock below decks seemed to sense it—there arose a clamorous bellowing from
their stalls that had nothing in it of fear or apprehension.
On his bridge Noab walked to the binnacle,
peered into its dimly lighted bowl. "Steer South Ninety-Five East,"
he ordered the quartermaster. One of the officers was speaking into a voice
pipe. "Revolutions for five knots, please," he said.
In his cramped quarters Angam sat with Evanee
and Linith.
"Land,"
he said. In his voice was wonder that there should be any solidity left in the
world.
FALSE DAWN 43
"And
about time," grumbled Evanee. "I don't believe that that old man Noab
ever knew where we were!"
"But what sort of
land?" Linith, as always, was practical.
"The
airman said that there were hills, and forests, and streams. But to the west it
was bare and glistening, like the ooze of the ocean bed. It seemed that it was
still rising from the sea."
"Something must rise,
I suppose, to balance Attrin."
"What does it matter ?
We have found a new home."
"And when do we get
there?"
"The
captain has reduced speed"—at this there was a cry of indignation from
Evanee—"he does not want to arrive before dawn."
It
was not only Evanee who was incensed by Noab's caution. Throughout the ship ran
the impatient murmuring, the indignant whispers. The rails were lined by people
peering ahead into the darkness. Overhead rode Loana, not far from the full,
her once smooth face scarred and pitted. On any other night the spectacle of the
seared sister world, still dreadfully novel, would have held the eye of every
observer. But not on this night. Every low dark cloud along the eastern
horizon was hailed as the long desired and anticipated landfall— and every low
dark cloud that lifted from the rim of the world made all beholders prey to the
uneasy suspicion that the pilot of the little airship had been the victim of an
hallucination.
But,
recking little of the hopes and fears of her living freight, the ship ploughed
steadily on. From aft, at regular intervals, came the whine of the little steam
winch as the questing plummet, having failed in its search for bottom, was
hauled once more to the taffrail. From the bridge, deep, sonorous, came the
sound of the gong as the last watches of the voyage tolled each its own
requiem.
At
about an hour before dawn Arra\ struck.
It was not a violent jar—as strandings go it was very gentle. The ship slid
forward slowly, then stopped. The great screws threshed in reverse—but Arra\ did not move. From the stern a depth of ninety fathoms was obtained— but
along the sides, from forward to as far aft as the mainmast, there was a bare
thirty-five feet. And this was Arrays draught.
On
the bridge the tired old man who wore on his wrists the gold bracelets of authority
heard the latest reports, then said—"There is nothing more for me to do. I
have found land for them. The ship is safe. Today, or tomorrow, or the day
after, the land will have risen still further—and they will be able to walk
ashore. And I have thrown away my ship."
44 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
One
of his officers suggested laying out an anchor astern, the jettison of stores
and ballast, but the captain refused to listen.
"No,"
he said. "The purpose of this, our last voyage, has been fulfilled. This
is our last port. And nowhere, in all the world, is there another haven for
us."
With
the first flush of dawn the water fell still further, and as the wan light
increased so did the depth of water around the ship decrease. From aft came
ominous creakings as the stern hanging clear of the ledge with no support,
began to sag and buckle. But only the seamen were concerned with this. The
refugees crowded the decks, staring ahead to the promised land. They saw the
green hills and the trees, the river that poured itself over the golden sand of
the beach and then spread itself over the gray slime of what had been the ocean
bed.
Some
were already over the side, clambering down the hastily improvised ladders,
floundering waist deep in the stinking ooze. Overhead the little airship
circled, its balloon glowing golden in the first rays of Ramanu. And the ship
that had served them so faithfully was no more than a prison from which they
proposed to escape with the utmost possible speed.
Angam Matangu sat outside his hut on the
westward slopes of Mount Arrak. The ship after which the hill was named, the
mountain that had been upthrust from the ocean depths silently and smoothly,
was now little more than a mound of rusted girders and ruined, useless
machinery—standing silent among the rank grasses, a mute witness to the high
estate from which Man had fallen.
Yet
Angam was content. Blue in the evening air rose the thin smoke of the cooking
fires where the women of the tribe prepared the evening meal. Around him were
his fields—the ground from which he had wrested, by the sweat of his brow
throughout the long, hard years, sustenance for his family and himself. Linith
was gone—but it was pleasant to sit here and remember her. He wrinkled his
hairy brows—gray now—in an effort to recall how many winters ago that had been.
She had been too civilized for this life, had
Linith. But Evanee— it was surprising how she had hardened. Yes—a wry smile
flickered over his broad mouth—and coarsened. But she had the qualities that
made for survival until the race should recover from the shock of its near
extinction, should begin once more the long climb upwards to mechanized
civilization.
FALSE DAWN 45
Abrel appeared on the slope of the hill,
climbed upwards to his father with long, easy strides. He sat down beside the
older man, pulled a generous bunch off the spray of berries that he was
carrying and gave them to him.
"Thank you, Abrel. These are good."
'Yes. I was thinking that we might take
cuttings and try to cul* tivate the bushes in our own garden." "By
all means, son."
For a while the two sat in
silence. Then—
"What is the trouble
between you and Carran?"
"Trouble ? Why, there
is no trouble, Father."
"Evanee told me that you had been
interfering with him, would not let him live his life his own way."
"Suppose
that way is altogether alien from what we consider right?"
"Oh.
So there has been trouble between you and your brother. Just what was it?"
"It
would have come to the ears of the Village Fathers sooner or later. It is all
these people who were born after the Day of the Ending. You must know that
they are different."
"Physically,
yes. They are smooth and hairless. Their bodies are frail. And they move around
so quickly that they will be worn out before they reach maturity."
"But
it's more than physical, father. It's here." The young man tapped his
head. "Do you know what I found them doing? Carran and Dorilee and Turbal?
They had taken a cow from the herd of Drinrud, and they had slit its throat
with a sharp instrument they had made from the metal of the Arra\. And they were cutting off great pieces of the bleeding flesh—and they
were eating it!"
"Abrel!"
"But it's true, Father. And when I
stopped them they were ashamed—but I saw a look in their eyes that wasn't
human. Have you ever looked into the eyes of a trapped rat ? And seen the
dreadful, sickening hate there? It was like that."
"Hate,"
muttered the old man. "We do not hate. We cannot. Yet—" His mind winged back to the evil
plain west of Boondrom, to the plant monsters encircling it, to the power of
the plain and the power that had blasted Loana and that had sunk Attrin. He
thought of the new hairless folk that had been born since the Day of the Ending—of
them and of the other children scarce more intelligent than
46 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
the
beasts. He thought of the arrogance of these new hairless folk, of their drive
and ambition, of the unhuman intensity of their emotions. Yet, one of them was
his son—and was beloved by Evanee.
"I
must think this over," he muttered. "Tomorrow I will call a meeting
of the Village Fathers."
But the next day was too late.
Late
that night he was awakened by Evanee. She bent over his bed, the bed in which
he was sunk deep in a nostalgic dream of Attrin. She shook him, gently at
first, then roughly. "Linith," he said, half awake.
"Linith."
"It's me, you old fool. It is long past
the tenth hour, and neither Abrel nor Carran are in."
"What of it? They are old enough to look
after themselves."
"Yes.
But you don't know all of it. Abrel has been interfering with Carran and his
friends. I am afraid that he may have done them some hurt."
And
Angam was afraid, but not for Carran. He arose hastily, cast around him a robe
against the night chill. Swifdy for one of his bulk he padded to the doo.way of
the hut, bent his head under the low lintel and passed outside.
The
sky was clear and Loana was at the full. The ghastly silver face shone with a
hard radiance, casting black shadows from huts and trees and rocks. It was very
quiet.
The
old man paused, listening intently. It seemed to him that from a black copse on
the upper slopes of the hill came the noise of chanting. There was some quality
about it, evil, alien, that made every hair of his body stand erect. He
hesitated—then reached inside his doorway for the metal-tipped sapling that
served both as spear and staff. The feel of the rough haft of his weapon in his
hand was comforting.
Swiftly,
silently, he climbed the hill. More slowly, but still silently, he crept
through the undergrowth of the coppice. A lane of trees had been cut down in a
north-south direction, and at the northern end was a stone slab. There was
something tied on the slab, something dark. It lay in the shadows cast by the
hairless folk around the altar.
One of them was Carran.
Held
high in his right hand was something that glinted. He faced away from the slab,
faced south so that the rays of Loana shone full in his face.
FALSE DAWN 47
"Mother
Loana, behold us, thy children," he cried. "Mother Loana, behold us,
thy children, "Spawned of the thunder, the flame and the flood— "Lift
us to sit with thee, "Smite thou our enemy—
"Let
the sins of our fathers be washed out in blood!"
The
group before the altar parted. Behind it was revealed the girl Dorilee. In the
masses of her black hair was bound a crescent of shining silver. And in the
light of Loana her body shone as silvery bright as Loana herself.
In
her right hand was a long knife.
And
the thing on the altar trussed and gagged was Abrel.
Angam
moved fast—but not fast enough. The knife had buried itself in AbrePs heart
before he had broken through the undergrowth. At first those around the
sacrifice did not notice him—then Carran turned. His right hand, that held a
knife like that used by Dorilee, swept forward. Angam parried with his spear,
caught his son a resounding blow on the right temple. The young man staggered
and fell to the ground.
Immediately
the hairless folk were all around the old man. They were weak—but they were
many. They pinioned his arms to his sides, one of them grasped the hair of his
head and pulled it back to stretch his neck for the eager knife.
But
Carran, raising himself on one elbow, called to his followers to stop.
"It
is my father," he said. "Do not harm him." "But Abrel was
your brother." "No matter. Him I hated."
He
took the old man's spear, leaned upon it like a staff. In spite of his youth an
almost visible mantle of authority seemed to descend upon him.
"I
am sorry, father," he said, "but it is best that we—I and my people—go. We are too
alike—and too unlike—to live in peace. Besides—we know that you and your
fellows, by your neglect of Loana, who craves worship, brought upon yourselves
the fire and the flood. We can live no longer with unbelievers."
"Then
go," said Angam.
There
was nothing more to be said. Carran and his people trooped silently from the
clearing. Angam watched them go, their pale forms flitting down the hillside.
He wondered dimly what they would make
48 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
of
it all—whether they would, in the fullness of time, attain the heights of lost
Attrin. He could not say—balanced against their undoubted drive was their emotional
instability, their queer, unbalanced beliefs, the savagery that might as easily
cast them into the depths as force them, fighting tooth and nail, to the peaks.
Angam
sat by the altar and the dead body of his son Abrel—an old man and tired. The
night was chill and he drew his robe ever closer about him. The stars shone
scintillant in the clear sky. Loana slowly slipped from the meridian and
dipped, lower and lower, to the western horizon. In the east fresh constellations
rose and wheeled in slow processional towards the zenith. A wan light, ghostly,
seemingly darker than the starry darkness, waxed slowly. And as the old man
rose stiffly to his feet it was already fading.
"The false dawn,"
he muttered into his beard. "The false dawn—"
Were Carran and his kind,
then, the true dawn ?
Or would they play out, here on Earth, the
tragic drama that had made the Moon a scarred and pitted horror—unleash powers
that would send the world reeling forever through time and space, a seared and
sterile mausoleum of the hopes and fears of the ages?
After
Attrin Man reverted
to savagery, his scientific knowledge forgotten. The first ice age came and
went, completing the destruction of the historical past. In the difficult
periods which followed neither the past nor the future seemed to matter.
Slowly, however, Mans aspirations flickered to life and grew into a
civilization so mighty that it blan\eted the world. Technician though he was,
he had yet to conquer himself.
ATLANTIS
by Edward E. Smith, Ph.D.
A |
riponides, recently elected Faros of Atlantis for his ^ third five-year term, stood at a
widow of his office atop the towering Farostery. His hands were clasped loosely
behind his back. He did not really see the tremendous expanse of quiet ocean,
nor the bustling harbor, nor the metropolis spread out so magnificently and so
busily beneath him. He stood there, motionless, until a subde vibration warned
him that visitors were approaching his door.
"Come
in, gentlemen . . . Please be seated." He sat down at one
end of a table molded of transparent plastic. "Psychologist Talmon-ides,
Statesman Cleto, Minister Philamon, Minister Marxes and Officer Artomenes, I have asked you to come here personally because I have every reason to believe that the shielding of this room is proof
against eavesdroppers; a thing which no longer can be said of our supposedly
private television channels. We must discuss, and if possible come to some
decision concerning, the state in which our nation now finds itself.
"Each of us knows within himself exactly
what he is. Of our own powers, we cannot surely know each others' inward
selves. The tools and techniques of psychology, however, are potent and exact;
and Talmonides, after exhaustive and rigorous examination of each one of us,
has certified that no taint of disloyalty exists among us."
"Which
certification is not worth a damn," the burly Officer declared.
"What assurance do we have that Talmonides himself is not
50 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
one
of the ringleaders? Mind you, I have no reason to believe that he is not
completely loyal. In fact, since he has been one of my best friends for over
twenty years, I believe implicitly that he is. Nevertheless the plain fact is,
Ariponides, that all the precautions you have taken, and any you can take, are
and will be useless insofar as definite knowledge is concerned. The real truth
is and will remain unknown."
"You
are right," the Psychologist conceded. "And, such being the case,
perhaps I should withdraw from the meeting."
"That
wouldn't help, either." Artomenes shook his head. "Any competent
plotter would be prepared for this, as for any other contingency. One of us
others would be the real operator."
"And
the fact that our Officer is the one who is splitting hairs so finely could be
taken to indicate which one of us the real operator could be," Marxes
pointed out, cuttingly.
"Gentlemen!
Gentlemen!" Ariponides protested. "While absolute certainty is of
course impossible to any finite mind, you all know how Talmonides was tested;
you know that in his case there is no reasonable doubt. Such chance as exists,
however, must be taken, for if we do not trust each other fully in this
undertaking, failure is inevitable. With this word of warning I will get on
with my report.
"This
world-wide frenzy of unrest followed closely upon the controlled liberation of
atomic energy and may be—probably is—traceable to it. It is in no part due to
imperialistic aims or acts on the part of Atlantis. This fact cannot be
stressed too strongly. We never have been and are not now interested in Empire.
It is true that the other nations began as Atlantean colonies, but no attempt
was ever made to hold any one of them in colonial status against the wish of
its electorate. All nations were and are sister states. We gain or lose
together. Atlantis, the parent, was and is a clearing-house, a co-ordinator of
effort, but has never claimed or sought authority to rule; all decisions being
based upon free debate and free and secret ballot.
"But
now! Parties and factions everywhere, even in old Atlantis. Every nation is
torn by internal dissensions and strife. Nor is this all. Uighar as a nation is
insensately jealous of the Island of the South, who in turn is jealous of Maya.
Maya of Bantu, Bantu of Ekopt, Ekopt of Norheim, and Norheim of Uighar. A
vicious circle, worsened by other jealousies and hatreds intercrossing
everywhere. Each fears that some other is about to try to seize control of the
entire world; and there seems to be spreading rapidly the utterly baseless
belief that
ATLANTIS 51
Atlantis
itself is about to reduce all other nations of Earth to vassalage.
"This is a bald statement of the present
condition of the world as I see it. Since I can see no other course possible
within the constituted framework of our democratic government, I recommend
that we continue our present activities, such as the international treaties and
agreements upon which we are now at work, intensifying our effort wherever
possible. We will now hear from Statesman Cleto."
"You
have outlined the situation clearly enough, Faros. My thought, however, is that
the principal cause of the trouble is the coming into being of this
multiplicity of political parties, particularly those composed principally of
crackpots and extremists. The connection with atomic energy is clear: since the
atomic bomb gives a small group of people the power to destroy the world, they
reason that it thereby confers upon the authority to dictate to the world. My
recommendation is merely a special case of yours; that every effort be made to
influence the electorates of Norheim and of Uighar into supporting an effective
international control of atomic energy."
"You have your data tabulated in
symbolics?" asked Talmonides, from his seat at the keyboard of a
calculating machine.
"Yes. Here they
are."
"Thanks."
"Minister Philamon," the Faros
announced.
"As I see it—as any intelligent man
should be able to see it—the principal contribution of atomic energy to this
world-wide chaos was the complete demoralization of labor," the
gray-haired Minister of Trade stated, flatly. "Output per man-hour should
have gone up at least twenty per cent, in which case prices would automatically
have come down. Instead, short-sighted guilds imposed drastic curbs on
production, and now seem to be surprised that as production falls and hourly
wages rise, prices also rise and real income drops. Only one course is
possible, gentlemen; labor must be made to listen to reason., This
feather-bedding, this protected loafing, this . • ."
"I
protest!" Marxes, Minister of Work, leaped to his feet. "The blame
lies squarely with the capitalists. Their greed, their rapacity,, their
exploitation of . . ."
"One moment, please!" Ariponides
rapped the table sharply. "It is highly significant of the deplorable
condition of the times that two Ministers of State should speak as you two have
just spoken. I take it
52 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
that
neither of you has anything new to contribute to this symposium ?"
Both claimed the floor, but
both were refused it by vote.
"Hand
your tabulated data to Talmonides," the Faros directed. "Officer
Artomenes?"
"You, our Faros, have more than
intimated that our defense program, for which I am primarily responsible, has
been largely to blame for what has happened," the grizzled warrior began.
"In part, perhaps it was—one must be blind indeed not to see the connection,
and biased indeed not to admit it. But what should I have done, knowing that
there is no practical defense against atomic bombs? Every nation has them, and
is manufacturing more and more. Every nation is infested with the agents of
every other. Should I have tried to keep Atlantis toothless in a world
bristling with fangs? And could I—or anyone else—have succeeded in doing
so?"
"Probably
not. No criticism was intended; we must deal with the situation as it actually
exists. Your recommendations, please?"
"I
have thought this thing over day and night, and can see no solution which can
be made acceptable to our—or to any real—democracy. Nevertheless, I have one
recommendation to make. We all know that Norheim and Uighar are the sore spots,
particularly Norheim. We have more bombs as of now than both of them together.
We know that Uighar's supersonic jobs are ready. We don't know exacdy what
Norheim has, since they cut my Intelligence line a while back, but I'm sending
over another operative—my best man, too—tonight. If he finds out that we have
enough advantage in speed, and I'm pretty sure that we have, I say hit both
Norheim and Uighar right then, while we can, before they hit us. And hit them
hard—pulverize them. Then set up a world government strong enough to knock out
any nation— including Atlantis—that will not cooperate with it. This course of
action is flagrantly against all international law and all the principles of
democracy, I know; and even it might not work. It is, however, as far as I can
see, the only course which can work."
"You—we all—perceive its
weaknesses." The Faros thought for minutes. "You cannot be sure that
your Intelligence has located all of the danger points, and many of them must
be so far underground as to be safe from even our heaviest missiles. We all,
including you, believe that the Psychologist is right in holding that the
reaction of the other nations to such action would be both unfavorable and violent.
Your report, please. Talmonides."
ATLANTIS 53
"I
have already put my data into the integrator." The Psychologist punched a
button and the mechanism began to whir and to click. "I have only one new
fact of any importance; the name of one of the higher-ups and its corollary
implication that there may be some degree of cooperation between Norheim and
Uighar . .
He
broke off as the machine stopped clicking and ejected its report
"Look
at that graph—up ten points in seven days!" Talmonides pointed a finger.
"The situation is deteriorating faster and faster. The conclusion is unavoidable—you
can see yourselves that this summation line is fast approaching unity—that the
outbreaks will become uncontrollable in approximately eight days. With one
slight exception— here—you will notice that the lines of organization and
purpose are as random as ever. In spite of this conclusive integration I would
be tempted to believe that this seeming lack of coherence was due to
insufficient data—that back of this whole movement there is a carefully set-up
and completely integrated plan—except for the fact that the factions and the
nations are so evenly matched. But the data are sufficient. It is shown
conclusively that no one of the other nations can possibly win, even by totally
destroying Atlantis. They would merely destroy each other and our entire
civilization. According to this forecast, in arriving at which the data
furnished by our Officer were prime determinants, that will surely be the
outcome unless remedial measures be taken at once. You are of course sure of
your facts, Artomenes?"
"I am sure. But you said you had a name,
and that it indicated a Norheim-Uighar hookup. What is that name?"
"An old friend of yours . . ."
"Lo Sung!" The words as spoken were
a curse of fury.
"None other. And, unfortunately, there
is as yet no course of action indicated which is at all promising of
success."
"Use mine, then!" Artomenes jumped
up and banged the table with his fist. "Let me send two flights of rockets
over right now that will blow Uigharstoy and Norgrad into radioactive dust and
make a thousand square miles around the only way they can learn anything; let
them learn!"
"Sit
down, Officer," Ariponides directed, quietly. "That course, as you
have already pointed out, is indefensible. It violates every Prime Basic of our
civilization. Moreover, it would be entirely futile, since
54 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
this
resultant makes it clear that every nation on Earth would be destroyed within
the day."
"What,
then?" Artomenes demanded, bitterly. "Sit still here and let them
annihilate us?"
"Not
necessarily. It is to formulate plans that we are here. Tal-monides will by now
have decided, upon the basis of our pooled knowledge, what must be done."
"The
outlook is not good, not good at all," the Psychologist announced,
gloomily. "The only course of action which carries any promise whatever of
success—and its probability is only point one eight—is the one recommended by
the Faros, modified slightly to include Artomenes* suggestion of sending his
best operative on the indicated mission. For highest morale, by the way, the
Faros should also interview this agent before he sets out. Ordinarily I would
not advocate a course of action having so little likelihood of success; but
since it is simply a continuation and intensification of what we are already doing,
I do not see how we can adopt any other."
"Are we agreed?"
Ariponides asked, after a short silence.
They
were agreed. Four of the conferees filed out and a brisk young man strode in.
Although he did not look at the Faros his eyes asked questions.
"Reporting for orders,
sir." He saluted the Officer punctiliously.
"At
ease, sir." Artomenes returned the salute. "You were called here for
a word from the Faros. Sir, I present Captain Phryges."
"Not
orders, son . . . no." Ariponides' right hand rested in greeting upon the
captain's left shoulder, wise old eyes probed deeply into gold flecked, tawny
eyes of youth; the Faros saw, without really noticing, a flaming thatch of
red-bronze-auburn hair. "I asked you here to wish you well; not only for
myself, but for all our nation and perhaps for our entire race. While everything
in my being rebels against an unprovoked and unannounced assault, we may be
compelled to choose between our Officer's plan of campaign and the destruction
of civilization. Since you already know the vital importance of your mission, I
need not enlarge upon it. But I want you to know fully, Captain Phryges, that
all Atlantis flies with you this night."
"Th
. . . thank you, sir." Phryges gulped twice to steady his voice.
"I'll do my best, sir."
And
later, in a wingless craft flying toward the airfield, young Phryges broke a
long silence. "So that
is the Faros • • . I like
him, Officer ... I have never seen
him close up before . . . there's some-
ATLANTIS 55
thing
about him ... He isn't like my
father, much, but it seems as though I have known him for a thousand years
I"
"Hm
... m
... m. Peculiar. You two are a lot
alike, at that, even though you don't look anything like each other. . . .
Can't put a finger on exactly what it is, but it's there." Although
Artomenes, or any other of his time, could not place it, the resemblance was
indeed there. It was in and back of the eyes; it was the "look of
eagles." "But here we are, and your ship's ready. Luck, son."
"Thanks,
sir. But one more thing. If it should—if I don't get back—will you see that my
wife and the baby are . . . ?"
"I
will, son. They will leave for North Maya tomorrow morning. They will live,
whether you and I do or not, Anything else?"
"No, sir. Thanks.
Goodbye."
The ship was a tremendous flying wing. A
standard commercial job. Empty—passengers, even crewmen, were never subjected
to the brutal accelerations regularly used by unmanned carriers. Phryges
scanned the panel. Tiny motors were pulling tapes through the controllers.
Every light showed green. Everything was set. Donning a water-proof coverall,
he slid through a flexible valve into his acceleration-tank and waited.
A
siren yelled briefly. Black night turned blinding white as the harnessed
energies of the atom were released. For five and six-tenths seconds the sharp,
hard, beryllium-bronze leading edge of the back-sweeping V sliced its way
through ever-thinning air.
The
vessel seemed to pause momentarily; paused and bucked viciously. She shuddered
and shivered, tried to tear herself into shreds and chunks; but Phryges in his
tank was unconcerned. Earlier, weaker ships went to pieces against the
solid-seeming wall of atmospheric incompressibility at the velocity of sound;
but this one was built solidly enough, and powered to hit that wall hard
enough, to go through unharmed.
The
hellish vibration ceased; the fantastic violence of the drive subsided to a
mere shove; Phryges knew that the vessel had leveled off at its cruising speed
of two thousand miles per hour. He emerged, spilling the least possible amount
of water upon the polished steel floor. He took off his coverall and stuffed it
back through the valve into the tank. He mopped and polished the floor with
towels, which likewise went into the tank.
He
drew on a pair of soft gloves and by manual control jettisoned the acceleration
tank and all the apparatus which had made that un-
56 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
loading
possible. This junk would fall into the ocean; would sink, would never be
found. He examined the compartment and the hatch minutely. No scratches, no
scars, no mars; no tell-tale marks or prints of any kind. Let the Norskies
search. So far, so good.
Back
toward the trailing edge then, to a small escape hatch beside which was
fastened a dull black ball. The anchoring devices went out first. He gasped as
the air rushed out into near-vacuum, but he had been trained to take sudden and
violent fluctuations in pressure. He rolled the ball out upon the hatch where
he opened it. Two hinged hemispheres, each heavily padded with molded
composition resembling sponge rubber. It seemed incredible that a man as big
as Phryges, especially when wearing a parachute, could be crammed into a space
so small. But that lining had been molded to fit.
This
ball had to be small. The ship, even though it was on a regularly scheduled
commercial flight, would be scanned intensively and continuously from the
moment of entering Norheiman radar range. Since the ball would be invisible on
any radar screen, no suspicion would be aroused; particularly since—as far as
Atlantean Intelligence had been able to discover—the Norheimans had not yet
succeeded in perfecting any device by the use of which a living man could bail
out of a supersonic plane.
Phryges
waited—and waited—until the second hand of his watch marked the arrival of zero
time. He curled up into one half of the ball; the other half closed over him
and plummeted downward; slowing abruptly, with a horrible deceleration, to
terminal velocity. Had the air been any trifle thicker the Atlantean captain
would have died then and there; but that, too, had been computed accurately and
Phryges lived.
And as the ball bulleted downward on a
screaming slant, it shran\l
This,
too, the Adanteans hoped, was new—a synthetic which air-friction would erode
away, molecule by molecule, so rapidly that no perceptible fragment of it would
reach ground.
The
casing disappeared, and the yieldingly porous lining. And Phryges, still at an
altitude of over thirty thousand feet, kicked away the remaining fragments of
his cocoon and, by judicious planing, turned himself so that he could see the
ground, now dimly visible in the first dull gray of dawn. There was the
highway, paralleling his line of flight; he wouldn't miss it by more than a
hundred yards.
He fought down an almost overwhelming urge to
pull his ripcord
ATLANTIS 57
too
soon. He had to wait—wait until the last possible second—because parachutes
were big and Norheiman radar practically swept the ground.
Low enough at last, he pulled the ring, Z-r-r-4?-t?-^—WHAP! The chute banged open; his harness tightened with a savage jerk,
mere seconds before his hard-sprung knees took the shock of landing.
That
was close—too close I He was white and shaking, but unhurt, as he gathered in
the billowing, fighting sheet and rolled it, together with his harness, into a
wad. He broke open a tiny ampoule, and as the drops of liquid touched it the
stout fabric began to disappear. It did not burn; it simply disintegrated and
vanished. In less than a minute there remained only a few steel snaps and
rings, which the Atlantean buried under a meticulously replaced circle of sod.
He
was still on schedule. In less than three minutes the signal would be on the
air and he would know where he was—unless the Norsks had succeeded in finding
and eliminating the whole Atlantean undercover group. He pressed a stud on a
small instrument; held it down. A line burned green across the dial—flared
red—vanished.
"Damn."
he breathed, explosively. The strength of the signal told him that he was
within a mile or so of the hideout—first-class computation—but the red flash
warned him to keep away. Kinnexa—it had better be Kinnexa!—would come to him.
How?
By air? Along the road? Through the woods on foot? He had no way of
knowing—talking, even on a tight beam, was out of the question. He made his way
to the highway and crouched behind a tree. Here she could come at him by any
route of the three. Again he waited, pressing infrequently a stud of his
sender.
A
long, low-slung ground-car swung around the curve and Phryges* binoculars were
at his eyes. It was Kinnexa—or a duplicate. At the thought he
dropped the glasses and pulled his guns—blaster in right hand, air-pistol in
left. But no, that wouldn't do. She'd be suspicious, too—she'd have to be—and
that car probably mounted heavy stuff. If he stepped out ready for business
she'd fry him, and quick. Maybe not—she might have protection—but he couldn't
take the chance.
The car slowed; stopped. The girl got out,
examined a front tire, straightened up, and looked down the road, straight at
Phyrges' hiding place. This time the binoculars brought her up to a little more
than arm's length. Tall, blonde, beautifully built; the slightly crooked left
eyebrow. The thread-line of gold betraying a one-tooth bridge and the
58 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
tiny
scar on her upper lip, for both of which he had been responsible— she always
did insist on playing cops-and-robbers with boys older and bigger than
herself—it was Kinnexal Not even Norheim's science could
imitate so perfecdy every personalizing characteristic of a girl he had known
ever since she was knee-high to a duck!
The
girl slid back into her seat and the heavy car began to move. Open-handed,
Phryges stepped out into its way. The car stopped.
"Turn
around. Back up to me, hands behind you," she directed, crisply.
The man, although surprised, obeyed. Not
until he felt a finger exploring the short hair at the back of his neck did he
realize what she was seeking—the almost imperceptible scar marking the place
where she bit him when she was seven years old!
"Oh,
Fry! It is you! Really
you! Thank the gods I've
been ashamed of that all my life, but now . . ."
He
whirled and caught her as she slumped, but she did not quite faint.
"Quick;
Get in . . . drive on . . . not too fast!" she cautioned, sharply, as the
tires began to scream. "The speed limit along here is seventy, and we
can't be picked up."
"Easy
it is, Kinny. But give!
What's the score? Where's
Kola-nides? Or rather, what happened to him?"
"Dead.
So are the others, I think. They put him on a psycho-bench and turned him
inside out."
"But the blocks?"
"Didn't
hold—over here they add such trimmings as skinning and salt to the regular
psycho routine. But none of them knew anything about me, nor about how their
reports were picked up, or I'd have been dead, too. But it doesn't make any
difference, Fry—we're just one week too late."
"What
do you mean, too late? Speed it up!" His tone was rough, but the hand he
placed on her arm was gentleness itself.
"I'm
telling you as fast as I can. I picked up his last report day before
yesterday. They have missiles just as big and just as fast as ours— maybe more
so—and they are going to fire one at Adantis tonight at exacdy seven
o'clock."
"Tonight! Holy
gods!" The man's mind raced.
"Yes."
Kinnexa's voice was low, uninfected. "And there was nothing in the world
that I could do about it. If I approached any one of our places, or tried to
use a beam strong enough to reach anywhere,
ATLANTIS 59
I would simply have got picked up, too. I've,
thought and thought, but could figure out only one thing that might possibly be
of any use, and I couldn't do that alone. But two of us, perhaps . . ."
"Go
on. Brief me. Nobody ever accused you of not having a brain, and you know this
whole country like the palm of your hand."
"Steal
a ship. Be over the ramp at exactly Seven Pay Emma. When the lid opens, go into
a full-power dive, beam Artomenes—if I have a second before they blanket my
wave—and meet their rocket head-on in their own launching-tube."
This
was stark stuff, but so tense was the moment and so highly keyed up were the
two that neither of them saw anything out of the ordinary in it.
"Not
bad, if we can't figure out anything better. The joker being, of course, that
you didn't see how you could steal a ship?"
"Exactly.
I can't carry blasters. No woman in Norheim is wearing a coat or a cloak now,
so I can't either. And just look at this dress! Do you see any place where I
could hide even one?"
He looked, appreciatively,
and she had the grace to blush.
"Can't
say that I do," he admitted. "But I'd rather have one of our own
ships, if we could make the approach. Could both of us make it, do you
suppose?"
"Not a chance. They'd keep at least one
man inside all the time. Even if we killed everybody outside, the ship would
take off before we could get close enough to open the port with the outside
controls."
"Probably. Go on. But
first, are you sure that you're in the clear?"
"Positive."
She grinned mirthlesly, "The fact that I am still alive is conclusive
evidence that they didn't find out anything about me. But I don't want you to
work on that idea if you can think of a better one. I've got passports and such
for you to be anything you want to be, from a tubeman up to an Ekoptian banker.
Ditto for me, and for us both. As Mr. and Mrs."
"Smart
girl." He thought for minutes, then shook his head. "No possible way
out that I can see. The sneak-boat isn't due for a week, and from what you've
said it probably won't get here. But you might make it, at that. I'll drop you
somewhere . . ."
"You
will not," she interrupted, quietly but definitely. "Which would you rather—go out in a blast like that one will be, beside a good Atlantean,
or, after deserting him, be psychoed, skinned, salted, and— still alive—drawn
and quartered?"
"Together, then, all the way," he
assented. "Man and wife. Tour-
60 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
ists—newly
weds—from some town not too far away. Pretty well fixed, to match what we're
riding in. Can do?"
"Very
simple." She opened a compartment and selected one of a stack of documents. "I can fix this one
up in ten minutes. We'll have to dispose of the rest of these, and a lot of
other stuff, too. And you had better get out of that leather and into a suit that matches this passport photo."
"Right.
Straight road for miles, and nothing in sight either way. Give me the suit and
I'll change now. Keep on going or stop?"
"Better
stop, I think," the girl decided. "Quicker, and we'll have to find a
place to hide or bury this evidence."
While
the man changed clothes, Kinnexa collected the contraband, wrapping it up in
the discarded jacket. She looked up just as Phryges was adjusting his coat. She
glanced at his armpits then stared.
"Where
are your blasters?" she demanded. "They ought to show, at least a little,
and even I can't see a sign of them."
He showed her.
"But they're so tiny!
I never saw blasters like that!"
"I've
got a blaster, but it's in the tail pocket. These aren't. They're air-guns.
Poisoned needles. Not worth a damn
beyond a hundred feet, but deadly close up. One touch anywhere and the guy dies
right then. Two seconds max."
"Nice!"
She was no shrinking violet, this young Atlantean spy. "You have spares,
of course, and I can hide two of them easily enough in leg-holsters. Gimme, and
show me how they work."
"Standard
controls, pretty much like blasters. Like so." He demonstrated, and as he
drove sedately down the highway the girl sewed industriously.
The
day wore on, nor was it uneventful. One incident, in fact— the detailing of
which would serve no useful purpose here—was of such a nature that at its end:
"Better
pin-point me, don't you think, on that ramp?" Phryges asked, quietly.
"Just in case you get scragged in one of these brawls and I don't?"
"Oh! Of coursel Forgive me, Fry—it slipped my mind completely that you
didn't know where it was. Area six; pin-point four seven three dash six oh
five."
"Got it." He
repeated the figures.
But
neither of the Adanteans was "scragged," and at six P.M. an allegedly
honeymooning couple parked their big roadster in the garage
ATLANTIS 6l
at
Norgrad Field and went through the gates. Their papers, tickets included, were
in perfect order; they were as inconspicuous and as undemonstrative as
newlyweds are wont to be. No more so, and no less.
Strolling
idly, gazing eagerly at each new thing, they made their circuitous way toward a
certain small hangar. As the girl had said, this field boasted hundreds of
supersonic fighters, so many that servicing was a round-the-clock routine. In
that hangar was a sharp-nosed, stubby-V'd flyer, one of Norheim's fastest. It
was serviced and ready.
It
was too much to hope, of course, that the visitors could actually get into the
building unchallenged. Nor did they.
"Back,
you." A guard waved them away. "Get back to the Concourse, where you
belong—no visitors allowed out here!"
F-f-t!
F-f-tl Phryges' air-guns
broke into soft but deadly coughing. Kinnexa whirled—hands flashing down, skirt
flying up—and ran. Guards tried to head her off 5 tried to bring their own weapons to bear.
Tried—failed—died.
Phryges,
too, ran; ran backward. His blaster was out now and flaming, for no living
enemy remained within needle range. A rifle bullet ar-h-l-n-g-e-d past his head, making him duck involuntarily
and uselessly. Rifles were bad; but their hazard, too, had been considered and
had been accepted.
Kinnexa
reached the fighter's port, opened it, sprang in. He jumped. She fell against
him. He tossed her clear, slammed and dogged all doors. He looked at her then,
and swore bitterly. A small, round hole marred the bridge of her nose; the back
of her head was gone.
He
leaped to the controls and the fleet litde ship screamed skyward. He cut in
transmitter and receiver, keyed and twiddled briefly. No soap. He had been
afraid of that. They were already blanketing every frequency he could employ;
using power through which he could not drive even a tight beam a hundred miles.
But
he could still crack that missile in its tube. Or—could he? He was not afraid
of other Norheiman fighters; he had a long lead and he rode one of their very
fastest. But since they were already so suspicious, wouldn't they launch the
bomb before seven o'clock? He tried vainly to coax
another knot out of his wide-open engines.
With
all his speed, he neared the pin-point just in time to see a trail of
super-heated vapor extending up into and disappearing beyond the stratosphere.
He nosed his flyer upward, locked the missile into his sights, and leveled off.
Although his ship did not have the giant
62 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
rocket's
acceleration, he could catch it before it got to Atlantis, since he did not
need its altitude and since most of its journey would be made without power.
What he could do about it after he caught it he did not know, but he'd do something.
He
caught it; and, by a feat of piloting to be appreciated only by those who have
handled planes at supersonic speeds, he matched its course and velocity. Then,
from a distance of barely a hundred feet, he poured his heaviest shells into
the missile's warhead. He couldn't be
missing! It was worse than shooting sitting ducks—it was like dynamiting fish
in a bucket! Nevertheless, nothing happened. The thing wasn't fused for impact,
then, but for time; and the activating mechanism would be
shell-and-shockproof.
But
there was still a way. He didn't need to call Artomenes now, even if he could
get through the interfrence which the fast approaching pursuers were still
sending out. Atlantean observers would have lined this stuff up long since; the
Officer would know exacdy what was going on.
Driving ahead and downward, at maximum power,
Phryges swung his ship slowly into a right-angle collision course. The
fighter's needle nose struck the war-head within a foot of the Atlantean's
point of aim, and as he died Phryges knew that he had accomplished his mission.
Norheim's missile would not strike Atlantis, but would fall at least ten miles
short, and the water there was very deep. Very, very deep. Atlantis would not be harmed.
It might have been better, however, if
Phryges had died with Kin-nexa on Norgrad Field; in which case the continent
would probably have endured. As it was, while that one missile did not reach
the city, its frightful atomic charge exploded under a hundred fathoms of
water, ten scant miles from Atlantis' harbor, and very close to an ancient geological
fault.
Artomenes,
as Phryges had surmised, had had time in which to act, and he knew much more
than Phryges did about what was coming toward Atlantis. Too late, he knew that
not one missile, but seven, had been launched from Norheim, and at least five
from Uighar. The retaliatory rockets which were to wipe out Norgrad,
Uigharstoy, and thousands of square miles of environs were on their way long
before either bomb or earthquake destroyed the Atlantean launching ramps.
But
when equilibrium was at last restored, the ocean rolled serenely where a minor
continent had been.
Vague
as the historical events appear, Mankind's progress up the ladder toward its
intangible Utopia is clearly seen now. A definite pattern had developed. Every
step upward had ended with a misstep; backsliding, in which Man lost what he
seemed to have gained, served to urge him to greater effort. Egypt, Greece and
Rome flourished until, in turn, the barbarians brought the Dar\ Ages. Another
great era was ready to commence.
LETTER TO A PHOENIX
by Fredric Brown
T |
here is
much to tell you, so much that it is difficult to know where to begin.
Fortunately, I have forgotten most of the things that have happened to me.
Fortunately, the mind has a limited capacity for remembering. It would be
horrible if I remembered the details of a hundred and eighty thousand
years—the details of four thousand lifetimes that I have lived since the first
great atomic war.
Not that I have forgotten the really great
moments. I remember being on the first expedition to land on Mars and the third
to land on Venus. I remember—I believe it was in the third great war—the blasting
of Skoro from the sky by a force that compares to nuclear fission as a nova
compares to our slowly dying sun. I was second in command of a Hyper-A Class
spacer in the war against the second extragalactic invaders, the ones who
established bases on Jupe's moons before we knew we were there and then almost
drove us out of the Solar System before we found the one weapon they couldn't
stand up against. So they fled where we couldn't follow them, then, outside of
the Galaxy. When we did follow them, about fifteen thousand years later, they
were gone. They were dead three thousand years.
And
that is what I want to tell you about—that mighty race and the others—but
first, so that you will know how I know what I know, I will tell you about
myself.
I am not immortal. There is only one immortal
being in the uni-
64 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
verse;
of it, more anon. Compared to it, I am of no importance, but you will not
understand or believe what I say to you unless you understand what I am.
There
is little in a name, and that is a fortunate thing—for I do not remember mine.
That is less strange than you think, for a hundred and eighty thousand years is
a long time and for one reason or another I have changed my name a thousand
times or more. And what could matter less than the name my parents gave me a
hundred and eighty thousand years ago?
I am
not a mutant. What happened to me happened when I was twenty-three years old,
during the first atomic war. The first war, that is, in which both sides used
atomic weapons—puny weapons, of course, compared to subsequent ones. It was
less than a score of years after the discovery of the atom bomb. The first
bombs were dropped in a minor war while I was still a child. They ended that
war quickly for only one side had them.
The first atomic war wasn't a bad one—the
first one never is. I was lucky for, if it had been a bad one—one which ended a civilization—I'd not
have survived it despite the biological accident that happened to me. If it had
ended a civilization, I wouldn't have been kept alive during the sixteen-year
sleep period I went through about thirty years later. But again I get ahead of
the story.
I was, I believe, twenty or twenty-one years
old when the war started. They didn't take me for the army right away because I
was not physically fit. I was suffering from a rather rare disease of the
pituitary gland—Somebody's syndrome. I've forgotten the name. It caused obesity,
among other things. I was about fifty pounds overweight for my height and had
little stamina. I was rejected without a second thought.
About two years later my disease had
progressed slightly, but other things had progressed more than slightly. By
that time the army was taking anyone; they'd have taken a one-legged one-armed
blind man if he was willing to fight. And I was willing to fight. I'd lost my
family in a dusting, I hated my job in a war plant, and I had been told by
doctors that my disease was incurable and I had only a year or two to live in
any case. So I went to what was left of the army, and what was left of the army
took me without a second thought and sent me to the nearest front, which was
ten miles away. I was in the fighting one day after I joined.
LETTER TO A PHOENIX 65
Now I remember enough to know that / hadn't anything to do with it, but it
happened that the time I joined was the turn of the tide. The other side was
out of bombs and dust and getting low on shells and bullets. We were out of
bombs and dust, too, but they hadn't knocked out all of our production facilities and we'd got just about all of theirs. We
still had planes to carry them, too, and we still had the semblance of an
organization to send the planes to the right places. Nearly the right places,
anyway; sometimes we dropped them too close to our own troops by mistake. It
was a week after I'd got into the fighting that I got out of it again—knocked
out of it by one of our smaller bombs that had been dropped about a mile away.
I came to, about two weeks later, in a base
hospital, pretty badly burned. By that time the war was over, except for the
mopping up, and except for restoring order and getting the world started up
again. You see, that hadn't been what I call a blow-up war. It killed off—I'm
just guessing; I don't remember the fraction—about a fourth or a fifth of the
world's population. There was enough productive capacity left, and there were
enough people left, to keep on going; there were dark ages for a few centuries,
but there was no return to savagery, no starting over again. In such times,
people go back to using candles for light and burning wood for fuel, but not
because they don't know how to use electricity or mine coal; but because the
confusions and revolutions keep them off balance for a while. The knowledge is
there, in abeyance, until order returns.
It's not like a blow-up war, when nine-tenths
or more of the population of Earth—or of Earth and the other planets—is
killed. Then is when the world reverts to utter savagery and the hundredth generation
rediscovers metals to tip their spears.
But
again I digressed. After I recovered consciousness in the hospital, I was in
pain for a long time. There were, by then, no more anaesthetics. I had deep
radiation burns, from which I suffered almost intolerably for the first few
months until, gradually, they healed. I did not sleep—that was the strange
thing. And it was a terrifying thing, then, for I did not understand what had
happened to me, and the unknown is always terrifying. The doctors paid little
heed—for I was one of millions burned or otherwise injured—and I think they did
not believe my statements that I had not slept at all. They thought I had slept
but little and that I was either exaggerating or making an honest error. But I
had not slept at all. I did not sleep until long
after I left
66 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
the
hospital, cured. Cured, incidentally, of the disease of my pituitary gland, and
with my weight back to normal, my health perfect.
I
didn't sleep for thirty years. Then / did sleep, and I slept for sixteen years. And at the end of that forty-six year period,
I was still, physically, at the apparent age of twenty-three.
Do
you begin to see what had happened as I began to see it then ? The radiation—or
combination of types of radiation—I had gone through, had radically changed the
functions of my pituitary. And there were other factors involved. I studied
endocrinology once, about a hundred and fifty thousand years ago, and I think I
found the pattern. If my calculations were correct, what happened to me was
one chance in a billion.
The
factors of decay and aging were not eliminated, of course, but the rate was
reduced by about fifteen thousand times. I age at the rate of one day every
forty-five years. So I am not immortal. I have aged eleven years in the past
hundred and eighty millennia. My physical age is now thirty-four.
And
forty-five years is to me as a day. I do not sleep for about thirty years of
it—then I sleep for about fifteen. It is well for me that my first few
"days" were not spent in a period of complete social disorganization
or savagery, else I would not have survived my first few sleeps. But I did
survive them and by that time I had learned a system and could take care of my
own survival. Since then, I have slept about four thousand times, and I have
survived. Perhaps someday I shall be unlucky. Perhaps someday, despite certain
safegards, someone will discover and break into the cave or vault into which I
seal myself, secretly, for a period of sleep. But it is not likely. I have
years in which to prepare each of those places and the experience of four
thousand sleeps back of me. You could pass such a place a thousand times and
never know it was there, nor be able to enter if you suspected.
No,
my chances for survival between my periods of waking life are much better than
my chances of survival during my conscious, active periods. It is perhaps a
miracle that I have survived so many of those, despite the techniques of
survival that I have developed.
And
those techniques are good. I've lived through seven major atomic—and
super-atomic—wars that have reduced the population of Earth to a few savages
around a few campfires in a few still habitable areas. And at other times, in
other eras, I've been in five galaxies besides our own.
LETTER TO A PHOENIX 67
I've
had several thousand wives but always one at a time for I was born in a
monogamous era and the habit has persisted. And I have raised several thousand
children. Of course, I have never been able to remain with one wife longer than
thirty years before I must disappear, but thirty years is long enough for both
of us—especially when she ages at a normal rate and I age imperceptibly. Oh, it
leads to problems, of course, but I've been able to handle them. I always
marry, when I do marry, a girl as much younger than myself as possible, so the
disparity will not become too great. Say I am thirty; I marry a girl of
sixteen. Then when it is time that I must leave her, she is forty-six and I am
still thirty. And it is best for both of us, for everyone, that when I awaken I
do not again go back to that place. If she still lives, she will be past sixty
and it would not be well, even for her, to have a husband come back from the
dead—still young. And I have left her well provided, a wealthy widow—wealthy in
money or in whatever may have constituted wealth in that particular era.
Sometimes it has been beads and arrowheads, sometimes wheat in a granary and
once— there have been peculiar civilizations—it was fishing scales. I have
never had the slightest difficulty in acquiring my share, or more, of money or
its equivalent. A few thousand years' practice and the difficulty becomes the
other way—knowing when to stop in order not to become unduly wealthy and so
attract attention.
For
obvious reasons, I've always managed to do that. For reasons that you will see
I've never wanted power, nor have I ever—after tht first few hundred years—let
people suspect that I was different from them. I even spend a few hours each
night lying thinking, pretending to sleep.
But
none of that is important, any more than I am important. I tell it to you only
so you will understand how I know the thing that I am about to tell you.
And
when I tell you, it is not because I'm trying to sell you anything. It's
something you can't change if you want to, and—when you understand it—you won't
want to.
I'm
not trying to influence you or to lead you. In four thousand lifetimes I've
been almost everything—except a leader. I've avoided that. Oh, often enough I
have been a god among savages, but that was because I had to be one in order to
survive. I used the powers they thought were magic only to keep a degree of
order, never to lead them, never to hold them back. If I taught them to use the
bow and arrow,
68 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
it
was because game was scarce and we were starving and my survival depended upon
theirs. Seeing that the pattern was necessary, I have never disturbed it.
What I tell you now will
not disturb the pattern.
It
is this: The human race is the only immortal organism in the universe.
There have been other races, but they have died
away or they will die. We charted them once, a hundred thousand years ago, with
an instrument that detected the presence of thought, the presence of intelligence,
however alien and at whatever distance—and gave us a measure of that mind and
its qualities. And fifty thousand years later that instrument was
rediscovered. There were about as many races as before but only eight of them
were ones that had been there fifty thousand years ago and each of those eight
was dying, senescent. They had passed the peak of their powers and they were
dying.
They
had reached the limit of their capabilities—and there is always a limit—and
they had no choice but to die. Life is dynamic; it can never be static—at however high or low a
level—and survive.
That
is what I am trying to tell you, so that you will never again be afraid. Only a
race that destroys itself and its progress periodically, that goes back to its
beginning, can survive more than, say, a hundred thousand years of intelligent
life.
In
all the universe only the human race has ever reached a high level of
intelligence without reaching a high level of sanity. We are unique. We are
already at least five times as old as any other race has ever been and it is
because we are not sane. And man has, at times, had glimmerings of the fact
that insanity is divine. But only at high levels of culture does he realize
that he is collectively insane, that fight against it as he will he will always
destroy himself—and rise anew out of the ashes.
The phoenix, the bird that periodically
immolates itself upon a flaming pyre to rise new-born and live again for
another millennium, and again and forever, is only metaphorically a myth. It
exists and there is only one of it.
You are the phoenix.
Nothing
will ever destroy you, now that—during many high civilizations—your seed has
been scattered on the planets of a thousand suns, in a hundred galaxies, there
ever to repeat the pattern. The pattern that started a hundred and eighty
thousand years ago—I think.
I cannot be sure of that for I have seen that
the twenty to forty
LETTER TO A PHOENIX 69
thousand
years that elapse between the fall of one civilization and the rise of the next
destroy all traces. In twenty to forty thousand years memories become legends
and legends become superstitions and even the superstitions become lost. Metals
rust and corrode back into earth while the wind and the rain and the jungle
erode and cover stone. The contours of the very continents change—and glaciers
come and go, and a city of forty thousand years before is under miles of earth
and miles of water.
So I cannot be sure. Perhaps the first
blow-up that I knew was not the first; civilization may have risen and fallen
before my time. If so, it merely strengthens the case I put before you to say
that mankind may have survived more than the hundred and
eighty thousand years I know of, may have lived through more than the
six blow-ups that have happened since what I think to have been the first
discovery of the phoenix's pyre.
But—except
that we scattered our seed to the stars so well that even the dying of the sun
or its becoming a nova would not destroy us—the past does not matter. Lur,
Candra, Thragan, Kah, Mu, Atlantis—those are the six I have known, and they
are gone as thoroughly as this one will be twenty thousand years or so hence,
but the human race, here or in other galaxies, will survive and will live
forever.
It will help your peace of mind, here in the
year 1950 of your current era, to know that—for your minds are disturbed.
Perhaps, I do not know, it will help your thoughts to know that the coming
atomic war, the one that will probably happen in your generation, will not be a blow-up war; it will come too soon for that, before you have developed
the really destructive weapons man has had so often before. It will set you
back, yes. There will be darkish ages for a century or a few centuries. Then, with the memory of what you will call World War III
as a warning, man will think—as he has always thought after a mild atomic war—that he has conquered his own insanity.
For
a while—if the pattern holds—he will hold it in check. He will reach the stars
again, to find himself already there. Why, you'll be back on Mars within five
hundred years, and I'll go there too, to see again the canals I once helped to
dig. I've not been there for eighty thousand years and I'd like to see what
time has done to it and to those of us who were cut off there the last time
mankind lost the space drive. Of course they've followed the pattern too, but
the rate is not necessarily constant. We may find them at any stage in the
cycle except the
70 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
top.
If they were at the top of the cycle, we wouldn't have to go to them—they'd
come to us. Thinking, of course, as they think by now, that they are Martians.
I
wonder how high, this time, you will get? Not quite as high, I hope, as
Thragan. I hope that never again is rediscovered the weapon Thragan used
against her colony on Skoro, which was then the fifth planet until the Thragans
blew it into asteroids. Of course that weapon would be developed only long
after intergalactic travel again becomes commonplace. If I see it coming I'll
get out of the Galaxy, but I'd hate to have to do that. I like Earth and I'd like
to spend the rest of my mortal lifetime on it if it lasts that long.
Possibly
it won't, but the human race will last. Everywhere and forever, for it will
never be sane and only insanity is divine. Only the mad destroy themselves and
all they have wrought.
And only the phoenix lives
forever.
Instead
of reconstruction measured by thousands of years, Mankind's flight had become
swift. Within two hundred years after the invention of the steam engine, Man
had harnessed atomic energy. And, once again true to the pattern, Mankind was
ready to destroy everything. The time had come in the twentieth century for
Man, on the verge of conquering space, to overcome his greatest obstacle to
progress—himself.
UNITE AND CONQUER
by Theodore Sturgeon
T |
hey were digging
this drainage canal, and the timekeeper drove out to the end, where the big
crane-dragline was working, and called the operator down to ask a lot of
questions about a half-hour of overtime. Next thing you know, they were going
round and round on the fill. The young superintendent saw the fight and yelled
for them to cut it out. They ignored him. Not wanting to dirty his new
breeches, the super swung up into the machine, loaded three yards of sand into
the bucket, hoisted it high, swung and dumped it on the scrambling pair. The
operator and the timekeeper floundered out from under, palmed sand out of their
eyes and mouths, and with a concerted roar, converged on the cab of the
machine. They had the super out on the ground and were happily taking turns at
punching his head when a labor-foreman happened by, and he and his men stopped
the fuss.
The red-headed youngster put down the book.
"It's true here, too," he told his brother. "I mean, what I was
saying about almost all of Wells' best science-fiction. In each case there is a
miracle—a Martian invasion in 'War of the Worlds,' a biochemical in 'Food of
the Gods,' and a new gaseous isotope in 'In the Days of the Comet.' And it
ultimately makes all of mankind work together."
The
brother was in college—had been, for seven months—and was very wise.
"That's right. He knew it would take a miracle. I think
72 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
he
forgot that when he began to write sociological stuff. As Dr. Pierce remarked,
he sold his birthright for a pot of message."
"Excuse me," said the dark man
called Rod. He rose and went to the back of the cafe and the line of phone
booths, while the girl with the tilted nose and the red sandals stared fondly
after him. The Blonde arrived.
"Ah," she mewed,
"alone, I see. But, of course." She sat down.
"I'm
with Rod," said the girl with the sandals, adding primly, "He's
phoning."
"Needed someone to
talk to, no doubt," said the Blonde.
"Probably,"
said the other, smiling at her long fingers, "he needed to come back to
earth."
The
Blonde barely winced. "Oh well. I suppose he must amuse himself between
his serious moments. He'll have one tomorrow night, you know. At the Ball. Pity
I won't see you there. Unless, of course, you come with someone else—"
"He's
working tomorrow night!" blurted the girl with the sandals, off guard.
"You could call it that," said the
Blonde placidly.
"Look,
Sunshine," said the other girl evenly, "why don't you stop kidding
yourself? Rod isn't interested in you and your purely local color. He isn't
even what you want. If you're looking for a soul-mate, go find yourself a
wolfhound."
"Darling,"
said the Blonde appreciatively, and with murder in her mascara. "You know,
you might get him, at that. // you
brush up on your cooking, and if he can keep his appetite by going blind—" She leaned forward suddenly.
"Look there. Who is that floozy?"
They
turned to the back of the cafe. The dark young man was holding both hands of a
slender but curvesome girl with deep auburn hair. She was laughing coyly up at
him.
"Fancy
Pants," breathed the girl with the red sandals. She turned to the Blonde^
"I know whereof I speak. Her clothesline is right under my window, and—"
"The
little stinker," said the Blonde. She watched another pretty convulsion of
merriment. "Clothesline, hm-m-m? Listen—I had a friend once who had a feud
on with a biddy in the neighborhood. There was something about a squirt gun and
some ink—"
"Well,
well," said the girl in the sandals. She thought a moment, watching Rod
and the redhead. "Where could I get a squirt gun?"
UNITE AND CONQUER 73
"My
kid brother has a water pistol. I got it for him for his birthday. Can you
meet me here at seven o'clock?"
"I certainly can. I'll
get the ink. Black ink. India ink!"
The
Blonde rose. "Be sweet to him," she said swiftly, "so he won't
guess who fixed Fancy Pants."
"I
will. But not too sweet. The heel. Darling, you're wonderful-"
The Blonde winked and walked away. And at a
nearby table, a gentleman, who had been eavesdropping shamelessly, stuffed a
soft roll into an incipient roar of laughter, and then began to choke.
# #
#
"Colonel
Simmons," said the annunciator.
"Well
for Pete's sake!" said Dr. Simmons. "Send him in. Send him right in!
And—cancel that demonstration. No . . . don't cancel it. Postpone it."
"Until when,
doctor?"
"Until I get
there."
"But—it's for the
Army—"
"My brother's the
Army, too!" snapped the physicist and switched
off.
A knock, "Come in.
Leroy, you dog!"
"Well,
Muscles." The colonel half ran into the room, gripped the scientist by the
upper arms, scanned his face up, back and across. Their eyes were gray, the
colonel's gray and narrow, the doctor's gray and wide. "It must've
been—" they said in unison, and then laughed together.
"Eight years,
anyway," said the colonel.
"All
of that. Gosh, gosh." He shook his head. "You and your shiny
buttons."
There was a silence. "Hardly know where
to begin, what to say, hm-m-m?" grinned the colonel. "What've you
been doing lately?" "Oh . . . you know. Applied physics."
"Hah!"
snorted the colonel. "Question: Mr. Michaelangelo, what are you doing?
Answer: Mixing pigments. Come on, now; what since you invented magnefilm?"
"Nothing
much. Couple of things too unimportant to talk about, couple more too important
to mention."
"Your
old garrulous self, I see. Come on, Muscles. Security regulations don't apply
here, and between us especially."
74 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
That's
what you thin\, thought
Dr. Simmons. "Of course not," he said. "What branch are you with
now?"
"Publicly,
the Air Corps," said the colonel, indicating his wings. "Actually,
I'm on the Board of Strategy. This won't be the kind of war which can be fought
with semipublic conferences and decisions after advisement in the General
Staff. The Board operates practically underground, without any publicity, and
without any delay."
"Board
of Strategy, eh? I'd heard only vaguely . . . and I'm in a position to hear
plenty. Well now. When you say *No delay,' what do you mean?"
"I
mean this," said the colonel. He put his hands behind him on a high lab
table and lifted himself up on it. He crossed his bright boots and swung them.
"We have plans • . . look; you know how M-Day plans work, don't you?"
"Certainly.
The personnel of draft boards is all chosen, the questionnaires are printed
and almost entirely distributed, the leases and domains of examination centers
are arranged for, and so on and on. When mobilization is called, everything
starts operating without a hitch. You hope," he added with a grin.
"Why?"
"The
Board operates the same way," said his brother. "But where Selective
Service has only one big problem to arrange for in detail we have—" he shrugged. "Name your
figure. We have planned what to do, if, for example, Russia attacks us, if we
attack Russia, if France attacks Brazil, or if Finland takes a swing at Iraq.
What's funny?"
"I
was thinking of the legend about the emperor who tried to grant the reward
asked for by a certain hero, who had stipulated simply that he be given some
wheat, the amount to be determined by a hypothetical chessboard, putting one
grain on the first square, two on the second, four on the third, eight on the
fourth, and so on . . . anyway, it wound up with an amount equal to a couple
of years' world supply, and with the empire and all its resources in the hands
of our hero. Your plans are like that. I mean, if one of the possibilities you
mention should occur, but if you should lose the third battle instead of
winning it as scheduled, why, you'll have a whole new set of plans to make. And
this applies to every one of your original master-plans."
"Oh,
don't misunderstand me. I don't mean that each plan is as detailed as the M-Day
deal. Lord, no. The plans are policies of action, rather than blueprints. They
stay within the bounds of statistical probability, though we push those bounds
outward as far as possible. I've mentioned possible enemies, and possible
combatants aside from en-
UNITE AND CONQUER 75
emies.
There are also plans covering combinations and permutations of alliance.
Anything is possible after such precedent, for example, as the situation in the
Second War, when our close ally Russia was at peace with our worst enemy."
He laughed. "If that happened in human instead of in international terms,
with my closest friend lunching daily with a man who was openly trying to kill
me, we'd call it fantastic. Maybe it is," he said cheerfully, "but
it's most engrossing." "You rather enjoy it, don't you?"
"I have never had such
fascinating work in all my life."
"I didn't mean
strategy, soldier-boy. I meant war."
"War
? I s'pose it is. Now, another thing the Board is doing . . . wait a minute.
Muscles! You're not still the dewy-eyed idealist you used to be—brotherhood of
mankind, and all that, are you?"
"I
invented the sonic disruptor, didn't I?" You probably thin\ that answers your
question, he
thought bitterly.
"So you did. A very healthy development
in you and in the noble art of warfare. Nicest little side arm in history.
Busts a man all up inside without breaking the skin. So little mess."
Healthy!
Dr. Simmons stared at his
brother, who was looking into his cigarette case. Healthy! And I developed the disruptor to
focus ultrasonic vibrations under the s\in, to homogenize cancerous tissue. I
never dreamed they'd . . . ah, neither did Nobel. "Go on about the Board," he said.
"What
was I ... oh yes. Not only have we
planned the obvious things—political situations, international crises,
campaigns and alliances, but we are keeping a very close watch on technology.
The War Department has, at long last, abandoned the policy of fighting this war
with last war's weapons. Remember how Hitler astonished the world with the
elementary stunt of organizing liaison between his tanks and his dive bombers?
Remember the difficulties they had in promoting the bazooka to replace the
mortar in jungle warfare? And how the War Department refused to back the Wright
Brothers ? There'll be no more of that."
"You
mean we're preparing to use the latest in everything? Really use it?"
"That's
right. Atomic energy and jet propulsion we know about. Then there's biological
warfare, both disease and crop-hormone techniques. But it doesn't stop there.
As a matter of fact, those things, and other proven developments, account for
only a small part of our plans. We have the go-ahead on supplies, weapons,
equipment and
76 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
techniques
which haven't even been developed yet Some haven't even been invented
yet!"
Dr. Simmons whisded.
"Like what?"
The
colonel smiled, rolled his eyes up thoughtfully. "Like impenetrable
force-fields, mass-multipliers—that's a cute hypothesis, Muscles. Increase the
effective mass of a substance, and the results could be interesting.
Particularly if it were radioactive. Antigravity. Tele-path scrambles, which
throw interrupting frequencies in and around thought waves, if thoughts are waves . . . we've considered practically every gadget and gimmick in
every story and article in every science fiction magazine published in the last
thirty years, and have planned what to do in case it suddenly pops up."
Ignoring
all the Utopian, philosophical,
sociological stories, of course, thought Dr. Simmons. He said, "So your
visit here isn't purely social?"
"Gosh
no. I'm with the observation group which came here to see your Spy-Eye in
action. What is it, anyhow? And how did it get the cute soapsuds name?"
Dr.
Simmons smiled. "One of the armchair boys in the front office used to work
in an advertising agency. The device is a 'Self-Propelled Information
Interceptor'—SPII—which, once it touched that huckster brain, became 'Spy-Eye.'
As to just what it is, you'll see that for yourself if you attend the
demonstration, which starts as soon as we've finished talking."
"You mean you
postponed it until I was through with you?"
"That's
right." / thought
you'd li\e that, he thought, watching the pleased grin on his
brother's face. "Tell me something, Leroy. All these plans ... are we at war?"
"Are we . . . well,
no. You know that."
"But these preparations. All they lack
is a timetable." He squinted
quizzically. "By golly, I believe you have that, too." "We have
plenty," the colonel sidestepped, winking. "Choose sides? What's the
lineup?"
"I
won't tell you that. No, I'm not worried about security! It's just that I might
be wrong. Things move so fast these days. I'll tell you one thing, though. We
already have our neutral ground."
"Oh
yes, of course—like Switzerland and Sweden. I've always wondered what exact
powers kept them neutral."
"Well, if you're going
to fight a war, you've got to have some way
UNITE AND CONQUER 77
to
exchange prisoners and have meetings with various interested parties, and so on—"
"Yep.
And it used to come in pretty handy for certain manufacturers."
The colonel eyed him. "Are you sure
you're off that lion-and-lamb kick?"
Dr.
Simmons grimaced. "I think the Spy-Eye can answer that quite
adequately."
The
colonel slipped off his perch. "Yes, let's get to it," he said
eagerly.
They went to the door. "By the
way," said Dr. Simmons, "just what have you picked out for your
neutral ground?" "Japan," said the colonel.
"Nice of 'em to agree to anything so
close to home." "Nice of 'em? Don't be silly! It's the only way they
can be sure it won't be fortified."
"Oh," said his brother. They went
out.
The demonstration went off without a hitch,
and afterward the six Army observers and the plant technicians repaired to the
projection room for Dr. Simmons' summation.
He talked steadily and tiredly, and his
thoughts talked on at the same time. As he reeled off specifications and
characteristics, his mind rambled along, sometimes following the spoken
thought, sometimes paralleling it, sometimes commenting acidly or humorously,
always tiredly. It was a trapped thing, that talking mind, but it was articulate.
".
. . five point eight feet long overall, an aerodynamic streamline, with its
largest diameter only two point three seven feet. Slide One, please. As you
have seen, it has one propelling and three supporting jets. These three are
coupled directly to the same outlet-valve, which is controlled by an absolute
altimeter. The whole is, of course, gyro-stabilized. It is capable of
trans-sonic speeds; but it can very nearly hover, subject only to a small
nutation which can probably be designed out."
It was going to be a mail-rocket, commented his thought.
"Its
equipment includes the usual self-guiding devices, a coding flight-recorder,
and radio receivers tuned to various preselected FM, AM, and radar channels. In
regard to radar; should it pick up any yS JOURNEY
TO INFINITY
radar
pulses close enough or strong enough to suggest detection, it changes course
and speed radically. Should they persist, the Spy-Eye releases
'window'—aluminum-foil strips of various lengths, and returns to its starting
point by a preset and devious course.
"The
spy device itself is relatively simple. It uses magnefilm, taking pictures of
the source of any desired radio signal. When the signal is received, it locates
the beam, aims the camera, and records the audio signal magnetically. Of
course, the synchronization between the picture and the audio recording is
perfect, because of the magnefilm."
"Will you explain
magnefilm, please, doctor?"
"Certainly,
captain. It was developed through research into the rather wide variation in
dielectric characteristics of the early plastics —the styrenes, ureas, and so
on. Molecular arrangement was altered in various plastics until a transparent
conductor was developed. It was not very far from that to the production of a
plastic with a remarkably high magnetic density. Once this was made in a
transparent, strong, pliable form, it was simple to make photographic film of
it. The audio impulses are impressed directly upon the film, as in any magnetic
tape system." And
it was invented for 8mm movie addicts, so that they could have sound
film, added his thought. Now it's a secret weapon.
"The purpose of the Spy-Eye, of course,
is to pick up short-range transmissions; vertically beamed walkie-talkies,
line-of-sight FM messages, and the like. Since these are usually well beyond
the range of the enemy's listening-posts, they are seldom coded. Therefore,
with this device, we have access to a wealth of intelligence that has so far
been regarded as unreachable."
He signaled the projection room. The screen
came to life. During the test, the various officers had spoken into the
microphones of several AM and FM transmitters spotted within a quarter-mile. Unerringly,
after a few spoken words, the screen showed the source and its identification
numeral, painted on large white signboards.
"In
enemy territory," remarked the doctor dryly, "we shall probably have
to do without the boards." There was polite laughter. "If you will
remember, gentlemen, the selector was next set to pick up something on the
broadcast band."
The
screen, blank, gave an agonized groan. Then a child's voice said clearly,
"What's the matter, Daddy? Has that old acid indigestion got you down
again?" "Owoo," said the man's voice. The screen suddenly
showed, far below, the tall towers of a transmitting antenna.
unite and conquer 79
"Honey
Child, you'd better go for the doctor. Your old Daddy's real poorly."
"No need to be," rejoined the litde angelic voice. "I took my ice-cream money and brought you a
package of Bubble-Up, the fastest relief known to the mind of man. It is only
ten cents at the nearest drugstore. Here. Take one and drink this glass of
water I brought you." Glug-glug. Clin\! "Ah-h! I'm a new man!" "Now Daddy, here's my report card.
I'm sorry. It's all D's." "Ha ha ha! Think nothing of it, Honey
Child. Here—take this dollar. Take five dollars! Take all the other kids down
for a treat!"
"Cut!"
said Dr. Simmons. "I would consider this conclusive evidence, gentlemen,
that the Spy-Eye can spot a target for bombing."
Amid
laughter and applause, the lights came on. The observers pressed forward to
shake the physicist's hand. Colonel Simmons stood by until the rest went to a
table, where a technician was explaining the flight-record tapes and the
course and radio-band pre-selector mechanisms.
"Muscles, it's fine. Just fine! How
about duplication? I know there can be no leaks out of here, but do you think they will be able to figure it out quickly enough to get something like it
into production?"
Dr.
Simmons rubbed his chin. "That's hard to say. Aside from the fuel and the
magnefilm, there's nothing new about the device except for the fact that old
components are packed in a new box. The fuel can be duplicated, and
magnefilm—well, that's a logical development."
"Well,"
said the colonel, "it can't matter too much. I mean, even if they have it
already. We can blanket the earth with those things. There needn't be a single
spot on the globe unobserved. The Spy-Eye doesn't have to detect radio alone,
does it?"
"Lord,
no! It could be built to seek infrared, or radioactivity, or even sound, though
we'd have to tune the jets acoustically for that. The magnefilm's audio could
pick up our own directional beams and get a radio fix on anything we wanted it
to take pictures of. The camera could be triggered to a time mechanism, or to
anything that radiated or vibrated. Likewise the hunting mechanism."
"Oh,
fine," said the colonel again. "There'll be no power on earth that
can't be spotted and smashed within hours, once we get enough of these things
out,"
"No
power on earth," nodded his brother. "You have every reason to be
confident." And
no reason to be right, his
silent voice added.
80 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
The first signs of the war to come were in
all the papers. But hardly anyone read them. They were inside, with small
headings. The front pages were more exciting that day. They screamed of new
international incidents. The tabloids were full of a photo-series of the mobbing
of a bearded man called Kronsky. (He was English—Somerset— and spoke the
buzzing brogue of his shire. His name had been Polish, three generations
before. He was wearing a beard because of scars caused by a severe attack of
barber's itch. These facts were not touched upon.) An Estonian student was
wrapped in a U.N. banner and stoned for having sung "OF Man River" at
a folk-song recital. An astonishing number of tea-leaf readers were hired
overnight by restaurants in which "Beef Stroganoff" suddenly became
"Gypsy Goulash."
The small notices in the papers dealt with
the startling discovery, by three experimenters, one in France and two in
Canada, of a new noise in Jansky radiation, that faint hiss of jumbled radio
frequencies which originates from somewhere an interstellar space. It was a
triple blast of sound, each one two and two-fifths seconds in length, with two
and two-fifths seconds of silence between the signals. They came in groups,
three blasts each, a few fractions of a second under ten minutes apart. The
phenomenon continued for seven months, during which time careful measurements
showed an appreciable increase in amplitude. Either the signal source was
getting stronger, or it was getting nearer, said the pundits.
During these seven months, and for longer,
the Simmons brothers lapsed into their usual "got to write to him some
time" pattern in regard to each other. Both were busy. The colonel's life
was a continuous round of conferences, research reports, and demonstrations,
and the load on the physicist became heavier daily, as the demands of the Board
of Strategy, stimulated by its research, its Intelligence Section, and the
perilous political situation, reached his laboratories.
The
world was arming feverishly. A few historians and philosophers, in their very
few objective moments, found time to wonder what the political analysts of the
future would have to say about the coming war. The First War was a war of
economic attrition; the Second was too, but it was even more an ideological
war. This incipient unpleasantness had its source in ideology, but, at the eve
of hostilities, the battle of philosophies had been relegated to the plane of
philosophy. In practice, each side—or rather, all sides—had streamlined them-
UNITE AND CONQUER 8l
selves
into fighting machines, with each and every part milled to its function, and
all control centralized. The necessary process of kindling fire to fight fire
had resulted in Soviets
where the proletariat did
not dictate, and in democracies where the people did not rule. Indeed, since
the increase of governmental efficiency everywhere had resulted in a new high
in production of every kind, the economic and political aspects of the war had
been all but negated, and it began to appear as though the war would be fought
purely for the sake of fighting a war, and simply because the world was
prepared for it.
On December 7th, as if to perpetuate the memory of infamy, the first bomb was dropped.
It
was dropped. It wasn't a self-guided missile. It wasn't a
planted mine. It wasn't dust or bio, either; it was a blast-bomb, and it was a
honey.
They got the ship that dropped it, too. A
proximity-fused rocket with an atomic warhead struck it a glancing blow. That
happened, spectacularly, over Lake Michigan. The ship, or what was left of it,
crashed near Minsk.
It
was Dr. Simmons' urgent suggestion which accounted for the ship. It had not
been seen, but it had been spotted by radar on December 6th, when it encircled the Earth twice. It was far inside Roche's Limit; the
conclusion was obvious that it was self-powered. Simmons calculated its orbit,
knowing that at that velocity it could not alter its course appreciably in the
few hours it took to pass and repass any given point. The proximity rocket was
launched on schedule, not on detection. Unfortunately, on its way to its
rendezvous with fission, the ship dropped its bomb.
And
when that happened, the world drew itself together like . . . like— Ever see a
cat lying sleeping, spread out, relaxed, and then some sound, some movement
will put that cat on guard ? It may not move a muscle, but it isn't relaxed any
more; it isn't asleep any more. It has changed its pose from a slumber to a
crouch, and you can only know that because of the new shape of its eyes. The world did that.
But nobody started throwing
bombs.
"Cool down,
soldier-boy!"
"Cool down, he says," fumed the
colonel. "This is . . . this—" His
words died into a splutter.
"I know, I know,"
said Dr. Simmons, trying not to grin. "You
82 JOURNEY
TO INFINITY
figured,
and you figured, and you read all sorts of fantastic things and swallowed your
incredulity and planned as if these things actually could happen. You worked
all practicable statistical possibilities, and a lot more besides. And it has
to start like this,"
"Everybody
\nows Japan is neutral ground, and will stay that way. There's no point in it!" the colonel all but wailed. "The bomb didn't even land
on a city, or even a depot! Just knocked the top off a mountain in the Makabe
country on Honshu. There isn't a blasted thing there."
"I'd
say there isn't an unblasted thing there at the moment," chuckled his
brother. "Stop telling me how you feel and let's have what you know. Was
the bomb traced?"
"Of
course it was traced! We have recording radar all over. It came from that ship,
all right. Muscles, it was a dinky litde thing, that bomb. About like a two
hundred fifty pounder. But what a blossom!"
"I
heard the news reports on it. Also seismographics. They had trouble picking up
the Hiroshima bomb. They didn't have any with this one. It ran about seven
hundred and forty-odd times as powerful."
"Officially,"
said the colonel, "it was well over nine hundred at the source."
"Well,
well," said Dr. Simmons, in the tone of an orchid fancier noting red spots
on a new hybrid. "Disruption, hm-m-m?"
"Disruption,
and how," rejoined the colonel. "Look, Muscles. We've got disruption
bombs too—you know that. But just as a fission bomb blows away most of its
fissionable material before it can be effective, so a disruption bomb blasts
off that much more. We have bombs that make the old Baker-Day bomb look like a wet
firecracker, sure; but the best we can do is about four hundred per cent. I
thought that was plenty; but this thing— Anyhow, Muscles, I just don't get it.
Who threw it? Why? Great day in the morning, man! An egg like that would've
thrown us into a ground-loop if it had landed on any one of our centers. No
power on earth would be that careless. To miss, I mean. We can't even be sure
it wasn't a wild throw by one of our allies, on the other hand. Nowadays, you
know everything, and you know nothing; you know it ahead of time, or you know
it too late."
"My, my," said Dr. Simmons mildly.
"What about the ship?" "The ship," repeated the colonel,
and his face reddened again. "I just can't believe that ship. Who built
it? Where? We have every-
unite and conquer 83
thing on earth spotted that's worth spotting.
Muscles, that thing was fifteen hundred feet long according to the radar."
"Anybody photograph it?"
"Apparently
not. I mean, lots of radar-directed cameras shot where it was, but it didn't
show, except as a blur."
"How
do you know it was that big, then ? You know what 'window' does to radar, for
example. I don't know just how, but that could be camouflage of some
sort."
"That's
what we thought at first. Until we saw the hole in the ground where it hit.
That thing was bigl"
"Saw
it? I understand that the Russians cordoned off the area and threatened mass
bombing if anyone came smelling around."
"A
thing called a Spy-Eye," said the colonel, "with a telescopic
lens-"
"Oh," said the physicist.
"Well—how much of the ship was left?"
"Not
much. It exploded when it hit, of course. Apparently most of it was vaporized
over Michigan. The Spy-Eye pix show something being dug up, though."
"Wish
I had a piece of it," said Dr. Simmons longingly. "A thorough qualitative
analysis would very soon show where it came from."
"We
won't get it," said the colonel positively. "Not without the Russki's
co-operation anyway."
"Could that
happen?"
"Certainly
not! They're not stupid! They'll play this thing for all it's worth. If they
can figure out where it came from, they'll know and we won't—one up for them in
the war of nerves. If they can't, and the sample's worthless to them, we can't
know it until we try, and we want to try. So they'll hold out for some
concession or other. Whatever it is will cost us plenty."
"Leroy,"
said the physicist slowly, "have you heard about the so-called 'signals'
in the Jansky bands?"
"I
know what you're driving at," snorted the colonel. "The answer is
no. But really, no. That's no ship from outer space. We fixed on
those signals months ago, and had even the 200-incher and a whole battery of image orthicons on the indicated
direction. The signal strength increased, but nothing could be seen."
"Uh-huh. And when it
arrived, it couldn't be photographed."
"It— Oh. Oh-oh!"
"Well,
you said yourself that if it had been built anywhere on earth you'd have known
it."
84 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"Your
phone," gasped the colonel. "I've got to find out about those Jansky
signals." He rushed to the corner of the room.
"They stopped,"
said the doctor. "Yes, Leroy. I've been following them all along. They cut
out when we shelled the ship," "Th-they did?" "Yup."
"Well—that
takes care of that, doesn't it? Even if it was something from Outside—"
"Now,"
said Dr. Simmons relentlessly, "with that racket off the Jansky bands,
it's possible to hear the new noises."
"New—"
"Three sets of 'em. By their amplitude,
I'd judge that they're scheduled to be here in two, three, and five months
respectively." The colonel gasped. '7 think,"
added Dr. Simmons calmly, "that they're approaching faster than the first
one."
"That can't be!" bellowed the
colonel. "Haven't we enough to watch without fighting a Buck Rogers war as
well? We just can't fight our own war and these invaders, too!"
"Come,
come," said Dr. Simmons gently. "Why not take it up with the Board,
Leroy? They're ready for everything. You told me so yourself."
The colonel glared at him. "This is no
time to needle me, Muscles," he growled. "What do you think's going
to happen?"
The
scientist considered. "Well, what do you think would happen if you sent
out—say, a plane to investigate an island? The plane circles it a couple of
times, and then without warning gets shot down. What would you do?"
"Send a squadron and
bomb the—" He fell silent.
"Yes, Leroy."
"But—they dropped the
bomb first!"
"How
do you know what they were doing? Put it on other terms; you are walking in the
woods and you come to a mound of dry earth. You wonder what it is. You stick a
piece of wood into it." He shrugged. "Maybe it's an ant hill. It
would seem to me that an atomic bomb would be an excellent method to get a
quick idea of the elemental composition of a strange planet. There's all kinds
of light from the disruption, you know. Screen off what radiation you can
expect from your own bomb, and what's left will give you a pretty fair spectral
analysis of the target."
UNITE AND CONQUER 85
"But they must have known the planet was
inhabited. What right had they to bomb it?"
"Did the bomb do any damage?" The
colonel was silent.
"And yet we shot the ship down. Leroy,
you can't expect them to like it."
The
soldier looked up suddenly, narrowly at his brother. "It was your idea to
shoot it down."
"It
was not I" Dr. Simmons snapped. "I was asked how it
could be done, and I said how it could be done. That was all. The order was
given by some eager lad in your Board, if anyone." He made an impatient
gesture. "That's beside the point, Leroy. We can come out of our caves in
the brave new postwar world and fix the blame to our hearts' content. Our
problem at the moment is what to do when the next contingent arrives. I rather
think they'll be loaded for bear. That was, you say, a big ship, and what it
dropped was a small bomb. You can guess what will happen if three ships drop a
few whole sticks of bombs like that—say a thousand of them."
"Three
hundred would be enough to make this planet look like the moon," said the
colonel whitely.
"I
remember a lecture, long ago," said Dr. Simmons reminiscently, "by a
man named Dr. Szilard. Someone asked him if there was any conceivable defense
against the atomic bomb. He laughed and said, 'Certainly. The Japs discovered
it in eight days.'"
"A defense? Oh. They
surrendered."
"That's right. That
stopped the bombs from coming over."
"How do you surrender
to a force you can't communicate with?"
"Perhaps
we can. We can try. But from their point of view we attacked first, and in all
probability they'll hit first and talk later. You would."
"Yes,"
admitted the colonel. "I would. The thing to do, Muscles, is to try to
organize some defense."
"With
the world in the state it's in now? Don't be silly! There might be a chance if
everyone believed, if every nation would co-operate. But if nobody trusts
anybody—"
The
colonel bolted to the door, "We'll have to do what we can. So long,
Muscles. I'll keep you posted— What in blazes are you grinning for?"
"Don't
mind me, please," said Dr. Simmons, half laughing. "It's
nothing."
86 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"Tell me what your nothing is so I can
get to work with a clear mind," said the colonel irritably.
"Well,
it's just that I've been expecting the well-known atomic doom for so very long, that I've covered every emotion but one over it. I've been afraid,
even terrified. I've been angry. I've been disgusted. And now—it's funny. It's
funny because of what you're going through. Of all the things you've guessed
at, trained for, planned for —it has to come like this. Sitting ducks. An enemy
you can't out-think, outweigh, outsmart, or terrorize. It was always
inevitable; now even a soldier can see it."
"Very
funny," growled the colonel, jamming his hat down. "Out of this
world."
"Hey!" called the
physicist. "That was good!"
Laughing,
he went to his inner laboratory. The one where no one else ever went.
Their next contact was by telephone. Too much
time had passed; at least, Dr. Simmons thought it was too much time. So he
called his brother. Having determined to do so, it occurred to him that he did
not know exactly how to go about it; so he called the War Department in
Washington. It took two minutes and forty seconds to make the contact; but the
doctor heard the Washington operator, the Chicago operator, the Denver
operator, the Gunnison operator, the Gunnison mobile operator, and an
Operations lieutenant passing along something called a crash pri. Dr. Simmons
raised his eyebrows at this, and never forgot it.
"Hi, Muscles!"
"Hello,
Leroy, Listen. What's with the salvage situation ? I want to do that
analysis."
"The
stinkers!" the colonel said heatedly. "They made a proposition. I
turned 'em down. The Board backed me up.*
"What was the
proposition?"
"They
wouldn't send a sample. They said if we had someone who could perform a
definitive analysis, to send him to Russia."
"Aha! Mountain to
Mahomet, eh? Why did you refuse?"
"Don't
be silly! There are maybe a half-dozen men in this country who might be able
to make a really exhaustive analysis, and come up with a reliable conclusion.
And about five of 'em we can't be sure."
"Send the other one,
then."
"That's you, egghead.
We're not going to run a risk like that."
UNITE AND CONQUER 87
"Why not?"
"They could use you, Muscles."
"I couldn't use anything they could give me." "That isn't the
point," the colonel assured him. "But they have ways—"
"Knock
off the dramatics, Leroy. This isn't a grade B movie. And there isn't time for
fooling around. We have maybe six weeks."
There was a silence. Then, "Only six
weeks?"
"That's
right," said the doctor positively. "Tell you what. Make arrangements
to get me to Minsk right away, and let me get on that analysis. At worst we can
find out what the ship was made of, and get an idea of how advanced those
people are. At the very best, we might find a defense. Tell the
'proprietors'"—although this was a closed circuit, he was
careful—"that my work will be open and above-board. They can put on as
many observers as they want to, and I will share my findings completely with them."
"You can't do that! That's just what we
want to avoid!"
It
was the physicist's turn to fall silent. How do you li\e that! he thought. The Board is clinging to some faint hope that
the invaders will do their dirty wor\ for them. They thin\ that we'll find a defense
and no one else will. He
said, finally, speaking slowly and carefully as if to a child, "Leroy,
listen. I'm just as anxious as you are to do something about this matter. I
think I can do something. But either I do it my way, or I don't do it at all.
Is that quite clear? Perhaps I'm more resigned than you are. Perhaps I think we
deserve this . . . are you there?"
"Yes."
The doctor knew his brother had paused to lick his lips nervously. "You
really think you can get something of value out of the analysis?"
"Almost certainly."
"I'll check with the Board.
Muscles—" "Yes, Leroy."
"Don't go mystic on us, hah?"
"Go see the Board," said Dr.
Simmons, and hung up. He went to Russia.
The colonel met him on his return, two weeks
later at a West Coast field. The unarmed long-range jet fighter, and its
bristling escort, which had accompanied it from Eniwetok, skimmed to the landing
strip. The colonel had a two-place coupe sport plane waiting. Dr.
88 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
Simmons,
inordinately cheerful, refused a meal and said he wanted to take off right away
for his laboratories. The colonel wanted him to appear before the Board for a
report, but he smiled and shook his head, and the colonel knew that smile
better than to argue.
When
they reached traveling altitude, and the colonel had throttled down to stay
under the sonic barrier, and they had the susurrus of driving jets to accompany
them rather than the roar of climbing jets to compete, they talked.
"How was it,
Muscles?"
"Oh, I had a ball. It
was fine."
The colonel shot a look at him. He disapproves, thought
the doctor. War
is grim and businesslike, and for anyone to enjoy the business of war seems to
him a sacrilege.
"It
looked pretty touchy at first. They all acted as if I had an A-bomb in my watch
pocket. Then I ran into Iggy."
"iggy?"
"Yup.
I could recite his whole name if I tried hard, but it's a jawbreaker. We used
to drink forbidden sherry together in the dorm at the University of Virginia
when I was a kid in school. We thrashed out all the truths of the cosmos
together. He was a swell guy. I remember once when Iggy decided that the rule
forbidding women in the dorm was unreasonable. He rigged up a—"
"What happened in
Minsk?" asked the colonel coldly.
"Oh.
Minsk. Well, Iggy's come a long way since college. He specialized in
aerodynamics, and then got tired of it. For years he'd been fooling around with
nuclear physics as a hobby, and during the Second War he got real high up in
the field. Naturally he was called in when this ship nosed in at Minsk."
"Why naturally?"
"Well,
the fragment retained much of its shape. That's aerodynamics. And it was
hot—really hot. That's nuclear physics. He was a big help. According to his
extrapolations, by the way, your radar was right. If that was a part of the
hull, as it probably was, and if it was a more or less continuous curve, then
the ship must've been all of fifteen hundred feet long, with a four
hundred-foot cross-section at max. Quite a piece of business."
"I can't say I'm happy
to hear about it. Go on."
"Well,
the high brass there apparently expected me to smell the fragment, taste it,
and come up with a trade name. There was a lot of pressure to keep me away from
testing equipment, if any. That's
UNITE AND CONQUER 09
where
Iggy came in. He apologized for my carelessness in not bringing my betatron
and some distillation apparatus. They saw the point, and got me to a
laboratory. They have some nice stuff." He shook his head appreciatively.
Eagerly the colonel asked: "Anything we
haven't got? Can we duplicate any of it? Where is this place? Did you see any
defenses?"
"They
have lots of stuff," said the doctor shortly. "Do you want me to
finish? You do? All right. Well, we volatilized pieces of it, and we distilled
it. We subjected it to reagents and reducers and stress analyses and
crystallographic tests. We put it in magnetic fields and we tested its
resistance and conductivity. We got plenty of figures on it." He laughed.
Again the colonel looked impatiently at him.
"Well, what is the
stuff?"
"There is no name for it, yet. Iggy
wants to call it nichevite—in other words, 'never mind/ Leroy, it looks
like dural, only it's harder and it's tougher. But it oxidizes very easily.
It's metallic, but it has such a low conductivity that it makes like porcelain.
It has heavy-isotope aluminum in it, and light copper, and it isn't an alloy.
It's a compound. It's a blasted chemical compound, very stable, made of nothing
but elements with a positive valence. It's stronger than any steel, and can
withstand temperatures so high that you can forget about them. The atomic blast
broke it; it didn't fuse it. We volatilized it only by powdering it and
oxidizing it in an electric furnace, and then subtracting the oxygen from our
calculations. That got us near enough to where we wanted to go. One thing is
certain; no place on earth you ever heard about was the source of that stuff.
Iggy has sworn to his bunch that the material is of extra-solar origin. They're
propagandizing it in Russia now. A good thing, too. The Russians were all ready
to call the whole thing a Yankee trick."
"I've
heard some of those broadcasts," said the colonel. "I was hoping we
could keep that information to ourselves."
"Don't
be childish," said the physicist, in as abrupt a tone as he ever used.
"We're not out on maneuvers, sonny. Time and time again one person or
another has told the world to wake up to reality. This once the world will wake
up or else. You won't be able to keep it asleep any more. It's gone too
far."
The threat from Outside finally broke in the
papers, but only after long and worried conferences in governmental and
military headquarters all over the world. The simple fact that the world would
Cp JOURNEY TO INFINITY
work
together or face extinction made, at first, as much impression as it ever
had—very little. It was not enough to overcome man's distrust of himself. Not
at first.
JJut
the die-hards yielded, gradually and with misgivings, and acquainted the
people with the menace that faced them. There was little dangerous
panic—controls were too tight to allow for it—but, after the first thrill of
excitement, there came a unanimous demand for a plan of action which was too
powerful to ignore.
Bulletins
were posted hourly on the amplitude of the Jansky signals. As Dr. Simmons had
pointed out, there were three sets of them, and it became increasingly evident
that the three sources were in V formation, and coming fast—much faster than
the first one had.
"They'll
box us," said Colonel Simmons. "There won't be any circling this
time. They'll take up equidistant positions around the planet, out of our
range, and they'll fire at will."
"I
think you're right," said his brother. "Well, that gives us two kinds
of defense. They're both puny, but it'll be the best we can do. One's
technological, of course. I don't know exactly which direction would be the
best to take. We can build ships ourselves, and attack them in Space. We can
try to develop some kind of shield against their bombs, or whatever else they
use against us. And we can work on seeking torpedoes of some sort that'll go
out and get 'em—bearing in mind that we might be out there ourselves some time
soon, and we don't want to fall prey to our own weapons."
"What's the other
defense?"
"Sociological.
In the first place, we must decentralize to a degree heretofore impossible. In
the second place, we must pool our brains and our physical resources. No nation
can afford to foot the bill of this kind of production; no nation can afford to
take the chance of bypassing some foreign brain which might help the whole
earth. Leroy! Stop puckering up like that! You look as if you're going to cry!
I know what's bothering you. This looks like the end of professional
militarism. Well, it is, in the national sense. But you have a bigger enemy
than ever before, and one more worthy of the best efforts of humanity. You and
your Board have been doing what seemed to be really large thinking. It wasn't,
because its field was too small and too detailed. But now you have something
worth fighting. Now your plans can be planetary—galactic—cosmic, if you like.
Don't hanker after the past, soldier-boy. That attitude's about the only way
there is to stay small."
UNITE AND CONQUER 91
"That's
quite a speech," said the colonel. "I . . . wish I could argue with
it. If I admit you're right, I can only admit that there is no solution at all.
I don't believe the world will ever realize the necessity for co-operation
until it's too late."
"Maybe it will. Maybe. I remember once
talking to an old soldier who had been in the First War. In his toolshed he
had a little trench shovel about eighteen inches long—a very flimsy piece of
equipment it was. I remarked on it, and asked him what earthly good it was to
a soldier. He laughed and said that when a green squad was deployed near no
man's land and ordered to dig in, they gabbled and griped and scratched and
stewed over the job. And when the first enemy bullets came whining over, they
took their litde shovels and they just melted into
the ground." He chuckled. "Maybe it'll be like that. Who knows ?
Anyway, do what you can, Leroy."
"You
have the strangest sense of humor," growled the colonel, and left.
They came.
The first was just a shape against the stars.
It could be heard like a monster's breath in a dark place: wsh-h-h-t wsh-h-h-t wsh-h-ht on the sixty megacycle band, where, before,
nothing had been heard but the meaningless hiss of the Jansky noise. But it
could not be seen. Not really. It was just a—a shape. A blur. It did not
reflect radar impulses very well; the response was indeterminate, but
indicated that it was about the size and shape of the mysterious bomber which
had dealt the first, terrifying, harmless blow.
The
world went crazy, but it was a directive madness. With the appearance of the
Outsider, all talk of the advisability of defense ceased. There could be no
discussion of priorities.
A
Curie Institute scientist announced light-metal fission. A Hungarian broke his
own security regulations with the announcement of an artificial element of
heretofore unthinkable density, which could be cast into fission-chambers,
making possible the long-awaited pint-sized atomic engine. A Russian scientist
got what seemed to be a toe hold on antigravity, and set up a yell which
resulted in a conclave of big brains in Denver—men from all over the world. He
was wrong, but a valuable precedent was set. A World Trade Organization was
established, with control of raw materials and manufactured goods, their routes
and schedules. Its control was so complete that tariffs were suspended in toto—the regulation read "for the duration"—and,
92 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
since
it is efficient to give a square deal, a square deal was given in such a
clear-cut fashion that objectors were profiteers by definition. Russian ores
began appearing in British smelters, and Saar coal was loaded into the
Bessemers of Birmingham. Most important of all, a true International Police
force came into being with hardly a labor-pain. Its members were free to go
everywhere, and their duty was to stop anything which got in the way of
planetary production. Individual injustice, faulty diet, poor housing,
underpaying and such items fell immediately into this category, and were dealt
with immediately and with great authority.
Propaganda
unified itself and came to a focus in the hourly bulletins concerning the
Outsiders. And every radio station on earth included that dread triple hiss in
its station-breaks.
And
the Outsider just stayed where it was, just lay there in the spangled black,
breathing, waiting for its two cohorts.
"It's
makeshift," said Dr. Simmons, "but it might do. It just might
do."
The colonel stepped past him and looked at
the cradle, on which rested a tubby, forty-foot object like a miniature
submarine. "A satellite, you said?"
"Uh-huh. Loaded to the gills with
direction-finders and small atomic rockets. It'll keep a continuous fix on the
Invaders during its transit, and relay the information to monitor stations on
Earth. If one of the ships fires a torpedo, it will be detected immediately, reported,
and the satellite will launch an interceptor rocket. If the bomb or torpedo
dodges, the interceptor will follow it. In the meantime, big interceptors can
be on their way from Earth. If a torpedo comes close to the satellite, the satellite
will dodge. If it comes too close, the satellite will explode violently enough
to take the torp with it. We plan to set out three layers of these things, nine
in each stratum, twenty-seven in all, so spaced as to keep a constant scanning
in every direction."
"Satellites,
hm-m-m ? Muscles, if we can do this, why can't we go right out there and get
the ships themselves?"
The
physicist ticked the reasons off. on his fingers. "First, because if they
bracket us, as in every likelihood they will, they'd be foolish to come any
closer than the one that's already here, and he's out of any range which we can
certainly handle just now. We can assume that his ships, if not his bombs, will
be prepared against our proximity devices. We'll try, of course, but I wouldn't
be too hopeful. Second, we still haven't a fuel efficient enough to allow for
escape velocity
UNITE AND CONQUER 93
maneuvers
without a deadly acceleration, so our chances of sending manned rockets up for
combat are nil at the moment."
The
colonel looked admiringly at the satellite and the crowd of technicians which
swarmed around it. "I knew we'd come up with something."
His
brother gave him a quizzical glance. "I don't know if you fully realize
just how big a 'we' that is you just used. The casing of that satellite is
Swedish steel. The drive is a German scientist's adaptation of the Hungarian
baby fission engine. The radio circuits are American, except for the scanning
relay, which is Russian. And those technicians—I've never seen such a bunch.
Davis, Li San, Abdallah, Schechter, O'Shaugnessy—he comes from Bolivia, by the
way, and speaks only Spanish—Yokamatsu, Willet, Van Cleve. All these men, all
these designs and materials, and all the money that make up these satellites,
have been found and assembled from all over the earth in only the last few
weeks. There were miracles of production during the Second War, Leroy, but
nothing to match this."
The
colonel shook his head dazedly. "I never thought I'd see it happen."
"You'll
see more surprising things than this before we're done," said the
scientist happily. "Now I've got to get back to work."
That
was the week the second Outsider arrived. It took up a position in the
celestial South, not quite opposing its fellow, and it lay quiet, breathing. If
there was converse between them, it was not detectable by any known receiver.
It was the same apparent size, and had the same puzzling effect on radar and
photographic plates as had its predecessors.
In Pakistan, an unfueled airplane took off
from a back-country airstrip, flew to twenty-thousand feet, and came in for a
landing. The projector which was trained on it had no effect on the approaching
aircraft in the moment it took the plane to disappear behind a hillock and
reappear on the other side. There was a consequent monetary power loss, and the
plane lost too much altitude and had to make another pass. The wind direction
dictated a climbing turn to the north, and the beam from the projector briefly
touched the antenna of an amateur radio operator called Ben Ali Ra. Ben Ali
Ra's rig exploded with great enthusiasm, filling the inside of his shack with
spots and specks of fused metal, ceramic, and glass. Fortunately for him— and
for the world—he was in the adjoining room at the time, and suf-
94 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
fered
only a deep burn in the thigh, where it was struck by a flying fragment of a
coil-form.
This was the first
practical emergence of broadcast power.
Ben
Ali was aware of the nature of the experiments at the nearby field, having
eavesdropped by radio on some field conversations. He was also aware of certain
aims and attitudes held by the local authority. Defying these, he left the
area, at night, on foot, knowing that he would be killed if captured, knowing
that in any event his personal property would be confiscated, and in great pain
because of his wound. His story is told elsewhere; however, he reached Benares
and retained consciousness long enough to warn the International Police.
The
issue was not that broadcast power was a menace; it had a long way to go before
it could be used without shouting its presence through every loud-speaker
within miles. The thing that brought the LP. down in force on this isolated,
all but autonomous speck on the map was the charge that the inventors intended
to keep their development to themselves. The attachment of the device and all
related papers by the Planetary Defense Organization was a milestone of legal
precedent, and brought a new definition of "eminent domain." Thereafter
no delays were caused by the necessity of application to local governments for
the release of defense information; the LP. investigated, confiscated, and
turned the devices in question over to the Planetary Defense Organization,
acting directly, and paying fairly all parties involved. So another important
step was taken toward the erasure of national lines.
Two weeks before the arrival of the third
Outsider—the third of the V, excluding the one which had been shot down—the
last of the twenty-seven satellites took up its orbit, and the Earth enjoyed
its first easy breath since the beginning of the Attack—for so it was called.
Due
to high-efficiency circuits and components, the fuel consumption of the
electronic setup in the satellites was very small. They held their orbits
without power, except for an occasional automatic correction-kick. They could
operate without servicing for years. It was assumed that by the time they
needed servicing, astrogation would have developed to the point where they
could be refueled—and recharged—by man-carrying ships. If technology did not
solve that problem, little harm could be done by the silent, circling machines;
when, at long last, they slipped from their arbitrary orbits and spiraled
\
UNITE AND CONQUER 95
in
to crash, so many years would have passed that the question was, momently,
academic.
And even before the twenty-seventh satellite
was launched, factories were retooling for a long dreamt-of project—a Space
Station, which would circle the Earth in an orbit close enough to be reached by
man-carrying rockets, which would rest and refuel there and take off again for
deep Space, without the crushing drag of Earth's gravity.
The
third Outsider took up its position, as Dr. Simmons had prophesied, equidistant
from the others with the Earth in the center, rolling nakedly under them. As in
the case of the arrivals of the other two, there was no sign of its presence
but the increasing sound on the sixty megacycle band. Radar failed utterly to
locate it until, suddenly, it was in its position—a third blur against the
distant stars, a third indeterminate, fifteen-hundred-foot shape on the
radarscopes.
The
Board of Strategy was happily, almost gleefully, busy again. Their earlier work
within the field of the probability of human works, faded to insignificance
against the probabilities inherent in the Attack. There was another major
difference, too; they came out in the open. They plastered the world with
warnings, cautions, and notices, many of them with no more backing than the
vivid imaginings of some early science fiction writer—plus probability.
Although logic indicated that the first blows would be in the form of
self-guided missiles, thousands of other possibilities were considered. Spy
rays, for example; radio hams the world over were asked to keep winding coils,
keep searching the spectrum for any unusual frequencies. Telepathic amplifiers,
for another example; asylums were circularized for any radical changes in the
quality and quantity of insanity and even abnormal conduct. The literary
critics were called in to watch for any trends in creative writing which seemed
to have any inhuman content. Music was watched the same way, as were the
graphic arts. Farmers and fire wardens were urgently counseled to watch for any
plant life, particularly predatory or prehensile or drug-bearing plant life,
which may develop. Sociologists were dragged from their almost drunken surveys
of this remarkable turn of social evolution, and were ordered right back into
it again, trying to extrapolate something harmful to come from this functional,
logical, unified planet. Only the nationalists found harm, and they were—well,
unfashionable.
The
bombs came about a month after the third Outsider took up his post.
96 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
The
whole world watched. Everything stopped. Every television screen pictured
radarscopes, and the whip-voiced announcer at Planetary Defense Central in
Geneva, which had at long last regained its place as a world center.
The
images showed Outsiders A, B, and C in rapid succession. So well synchronized
was the action that the three images could have been superimposed, and would
have seemed like one picture. Each ship launched two bombs; of each two, one
turned lazily toward Earth, and the other hovered.
"Out
of range of the satellites," said the announcer. "We shall have to
wait. The satellites will detect the bombs when they are within two hundred
miles, and will then launch their interceptors. Our Earth-based rockets are
aiming now."
There
was a forty-minute wait. Neighbor called neighbor; illuminated news-banners on
the sides of buildings gave the dreaded news. Buses and trains stopped while their
passengers and crews flocked to televisors. There was a hushed tension,
world-wide.
"Flash! Satellite 24 has released an interceptor. Stand by; perhaps we can get a recording
of the scanner . . . one moment please . . . Anything from Monitor 24b yet,
Jim? On the air now? Chec\ . . . Ladies and gentlemen, if you can be patient a moment; we are
recording pictures of the radarscope at Monitor 24b in Lhasa. It will be only a few . . . here it is now."
Flickering
at first, then clearing, came the Lhasa picture. The monitor station there kept
a fix on Satellite 24 from horizon to horizon, as did the
satellite's other two stations in San Francisco and Madrid. The picture showed
the familiar lines of the satellite. Abruptly a short, thick tube began to
protrude from the hull. When extended about eight feet, it swung over about
forty degrees on its ball-and-socket base. From its tip shot a small cylinder;
there was a brief flicker of jets. "The interceptor," said the
loud-speakers unnecessarily.
The
scene flashed to the Earth-based interceptor station at White Sands. A huge
rocket mounted with deceptive slowness, balanced on a towering column of flame,
and disappeared into the sky.
Then,
bewilderingly, the scene was repeated for Monitor Stations 22c and 25a,
as their satellites sensed
the bombs coming from Outsiders B and C. White Sands sent two more giant
rockets up as fast as they could set the seeking gear.
Then, after an interminable four hours, came
the picture which was to stand, forever, as the high-point in newsreel
coverage. It was
UNITE AND CONQUER 97
the
image picked up from the relaying television camera in the nose of Satellite 24's little interceptor.
It
fixed the image of the Outsider's bomb, and it would not let go. The bomb, at
first only a speck, increased in size alarmingly. It was a perfect cylinder,
seen in perspective. There was nothing streamlined about it. It was quite
featureless except for a strange indistinc-tion around one end, as if it were
not in focus. It was like a small patch of the substance of the Outsiders
themselves.
The image grew. It filled
the screen—
And then there was nothing.
But
cameras all over Europe picked up and relayed the image of that awe-inspiring
explosion. Silently a ball of light appeared in the sky, expanding, flickering
through the entire spectrum, sending out a wheel of blue and silver rays. It
lasted for a full fifteen seconds, growing in size and in brilliance, before
it began to fade, and it left a pastel ghost of itself for a minute afterward.
Speckles of random radiation cluttered the screens then, and there were no more
actual pictures of the action.
The entire earth gave a concerted shout of
joy. In dozens of languages and dialects, the fierce, triumphant sound roared
skyward. Got
one! And the bells and the
whistles picked up the cry, frightening sleeping birds, sending crocodiles
scuttling off river banks, waking children over the world. It was like a
thousand New Year's Eves, simultaneously.
What happened next,
happened quickly.
A
White Sands rocket got the second bomb. For some reason there was no atomic
explosion. Perhaps the proximity gear failed. Perhaps it was neutralized,
though that would seem impossible, since the seeking gear obviously did not
fail. It was not as spectacular as the first interception, but it was quite as
effective. The purely physical impact as the huge interceptor struck the tiny
bomb all but pulverized them both.
The
third bomb breezed past its satellite interceptor, its White Sands interceptor,
and a second-stratum satellite. It was observed that on getting within range of
the seeking-radar of each of these, it became enveloped in the misty,
coruscating field which characterized the Outsider ships. Apparently this
field completely confused the radar; it was as if the radar detected it but
didn't know what to do with it—"same spot we were in a year ago," as
Dr. Simmons remarked tersely.
The bomb entered the
atmosphere—
98 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
And burned up like a meteor.
Then it was that the most incredible thing of
all happened. The three hovering bombs—one by each Outsider—slowly retreated
toward the parent vessel, as if being reeled in. They recalled their bombs.
Thereafter they lay quietly, the three
Outsiders. They did not move, they made no move. They gasped their triple
pantings, and they filled thousands of photographic plates with their
indeterminate muz-ziness, and that was all.
Four giant rockets out of five, which were
sent after the invaders, missed their mark completely. The fifth, which was
equipped with an ingenious seeking device based on correlation of its target
with an actual photographic transparency of the target, apparently struck Outsider
B. There was a splendid atomic display, and again the world went mad with joy.
But
when the area could be observed again, Outsider B was still there. And there it
stayed. There they all stayed.
A cyclic, stiffly controlled panic afflicted
the Earth, as a sense of impending doom was covered by humanity's classic
inability to fix its attention for. very long to any one thing; alternated to
reactive terror, swung away from terror again because life must go on, because
you must eat and he must love and they must make a bet on the World Series. . .
.
Seven months passed.
Dr. Simmons plodded into
his private office and shut the door. He was tired—much more tired than in the
days, earlier that year, when he was working an eighteen-hour day. The more a man does, the more he can do, he reflected wearily, until the optimum is reached; and the optimum
is way up yonder, if he cares about what he's doing. He sat down at his desk and leaned back. And if he cares just as much as ever, but
there just isn't as much to do, he gets tired. He gets very, very tired . . .
He
palmed his face, blinked his eyes, sighed and, leaning forward, flipped the
annunciator switch. His night secretary said brightly: "Yes, doctor?"
"Don't
let anything or anybody in here for two hours. And take care of that
cold."
"Yes, sir. Thank you, doctor; I
will."
A good \id. . . . He rose and went to the washroom which
ad-
UNITE AND CONQUER 99
joined
his office. Stepping into the shower stall, he lifted up the soap dish, which
had a concealed hinge, and pressed a stud under it. He counted off four
seconds, released the stud, and pulled on the hot water faucet. The back wall
of the shower swung toward him. He stepped through into his own private laboratory—the
one where no one else ever went.
He
kicked the door closed behind him and looked around. / almost wish I could do it all over again. The things that have happened here, the
dreams . . .
His thought cut out in a
sudden, numbing shock.
"What are you doing
here?"
The
intruder accepted the question, turned it over, altered it and gave it back.
"What have you been doing here?" rasped the colonel.
The
physicist sank into an easy-chair and gaped at his brother. His pulse was
pounding, and for a moment his cheek twitched. "Just give me a
second," he said wryly. "This is a little like finding someone in
your bed." He took out a handkerchief and touched his dry lips with it.
"How did you get in here?"
Leroy
Simmons was sitting behind a worktable. He had his hat, with its polished
visor, in the crook of his arm, and his buttons were brilliant. He looked as if
he were sitting for a particular kind of portrait. The doctor jumped up.
"You've got to have a drink!" he said emphatically.
The
colonel put his hat on the table and leaned forward. The act wrinkled his tunic
and showed up his bald spot. "What's the matter with you, Muscles?"
The
doctor shook his head. He
doesn't loo\ li\e a man of distinction any more, he thought regretfully. "I feel a little
better now," he said. "What brings you here, Leroy?"
"I've
been watching you for months," said the colonel. "I've had to do it
all myself. This is . . . it's too big." He looked completely miserable.
"I followed you and watched you and checked up on you. I took measurements
all around these offices, and located this room. I was in here a dozen times,
looking for the gimmick on the door."
"Oh,
yes. Always dropping around to see me when I wasn't around, and saying you'd
wait. My secretary told me."
"Her!"
The syllable was eloquent. "She's no help. I never saw anyone harder to
get information from."
"It's
an unbeatable combination in a secretary," he grinned. "Infinite
tact, and no facts. She's not in it, Leroy. No one is."
100 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"No one but you. I notice you're not
denying anything."
The
doctor sighed. "You haven't charged me with anything yet Suppose you tell
me what you know, or what you think you know."
The
colonel took a somber-backed little notebook out of his pocket. "I have no
associates," he said grimly, "either. It's all in here. Some of it is
Greek to me, but some I understand—worse luck. I wish I didn't You have
something to do with the Outsider, don't you?"
His
brother looked at him for a long moment, and then nodded, as if he had asked
and answered a question.
"Yes."
"You know where they come from, what
they're going to do, how they operate—everything about them?" "That's
right."
"They
have given you—information. They have given you a way to"—he referred to the book, his lips moving as he read;
they always had—"expand and concentrate binding energy into a
self-sustaining field."
"No."
"No?
You have all the formulas. You wrote thousands of pages of notes on the
subject. Your diary mentions it repeatedly—and as if it was an accomplished
fact."
"It is. I didn't get
it from the Outsiders. They got it from me."
There
was a jolting silence. The colonel turned quite white. "That . . . does .
. . it," he whispered. "I knew you were in contact with the enemy,
Muscles. I tried my best to believe that you were simply working them for
information, so that we could use it against them. A risky game, and you were
playing it alone. After I went through your papers here, I just couldn't
believe it any more. You seemed to be working along with them. And now you
tell me that you actually are supplying them with devices we haven't
got!"
The scientist nodded
gravely.
The
colonel's hand, under the table, moved to his wrist. He touched a button on the
small transmitter there, and pulled a slide over.
Dr.
Simmons said, thickly: "Leroy, Would you mind telling me how you got on to
this?"
"I'll
tell you, all right It started with a routine checkup of supplies and
equipment into these laboratories, for auditing purposes. No production is run
without cost accounting, even by the govern-
UNITE AND CONQUER 101
ment.
Even by a Planetary one. It was brought to my attention that certain things
came in here that apparently never went out. When I went over the reports and
saw they were correct, I wrote a memo which cleared you completely, on my
authority, and I killed the investigation. I—picked
it up myself." "Good heavens, why?"
"If
I found anything," the colonel said with difficulty, "I wanted to
take care of it myself."
"Sort of keep the
family name sweet and clean?"
"Not
that. You're too clever. You always were, I . . . I'll tell you something. I
was appointed to the Board because of you. I never could have made it
otherwise. The Board figured I'd be an intimate link with you; that I could see
you any time, when no one else could."
Of
course I \new that, thought
the doctor. "I didn't know that," he said. "I don't believe
you."
"Oh,
cut it out," said the colonel. "You played me for a sucker all along,
and through me, the Board."
Correct
again, the physicist
thought. He said: "Nonsense, Leroy. I just withheld information from time
to time."
'You
gave us tips," said the colonel bitterly. "You sent us off on goose
chase after goose chase. And we pushed the whole world around the way you
wanted us to."
The
boys real sharp tonight, thought Dr. Simmons, and added to himself, He's such a swell, sincere character. I hate
to see him go through all this. "And why does all this make you squelch the Board's investigation
and pick it up yourself?"
"I
know how slick you are," said the colonel doggedly. "You just might
talk a jury or a court-martial out of shooting you. I don't see how you could,
but I don't see how you could have done any of this either." He waved a
hand around the secret lab. "You won't talk your way out of it with me."
"You're my judge,
then, my jury. My executioner, too?"
"I'm
. . . your brother," said the colonel in a low voice, "and, like
always, I want you to get what you deserve."
"I
could puddle up and bawl like a baby," said Dr. Simmons suddenly, warmly.
"Let's stop playing around, Leroy, and I'll tell you the whole
story."
"Is it true you've
been working with the Outsider?"
"Yes, you idiot!"
102 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
The colonel slumped back and said, glumly:
"Then that settles it. Go ahead and talk if you want to. It can't make any
difference now." He looked at his watch.
The scientist rose and went to a wall panel,
which he pulled out, revealing a compact tape recording outfit. From a rack
above it he selected a reel, set it on the peg, and drew the end of the tape
into the self-threader. Without switching on, he returned to his chair.
"Just
a couple of preliminaries, Leroy, and then you can have the whole story. I have
done what I have done because of what you used to call my 'dewy-eyed idealism.'
It has worked. We live now in a unified world. It must remain unified until
the threat of the Outsider is done with; it has no alternative. I don't think
that the Outsider will be removed for a while yet, and the longer the world
lives this way, the harder it will be for it to go back to the old cut-up,
mixed-up way of life it has followed for the last fifteen thousand years or so.
"I'll
tell you what will happen from now on out. The Space Station will be completed
and put into action. A new fuel will be developed which will speed things just
at the boredom point. Shordy afterward, the three Outsiders will put out their
hovering bombs again. It'll throw the world into a. panic, but with the Station
and the new fuel and the whole world working at it, a fighting ship will leave
the Station—outbound.
"It
will sling some torps at the Outsiders, and they won't go off, or they'll miss, or they'll explode prematurely. The Outsider won't hit
back. The warship will move in close, and when it gets close enough to do real
damage, it will get a mesage.
"This
message will be broadcast on the three most likely frequencies, and signals
will go out all over the other bands advertising those three frequencies. The
message will start like this: 'Stop and listen. This is the Outsider.' This
will be repeated in English, French, Spanish, German, Arabic and, for good
measure, Esperanto. This is the message."
He
rose again, put his hand on the switch, smiled, and turned to face the colonel.
"Funny . . . this was designed only to speak to the future. And you're the
first to hear it."
"Why is that funny?"
"You're
the past." He flipped the switch. "You'll pardon the tone of
it," he said gently. "I had a chance to make a deep purple oration,
and I find I ramble on like an old lady over her knitting."
"Yoa?"
UNITE AND CONQUER
"Me. The Outsider. Listen."
This is the message, as it came from the tape
in Dr. Simmons' leisurely mellow voice:
I am the Outsider. Do not fear me. There will
be no battle. I am your friend. Hear me out.
I am
four ships and a noise in the Jansky radiations. The ships are not ships, and
they came from Earth, not from Outside. The Jansky signals do not come from the
stars. Listen.
I am
one man, one man only, without helpers, without any collaborators, except
possibly thinkers—a little Thoreau, a little Henry George, maybe a smattering
of H. G. Wells . . . you can believe me. Archimedes once said, "Give me a
lever long enough, and a place for a fulcrum, and I shall move the earth!"
Given the tools, one man can do anything. There's
plenty of precedent for this. Aside from the things which produce a man, aside
from the multitude of factors which make his environment, if the man is
capable, and if the environment provides tools and a time ripe for action, that
man can use his tools to their utmost extent. Hitler did it. John D.
Rockefeller and Jay Gould did it. Kathleen Winsor did it. I read somewhere,
long ago, a beautiful allegory. "Take a naked human being, and set him
down beside the Empire State building, and ask, what have these two things in
common?" Given the tools, mankind can do anything.
I
was given the greatest single tool in history. I stumbled on it. I'll tell you
the truth: I worked like a hound dog to find it, once I suspected that it was
there.
It's
a theory and a device. The theory has to do with binding energy; the device
releases and controls it. It is all completely and clearly explained elsewhere;
I'll come to that in time. Roughly speaking, however, it is a controlled
diffusion of matter. Any gas can be rarefied and diffused. So, I have
discovered, can any matter. Further, it can be diffused analytically. Binding
energy is actually a component of matter. If a close-orbit situation can be
induced between the electrons and the nucleus of an atom, its binding energy
can be withdrawn, if equally diffused, to form a field around the atom. The
field is toroidal, and has peculiar qualities.
For
one thing, it does crazy things to the apparent center of gravity of the
mechanism producing the field. Any seeking device which tends to locate mass,
directs itself at the e.g. But on approaching a field of this sort, the closer
it gets, the harder it becomes for it to find the e.g.,
104 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
since
the apparent center of mass is out at the edges. When directed at the actual
center of the device, your seeker veers violently to the edge— hard enough,
generally, to make it pass the mechanism altogether.
The
field distorts and reflects radio and light waves in an extremely complex
fashion. These waves are led powerfully to follow the outlines of the toroid;
but since the field is a closed one—closed as tighdy as only binding energy can
close anything—light and radio cannot penetrate, no matter how strong the
temptation. And so they are thrown back, rather than reflected in reflection's
ordinary sense, and return to their detectors—receivers, photographic plates,
or what have you—in a rather distorted pattern.
The
field has also a strange effect on valence, making it possible to build
chemical compounds out of elements of similar valence. The atomic situation
within the toroid—in the hole of the doughnut, as it were—is weird, and is the
place where such compounding can be done. Exact data on this will also be given
you.
Now,
here is exactly what was done. Having found the way to generate this field, I
debated the wisdom of giving it to a world on the verge of war. I contemplated
destroying all my evidence, but could not; the thing was too big; humanity
needed it too much. But it was too big for even a unified humanity on one
planet. It's big enough for all of space, and needs a humanity big enough to
control it. I felt that if humanity were big enough to unify, it would be big
enough for this device. It is, now, or you spacemen would not be listening to
me.
After
having developed the binding-energy field, I invented another device—the
Spy-Eye. I knew that the little eavesdroppers would be produced by the
thousands, so that a few would not be missed. A half-dozen were launched with
their selector circuits altered, and some of their equipment replaced. Their
fueling was different, too; there is a reaction-formula using the b.e. field
which will be found with the rest of these things.
My half-dozen Spy-Eyes, powered vastly beyond
any of their litde brothers and sisters, went Outside and took up their
positions in space. They
are the Outsiders!
The
noise in the Jansky radiation was pure propaganda, and its execution was
simple—practically primitive. It was a trick once used by illegal radio
stations during one of the Wars—I forget which. Three of them, widely separated
and synchronized, sent out the same signal, beamed to an Earth diameter.
Direction-finders on Earth obediently pointed out their resultant—a direction in which they did not exist!
UNITE AND CONQUER IO5
The
Spy-Eyes themselves were too small and too far away to be detectable, unless
one knew exactly what to look for and where to look. The amplitude of the
signals was raised gradually until it reached a preselected volume. Then one
of the Spy-Eyes set up a b.e. field and dropped toward Earth. It looked strange
and huge. It came in close and circled Earth twice at a high velocity. I think
I had more trouble there than at any other point; but I managed, finally, to
wangle the Board of Strategy into firing on it. Their shell hit nothing; the
b.e. field disrupted its atomic warhead, for in the presence of a hard-radiation
source, the field increases the effective critical mass. The Spy-Eye itself is
what fell on Japan; it was armed, of course, and was mistaken for a little
bomb. What made the explosion so intense was the fact that the field held the
disrupting matter together for a fraction of a millisecond longer than it had
ever been done before. The object which fell near Minsk was a piece of
stage-property I had made earlier. It, too, had a b.e. field generator on its back.
Again it exhibited its exclusive-ness and its penetrating power; it acted like
a thing of great mass when it hit the ground. The generator was, of course,
blown to dust on impact, leaving only the supposed specimen.
The
other three Outsider ships were Spy-Eyes, b.e. field equipped. The bombs were
real bombs, however. They were supplied by Satellite 18, which, if examined, will be found inexplicably empty of its interceptors.
I put guiding heads on them, and sent one to each of my "Outsider"
Spy-Eyes.
I
think that explains everything. If you question my motives, regard the Earth
as you deep-spacemen see it today—unified, powerful, secure within and without.
Humanity is ready, now, to take the first steps toward greatness. Therefore:
Send
my name—Simmons—in the old International Morse code on 28.275 meters, from a distance of ten statute miles from any of the three
Invader ships, at one thousand watts power. Repeat the name four times. The
field will break down; you may then locate the Spy-Eyes and pull them in.
Dismantle them; inside you will find this recording and certain papers, which
contain everything I know about the binding-energy field. Use it well.
Colonel Simmons leaned back in his chair. His
face was gray. "Muscles—is this all true?"
"You know it is. You've seen it in
action." "Now what have I done?" muttered the colonel.
106 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"Jumped to conclusions," said the
doctor easily.
The
colonel's mouth opened and closed spasmodically. Then in violent reaction, he
swore. "You couldn't've done it!" he roared. "You set the
timetable for this whole thing and built it into those Spy-Eyes. Well, what
about all that was done here—the interceptors from White Sands, and the
development of the satellites, and all that?"
"Leroy,
old horse, take it easy, will you? Who had charge of all that development? Who
had the final say on design? Who outlined the exact use of each piece of
equipment—by way, of course, of using it to its greatest efficiency?"
"You
did. You did." The colonel covered his face. "All that power. All
that control. You could have had the whole world for the taking, if you'd
wanted it. Instead—"
"Instead,
everyone on earth has a job, enough food, good quarters, and an equal chance at
education. I have it on good authority that the next session of Congress will
unify divorce laws and traffic laws in this country. Russia has not only a
second party, but a third one. Social legislation is beginning to follow the
lines of the Postal Union, and already a movement has started to have the
Governments pay the people their full wages during a six-week vacation. No
Communism, no Fascism; function is the law, and social security—lower case—is
function."
"Shut
up!" mouthed the colonel in a peculiar tone, half moan, half roar. He held
his head and he rocked.
The
doctor clasped his shoulder and laughed. "Listen to me, Leroy," he
said, "and I'll tell you something funny. You know how little, stupid
anecdotes will stick with you, like the limerick about the young lady from
Wheeling, and the time you took the ball of tar to bed with you and we had to
shave your head? Well, believe it or not, I honestly think that this job I have
just done had its source in a couple —no; three—things that happened to me when
I was young. When I think of them, and look at the world today—my!"
He took a turn around the
floor. His brother sat still.
"Wells
had something to do with it. Wells pointed out, mostly indirectly, that only a
miracle could make humans work together. And sometimes his miracle was
entertaining but untenable, because it constituted a common aim for mankind.
That never did work. World peace is the finest aim a race could have, but it
never tempted us much. Wells' other miracle was a common enemy—the Martian
invasion, for example. Now, that makes sense. It did then and it does now.
UNITE AND CONQUER IO7
"And
here are the silly litde things that have stuck with me. Remember that summer
when I got a job as a dirt-moving foreman on a canal job? Two of the muckers
got into a fight out by one of the machines. I got up into the dragline and
dumped a load of sand on the two of them. They stopped fighting, ganged up on
me, and punched the daylights out of me." He laughed.
"Then
there was the other one. It was even sillier. It was in a restaurant, right
after I started to teach at Drexel Tech. There were two bubble-headed little
chicks sitting at a nearby table, verbally clawing each other's eyes out over
a young man. Just as I was about to get up and move back out of the combat
area, they spotted the young man in question submitting to the wiles of a very
cute redhead. Whereupon the combatants were suddenly allies, and on the
spot"—he laughed again—"concocted a devilish scheme to squirt ink on
the contents of the redhead's clothesline I"
The colonel was looking at him dully.
"The
common denominator," continued the doctor, "in the analysis of Wells,
the fight on the canal job, and the feline fiddle-faddle in the café, was surprisingly valid, considering the wide
difference in the nature of the fields of combat. It boils down to this: that
human conflicts cease to be of importance in the face of a common enemy.
'Divide and rule' has its obverse; 'unite and conquer.' That's what the world
has done during the Attack; except that instead of conquering the Outsider, it
has conquered itself—still its common enemy."
"Wells,"
murmured the colonel. "I remember that. I was reading him and told you the
miracle idea. I was in military prep., and you were a freshman in
college."
"Gosh yes," said
the doctor. "I remember, Leroy."
The
colonel seemed to be thinking hard, and slowly. He spoke slowly.
"Muscles," he said, "remember how I wore your freshman dinky
when you came home for a week end?"
"Do I!" chuckled the doctor.
"You wouldn't give it back, and I spent the next six weeks sweeping out
seniors' rooms because I showed up at school without it. Heh! Remember me
strutting around in your gray cape when you were at the Point?"
"Yeh.
We were always doing that. Your tie, my tie, our tie. Those were the days. You
wouldn't fit my clothes now, Fatso."
"Is
that so!" laughed the doctor, delighted to
see his brother making some effort to come up out of his doldrum.
"Listen, son; you rate
108 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
too
much to be in shape. Too many flunkies to bend over for you when you want your
shoes tied."
The
colonel whipped off the coat with all those shiny buttons. "You couldn't
button that around your fallen chest."
In
answer the grinning doctor shucked out of his laboratory smock and put his arms
into the uniform jacket. With some difficulty and a certain amount of sucking
in and holding back, he got it buttoned. "The hat," he demanded. He
put it on. It was too small.
Meanwhile
the colonel slipped into the smock, with its solder-flux stains and its worn
elbows. He flapped it in front of him. "What do you do with all this
yardage? Smuggle stuff? Hey, Muscles; let's have a look in the cheval glass in
the office. I want to see what I would look like as a Great Brain."
They
went into the office, through the door in the shower stall. The doctor, all
aglitter in his brother's jacket, went first. There was a man standing just by
the outside door. He had a black cloth over his nose and mouth and a silenced
automatic in his hand.
The
colonel, his smock flapping, pushed past his brother and walked out into the
room. The man shot him twice and disappeared through the door.
"Leroy! Who did it,
kid?"
"I did," said the
colonel. "No!
No doctor. Too late.
Stay—"
"You
... oh. Oh! That bullet was meant for me. The jacket switch, hm-m-m? But why? Who
was it?"
"Never
mind . . . him," said the colonel. "Hired. Psychoed. Whole thing
planned. Foolproof escape. All witnesses called away. He doesn't know you. Or
me. My idea. Was very . . . careful."
"Why? Why?"
"Found
out you . . . work with . . . enemy—"
His voice trailed off. He closed his eyes sleepily and lay still for a moment.
Then, his face twisted with effort, he sat suddenly upright. His voice
returned— his normal, heavy, crackling tone. "I had proof—proof enough
that you were a traitor, Muscles. I was afraid you'd get clear if you got a
chance to work on a court. But I couldn't bring myself to kill you with my own
hands. I figured it out this way."
"So
he'd be there, and shoot me when we came out of the office. But why didn't you
call him off?"
"Couldn't. He had orders to shoot the
civilian. You were an officer for the moment. He didn't know us, I tell you. I
radioed to a
UNITE AND CONQUER IOC;
third
party, who knows nothing. He gave this hood the starting gun." He raised
his left hand. On the wrist was the miniature transmitter. "I called him
when you admitted you worked with the Outsider . . . then you explained . . .
and I couldn't call back; he was on his way here."
"Leroy,
you fool. Why didn't you let him go ahead? Why did you make that silly switch?
My work's done. Nothing can change it now!"
"Muscles
. . . I'm . . . old-line Army. Can't help it . . . don't like this . . . brave
new . . . never could. You're fit for it. You made it; you live in it. Besides,
you'll . . . appreciate the joke better than ...
I would"
"What do you mean, kid?"
"You
underestimated . . . you thought you'd be dead when the . . . spacemen heard
your recording." He laughed weakly. "You won't be, you know.
Things're moving too fast."
There was a sudden,
horrible spell of coughing.
And
then Dr. Simmons was alone, holding his dead brother's head in his arms,
rocking back and forth, buffeted and drowning in an acid flood of grief.
And behind it—far, far behind it, his
articulate mind said, dazedly: Great day in the morning, he's rightl Whafll they ma\e of me— a saint, or a blood-red Satan?
Divided
no longer, Mankind consolidated its gains and looked to the stars. From the
initial moon trip in 1978, space travel rapidly extended to the planets.
With Mars and Venus colonized, the twenty-first century's economy had an
interplanetary basis, influenced by the powerful spacemen's union. By 214$ the union had destroyed the corporations and had instituted, after a bitter fight, a dictatorial rule.
BREAKDOWN
by
]ac\ Williamson
O |
fficially, Boss Kellon was merely executive secretary
of the Union of Spacemen, Managers & Engineers. But boss, now in 2145,
was equivalent to caesar. From the unitron converters on Mercury to
the lonely mining outposts scattered across the Jovian moons, the Union
dominated mankind. And Harvey Kellon was the Union.
He
was a big man. His shrewd, deep-set, deliberate eyes could be chill as blue
Callistonian fire diamonds, but a bland professional smile warmed his cragged
red face. He wore a flowing white toupee, and few of Sunport's millions
suspected that the boss was bald as the first caesar of old Rome.
Sunport
was his capital. For a hundred years the monopoly of interplanetary commerce
had fed its power, until even New York was now only a quaint provincial suburb.
The towers of the megalopolis stood like a forest of bright monoliths for a
hundred miles about the high Colorado mesa that had become the port of space.
Forever the tiny moonlet of the Outstation rode at the city's meridian, a
man-made star of its fortune.
Boss
Kellon lived in the crown of the lofty Union Tower. The huge, luxurious halls
of his penthouse suite were named for the worlds of the Sun. Tonight there was
a ball in the Neptune Room, and he was dancing with Selene du Mars.
The boss was short of breath, and dark
perspiration spotted the
no
BREAKDOWN III
shoulders
of his purple dress pajamas. His feet ached. Perhaps, at sixty, he was too old
to be dancing; certainly he had too much weight about the middle. But Selene du
Mars could make men seek to banish such uncomfortable thoughts.
She
was tall and supple and green-eyed. She had been a famous teleview dancer. He
thought she was the most costly and glittering thing in all Sunport. Tonight
her hair was platinum, and she was dazzling with fire diamonds. He thought
those favorite stones were like herself—cold and bright and hard. But he could
admire even her calculating ambition, because it was so akin to his own.
Selene
claimed a hereditary degree in militechnic engineering. Once Kellon had ordered
a quiet investigation, and the Goon Department reported evidence of forgery.
Her father had been merely the servant of a militechnic officer, on Jupiter
Station. But Kellon suppressed the report, with not a word to Selene. He knew
how hard was the climb up from the gray.
Now,
and not for the first time, she was wheedling him to crown himself. Her voice
was cool and perfect as her long body, and she used the flattering address that
she herself had first suggested:
"Your
genius, can we have the coronation soon? Everything is planned. Your historian
friend Melkart has dug out the old ceremonials for me. My jewelers are working
on a fire-diamond crown."
"For
me to pay for," Kellon chuckled, and drew her pantherine body close
against him. "Darling, I know you want to be Empress of the Sun, but your
pretty head is in danger enough, without a coronet."
Kellon
frowned, sobered by the thought. He had climbed to the perilous apex of a human
pyramid. He was first of the million hereditary engineers, who, with their
families and the various grades of their retainers, occupied nearly all the
upper-level towers of Sunport.
But,
here in Sunport alone, nearly eighty million more wore the gray of labor. They
dwelt and toiled in the subsurface levels, and the Goon Department bound their
lives with iron restrictions. Kellon knew how they lived—because he had been
one of them.
Most of them hated the technician nobility of
the Union. That was the dangerous flaw in the pyramid. Kellon had once tried to
mend it, with reforms and concessions. But Melkart warned that he was three
generations too late. Yielding to that hatred, he was merely paying out the
rope to hang himself.
"We're
dancing on a volcano, darling," he told Selene. "Better not poke the
fire!"
112 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
Selene's bare shoulders tossed, and her eyes
flashed dark as her em> erald-sequined
gown. But she curbed her displeasure. She knew that a hundred other women in the long, green-lit hall would have murdered
gladly for her place in Kellon's arms. Her frown turned to a pretty pout.
"Please,
your genius." Her perfect face winced slightly. Kellon knew that he had
stepped on her silver slipper. But she smiled again, shrugging off his apology.
"It wasn't caution that conquered the planets for you," she chided.
"Your genius isn't getting old?"
That
was his vulnerable point, and Selene knew it. Perhaps he was. The details of
administration were increasingly burdensome. It was hard to find trustworthy
subordinates. Sometimes he felt that the Union itself was slipping into
decadence, as he grew older.
"The coronation—" her coaxing voice went on.
But
Kellon stopped listening. He let her dance out of his arms. He watched the thin
man threading toward him through the press of bright-clad engineering
aristocracy wheeling about the dance floor.
The thin man was Chief Marquard of the Goon
Department. He wore wine-colored formal pajamas and a jeweled Union star. But
he had no partner, and his harassed expression meant bad news. Kellon braced
himself for trouble.
"Your
genius, it's the Preacher!" The whisper was hoarse with strain. "He's
here in Sunport." Marquard gulped and wet his lips. "Still in
hiding—somewhere down in the drainage levels."
This
was more than merely trouble. Kellon swayed. The lofty shining murals blurred.
He saw instead the dark, dripping tunnels, a thousand feet beneath the
pavements of Sunport. Once he had hidden there himself, a hunted man in gray.
The syncopated drone of the orchestra was suddenly the throb of drainage
pumps.
Kellon's
thick, pink hands made a desperate clutching gesture. He had watched the spread
of the Gray Crusade, a poison that attacked the Union and rotted the very
fabric of civilization. For years the Goon Department had sought the Preacher,
in vain. But it was hard to believe that the fanatic had dared to enter
Sunport.
He
was getting old, indeed. Old and alone. He felt helpless against the demands of
this grim moment. Suddenly he was almost ill with a desperate regret for the quarrel with his
son. Family loyalty, in this cynical metropolis, was almost the only dependable
bond. Now he needed Roy, terribly.
Dazed by the impact of this emergency, his
mind slipped back into
BREAKDOWN II3
the
past. To Roy, and Roy's mother. It had been Melkart who first introduced the
slender, gray-eyed girl. They were at a secret meeting, down in the drainage
ways. Melkart said proudly, "Ruth is going to be the Joan d'Arc of the New
Commonwealth."
Perhaps Ruth had loved Melkart. Kellon was
never sure. For the secret police of
the Corporation raided the party headquarters, a few months later. Melkart was captured
and transported to Mars. It was only after she had received a false report of
Melkart's death, that she would marry Kellon.
Kellon
was responsible for that report. He had tried to atone for it, however, with
the parole he secured for Melkart as soon as he had sufficient influence.
Ruth
had never abandoned her dream of the New Commonwealth. She had not approved
the methods of Kellon's rise to power, and she was deeply hurt when he ordered
the Union Goons to hunt down the few surviving members of the party. Roy was
twelve years old when she died.
Roy
was like his mother—lean, intense, idealistic. Kellon was delighted when the
boy wanted to take practical degrees in unitronic engineering—it helped him
forget that his own hereditary tides were forgeries.
But
Roy had been a bitter disappointment. He failed to show any interest in Union
politics. He refused to enter the Militechnic College, to prepare for command
and promotion in the Fleet. Instead, at twenty, he had gone to waste a year
with some meaningless research at the solar power plants on Mercury.
The
quarrel happened after Roy returned—five years ago. Roy didn't like Selene du
Mars. She made matters worse by trying to flirt with him. He called her an
unpleasant name, and stalked out of the penthouse suite. He had never come
back.
But
Kellon had followed him, next day, to the great unitronics laboratory on the
mesa. A silent crystal egg, his unitron glider sloped down toward the long,
low, white-roofed building that stood between the commercial port and the
militechnic reservation.
Like
an elongated silver bubble, a freighter was lifting from the Venus Docks,
bright and strange in the shimmer of its drive field. Gray stevedores were
trucking away the gleaming metal ingots and squared hardwood logs it had
unloaded. A Martian liner lay in her cradle, spilling dark ore concentrate
down a chute. A space-battered Jovian relief ship was loading mountains of
crates and bales and drums—food and
114 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
equipment
and power for the miners on Callisto. The Mercury Docks were stacked with
crated dynode batteries, freshly charged in the Sun plants. All the commerce of
an interplanetary empire!
But
Kellon's pride had a bitter taste. He could remember when the port was far
busier, back in the days of the Corporation. Now half the yards were weed grown
and abandoned. Dismanded ships were turning red with rust in the cradles at
the disused Saturn Docks.
His
pilot landed the glider on the white roof. Kellon asked for his son, and a
startled watchman guided him down through the laboratory. Space had really been
conquered in this building, Kellon knew; all the great advances in unitronic
flight had been made here. But most of the halls were deserted now, the old
equipment dismantled or ruined.
Kellon
found Roy in a long, clean shop whose plastic walls were softly radiant with a
clear blue-white. Huge windows looked out across the militechnic reservation,
where the unitron cruisers of the Fleet lay like immense dead-black arrows.
Roy
was bronzed with spaceburn from his year on Mercury. He looked up, with his
mother's nervous quickness, from some gadget on a bench. Kellon was a little
shocked to see the screwdriver in his hands —for an engineer of the higher
ranks, any sort of manual work was considered degrading.
Roy seemed glad to see him.
"Sorry
I lost my temper." He smiled—his mother's intense, grave smile. "I
don't like Selene. But she isn't important." His brown, quick fingers
touched the gadget, and his gray eyes lit with eagerness. "I'm searching
for a way to test the condensation hypothesis."
"Look,
son." Kellon gestured impatiently at the window, toward the row of mighty
black cruisers. "You don't have to play with abstractions. There's the
Fleet, waiting for you to take command as soon as you are qualified. Your
experiments should be left to underlings."
"I'm
sorry, boss" Roy's tanned face set with his mother's unbreakable spirit.
"I think my hypothesis is more important than the Fleet."
"Hypothesis?" Anger boomed in
Kellon's voice. "Important." He tried to calm his tone. "Can you
explain what is important about it?"
"I
tried to, before I went to Mercury," Roy said. "You were too busy to
listen. You see, I have a new idea about how the planets were formed. I went to
Mercury to check it, with closer observations of the •Sun. I believe I am
right."
BREAKDOWN 115
Kellon attempted to swallow his impatience.
"I'm listening, now," he said.
"You
see, the origin of solar systems has never been well explained," Roy
began in a careful voice. "The tidal theories of the twentieth century
were all somewhat strained. There was a statistical difficulty. Only one star
in a hundred thousand could possibly pass near enough to another to raise
planet-forming tides. But the astronomers of the Outstation long ago convinced
themselves that planetary systems are a lot more frequent than that.
"The
discovery of the unitron, a hundred years ago, caused a revolution in nearly
every science. It was recognized as the ultimate matter-energy unit of the
universe. For the first time, it fitted all the various phenomena of
electromagnetics and gravitation into a single picture. But most engineers, in
the era of the Corporation, were too busy conquering and exploring the planets
to devote much time to abstract theories."
Kellon
felt a brief amusement at his son's simple lecture-room explanations, and then
wondered uneasily if Roy knew that his degrees were forged. He frowned, trying
to follow.
"The
twentieth-century cosmogonists had to deal with a confusing array of
concepts," Roy went on. "Electrons and protons, neutrons and
mesotrons and barytrons, photons and light waves, electric fields and magnetic
fields and momentum fields and gravity fields. Already they were beginning to
grope for a unified-field theory, but they never quite perceived all those
things as manifestations of the same ultimate unit. It's no wonder they never
quite understood the Sun, or how the planets came to be born from it!"
"But you do?" Kellon was
interested, in spite of himself.
Roy nodded eagerly, and touched the gadget
again.
"I
think I do," he said. "It is hard to believe that the existence of
planets depends on a freakish accident. In my theory, a star forms planets as
normally as it radiates energy. Even now, the Sun is emitting unitron mass at
the rate of about four million tons a second. I believe that planets have been
condensed out of emitted unitron matter, by a combination of several processes,
over periods as long as the life of the stars."
Roy's gray eyes were shining.
"That
is my hypothesis—that every normal star has formed planets of its own. The
tidal theories allowed only a handful of habitable planets in the entire
galaxy. I believe there may be—millions!" His
Il6 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
quick
hand gestured, with the gadget. "Of course, it is still only a hypothesis—though
the Outstation astronomers have found evidence of planets about several of the
nearer single stars. But I'm going to find out!"
He searched Kellon's face. "Do you see
it, father?"
Heavily, Kellon shook his rugged white-wigged
head.
"Your
argument sounds reasonable enough," he admitted. "Once at the
Outstation I saw a graph that had some little dips they said meant planets. But
what of it? I don't see anything to get excited about."
Tears of frustration came into Roy's eager
eyes.
"I
can't understand it," he whispered bitterly. "Nobody gets excited.
Nobody cares." His bronzed head lifted defiantly. "But the engineers
of a hundred years ago would have been building ships to explore those
planets!"
"I
don't think so," Kellon objected wearily. "It would be too far for
commerce. The moons of Saturn haven't been visited for sixty years. Right now,
our Jovian outposts are losing money. Supplies and transportation cost more
than we get back. If it wasn't for Union prestige, I would abandon them
today."
"Science
has been slipping back, ever since the uranium process was lost." Roy's
face was troubled. "I don't know why." His brown chin lifted.
"But we can go on. The unitron drive can be improved. With time and money,
I could build an interstellar ship!"
"Maybe
you could," Kellon said. "If you are fool enough to want to die on
some strange, barren world that men never even saw—when I have an
interplanetary empire to give you!"
"I
guess I'm just that kind of fool," Roy said quiedy. "I don't want an
empire."
Kellon lost his temper, then.
"I'm
going to cut off your allowance," he shouted at the white-lipped boy.
"That will stop this nonsense. Come to me whenever you are ready to take
up militechnics."
"You
had better go back to Selene du Mars," Roy told him, in a thin, low voice.
"I don't need the allowance."
And
that was true. Within a few months, Kellon learned that Roy had designed a new
type drive-field coil for the unitron transports in the Jovian service. It
saved three days in the long run out to Jupiter, and increased the power
recovery in deceleration nearly forty percent.
BREAKDOWN 117
For
the first time in twenty years, the Callistonian mines showed a tiny profit.
Roy's fees, paid by the Union Transport Authority, were a hundred times the cut-off
allowance.
In the five years since, Kellon hadn't seen
his son. Roy had ignored an invitation he made Selene send. But he knew,
through the Goon Department, that Roy was still at the old unitronics
laboratory, furiously busy with his research. Learning that his funds were
running low, Kellon had ordered the Transport Authority to double the promised
royalties. Roy had replied with a brief note of thanks.
Now, standing stunned and alone amid the
whirling dancers under the green-glowing murals of the Neptune Room, Boss
Kellon felt a crushing need to see that thin, determined face, that was so much
like Ruth's had been.
But Roy had failed him. Under the burden of
the tottering Union, he stood all alone. There was no other that he could trust
completely. And Marquard's thin, frightened whisper goaded him back to face the
present grim emergency.
"The
Preacher's in Sunport," the distracted Goon chief repeated. "His
followers already know. Mob gathering in Union Square." His lean shoulders
shrugged, in a helpless bewilderment. "Delicate situation, your
genius."
"Delicate, hell I" Kellon caught his breath, and decision flashed in his shrewd blue eyes.
He had fought alone before, and he could again. "Search the drainage
levels," he ordered crisply. "Arrest the Preacher."
"Is your genius sure—" Marquard blinked uncertainly.
"He has terrific influence. Before he came, it might have been safe. Now
his followers will make trouble."
"I'll handle trouble when it
happens." Kellon stiffened his big shoulders, and managed to smile again.
He must hide the black panic that swept him. "Don't kill him," he
added. "Just bring him in. Martyrs are dangerous."
"Your genius commands."
The
thin man turned nervously away, the frown of worry cut deeper in his dark face.
The orchestra throbbed on—playing from a high platform whose glowing plastic
decorations represented an ice cave on Triton, Neptune's once-visited moon.
Kellon started back to Selene du Mars.
She was waiting, slim and tall in the
flashing green sequins. Even
Il8 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
her
smile was hard and bright and beautiful. Kellon felt an eager little quickening
of his pulse, for he still loved Selene. Then he saw that she was smiling for
another man.
Admiral
Hurd came striding across the crowded floor. Black-and-orange pajamas were cut
to emphasize the broad triangle of his shoulders. He was young and tall and
dark. His toothy smile flashed, and he greeted Selene by the militechnic title
she claimed:
"May
I, Miss Captain?" Then he saw that Kellon was approaching. A kind of wary
alertness tensed his face, and the smile that erased it was a little too broad.
"If your genius will allow?"
"Darling, you look
tired."
Selene
turned the white dazzle of her smile on him, and slipped into the dashing
admiral's arms before he could respond. Left alone on the floor, Kellon felt a
tired envy for Hurd's youth and looks and vigor. Really, he was getting old.
He
watched Hurd and Selene, dancing cheek to cheek. Her eyes were closed; her
restless face seemed relaxed for once, and happy. But he caught a covert glance
from Hurd's dark eyes, watchful, oddly hostile.
Turning
wearily away, Kellon felt another surge of black regret for his son. If they
had not quarreled, Roy might now have been in command of the Fleet, instead of
Hurd. The new admiral was brilliant, and his record was clear, but Kellon
didn't like him.
Kellon
left the ballroom, escorted unobtrusively by his Goon bodyguards. He crossed
the vast, silent Moon Room, to a terrace that looked down over Union Square.
It
was night, and Sunport after dark was a view that had always stirred him. The
towers were wide apart. Facades of luxion plastics turned them to tapering,
graceful pylons of soft and many-colored fire. Their changing splendor lit the
broad parks between, and stood inverted in a hundred pleasure lakes. The
surface ways were broad curving ribbons of light, alive with the glowing cars
of joy-riding engineers. A few pleasure gliders floated above the landing
terraces, colored eggs of crystal light.
Sometimes,
with an ache of longing, Kellon recalled his first rare glimpses of this bright
and magical scene. For his childhood had been lived in the lower levels. It was
only on infrequent holidays that he was allowed to come up into the parks,
where he could see this forbidden, shining paradise of the engineers.
BREAKDOWN 110,
How mad his dreams had been! Ten million
others must have dreamed them, but only he had come up to take the city for his
own. Sometimes even yet the hard-won victory seemed altogether incredible. Nor
ever had it been the pure untroubled delight he had dreamed of. Heavily, he
sighed.
"Your
genius!" The husky officer of the bodyguard stopped him in the wide arch
of the terrace doorway, where drafts were checked only by a film of moving air.
"The terrace may be dangerous—there's an ugly mob below,"
"Thanks,
major." He shrugged, and pushed on. He couldn't afford to yield to the
fear in him. Confidence was his safest armor. "You know this is my
favorite view."
But tonight the picture was grimly different.
The
long rectangle of Union Square, below him, was gray with pressing crowds. From
this elevation, the surging masses looked like some strange vermin, crawling
about the bases of these mighty, shining, clean-lined towers that he loved.
Scores
of bonfires glared, points of angry red. His nostrils stung to a whiff of paper
burning. Faint with distance, the angry buzz of voices came up to him.
Evangelists were screaming hoarsely, and shrill voices sang. He caught a snatch
from the "Battle Hymn of God":
"Burn the boo\s and brea\ the gears]
Kill Antichrist and engineers!"
Kellon stood there a long time, until his
sweaty hands set cold upon the shining rail. He was sick with a fear that all
these glowing towers would crumble into that gray ocean of blind destruction.
But Melkart said there was nothing left that he could do.
Suddenly
his cold body jerked to a brittle clatter of automatic gunfire. A mile from
him, at the end of the square, gray mankind was flowing like a queer, viscid
liquid over the bright-lit surface way: Cars were seized and capsized in that
live flood, like small, glowing beetles.
Tiny screams reached him. Black Goon cars
appeared on the shining pavement, and guns crackled again. It was too far to
distinguish individual human forms, moving or dying. But the mass of the gray
wave drew reluctantly back. The stream of traffic halted, and the light went
out of the luxion pavement.
Anxiously, Kellon went back through the
archway in the softly
120 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
glowing
wall—it was pulsating tonight with soft and slowly changing hues of violet and
rose. He wondered briefly if quieter colors and a slower beat would seem more
confident.
In
the silent, cyclopean Moon Room, he hurried to the telephore desk. He dropped
impatiently on his seat in the U-shaped slot, with the stereo prisms standing
in a half circle before him. In the center screen, the bright image of the
red-haired operator was a litde smaller than life.
"Get
me Marquard," he rapped. The girl nodded silently, and the dark, thin
features of the Goon chief sprang into the next crystal oblong. Kellon couldn't
keep the rasping tension out of his voice. "Have you got the
Preacher?"
"Not
yet, your genius," Marquard replied in his habitual jerky, nervous
whisper. "Mob is getting ugly. Looted the park library and made fires of
the books. Started smashing pleasure cars on Union Way. Had to kill a few of
them, to rescue an engineer and his girl. Diverted traffic." His worried
eyes blinked uneasily. "Maybe we ought to clean the square?"
"No,"
Kellon told him—it was good to be able to make one more sure and instant
decision. "The dead ones are martyrs. Leave them alone. They'll howl
themselves exhausted and go back to their warrens."
"I hope so,"
Marquard whispered faintly.
"Just
catch the Preacher, and send him to me." Kellon nodded at the operator,
and the Goon chief vanished from the prism. "Reference Department."
He spoke to a dyspeptic-looking female. "Show me the latest Goon report on
the Preacher." The document was projected in the next screen.
Special Report No. 45-H-198
Union Goon Office, Sunport,
E. February 30,
2145 BY: Goon Operative GK-89 (R. A. Meyer, Politicotechnic Engineer).
SUBJECT:
Eli Catlaw, alias the Preacher of the Revelation, alias the Word of God, alias
the King of Kings. Labor No. G-496-HN-009. Escaped convict, Mars Penal Reservation, No. 45-V-18.
Wanted for murder of guard.
Believed now in America, but whereabouts unknown. Note: Catlaw is a dangerous character.
Liquidation recommended.
BREAKDOWN 121
Tapping a key to change the pages, Kellon
skimmed significant passages. "Catlaw was born in the Ozark District, of
labor-class parents. . . . Mother's claim to illegitimate technical blood
probably false. . . . Transported to Mars for assault on engineer. . . . Guard
murdered, in escape. . . . Catlaw reached Venus Commonwealth on ore ship. . . .
Became 'swamp walker' and successful herb trader. . . . 'Conversion' and
preaching dates from recovery from attack of jungle fever. . . . Returned to
Earth about nine years ago, to lead underground 'Crusade' against Union. . . .
Enabled to evade many Goon raids by vast popular support. . . . Treason charges
against Union factions. . . . Cadaw has incited assassination and sabotage. . •
. His program implies total destruction of technical civilization."
Kellon
finished the report. He sat staring into the empty prism, as gravely as if he
could read there the end of Sunport and all his world. He had scarcely moved,
an hour later, when Marquard brought in the Preacher.
Eli Catlaw seemed almost unaware of the burly
Goons who gripped his arms. He was lank and tall in faded gray overalls, and he
stood erect and defiant. His dark, hollow eyes stared arrogantly past Kellon,
at the lofty luxion murals that illuminated the room. Kellon's shrewd eyes
studied the man, against the background in the Goon report. Thick lips and high
cheeks and stiff black hair showed Negro and Indian blood. The yellow face was
long and angular and stern. At last the sullen, hostile eyes came back to
Kellon's face, but obviously the Preacher didn't intend to speak first.
Kellon turned on his frank,
confident smile.
"I'm
glad to see you, Catlaw," he said smoothly. "I'm sorry if this is
inconvenient for you, but it was the only way I knew to get your point Qf view."
The
boss paused invitingly, but the Preacher said nothing. He stood absolutely
motionless, between the big men who held him. His burning eyes stared bleakly
away, through the far, glowing murals.
"I
know that times are difficult." Kellon kept his voice suave and even.
"The exhaustion of the Jovian mines has caused depression. All the heavy
industries are almost dead, and labor has naturally suffered. But I personally
am deeply concerned for the comfort and welfare of the masses. And I assure you
that the Union will earnesdy consider any reform measures you will
suggest."
Kellon paused again. Stillness whispered in
the long Moon Room.-
122 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
Beneath
the mighty glowing murals, that showed station domes and robot miners and long
unitron transports against a background of towering lunar peaks and star-shot
space, the little group at the tele-phore desk seemed queerly insignificant.
The room seemed too vast for its builders.
Now
at last the Preacher spoke. His long, stern face showed no response to Kellon's
persuasive smile, and he ignored Kellon's arguments. In a tense, grating,
stifled voice, he began quoting texts from the Revelation:
"Babylon the great is fallen, is fallen,
and is become the habitation of devils, and the hold of every foul spirit. . .
. Alas, alas, that great city Babylon, that mighty city! for in one hour is thy
judgment come."
Kellon's smile had turned a
little pale.
"Are
you crazy?" He coughed against a troublesome rasp in his throat. "I
suppose you mean Sunport?" His bewilderment was honest. "But Sunport
is civilization!"
Stiff and insolent, the
Preacher croaked:
"He that kjlleth with the sword must be
hilled with the sword. . . . Therefore shall her plagues come in one day,
death, and mourning, and famine; and she shall be utterly burned with fire. . .
. In one hour is she made desolate. . . . And the light of a candle shall shine
no more at all."
Kellon
leaned over the curving desk, with a look of earnest puzzlement.
"I
don't understand you, Catlaw," he protested gravely. "Do you want to
wreck all that men have accomplished ? Do you want the future to forget the
power of science? Do you want to turn men back into naked savages, and wipe out
civilization?"
"Civilization?"
The Preacher made a harsh snorting laugh. "Your glittering civilization is
itself the Harlot of Babylon, poisoning all that yield to her painted lure. The
science you revere is your false prophet. Your machines are the very Beast of
the Apocalypse."
He gulped a hoarse breath.
"Yea, Armageddon and
the Kingdom are at hand!"
"Listen to me,"
begged Kellon. "Please—"
Catlaw jerked angrily in
the grasp of the Goons.
"I
have come to destroy this last, most evil Babylon." His metallic, pulpit
voice rang through the long Moon Room. "Even as the angels of God once
smote the wicked cities of the plain, Sodom and
BREAKDOWN I23
Gomorrah.
And every engineer shall be burned with the fire of the Lord—save that he
repents tonight!"
His yellow face was a
stern, rigid mask.
"I
warn you, Antichrist. Repent tonight, and follow me." The cunning of the
swamp trader glittered briefly in his hollow eyes. "Turn your power to the
path of God, and I will receive you into the Kingdom. Tomorrow will be too
late."
Kellon rose, gasping for
breath.
"Listen!"
His voice trembled. "I fought to rule Sunport. And 111 fight to preserve
it from you and all the lunatics who follow you. Not just because it is mine.
But because it is the storehouse of everything great that men have
created."
"Then
you are damned!" Scuffling with the Goons, Catlaw shook a dark, furious
fist. "With all your city of evil."
Kellon's voice dropped
grimly.
"Fm
not going to kill you, Catlaw. Because you are probably more dangerous dead
than alive, just now. But I know that you are a fugitive from the Union, with
an untried murder charge waiting for you, Fm sending you to the Outstation
prison, tonight, to await trial for murder."
He nodded at the Goons, and
they dragged the prisoner away.
Kellon
sat down heavily at the telephore desk. The Preacher unnerved him. It was hard
for him to understand that deadly, destroying hatred, that blindness to all
reason. But he knew that it was multiplied many million times in the gray-clad
masses under the Union. He thought of the howling mob of the Preacher's
fanatics about the foot of this very tower, and he was afraid.
But he must not yield to
fear.
"Get
me the militechnic reservation," he told the telephore operator.
"The Admiralty Office. Hurd's at the ball, but I'll talk to the officer
in charge."
The
efficient redhead nodded, in the center prism. Kellon was astonished when the
next screen lit with the dark, handsome features of Admiral Hurd, himself.
"Your
genius looks surprised." Hurd flashed his easy, white-toothed smile.
"But I left the ball, after one dance with Miss Captain du Mars. I had
reports of this crisis, and I felt it my duty to be ready for your
commands."
"Thank you, admiral." Kellon tried
to put down an uncomforta-
124 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
ble
feeling that Hurd was far too alert and dutiful. "I have arrested the
Preacher. His followers may try to set him free. I want a cruiser to take him
to the Outstation prison, as soon as possible."
"At
once, your genius. I was expecting duty, and my flagship is hot. Ill take the
prisoner myself. The Technarch
will be on the Goon Office
terrace, to receive him, in five minutes."
Smiling, Hurd flickered out
of the prism.
Kellon
felt another stab of sharp regret that Roy had failed him. But he had no time
to dwell upon his dim mistrust of Hurd. For the empty prism lit again, with
Marquard's worried features.
"Your
genius, the people know we caught the Preacher." The Goon chief's whisper
was nervous and hurried. "Mob in the square getting ugly. Fighting the
Goon cordons. Fm afraid they will attack the Tower."
Kellon
caught his breath, and tried to keep smiling. He felt confused and tired. He
was afraid that any violent action would jar the human volcano under Sunport
into terrible eruption.
But
something had to be done. Some display of confidence was necessary, to help the
morale of his supporters. He lifted his big shoulders, and groped for his old
habit of instant decision.
"I'll
talk to them," he told Marquard. "They can't all be as mad as Catlaw.
I'll tell them who butters their bread." He smiled a little, as he turned
to the operator. Any action made him feel better. "I'll speak from the
terrace," he said, "on the Tower telephore."
"Wait,
your genius," the Goon chief objected anxiously. "The terrace is
dangerous. Automatic arms in the mob. Afraid the demonstration has support
from some faction in the Union. My operatives still looking for evidence.
Better keep out of range."
"I'll speak from the
terrace," Kellon repeated.
Of
course, he might be killed. Fear was a cold, crawling thing inside him. But he
had faced death before. Now a display of perfect confidence was the best weapon
he could use. He prepared to conceal his gnawing unease.
The
touch of a key dropped the telephore desk into the lavatory below, a hall of
glowing luxion almost as splendid as the huge Moon Room. Kellon adjusted the
white toupee. A servant rouged his heavy jowls back to a cheerful glow. He
tried to rinse the dry rasp out of his throat.
The
elevator section lifted him back to the Moon Room. He walked back through the
glowing luxion arch, to the lofty terrace. The
BREAKDOWN 125
telephore
stand here had only two prisms. Standing between them, he could look down across
Union Square.
Now
the pavements had been darkened, all around the square. Surface traffic was
stopped. That gray, human sea had grown until it overflowed the ways, to the
shining bases of the towers beyond. The hum of voices had a lowered, vicious
tone.
Kellon
spoke to the operator in the prism beside him. The wall behind—and all the
illuminated faces of the Union Tower—began to flash, red and dark, red and
dark, to gain attention. That ugly buzzing ceased, and he nodded. The crown of
the Tower became a cool, steady violet.
"People
of Sunport." From the three-hundred-foot screen in the wall beneath him,
his giant image looked down over the mob. Magnified to the depth of thunder,
his voice rolled out of a thousand speakers. "My friends, the action I have taken tonight was taken for your own good."
He
trusted the old magic of his frank, robust smile and his candid, booming voice.
After all, he had talked his way to victory over better men than Eli Catlaw.
But that breathless quiet lasted only a moment, before the defiance of the mob
rolled up to him at the slow speed of sound. It was a monstrous animal bellow.
"My
friends, listen to me." At his quick nod, the operator stepped up the
volume of that tremendous voice. "Listen to reason." A bullet slapped
against the cold, glowing wall behind him. Stinging particles of plastic
showered him. But fortunately the telephore picked up only a muffled thump.
"What can you gain from the Preacher?"
Boos and jeers roared up
from the mob.
"The
Preacher has told you to destroy the machines." He tried to drown that
defiant bellow. "He has told you to kill the men who create and control
them. But think what you owe to machines—everything! Obey the Preacher, and
the most of you will perish—"
BrrrramI
A dull but mighty concussion rocked the
terrace. Kellon glimpsed flying debris, spreading out in a giant fan from
somewhere beneath him. Black smoke overtook it, and covered the mob in a
billowing cloud. His knees were shaking, and his throat went dry. But he tried
to go on:
"The most of you will
perish—"
But
the amplifiers were dead. His natural voice was wholly lost in the blasting echoes that came rolling back through the smoke from
126 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
the
distant towers. The telephore was out of order. Even the operator's image was
gone. He shouted hoarsely at it, and clicked the call key. But the prisms
remained empty.
He
stood clutching the edges of the stand. He felt bewildered and ill, too dazed
even to wonder actively what had happened. At last the smoke came up about him,
in a choking, blinding cloud. He stumbled back into the Moon Room.
"Your
genius!" Frightened members of the bodyguard met him in the doorway.
"Are you hurt?" The officer told him: "It was a bomb. Under the
giant screen. Spies must have set it."
The telephore in the Moon Room was still
working. Kellon dropped weakly in his seat in the slot, with a grateful smile
at the white-lipped operator. He told the redhead to call the Goon Office.
Marquard answered, his jerky whisper briefly relieved:
"Afraid
they had got you, boss." Alarm came back to his thin, dark face.
"Thing is worse than I thought. Widespread plot. Organization. Probably
Preacher is the leader, but engineers were in it. Got surprising quantities of
arms and explosives, and experts to use them."
Kellon managed a hard,
little grin.
"Evidently it isn't
sinful to use machines—when they're guns."
The Goon chief was too
harassed to smile.
"Watch
for your life, boss," he whispered. "Warn your guards. May strike
anywhere. Rioters smashing cars and storming buildings and murdering engineers,
all over the city. Union Tower may be next."
Kellon
drew a long breath. His shaken nerves were recovering from the blast.
"Chin
up, chief!" His rouged smile was easier. "We'll handle things. I'll
call Hurd, and have him stand by with the Fleet. We may need a few tons of
tickle powder dropped out of space. There's nothing like a couple of hundred
thousand tons of long, black unitron cruiser to instill respect." He
turned to the watchful redhead. "Get me the Technarch!'
The
operator nodded. Her head bobbed a little in the prism, as her unseen hands
sped over the switchboard. But the next prism remained blank. A puzzled
expression came over her tense face. At last she told Kellon, "Your
genius, the Technarch
doesn't answer."
Icy, unreasoning panic
clutched Kellon's heart.
"Get me the Admiralty Office."
A dazed-looking militechnic
cadet informed him that Admiral
BREAKDOWN 127
Hurd had taken the entire Fleet into space.
"All the ships had been hot for twenty-four hours, sir," he
stammered. "I understand the annual maneuvers are taking place, off the
Moon."
Kellon
made a stunned little nod, and the startled cadet was cut off. He stared at
Marquard, still imaged in the adjacent prism. The Goon chief had seen and heard
the cadet, and his lean, furrowed face reflected Kellon's consternation.
"The
maneuvers were not to begin for a week," Kellon gulped uneasily.
"Hurd shouldn't have begun them without an order from me." He shook
his cragged head. "But—wholesale mutiny—it's too appalling to think
of!"
Marquard made a tiny,
bleating sound.
"That
explains it, your genius," his whisper rasped. "Arms. Organization.
Experts. Evidence that the Preacher had help from in the Union. He was plotting
with Hurd." His pale face looked frightened. "Looks desperate,
boss!"
"I
won't believe it," muttered Kellon. He didn't dare believe it. Anxiously
he told the tense-faced redhead, "Get me the Outstation. Manager General
Nordhorn. At once."
The
Union's supremacy—and his own—depended on control of space. To that end, the
Fleet and the Outstation were equally essential. That artificial moonlet was
scarcely a mile in diameter, but an often-proved proverb ran, "The master
of the Outstation will be master of the planets."
The
tiny metal moon had a twenty-four-hour period, which kept it swinging always to
the south of Sunport's zenith. At first it had served merely as observatory,
laboratory and steppingstone to space. But the militechnic engineers of the
Commonwealth, the Corporation and the Union had thickened its massive armor of
meteoric iron, until it was the Gibraltar of the system. The theoretical range
of its tremendous guns extended around the Earth and out to the Moon.
"Hurry!"
Kellon croaked. Breathless with impatience, he watched the red-haired operator.
She fumbled with her unseen controls, as if there was some difficulty. But at
last Nordhorn's thin, dark face flashed into the prism.
Manager
General Nordhorn was an old man, bent and yellowed and deaf. He should have
been retired years ago. But few younger men had shown steadfast loyalty—and
even those few, like Marquard, were usually of indifferent ability. Something
had happened to the fine tradition of the militechnic service.
128 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"Has Hurd arrived?" Nordhorn cupped
a trembling yellow hand to his ear, and Kellon shouted: "I have arrested
the Preacher. I sent Hurd to carry him out to prison. He took the Fleet to
space, and he doesn't answer the telephore. There may be trouble. Better call
your men to action stations—"
Kellon's
voice dried up. Nordhorn had looked sternly composed. But now, as he gulped to
speak, Kellon saw the evidence of desperate emotion in his bloodless cheeks and
his thin, quivering lips.
"Your
genius, Hurd has already called." His voice quavered, uncertainly. "I
was just about to call you. Hurd did not mention any prisoner. He delivered an
ultimatum. A shocking thing, your genius —I can't quite understand—he demanded
that I surrender the Out-station!" Nordhorn's yellow Adam's apple jerked,
as he swallowed. "Your orders, sir?"
Blood drummed in Kellon's ears. Cold with
sweat, his hands clutched the edges of the desk. In spite of all the evidence,
the completeness of this disaster was still incredible. He tried to steady his
reeling brain. Hoarsely he ordered:
"You will defend the
Station—to the last."
"To the last." Nordhorn's white
head lifted proudly. "But the situation is desperate, sir." A stunned
bewilderment came back to his face. "I can't understand—things are
happening so fast. But mutiny is reported in some of the gun crews. Men are
fighting in the spaceward bays now."
"Hold out—" begged Kellon. But suddenly the haggard-faced old
general was swept out of the prism. He clicked the call key desperately, and
shouted at the operator, "Get back Nordhorn!"
"I'm sorry, your genius," the tense
girl told him. "The Outstation doesn't answer."
Marquard's sick, shaken face was still in the
other screen. For his benefit, Kellon tried to grin. "So Hurd and the
Preacher are in bed together?" he muttered. "Which do you say will
manage to kick the other out?"
"Won't
matter, if the Station falls," rasped the Goon chief's hasty whisper. He
listened. "Excuse me, your genius. The riot bureau is calling me.
Remember—watch your life!"
His
image was gone. Aimlessly, Kellon stalked up and down the pale-glowing luxion floor
of the long Moon Room. What next? The news from the Outstation had shaken him
more than the explosion
BREAKDOWN 120,
under
the terrace. He felt numbed and ill. Still the Station didn't answer, and he
knew nothing useful to do.
The
ball was still going on in the Neptune Room, the officer of his bodyguard told
him. Even the telephore newsmen had as yet received little hint of the real
gravity of the situation. The bright-clad dancers didn't know that their world
was at the brink of catastrophe.
Perhaps
that was the trouble. If the engineering class had danced less—if they had
learned more and done more about the other nine-tenths of the population—things
might have been different. But Mel-kart said it was three generations late to
think of that.
"Boss!" a guard
shouted. "Look out!"
Shots echoed against the high, glowing
murals. Somewhere a woman screamed. Fighting men surged through the wide arch
from the Neptune Room. The lights went out in the luxion panels. An automatic
clattered in the dark.
The
broad connecting doorway had been closed only with the sound-absorbing air
screen. Now Kellon heard a muffled woosh! The
armored safety panel had lifted, but too late. The attackers were already in
the Moon Room.
In
the faint glow that came through the terrace arch, he glimpsed crouching,
darting figures. An arm threw something over the fighting Goons. It crashed
beside him. Desperately he groped for it, hurled it toward the far end of the
room, dropped flat behind the telephore desk.
His
ears rang, and the immense dark room was alive with screaming metal. He rose
behind the desk, snatching a hidden automatic from under the seat. But the
shooting had stopped. Light flowed back into the high luxion murals.
Three
men were lying still inside the closed archway. One made a thin, whimpering
sob, and a frightened Goon fired a final shot into his head. The officer came
running anxiously to Kellon.
"Is your genius all
right?"
Kellon managed to grin.
"Attempt No. 17." He was glad of the rouge on his face. No
other attempt had ever come quite so close, or made him feel so weak inside.
He dragged his eyes away from the ruin at the end of the room, where the bomb
had shattered a cragged lunar peak into dusty rubble. "Who were
they?"
Already the Goons were examining the three
dead men. Their
130 journey to infinity
fingerprints
were swiftly identified by telephore. One of them proved to be an hereditary
engineer, who had failed in the examinations for a practical militechnic
degree. The other two were members of the auxiliary white-collar class.
"The
engineer must have come with the guests," the guard officer reported.
"The others were among the musicians. They had guns and the bomb in
instrument cases." He caught his breath. "I regret this terribly,
your genius. But let me congratulate your personal courage, with the
bomb."
Courage! Kellon shrugged and turned quickly
away from the still figures in their gay bloodstained rags. There was already
an odor. Death made him ill. If he had been an instant slower—desperation
wasn't courage. His voice came harsh and loud:
"Get
them out and clean the floor." Then he thought of Selene du Mars. Concern
sharpened his tone. "There was fighting in the ballroom? Was anyone hurt?
Find out if Miss Captain du Mars was hurt."
The safety door dropped again. Anxiety made
him follow the questioning Goons. An ominous, hysterical tension met him in the
vast green-glowing Neptune Room. Cold-eyed officers were grilling the
frightened musicians. Half the guests were gone. The rest were gathered in
pale-faced groups, chattering nervously.
He
couldn't find Selene. The guards at the main entrance, off the public glider
terrace, had not seen her among the departing guests. But she had vanished
early in the evening.
Apprehension
seized him. In spite of her scheming ambition—or even because of it—he loved
Selene. He knew that the Preacher's followers hated her savagely, as the very
symbol of all that was denied them. She might be abducted, perhaps even
murdered.
He
hurried back to the telephore in the bomb-shattered Moon Room, and called her
suite on the floor below. The dark Eurasian major-domo said she had not come
in. But the red-haired operator told him:
"Your
genius, there's a recorded message from Miss Captain du Mars. It was left two
hours ago, to be delivered whenever you called for her. Will you receive
it?"
Kellon nodded, suddenly
voiceless.
Selene's face came into the crystal block.
The fire diamonds burned in her platinum hair. Their changing blaze went blue
as her
BREAKDOWN I3I
clear
eyes, and redder than her lips. Her voice came, cool and hard and perfect.
"Harvey,
I am leaving you tonight. We shall not meet again. This is to thank you for all
you have given me, and to tell you why I have gone. It isn't because you are
getting old, or because I think you are slipping—believe me, I wouldn't go
because of that. But I'm in love with Admiral Hurd. By the time you hear this,
we shall be in space together. I'm sorry, Harvey."
Kellon
sat for a long time at the telephore desk. He felt numb and cold. In a hoarse
voice, he told the operator to run it over. Selene smiled again, and wiped away
the same solitary jewel-bright tear, and spoke the same gem-hard words.
She
lied. Kellon stared blankly at the mural the bomb had shattered—his own life
was darkened and broken, like the luxion panel. He clenched his fists in a sick
and useless fury. Of course she lied!
Maybe
she did love Hurd. The traitor had looks and youth. That would be no wonder.
But it wasn't love that made her go with him. He knew Selene too well to accept
that. She had gone with Hurd because she expected him to be the next master of
the world.
"Run
it again," he told the operator. "Without the sound." And he
greeted the silent image with a tired, bitter grin. "Good hunting,
Selene," he whispered. "After all, we've had our day. Good hunting
—but you and your dashing admiral had better watch the Preacher!"
The lone tear fell, and she
vanished once more.
And
presently Kellon told the operator to try the Outstation again. Selene wasn't
everything. Tonight the world was at stake. His life, and hers. The Union, and
Sunport. The game was being played, far out in the silent cold of space.
Between an old man's loyalty and a young one's ruthless ambition. Between the
old world he had conquered and one unknown. He could only wait for the issue.
There was nothing else to do.
But the Outstation didn't
answer.
"Nothing,
your genius," the operator said. "There has been nothing from space
since General Nordhorn was cut off."
Wearily
restless, Kellon rose from the desk. The dead men had been taken away. But he
thought that the faint, sickening smell of death still hung in the room. He
felt cold, and his big body was haunched with tension. And he felt desperately
alone.
Then he thought of Melkart.
132 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
The
old philosopher-historian was one man who ought to know what was happening to
Sunport. Often in the past his somewhat Machiavellian advice had been useful.
Almost before Kellon knew it, his restless feet were taking him through the
Saturn Room.
That
immense hall was his library. Books walled it, four galleries high. Vaults
beneath held microfilm copies of all known literature. Kellon left his guards
outside the historian's office.
Charles
Melkart occupied a tiny alcove. The white-glowing walls were bare, but one huge
window gave a spectacular view of the shining, night-cloaked city. A huge,
ancient, wooden desk took up nearly half the room. It was piled untidily with
books and stacks of manuscript.
As if unaware of any trouble outside, Melkart
sat behind the desk, writing swiftly with an old-fashioned pen. He was a small,
stooped man. He wore a wrinkled lounging robe. A red wool skullcap covered his
baldness. He blinked as Kellon entered and took off his spectacles. In his
wizened, yellow face, his eyes looked strikingly young and alive.
"Sit down, Wolfe." Melkart never
fawned. "I was expecting you."
Wolfe!
That had been Kellon's party name. He remembered secret meetings, down in the
drainage levels, where the cold walls sweated and the air was alive with the
throb of pumps. That was in the old, dangerous days, before they gave up the
fight for the forbidden ideals of democracy.
Suddenly
Kellon wondered if Melkart and Ruth had really been in love. He dismissed the
thought. That hadn't mattered, for many years. The New Commonwealth was a forgotten
dream. Melkart had left his idealism, with his health, in the carnotite mines
of Mars. And the parole had settled whatever debt there might have been.
But
Melkart had given him a great deal—besides Roy's mother. The lean, brilliant
New Zealander had taught him the science of politics. His degrees had been
forged at the party headquarters, to make him a more useful agent. When the
Corporation shattered the underground organization, Kellon had managed to
escape with most of the party funds.
Kellon
had attempted to repay him with some high position in the Union. But the
sardonic ex-radical declined to accept anything more than the needs of his
simple life, and use of the vast library in the Saturn Room.
"You have made the solar system into a
laboratory for the test of
BREAKDOWN 133
my
politicotechnic theories," he said, with his thin, yellow grin. "Now
all I want is time to finish wridng 'Destiny.'"
Now,
when he came into the scholar's narrow room, Kellon was too perturbed to take
the single chair beside the cluttered desk. He walked to the great window. The
rioters made a gray, uneasy sea below, flecked with the scarlet of fires. A
distant explosion jarred the air; a machine gun rattled; the drone of voices
lifted angrily.
Melkart picked up his pen
to make some hurried note.
Pale
and tense, nails biting into his palms, Kellon turned back from the window. In
a hoarse, desperate voice he asked the lean old man at the desk:
"Charles—do you know
what is happening to Sunport?"
The red fez nodded.
"I've
known for thirty years," Melkart grinned, with owlish assurance.
"Old Giovanni Vico had a glimmer of it, with his 'law of cycles,' back in
the seventeen hundreds. Spengler and Toynbee glimpsed it. Sprague, later, saw
farther. But it remained for me to reduce the laws of the rise and fall of
human cultures to the exact science that I call destiny."
His yellow, clawlike hand
gestured quickly at a huge manuscript. "Here, in my last volume—"
"Listen!"
Kellon's fist banged the desk in interruption. "I've no time for books.
The gray class is rioting. The Fleet has mutinied. The Outstation is under
attack—if it falls, we'll be bombarded from space. Already assassins have
attacked me once tonight."
He made a harsh, mirthless
laugh.
"Books! Can you sit here writing a book,
when the Preacher's fanatics are burning libraries in the park? They are
murdering every engineer they can lay hands on. Who will be left to read your
precious book?"
Melkart's fleshless, yellow
visage grinned.
"Nobody,
I'm afraid," he said slowly. "It is tragic that cultures must reach
the point of breakdown before they can breed men able to understand them. But
lack of understanding does not change the truth. Every fact you mention is
inevitable. Because now Sunport is dead—a petrifact."
"Petrifact—you're
insane!" Kellon slammed the desk again. "This is no time for your
pessimistic theories. I want to know something to do." His voice sank,
pleading. "You have helped me before. There must be—something."
*34 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
Melkart
closed a big book, and Kellon saw that the yellow fingers trembled.
"You and I are finished, Wolfe."
His voice was slow and regretful. "Because the soul of Sunport is dead.
You see, a city or a nation or a culture is something more than the sum of the
individuals that make it up. Sunport was born, back in 1978, when the first rocket blasted off Toltec Mesa. It was created to conquer
space. It did, and that supreme victory made it the greatest megalopolis the
world has seen."
"That's
history," Kellon muttered impatiently. "What's the matter
today?"
"Space
is conquered," Melkart told him, "and that great idea is dead.
Because life doesn't stand still. Disused functions are lost. After the victory
was won, Sunport failed to discover a new purpose to keep her alive. Therefore,
she died. It makes no difference that ninety million new barbarians live on in
these dead towers."
Kellon had moved to speak,
but Melkart added sardonically:
"That's
as true of you, Wolfe, as it is of the city. You aren't a tenth the man you
were thirty years ago, when you set out to smash what was left of the
Corporation. You might have been a match for Eli Catlaw—then."
Kellon smoothed a frown of
displeasure from his face.
"Please,
Charles," he begged. "I know I'm getting old, but the Union is mine.
Maybe I got it by arbitrary methods, but it is a trust. I've got to save it
from the Preacher and his rabble, because the Union has created everything we
call civilization."
"True."
Melkart's red-capped skull nodded gravely. "The engineers were a creative
minority—a hundred years ago. A small group of experts conquered space—and
thereby created more wealth than mankind had ever owned before.
"Inevitably,
the creative power of the engineers resulted in political dominance. Unfortunately,
however, they have ceased to create. Now their spendthrift children merely loot
the wealth their fathers earned, and play their silly game of hereditary
degrees. And Sunport is as much a petrifact as the pyramids of old Egypt."
Kellon leaned over the
untidy desk.
"Sunport
is mine." His rugged face was pale under the rouge, and his low voice
trembled. "I paid for it, with brains and toil and years. I worked and
schemed and bribed and robbed and lied and killed. I
BREAKDOWN 135
lived
in dread of assassination. I fought like a jungle animal for the city." He
gulped a rasping breath. "I won't give it up."
"You
said that," Melkart smiled his wry, yellow smile, "but you help
establish my proposition. Because you completely fail to share the magnificent
aspiration that created Sunport. Out of these restless millions of new nomads,
you merely had superior cunning and audacity and luck.
"But men want to merge themselves in
things greater than their individual lives. Destiny is the word I use, for
those supernal living forces that exalt and give purpose to the lives of
myriads.
"Sunport
has fulfilled her destiny, and thereby lost it. But the Preacher has offered
these new barbarians another destiny—a fresh, common purpose—that is on their
own savage plane. That means that our world has ended, Wolfe."
Kellon stared at him silently.
"You're
lost, Melkart," he said at last. "You will still be sitting here,
when the Preacher's fanatics come along to burn your book and cut your throat.
I think that is the best criticism of your philosophy" —he swung
aggressively toward the door—"but I'm not done."
Kellon
went back to the bomb-torn Moon Room. Perhaps Melkart was right. Perhaps
Sunport was doomed. But he wasn't ready to die. He sat down anxiously at the
telephore desk, and told the operator to call the Outstation once more.
"I'll
try, your genius." The girl was pale and jittery. "But I've been
trying. They don't answer." Her voice was near hysteria. "The whole
telephore system is breaking down. They have been smashing equipment and
murdering operators."
"Get the
Outstation!"
His
voice was harsh with strain. He sat watching the busy girl. Unrest held him
tense, but there was nothing he could do. The minutes dragged. There was no
reply from space, until a terrible screaming came out of the sky.
The tower shuddered. A monstrous, bellowing
vibration drowned all thought. The floor pitched. Concussion jarred Kellon's
bones. The high luxion murals flickered and went dim. The plastic mosaic of a
moon city turned black and came crashing down. The air was filled with choking
dust.
The bombardment had begun.
No need to get the
Outstation now. That first terrible projectile
I36 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
from
space was enough to tell him that Hurd and the Preacher were victorious. The
Outstation had been taken or destroyed.
Sunport
was defenseless. True, there were huge batteries on the militechnic
reservation, beside the spaceport. But, hampered by Earth's gravitation and the
atmosphere, they were almost useless against attack from space—even if the
plotters had failed to put them out of commission already.
Kellon
shivered to something colder than personal fear. For he knew that Melkart was
right. This was the end of Sunport. The Union was finished. The engineering
class was doomed. Ahead he could see only ruin and chaos, ignorance and savage
cruelty, darkness and despair.
"Get me Marquardl" he shouted at
the frightened operator.
Now
the Goon Department was the last feeble defense of civilization. But Sunport
must be blacked out. The people must be warned to leave the city or take refuge
on the lower levels. And he wanted to know where that first projectile had
struck.
The
Goon chief's head came into the crystal block. But it was sagging wearily
back. Marquard's apprehensive frown was at last relaxed. There was a little
dark hole at his temple. The operator made a tiny, stifled scream, and the
peaceful face vanished.
"He's
dead I" She listened, and began a tight-voiced explanation. "The
office says he shot himself, when he learned—"
The second projectile cut her off.
The
Union Tower shuddered again, like a giant live thing struck with some deadly
harpoon. Concussion flung Kellon out of the seat. He was deafened, and the salt
sweet of blood was on his lips.
He
climbed back to the desk. But the operator's prism was blank. The dial lights
were out. Frantically he jiggled the call key, but there was no response. The
instrument was dead.
His
ears ceased to ring. Suddenly he felt that the huge shattered room was queerly
still. He shouted anxiously for his guards, but there was no reply. Peering
into the dust, he saw that the officer lay motionless under a pile of rubble,
in the broken archway. The others had fled.
He was alone.
Alone!
That realization was appalling. Now the breakdown was complete. No longer was
he boss of the Union. He was merely one among millions of frightened and
bewildered human beings. The only order left was the organization of his
enemies.
BREAKDOWN 137
In
his dazed aloneness, he was scarcely aware when the third projectile fell. But
the light flickered, in all the luxion walls, and went out. He cried out, in
the smothering dark. An ultimate purpose was awakened in him—the blind instinct
for survival.
A dim
glow from without guided him to the terrace. He saw that half the city's towers
were still pulsating with the changing radiance of their luxion facades. The
bombardment soon would black them out, he thought bitterly, forever.
Union
Square was almost empty. A few stragglers of the gray mob still fled across the
darkened ways. Near the base of the Tower, dust and smoke drifted out of an
immense dark crater.
So
near! Kellon shivered to a cold realization. The Union Tower was the target.
The space bombardment was aimed at him! Because, by now, he was almost the last
symbol of the Union's shattered power.
He
ran back through the archway, to the roof elevator. Its luxion walls still
glowed, and it shot upward when he pressed the controls. He stumbled out into a
chill night wind, on the penthouse roof.
"Here!"
he shouted, across the glider terrace. "Quick—haul out Ac Ruth!"
Then
he saw that the terrace was deserted. The hangar yawned black and empty. The
long crystal bubble of his unitron glider was gone. The crew must have fled
with it when the bombardment began.
Kellon
stood bewildered in the cold dark. He sobbed, and his fists were clenched
impotently. The world had crumbled under him, and there was nothing he could
do. Civilization had dissolved.
The fourth projectile came nearer still. An
appalling vibration battered him. He dropped flat. The deck quivered, like part
of a monster animal dying. The concussion stunned him.
He
came to himself in the elevator. Its luxion walls were black. He fumbled in the
dark for the controls. But the mechanism was dead. He flung himself into the
dark emergency stair, and started running down the steps.
Presendy,
he supposed, when those guns in distant space had found the Tower's range
exactly, the projectiles would come in salvos, instead of singly.
The
black stair was endless, and his descent became a blurred nightmare. Blast
followed blast, until he no longer tried to count them. The concussions were
shattering blows against his very sanity.
Down
and down, through dust and darkness. Once he tripped over something that felt
like a body, and fell until a landing stopped
I38 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
him.
His muscles jerked with fatigue. Stiff blood dried on his bruised temple.
Somewhere
there were levels where the walls still glowed dimly. It was part of the
administrative offices of the Union, for he glimpsed floor after floor covered
with identical unending rows of glass cubicles and telephore desks and business
machines. The mob must have been here, for he saw scattered bodies of Goons and
grays. But the living had fled.
Still
his numbed brain could function, in a disjointed way. For he realized that his
bright dress pajamas would be a sure warrant of death, when he came down to the
levels where the Preacher ruled. He stripped a gray-clad body, pulled the
coarse garments over his own, and threw away the white toupee.
Sometimes
black panic blotted out all awareness. Fatigue became a drug that destroyed
memory and sensation. But he kept on his feet. He kept moving. Because he
didn't want to die.
There
was another stratum of darkness. Then somewhere he found an elevator that
worked. It dropped him into the damp chill of the drainage levels. The
concussions were now muffled with hundreds of feet of earth. But still they
struck and struck and struck, numbing clubs of death.
Once
he came to himself, and found that rubble had almost buried him. An air tube
had caved above him. He dragged himself stiffly out of the debris. No bones
were broken. He stumbled on. It was a long time before he realized that the
bombardment had ceased.
A
burst of automatic fire crashed out of a dark crossway. He ducked for cover.
But a heavy, bloodstained man in gray lumbered into the pale, cold light of the
tin luxion tube strung along the roof, and covered him with a Goon automatic.
"Halt, for Armageddon
is at hand!"
"Yea,
Brother!" Kellon managed to respond with a dazed quotation from the
Preacher. "And the Kingdom is come."
"Pass,
Brother." The man grinned at him, redly, and explained: "I am hunting
engineers. I've killed seven." Kellon was about to pass, when the gun
moved ominously. "Wait, have you heard the news?"
Kellon waited.
"Admiral Hurd tried to trick the
Preacher." The red hunter chuckled triumphandy. "He was slain by the
hand of God—and a well-flung knife. Now the Fleet is ours—if any ships are
left, for they were last reported fighting one another."
BREAKDOWN I39
Kellon's throat was
suddenly dry.
"Selene—" he
whispered. "What about Miss Captain du Mars?"
"Forget
those words of Satan, Brother." The hunter licked his lips, with an
unpleasant relish. "The harlot of Babylon is also dead. They say that she
betrayed even the Antichrist, in the end. She was found with Hurd, aboard the
Fleet. She took poison when he was killed, to escape the Preacher's wrath.
Hallelujah!"
"Praise
the Lord!" Kellon gasped hoarsely. "Good hunting, Brother."
He
was sorry to learn of Selene's death. Yet he was certain that she had wasted no
pity on herself. She had played the game to the end, by her own hard rules. The
possibility of failure had been taken into her calculations, equally with
success. The poison she had ready was proof enough of that.
Shock
and bewilderment and fatigue made a black fog upon his mind. It was hard to
remember what had happened. Hard to understand it. Like Selene, he had played
by the rules that life had taught him. But now they no longer applied.
Once
he hid from a mob that came splashing along a dark tube. They had flaring
torches. Their leader carried a woman's head on a stake. They were singing the
"Battle Hymn of God."
Dimly,
he tried to understand what had turned human beings into such frightful things.
Of course, the rule of the Union had been a heavy burden, but he remembered
signing many measures for the relief of the masses. Melkart, he remembered,
said that he was three generations late.
It was twenty years since Kellon had felt the
wet chill of the drainage levels. But suddenly the last secret meeting of the
New Commonwealth party seemed only yesterday. This intricate maze of dripping
tunnels remained as familiar as if he had never left it.
Reeling
to his burden of fatigue, he found a little niche that he had dug long ago in
the side of a shaft above a drainage pump. He slept for a long time, and woke
staring at the even marks of his drill still visible in the damp sandstone.
It
gave him a curious and surprising pleasure to see that evidence of the old
strength and skill of his hands. For it was a long time since he had even
dressed himself completely without some aid.
He
was hungry, but still the far past served him. He climbed, by a way he had
known, to the freight levels. Traffic had ceased. He saw
140 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
no
Goons or workmen. In most sections, only a few pale emergency lights were
glowing.
A
few other looters were busy. He avoided them. Presently, he found a wrecked
electric truck, and loaded his gray pockets from its cargo of hydroponic
oranges and tinned imitation beef. He ate, and cached what was left in the
little cave.
It
was dawn of the second day when he came up a sloping freight ramp, into the
tangled weeds and rusting metal and time-dulled luxion masonry of the
long-abandoned Saturn Docks.
He was searching for his
son.
It
was five years, now, since their quarrel. He couldn't be sure that Roy would
want to see him. But the bright shadow of Selene was no longer between them. He
was lonely, and Roy was all he had left.
If
his Tower had been the brain of the Union, the spaceport had been its pulsing
heart. Remembering the great batteries on the mili-technic reservation, he
hoped that refugees from the bombarded city might have gathered here, to make a
last defense upon the natural fortress of the mesa.
Eagerly,
he pushed through the weeds toward the Venus Docks. Stumbling in the dim early
light, he came upon a new mountain of fresh black earth and broken stone. The
heart went out of him. He climbed wearily to the summit of the shell-built
ridge.
Beyond,
where the busy Venus Docks had been, was only a wide black chasm. Bitter fumes
stung his nostrils. But it was more than the explosive reek that blurred his
eyes with tears.
Chaos
met him. The shell-torn mesa looked desolate as the crater-pitted Moon. Outside
the Saturn Docks, scarcely any familiar structure was even a recognizable
ruin. Death had plowed deep. Only a few twisted scraps of metal even hinted
that docks and cradles and ships had ever existed.
Miles
away, on the rough field of dark debris where the militechnic reservation had
been, he saw a fallen cruiser. All the stern was gone, as if the magazine had
exploded. The plates still glowed with red heat over the battery rooms, and
smoke lifted a sharp thin exclamation point against the gloomy sky.
Sadly, he recognized the Technarch's lines.
Beyond
the dead ship, Sunport was burning. A terrible red dawn glowed all across the
east. But the low sky overhead remained dark with smoke from the conflagration.
Hours dragged on, as he searched
BREAKDOWN 141
for
the ruin of the unitronics laboratory where Roy had worked. But the Sun didn't
rise.
It
must have been noon when he came to what was left of the laboratory. Hope
ebbed out of him, when he saw the shattered ruin of the dead luxion walls. For
the old building had been directly hit.
A
huge, yet-smoking pit opened where the left wing had been. The roof was torn
off the massive gray walls. They were banked high with debris. It seemed
impossible that anybody could have survived, in all the building.
"Who comes?"
Kellon
whirled, startled. Behind him, a big man had risen silently from behind a mound
of rubble. The labor number printed across the front of his gray overalls
showed that he had been a dock worker. He carried a stubby automatic rifle.
"Steve
Wolfe." Cautiously, Kellon answered with his old party name. "Freight
handler."
"What do you
want?"
"I'm
looking for Engineer Roy Kellon," he said desperately. "I have a
message for him. He worked in the unitronics lab. Do you know him? Was he
hurt?"
The
big man made no immediate reply. His keen eyes studied Kellon over the level
gun. Puzzled and impatient, Kellon kicked uneasily at a bomb-tossed stone. At
last, as if he had reached some decision, the guard nodded.
"I
think you'll do. Come along, and I'll let you talk to Tom Pharr." He
pointed with the gun toward a gap in the shattered wall. "Roy Kellon is
here," he added, "but you will find it hard to deliver any message
right now. Because he is buried under a thousand tons of rock."
Kellon walked ahead, through a maze of ruined
rooms and roofless passages. He heard voices and the muffled clink of tools.
Abruptly, his guide brought him upon a surprising scene.
A
cracked, unroofed wall inclosed a long rectangle. It was piled deep with broken
rock and debris, flung from the crater where the other wing had been. But
scores of men and women were toiling desperately to move the rubble. They had
half uncovered a long, mirror-bright torpedo shape. The guard hailed a slim
young man in gray, who appeared to be in charge of the excavation.
"Pharr I Here's
another man for you."
I42 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
The
slim youth came to meet them. Kellon knew him. He had seen him here at the
laboratory when he came to beg Roy to give up his research. But his face showed
no recognition, and Kellon was glad of it.
"Refugee?"
Pharr asked quickly. "You don't like the Preacher? You want to leave
Sunport?" Kellon scarcely had dme to nod. "Are you willing to go to
space?"
"I
am." Kellon felt bewildered. "But I was looking for my . . . for
Engineer Roy Kellon. Is he all right?"
"He's
aboard the Nova"
Tom Pharr jerked a hurried
thumb at the half-buried torpedo. "He'll be all right—if we can get him
uncovered before the Preacher's fanatics get wind of us."
"That?"
Puzzled, Kellon nodded at the bright spindle. "A spaceship?"
"Interstellar
cruiser," Pharr explained swiftly. "We've been working on it, for
years. It was almost ready to test. When the bombardment started, Roy tried to
get it into space. The shell caught him.
"Lucky
I was in the city—trying to find a crew. I got back in a glider, after the
bombardment. I've been collecting refugees to dig him out." His quick eyes
ran over the busy scores. "We'll save a tiny seed of civilization—if we
get away."
Pharr's lean face betrayed
faint worry.
"Some
damage to the Nova.
But Roy signaled that he is
making repairs. Expects to be able to take off, as soon as we can get it uncovered.
There's fuel enough for Venus or Mercury. But we'll have to find dynodes and
supplies for the interstellar flight."
Eagerly, Kellon echoed,
"Interstellar?"
Bright enthusiasm burned all the fatigue from
Tom Pharr's face.
"Roy
believes every star has planets of its own. Won't matter so much if dark ages
come to Earth. Because we and our children will be sowing the seed of mankind
across the stars." His intense eyes peered at Kellon. "Want to sign
for the voyage?"
Kellon
gulped in vain to speak. This was something more than a chance to escape the
chaos of a crumbling world. Tom Pharr's quiet, brief words had painted a new
vision, suggested a new purpose. He nodded mutely.
"Then get to
work."
Kellon went to help a man and a girl who were
trying to roll a raw new boulder away from the Nova. It was queerly comforting to be
BREAKDOWN 143
accepted
as a member of this busy, efficient group. Never before had he quite realized
how lonely the boss had been.
As
the hours went on, he was scarcely conscious of fatigue. He wasn't much
concerned with the blood that presently began to ooze from his soft,
uncalloused hands. There was time for only a few brief words, but he began to
feel an eager interest in these new companions.
A
curiously assorted group. Burly dock hands in gray. A few young cadets who had
survived the destruction of the militechnic college. A dozen veterans who had
escaped from the Outstation in a life tube, when it was blown up. Engineers,
white-collar workers, servants, grays.
But
their one intense purpose had fused them all into a single unit. Class
distinction was gone. Kellon noticed a pretty girl, in low-cut dance pajamas.
She looked a little like Selene du Mars. But she was serving soup to a line of
hungry stevedores in gray.
Melkart's
dictum came back to him. Sunport was dead, because it had lost the purpose that
created it. But this desperate, tattered little group was still somehow a vital
entity. Because, as the old historian would have put it, they shared a destiny.
Night
fell again. Still Sunport was burning. Smoke blotted out the stars. The
eastward horizon was a wall of terrible red. Lightless towers stood against it,
broken and truncated by the space bombardment, like monuments of some dead
gigantic race.
They
worked on without resting. Now and again, a clatter of auomatic fire told them
that the guards were fighting some intruder. It was midnight when they reached
the valves of the Nova.
Roy Kellon came out, with
an arm in a sling, to inspect the battered hull.
Kellon
stood back in the shadows, too weary to call out. His breath came faster, and
his throat ached suddenly. Roy looked lean and strong; those were his mother's
eager gray eyes.
"Come
aboard," he called. "I think she'll do. I've patched up the damage in
the power room. We can make Venus for repairs and supplies—and then the
stars!"
Kellon
followed the shuffling line of weary men and women through the valve. Roy was
standing in the light, inside. His lean face lit with astonished pleasure, and
he put out his good hand.
"Why, father!" he
whispered. "I'm so glad!"
"Good
to see you, Roy." Kellon blinked and tried not to choke. "Now I
understand what you tried to tell me once—about the impor-
144 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
tance
of those other planets." He gulped, and hesitated. "But—I'm an old
man, Roy. If ... if you need the
space for younger men and women—I'll stay."
"Nonsense,
boss!" Roy gripped his hand. "Tickled. Just so we get away before the
Preacher comes."
"Forget
the boss!' Kellon grinned and blinked again. "But
we'll be loading supplies on Venus. You'll find that I'm a hell of a good
foreman on a cargo gang."
The
skirmishing guards retreated aboard. The valves were sealed. Anxiously, Roy cut
in the Novas
untested drive. She lifted
silently, swifter than any unitron vessel had ever been. The burning city
slipped beneath its dark shroud of smoke. Ahead were the stars.
Although
science and sanity were temporarily halted by the Preacher's world-wide
revolution, Mankind avoided complete chaos and recovered its balance. A
sensible peace was restored and with new initiative the people of Earth settled
down to greater interplanetary exploration. In 2200 the first interstellar ship too\ off on a journey that was to mar\ a new
progressive period and the beginning of a galactic empire.
DANCE OF A NEW WORLD
by John D. MacDonald
S |
hane Brent sat in the air-conditioned personnel office of the Solaray Plantations
near Allada, Venus, and stared sleepily at the brown, powerful man across the
table from him. Shane was an angular blond man, dressed in the pale-gray
uniform of Space Control. On his left lapel was the interlocked CA. of Central
Assignment and on the right lapel was the small gold question mark of Investigation
Section. Shane Brent had the faculty of complete relaxation, almost an animal
stillness.
His
hair was a cropped golden cap and his eyes a quiet gray. Below the edge of the
gray shorts the hair, tight curled on his brown legs, had been burned white by
the sun.
The
man on the other side of the table was stocky, sullen and powerful. His face
was livid with the seamed burns of space radiation before the days of adequate
pilot protection. His name was Hiram Lee.
The
conversation had lasted more than an hour and as yet Shane Brent was no closer
to a solution. He had been carefully trained in all the arts of persuasion, of
mental and emotional appeals. Hiram Lee had resisted them all.
Shane
Brent said: "Lee, the whole thing is ridiculous. You're thirty-eight now.
At least seven years of piloting ahead of you."
Lee
snorted. "Piloting! Tell your boss that I'm unadjusted or something."
MS
I46 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"Let's review the case again. You, at
the age of eighteen, were the first third-generation space pilot in history.
Your grandfather was John Lee who was an army pilot and who ran out of soup on
the second swing around the Moon. As a memorial they left the little silver
ship in orbit."
Lee's
expression softened for the first time. "That's the way he would have
wanted it."
"And
your father, David Lee, was kicked off the spaceways for getting tight and
balancing the old Los
Angeles of
the Donnovan Lines on its tail fifty feet in the air for ten minutes."
"And he won his bet of
fifty bucks, junior. Don't forget that."
"And
that brings us down to you, Hiram Lee. You made eighty-three trips with Space
Combo in the VME triangle. Your education cost Central Assignment a lot of time
and money. There aren't enough trained pilots who can stand the
responsibility."
"The
monotony, you mean." Lee stood up suddenly, his fists on his slim waist.
"I told you before and I'll tell you again. When I started, it was a fine
racket. You took off on manual controls and got your corrections en route from
Central Astro. You made the corrections manually. You ripped off in those
rusty buckets and the acceleration nearly tore your guts out. When I started
we had a mean time of one five nine days from Earth to Venus. The trip was
rugged. As a pilot you were somebody.
"Then
some bright gent had to invent the Tapeworm. Central Astro plots your entire
trip and sends the tape over. You co-ordinate the Tapeworm with takeoff rime
and feed in the tape. You've got a stand-by Tapeworm with a duplicate tape and
you've got an escape tape which you feed in if anything goes too far off.
"The
pilot sits there like a stuffed doll and the tape does everything. You don't
even have to worry about meteorites. The Pusher obliques the little ones off
and the Change-Scanner gives you an automatic course correction around the big
one. It just got too dull, Brent. I'm not a guy who wants to play up to the
rich passengers and tickle the babies under the chin and say kitcheekoo. I took
three years of rocking chair circuits and then I quit. And I won't go
back."
"What
makes the job you've got so attractive, Lee? You're just a foreman and
nursemaid to a bunch of Harids working in your herb patches."
Lee
smiled tightly. "I keep 'em working and I tell 'em what to do .and I try
to keep them happy. You know the final psycho report on
DANCE OF A NEW WORLD I47
them.
Their culture is much like the culture of ants on Earth—with one exception.
They have a high degree of emotional instability. Did you ever see a Harid run
berserk ? A bunch of them are picking away and all of a sudden one will stop
and start swaying his head from side to side. The others light out for far places.
The one who has gone over the edge starts clicking those teeth of his. He lets
out a scream that would split your head wide open and comes at you with his
arms all coiled to strike. Bullets won't stop them. You haven't got time to
mess with a powerpack and turn a ray on him. All you need is a knife. You just
step inside the arms, slice his head clean off and get out of the way fast. See
this scar ? I didn't move fast enough six months ago."
Shane
looked puzzled. "Then danger is an integral part of your pattern of
living. Are you trying to tell me there's no danger in space?"
"It's
a different kind, Brent. Once every few years a ship gets it. The people on it
don't even know what happened. I like a little danger all the time."
"Would
you consent to an alteration of glandular secretions to take away this yen for
danger?"
"And
start kissing babies again? Not a chance! Every Saturday I draw my pay and I
hit all the joints along the Allada Strip. You meet some interesting people.
All Sunday I have a head and a half. On Monday I'm out in the weeds again with
my crew of Harids."
"Central Assignment
isn't going to like my report on this."
Lee
chuckled. "I sure weep for you pretty boys in gray. Tell them to mark my
file closed and tell them where to file it for me, will you?"
Shane
Brent stood up slowly, looking more than ever like a big sleepy animal.
"Suppose, Lee, that you could take a route on one of the old ships? Manual
controls, magnetic shoes, creaking plates—all the fixings."
Lee
stared down at the table top for a few seconds. He said softly: "Nothing
in this world would keep me out of space, brother. Noth-ing!"
Shane Brent asked: "And what if you had
control of a modern job and had orders to take it so far that Central Astro
couldn't give you a tape?"
Lee grinned. "That'd be O. K., too. I
hate those smug characters sitting there in their ivory tower and supplying
litde strips of plastic to do the job that good pilots should be doing."
Shane Brent looked rueful. "Well, I
guess you've licked me,
I48 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
Hiram.
This will be the first time I've ever had to report back a complete
failure."
"Do
them good back there," Lee said, grinning. He stared curiously at Brent.
'You know, Brent, you don't look like a guy who'd get much of a bang out of all
this investigadon junk. Why don't you take a break? I'll get you a gang of
Harids. These Solaray people are O. K. to work for. Stick around. On Saturday
we'll hit the Strip. There's a little gal dancing at Brownie's. A Seattle gal.
Blonde. She won't even give me the right time, but you just might manage to—"
Brent grinned. "I better think that one
over. Sorry to have taken so much of your time, Lee. See you around."
Shane Brent stood at the window and watched
Hiram Lee walk off in the direction of the drying sheds. Already the thick heat
had put a sheen of perspiration across the broad muscular shoulders of Lee. He
walked with the carefree swing of an independent man of strength and courage.
Shane Brent sighed, walked out into the heat and headed for the Solaray
Communications Building.
He
showed his credentials to the pretty clerk and said: "I'll need a private
screen and a closed circuit and the usual guarantee of secrecy. It will be a
charge to Central Assignment."
He went into the small room she had
indicated, and opened the switch under the dead screen. A muted hum filled the
room.
"Central
Assignment," he said.
Thirty seconds later a clear feminine voice
said: "Central Assignment."
"Brent calling. Give
me Allison, please."
Allison's
face suddenly filled the screen. He was a white-haired man with a florid face
and an air of nervousness and vitality.
"Hello, Shane,"
he said quietly. "Closed circuit?"
"Of course, Frank.
I've got a report on Hiram Lee."
"Good! Let's have it.
I've got the recorder on."
"Here
goes. Memorandum to F. A. Allison. From Shane Brent. Subject: Personnel for
Project 81—Pilot Investigation. Case of Hiram Lee.
Hiram Lee has been carefully investigated and it is recommended that permission
be given the undersigned to approach Lee with an offer to join Project 81. Lee is alert, capable, strong, dependable to a sufficient degree. His
training is excellent. He will need little indoctrination. Quinn is to be
commended for recommending him to Central Assignment. It is believed that the
probable seven-year duration
DANCE OF A NEW WORLD I49
of
the trip will not discourage Lee. It is also believed that the calculated risk
of one in four of returning from the Project flight will not deter Lee.
Permission is requested to contact Lee and furthermore to sound him out on
becoming a colonist, dependent, of course, on his finding a suitable woman to
accompany him,"
Allison,
who had been listening with interest, said: "Good workl You have the
authority you request."
"Have
you got a line on the executive officer for Project 81 yet, Frank?"
Allison
frowned. "Not yet, Shane. But something will turn up. Foster and Brady
have filled most of the remaining slots. Denvers will go along as head
physicist for the refinement of the drive brick for the return. Central Astro
had given us the takeoff date as, let me see, ninety-three days from
today."
"Pushing us,
hey?"
"Can't
be helped. It's either then or about three years from then. Say, Shane, instead
of returning right away, see what you can find there in the line of an
executive officer. Report if you get a line on anybody. Good-by, Shane."
"Good-by, Frank."
As
the screen went blank, Shane sighed, cut the switch and walked out. At the
front exit he went up the stairs to the platform, stepped into the waiting
monorail suspension bus, found an empty seat. He felt drained and weary. Frank
Allison was a difficult taskmaster. His personal affection for Allison made the
job no easier.
At
the scheduled time the bus slid smoothly away from Solaray, and braked to a
stop in Allada seventy miles away in fifteen minutes. Shane Brent realized with
a tight smile that it was the first time he had made any trip on Venus without
paying any attention to the lush bluish-black vegetation below. The vegetation
had standards of vitality and growth completely different from Earth vegetation.
If the port city of Allada hadn't been originally constructed on a vitrified
surface, thousands of laborers would have been required to slash the tendrils
which would have grown each day. In fact, when the spot for Allada had been
originally vitrified, it had only been done to a two-foot depth. Tendrils broke
through on the third day, heaving and cracking the surface. After that
experience, spaceships had hung, tail down, over the Allada site for ten days.
When the molten rock had finally cooled, the experts had estimated that the
black soil was vitri-
I50 journey to infinity
fled
to a depth of sixty feet. No plant life had broken through since that time. The
electrified cables surrounding Allada constantly spit and crackled as the
searching vine tips touched them.
Shane
Brent went up to his room in Hostel B, shut the door wearily, listlessly
pushed the News button under the wall screen and watched the news of the day
with little interest as he slowly undressed. Crowds demonstrating in Asia-Block
against the new nutrition laws. Project 80, two
years out said to be nearing Planet K. Skirts once again to be midway between
knee and hip next season. The first bachelor parenthood case comes up to decide
whether a child born of the fertilization of a laboratory ovum can legally
inherit. Brent frowned. Soon a clear definition of the legal rights of
"Synthetics" would have to be made. He stopped suddenly as he had an
idea. He decided to submit it to Frank. Why not get Inter-Federal Aid for a
project to develop Synthetics to fill personnel requirements for future project
flights? But would humanity agree to colonization by Synthetics? It still
wasn't clearly understood whether or not they'd breed true.
He
turned off the news, took a slow shower and dressed in fresh clothes. It was a
nuisance changing the insignia. He wadded up the clothes he had removed and
shoved them into the disposal chute.
At five o'clock he got on the call screen and
got hold of the general manager at Allada. The man recognized him immediately.
"What can I do for you, Brent?"
"As
soon as Hiram Lee gets off duty, send him in to see me at Hostel B."
"I
hope you don't steal him away from us, Brent. He's the best man we've got with
the Harids. He doesn't scare easy,"
Brent grinned. "I'll
try to scare him away from me, sir."
He
walked away from the screen, went into the shower room and examined the
drinkmaster. It was one of the older type. No choice of brands. He set the
master dial to one ounce. He pushed the gin button three times, the dry
vermouth button once. He turned the stir lever and held it on for a few seconds
before he turned it off. He looked in the side compartment and found no lemon,
no olives, no pickled onions. That was the trouble with Central Assignment only
approving the second-class places. He took the right size glass off the rack,
put it under the spout and lifted it until the rim tripped the lever. The
Martini poured smoothly into the glass, beading the outside of it with
moisture. Down in the lobby the centralized accounting circuit buzzed and the
price of the Martini was neatly stamped on his bill.
DANCE OF A NEW WORLD 15I
He
walked back into the other room, sat in the deep chair and sipped the Martini,
thinking it odd that with all the scientific experimentation in taste effects,
no one had yet come up with any substitute for the delicacy and aroma of a dry
Martini.
Hiram Lee arrived as he was sipping his
third.
Twenty
minutes later Hiram Lee stood at the windows, his lips compressed, pounding his
fist into his palm in monotonous rhythm.
He
turned suddenly. "I don't know what I'm waiting for, Shane. Yes! Count me
in. When do we leave?"
"Hold
up there, boy. You've got to go to school for a while. And how about the
colonization angle. Will you want to stay?"
Lee
grinned. "If I could talk that little Seattle blonde into going along,
three years would be a short, short trip."
"Providing she could
pass."
"Oh,
sure. I think she'd pass. But she's too smart to tie up with me. Maybe. At
least I'll give it a try. When have I got to tell you about whether or not I
want to stay on this brand new world you boys have located?"
"Let
me see. Ninety-three days from now is takeoff. Thirty days would be needed to
approve and train a woman. You have sixty-three days to convince this blonde of
yours that you're a very attractive guy. And then you'll have to talk her into
taking a little three-year trip and settling down in the brush with you."
Lee
looked at him curiously. "You knew all this early this afternoon and you
gave me that song and dance with a straight face."
"That's my profession,
Hiram"
"You're good at it,
but I still have got an urge to bust you one."
"We'll
arrange that some time. Right now I'm looking for recommendations for somebody
to fill the slot of executive officer aboard the Project flight. Any
ideas?"
Lee
frowned. "None of those boys at Solaray
will do. I can tell you
that quick. They're either slowly congealing in their own juice or they're
making too good a thing out of their job. Better hunt around in the other
plantations. There's a guy named Mosey over at Factri-grown on the other side
of Allada that has a good reputation."
"I'll
take a look. And by the way, Hiram. All this is under the hat."
"Natürlich,
mein herr. May I respectfully recommend that we embark on
an evening of wine and song? I hold out little hope for the other
ingredient."
I52 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
One
big meal and two hours later, Shane Brent and Hiram Lee walked into the club on
the strip—the club called Brownie's.
The
air was chilled, thinned and scented with the crispness of pine. The place was
lighted by glowing amber disks set into the walls. It was packed with the usual
type of cro'wd. Bug-eyed tourists trying to pretend that it was old stuff to
them; hard-drinking, hard-fisted men from the plantations; neat, careful kids
from the ship crews in Allada port; the odd-job drifters who had become
parasites on the social structure of Allada; a big party of Allada politicos,
wining and dining two inspectors from Asia-Block.
By
luck they found an empty table for two not far from the dance floor. Hiram Lee
was on hard liquor and Brent, feeling his limit near, had shifted to beer.
Lee
said, slurring his words: "You're smart to get over onto beer, friend. You
got to drink in this climate quite a while before you pick up a good head for
the stuff." He glanced at his watch. "Floor show in ten minutes. Then
you can see my blondie."
Shane
Brent felt the artificial gaiety draining out of him. He looked around at the
other tables, seeing suddenly the facial lines of viciousness and stupidity and
greed. He remembered his reading of history and guessed that there must have
been faces just like these in the early days of the American West. California
in 1849 and 1850. Easy
money attracted those who had been unable to make a proper adjustment to their
accustomed environment. Actually it was the result of exploitation. The Harids,
with their ant culture, had put up suicidal defense until General Brayton had
discovered the wave length of the beamed thought waves which directed the
Harids of each colony. Science had devised stronger sending devices than the
colony waves and suddenly the Harids were servants.
Each
foreman, such as Hiram Lee, carried one of the wave boxes and directed his
crew. Central Economics had proven that the use of Harids in the
culture—picking and drying of the herbs—was cheaper than any mechanical devices
which could be set up.
Several
couples danced to the music which came directly from New York. The oversize
screen, a special three-dimensional job with good color values, covered most of
the wall beyond the dance floor, showed a full orchestra. Brent guessed that
when the floor show came on the management would either use live music or cut
off the New York program and feed recordings into the screen.
The second guess proved right. The screen
darkened and the cou-
DANCE OF A NEW WORLD I53
pies
left the floor. It brightened again, showing a canned vision of a small group completely equipped with electrical instruments. The M.C walked out as the spot came on. He carried
a small hand mike. After the initial fanfare, the music gave him a soft
background and he said: "This show costs a lot of money to put on. All you
folks drinking beer kindly turn your chairs around with your backs toward the
floor. It is my pleasure to present a young lady who doesn't belong out here on
Venus, wasting her time and talents on you space-burnt wanderers. On the other
hand, Venus is a very appropriate spot for her to be. I give you Caren Ames and
her famous Dance of a New World!" He grinned and backed out of the spot
which widened until it covered most of the small dance floor.
The
music shifted into a low, throbbing beat, an insistent jungle rhythm. Brent
smiled cynically at the build-up, thought it was pretty fancy for what would
probably turn out to be an aging stripper.
She
backed slowly onto the floor, staring into the shadows from which she backed.
Brent's breath caught in his throat. She was a faintly angular girl who should have had no
grace. She wore a stylized version of the jungle clothes of the foremen on the
plantations. Across her shoulder was slung a glittering replica of one of the
thought boxes. She carried in her right hand a shining knife of silver.
She
moved with such an intense representation of great fear that Brent felt the
uneasy shifting of the crowd. The music was a frightened heartbeat. Her grace
was angular, perfect and beautiful. Her face was a rigid mask of fear, her blond hair a frozen gout of gold that fell across one shoulder.
The
throng gasped as the thing followed her into the middle of the floor, stood
weaving, with its eyes on her. At first glance Brent thought that it was
actually one of the Harids, but then he realized that it was a clever costume,
worn by a rather small person. It had all the swaying obscenity of one of the
tiny praying mantis of Earth. The swollen abdomen, the little triangular head,
the knotted forearms held high—all of it covered with the fine soft gray scales
of a Harid. The three digits of each hand waved aimlessly about like the antennae
of a mammoth insect.
The
expanding spot showed a small bush covered with the blue-black oily foliage of
Venus. The girl stood her ground, lifted the thought box to her lips. She
swayed slightly in rhythm with the Harid and her shoulders straightened as the
Harid turned away from her, went over toward the bush. It began to pluck at the
leaves with the
154 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
perky,
incredibly fast motions of the genuine Harid. Her dance of fear turned slowly
into a dance of joy of release from fear. The tempo of the music increased and
she danced ever closer to the squat form of the Harid, the knife in her hand
cutting joyous sparkling arcs in the flood of tinted light.
She
danced ever faster, and Brent said to Lee out of the corner of his mouth:
"What is she doing here? She's wonderful!"
"I told you she was,
boy."
A
movement to Brent's right caught his eye. A bulky man from one of the
plantations, very drunk, wavered on his chair as he watched the dance with
slitted eyes. The lines around his mouth were taut. Brent felt wonder that the
girl's artistry could have such an effect on one of the hardened foremen.
The
music increased to a crescendo, and suddenly stopped. The girl stood
motionless, her arms widespread. A very slow beat began. The Harid began to
sway its head slowly from side to side in time with the beat, A woman in the
darkness screamed softly. Head swaying, the Harid turned slowly and faced the
girl. Her face once again became a face of fear. The knotted arms of the thing
lifted high. The girl took a slow step backward. The tension was a physical
thing—it could be felt in the utter silence of the audience.
At
that moment the man whom Brent had nodced earlier roared, and jumped to his
feet. There was a knife in his hand. He started for the mock Harid. Shane Brent
left his chair in a quick smooth motion. His shoulder slammed against the thick
thigh of the man with the knife and the two of them fell and slid across the
polished floor. The room was in an uproar. The foreman bounded up, his drunken
face twisted with rage. He drew the knife hand back to slash at Brent. Brent
fell inside the thrust and struck the man a hammer blow across the side of his
throat with the edge of his palm. The lights came on as the man dropped heavily
onto his face. No one had thought of the music. It continued on. The mock Harid
stood up and turned into a pale slight man who held the head portion of his
costume in his hand. His pale lips trembled. He said, with great wonder:
"That fellow would have cut my head off!"
The
M.C. came out and said to the girl: "Want to try again from scratch, Miss
Ames?"
Her
eyes were sdll wide with shock. "No ...
I couldn't. Not right now. The next show maybe."
DANCE OF
A NEW WORLD 155
The
M.C. turned to Brent. 'Your check will be on the house, of course. The
management is grateful."
The
pale young man said: "I'm a little more grateful than the
management."
"Thank you,"
Caren said simply.
Brent grinned at her. "You can return
the favor by coming to our table after you change, Miss Ames. We're right over
there." She looked uncertain for a moment. "I don't usually—"
"Just this time, Miss Ames," the M.C. said.
Her smile was brilliant as
she turned and left the floor. "See you
in a few minutes Mr.-------- ."
"Brent. Shane Brent."
By
that time the foreman was back on his feet, pale and shaking. He didn't
understand what had happened. His friends led him back through the tables and
out the door. He was protesting plaintively.
She sat quietly at the table between them and
talked generalities in a quiet, cultured voice. Her between-acts dress was dark
and conservative, her blond hair pulled back with determined severity.
She rebuffed the clumsy verbal advances of
Hiram Lee very politely. By the time Shane Brent sat through the next show, enthralled
anew by her artistry, Hiram Lee had his head on the table and was snoring
softly.
During
the dull act which followed Caren's, two heavily built men came over to the
table and shook their heads sadly. "Poor ole Hiram! Tchl
Tchl You mind, mister, if
we lug ole
Hiram back with us to
Solaray. The poor boy needs a nice soft bunk."
Hiram
protested feebly, but walked unsteadily between them, half supported by them as
he left. Caren came back a few moments later.
They
sat and talked of many things. At last she smiled and said: "I was silly
when I was afraid to sit with you. Usually such things become a bit . . .
messy."
He
grinned. "I'm harmless. It does seem a little funny to me to find somebody
like you in . . . this place."
Her
eyes hardened. "I know how it goes from here on. Caren, you're too nice
for a place like this. Let me take you away with me. I know the whole routine,
Mr. Brent."
"It's not like that, Caren. Honesdy. If
I've asked a clumsy question, I'm sorry. It wasn't a buildup."
I56 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
She
looked into his eyes for long seconds. "All right, Shane. I believe you.
I'll tell you how it happened. I was trained for ballet. When I was nineteen I
married a very rich and very weak young man. After two years life became
impossible. I managed to get a divorce. Every minute I spend on Earth is spent
keeping out of his way. He manages to queer me in every dancing job I get. He
has a weak heart. They won't accept him for space travel. I'm safe here. I can
keep this job. But I can't ever go back."
She
didn't ask for pity as she told him. It was as though she spoke of someone
else.
"What kind of a career
can you have here, Caren?"
She
smiled and for once it wasn't a pretty smile. "I can make a living here.
Some day there will be other cities beside Allada. Some day there will be a
civilization on Venus which will be cultured enough so that my kind of career
can exist here. But I won't live to see it."
"What do you want out
of your life?" he asked gendy.
"Peace. Freedom to do
as I please." Her eyes were troubled.
"Is that all?" he
asked insistently.
"No!"
she flared. "I want more than that, but I don't know what I want. I'm just
restless." She stopped and looked at him for long moments. "You are
too, Shane. Aren't you?"
He
tried to pass it off lighdy. "Things have been a little dull lately."
"Take
me for a walk through the city, Shane. When I feel like this I have to walk it
off."
They
walked to the edge of the wire near the constant sparking and crackling as the
electricity crisped the searching tendrils. Above them the strange stars shone
dimly through the constant heavy mist.
She
stood with her head tilted back, her eyes half shut. On an impulse he reached
out and unclasped the heavy pin that bound her hair so tightly. It fell in a
shining flood over her shoulders.
"Why—" she said,
startled.
"It
just had to be. I feel like we've both been caught up in something outside of
us and we're being hurtled along. Everything from here on will be because it
has to be."
Without
another word she came quickly into his arms. She was as intensely alive as
during the intricate figures of her strange dance.
Once again the pretty clerk pointed out the
small room to Shane Brent. He walked slowly, reluctantly, shut the door quietly
behind
DANCE OF A NEW WORLD I57
him.
In a short time he had a closed circuit to Central Assignment and moments later
the alert face of Frank Allison filled the screen.
"What's the matter,
Shane? You look done in. Rough night?"
"You could call it
that I guess."
"How about Lee?"
"Everything is set, Frank. He'll leave
on Flight Seven a week from today. Have somebody meet him and get him cleared
and out to the school, will you?"
"Sure thing. What else have you got on
your mind? From your tone that isn't all you called about."
"It isn't. I've got an
exec for you, Frank."
"Good! A competent
man?"
"I
guess so. At least he's had the proper background for it." "Don't
keep me in suspense. Who is the man?" "Me," Shane said flatly.
Frank Allison looked at him for long seconds,
no trace of expression on his face. "Are you serious, Shane?"
"Completely, Frank."
Allison
moved away from the screen. Shane waited impatiently. In a few moments Allison
was back and Shane was mildly shocked to see that the man was smiling broadly.
"I had a litde detail to attend to, Shane. I had to collect ten bucks. You
see, I had a bet with West. We had you picked for the job for the last seven
months, but in order for you to qualify for it, the idea had to originate with
you. If it didn't, Psycho wouldn't approve your arbitrary assignment to the
spot. Congratulations!"
Shane Brent wanted to laugh as he realized
Allison had been playing almost the same game with him that he had been
playing with Hiram Lee.
"I won't be back, Frank," he said
quietly.
Allison
sobered. "I had hoped you would, Shane. It's your privilege to make your
own choice. I had hoped that seven years from now, with your experience on this
project, you'd be fitted to come in here and take my job."
"I'm sorry,
Frank," Shane said.
Allison sighed. "So be
it. When will you be in?"
"I'll wait until she can come with me.
It'll be Flight Eight probably. I'll confirm."
There
was deep affection in Allison's smile. "Whoever she is, boy, I'm sure that
she's a very lovely person. See you when you get here."
I58 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
The screen darkened. He stood for a moment
and looked at its opaque dead grayness. He didn't see the screen. He saw,
instead, a distant planet. He saw himself standing in a clearing, his hands hardened
with pioneer labor. Above him was an alien sky. Beside him was a tall girl. Her
hair of purest gold blew in the soft breeze.
Shane
Brent turned and walked quickly from the small room. Caren would be waiting.
Kindred
worlds established by Mother Earth were scattered throughout the universe by 4200. The home planet was proud of the far-flung colonies and the commerce of
many alien places was immense. The Golden Age had swung to its pea\. But,
pendulum-life, there were signs that Earth, at the height of its glory, was facing
another decisive crisis. Many heard the bell tolling the %nell for the Empire,
yet few recognized the tune.
MOTHER EARTH
by Isaac Asimov
"T^ut can you be certain? Are you sure that even a profes-JD sional historian can always distinguish between victory and
defeat?"
Gustav
Stein, who delivered himself of that mocking question with a whiskered smile
and a gentle wipe at the gray mustache from the neighborhood of which he had
just removed an empty glass, was not an historian. He was a physiologist.
But
his companion was an historian, and he accepted the gentle
thrust with a smile of his own.
Stein's
apartment was, for Earth, quite luxurious. It lacked the empty privacy of the
Outer Worlds, of course, since from its window there stretched outward a
phenomenon that belonged only to the home planet—a city. A large city, full of
people, rubbing shoulders, mingling sweat—
Nor
was Stein's apartment fitted with its own power and its own utility supply. It
lacked even the most elementary quota of positronic robots. In short, it lacked
the dignity of self-sufficiency, and like all things on Earth, it was merely
part of a community, a pendant unit of a cluster, a portion of a mob.
But
Stein was an Earthman by birth and used to it. And after all, by Earth
standards, the apartment was still luxurious.
It
was just that looking outward through the same windows before which lay the
city, one could see the stars and among them the
159
100 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
Outer
Worlds, where there were no cities but only gardens; where the lawns were
streaks of emerald, where all human beings were kings, and where all good
Earthmen earnestly and vainly hoped to go some day.
Except for a few who knew
better—like Gustav Stein.
The Friday evenings with Edward Field
belonged to that class of ritual which comes with age and quiet life. It broke
the week pleas-andy for two elderly bachelors, and gave them an innocuous
reason to linger over the sherry and the stars. It took them away from the
crudities of life, and, most of all, it let them talk.
Field,
especially, as a lecturer, scholar and man of modest means quoted chapter and
verse from his still uncompleted history of Terres-trian Empire.
"I
wait for the last act," he explained. "Then I can call it the 'Decline
and Fall of Empire' and publish it."
"You must expect the
last act to come soon, then."
"In
a sense, it has come already. It is just that it is best to wait for all to
recognize that fact. You see, there are three times when an Empire or an
Economic System or a Social Institution falls, you skeptic—"
Field paused for effect and waited patiently
for Stein to say, "And those times are?"
"First,"
Field ticked off a right forefinger, "there is the time when just a little
nub shows up that points an inexorable way to finality. It can't be seen or
recognized until the finality arrives, when the original nub becomes visible to
hindsight."
"And you can tell what
that little nub is?"
"I
think so, since I already have the advantage of a century and a half of
hindsight. It came when the Sirian sector colony, Aurora, first obtained
permission of the Central Government at Earth to introduce positronic robots
into their community life. Obviously, looking back at it, the road was clear for
the development of a thoroughly mechanized society based upon robot labor and
not human labor. And it is this mechanization that has been and will yet be the
deciding factor in the struggle between the Outer Worlds and Earth."
"It
is?" murmured the physiologist. "How infernally clever you historians
are. What and where is the second time the Empire fell?"
"The
second point in time," and Field gently bent his right middle finger
backward, "arrives when a signpost is raised for the expert so
MOTHER EARTH l6l
large
and plain that it can be seen even without the aid of perspective. And that
point has been passed, too, with the first establishment of an immigration
quota against Earth by the Outer Worlds. The fact that Earth found itself
unable to prevent an action so obviously detrimental to itself was a shout for
all to hear, and that was fifty years ago." "Better and better. And
the third point?"
"The
third point?" Down went the ring finger. "That is the least
important. That is when the signpost becomes a wall with a huge 'The End*
scrawled upon it. The only requirement for knowing that the end has come then
is neither perspective nor training, but merely the ability to listen to the
video."
"I take it that the
third point in time has not yet come."
"Obviously
not, or you would not need to ask. Yet it may come soon, for instance, if there
is war."
"Do you think there
will be?"
Field
avoided commitment. "Times are unsettled, and a good deal of futile
emotion is sweeping Earth on the immigration question. And if there should be a
war, Earth would be defeated quickly and lastingly, and the wall would be
erected."
"Can
you be certain? Are you sure that even a professional historian can always
distinguish between victory and defeat?"
Field
smiled. He said: "You may know something I do not. For instance, they talk
about something called the 'Pacific Project.'"
"I
never heard of it." Stein refilled the two glasses, "Let us speak of
other things."
He
held up his glass to the broad window so that the far stars flickered rosily in
the clear liquid and said: "To a happy ending to Earth's troubles."
Field held up his own,
"To the Pacific Project."
Stein
sipped gently and said: "But we drink to two different things."
"Do we?"
It is quite difficult to describe any of the
Outer Worlds to a native Earthman, since it is not so much a description of a
world that is required as a description of a state of mind. The Outer
Worlds—some fifty of them, orginally colonies, later dominions, later
nations—differ extremely among themselves in a physical sense. But the state of
«nind is somewhat the same throughout.
l62 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
It is something that grows out of a world not
originally congenial to mankind, yet populated by the cream of the difficult,
the different, the daring, the deviant.
If it is to be expressed in a word, that word
is "individuality."
There
is the world of Aurora, for instance, three parsccs from Earth. It was the
first planet settled outside the Solar System, and represented the dawn of
interstellar travel. Hence its name.
It had air and water to start with, perhaps,
but on Earthly standards, it was rocky and infertile. The plant life that did
exist, sustained by a yellow-green pigment completely unrelated to chlorophyll,
and not as efficient, gave the comparatively fertile regions a decidedly
bilious and unpleasant appearance to unaccustomed eyes. No animal life higher
than unicellular, and the equivalent of bacteria, as well, were present.
Nothing dangerous naturally, since the two biological systems, of Earth and
Aurora, were chemically unrelated.
Aurora
became, quite gradually, a patchwork. Grains and fruit trees came first;
shrubs, flowers, and grass afterward. Herds of livestock followed. And, as if
it were necessary to prevent too close a copy of the mother planet, positronic
robots also came to build the mansions, carve the landscapes, lay the power units.
In short, to do the work, and turn the planet green and human.
There
was the luxury of a new world and unlimited mineral resources. There was the
splendid excess of atomic power laid out on new foundations with merely
thousands, not billions, to service. There was the vast flowering of physical
science, in worlds where there was room for it.
Take
the home of Franklin Maynard, for instance, who, with his wife, three children,
and twenty-seven robots lived on an estate more than forty miles away, in distance,
from the nearest neighbor. Yet by community-wave he could, if he wished, share
the living room of any of the seventy-five million on Aurora—with each singly;
with all simultaneously.
Maynard
knew every inch of his valley. He knew just where it ended, sharply, and gave
way to the alien crags, along whose undesirable slopes the angular, sharp
leaves of the native furze clung sullenly—as if in hatred of the softer matter
that had usurped its place in the sun.
Maynard
did not have to leave that valley. He was a deputy in the Gathering, and a
member of the Foreign Agents Committee, but he could transact all business, but
the most extremely essential, by com-
MOTHER EARTH 163
munity-wave,
without ever sacrificing that precious privacy he had to have in a way no
Earthman could understand.
Even
the present business could be performed by community-wave. The man, for
instance, who sat with him in his living room, was Charles Hijkman, and he,
actually, was sitting in his own living room on an island in an artificial lake
stocked with fifty varieties of fish, which happened to be twenty-five hundred
miles distant, in space.
The
connection was an illusion, of course. If Maynard were to reach out a hand, he
could feel the invisible wall.
Even
the robots were quite accustomed to the paradox, and when Hijkman raised a hand
for a cigarette, Maynard's robot made no move to satisfy the desire, though a
half-minute passed before Hijkman's own robot could do so.
The
two men spoke like Outer Worlders, that is, stiffly and in syllables too
clipped to be friendly, and yet certainly not hostile. Merely undefinably
lacking in the cream—however sour and thin at times—of human sociability which
is so forced upon the inhabitants of Earth's ant heaps.
Maynard
said: "I have long wanted a private communion, Hijkman. My duties in the
Gathering, this year—"
"Quite.
That is understood. You are welcome now, of course. In fact, especially so,
since I have heard of the superior nature of your grounds and landscaping. Is
it true that your cattle are fed on imported grass?"
"Fm
afraid that is a slight exaggeration. Actually, certain of my best milkers feed
on Terrestrial imports during calving time, but such a procedure would be
prohibitively expensive, Fm afraid, if made general. It yields quite
extraordinary milk, however. May I have the privilege of sending you a day's
output?"
"It
would be most kind of you." Hijkman bent his head, gravely. "You must
receive some of my salmon in return."
To a
Terrestrial eye, the two men might have appeared much alike. Both were tall,
though not unusually so for Aurora, where the average height of the adult male
is six feet one and one half inches. Both were blond and hard-muscled, with
sharp and pronounced features. Though neither was younger than forty,
middle-age as yet sat lightly upon them.
So
much for amenities. Without a change in tone, Maynard proceeded to the serious
purpose of his call.
He said: "The
Committee, you know, is now largely engaged with
164 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
Moreanu
and his Conservatives. We would like to deal with them firmly, we of the
Independents, that is. But before we can do so with the requisite calm and
certainty, I would like to ask you certain questions."
"Why me?"
"Because you are Aurora's most important
physicist."
Modesty
is an unnatural attitude, and one which is only with difficulty taught to
children. In an individualistic society it is useless and Hijkman was,
therefore, unencumbered with it. He simply nodded objectively at Maynard's last
words.
"And,"
continued Maynard, "as one of us. You are an Independent."
"I am a member of the Party.
Dues-paying, but not very active." "Nevertheless safe. Now, tell me,
have you heard of the Pacific Project?"
"The Pacific Project?" There was a
polite inquiry in his words. "It is something which is taking place on
Earth. The Pacific is a Terrestrial
ocean, but the name itself probably has no significance." "I have
never heard of it."
"I am not surprised. Few have, even on
Earth. Our communion, by the way, is via tight-beam and nothing must go
further." "I understand."
"Whatever
Pacific Project is—and our agents are extremely vague —it might conceivably be
a menace. Many of those who on Earth pass for scientists seem to be connected
with it. Also, some of Earth's more radical and foolish politicians."
"Hm-m-m.
There was once something called the Manhattan Project-"
"Yes," urged Maynard, "what
about it?"
"Oh,
it's an ancient thing. It merely occurred to me because of the analogy in
names. The Manhattan Project was before the time of extra-terrestrial travel.
Some petty war in the dark ages occurred, and it was the name given to a group
of scientists who developed atomic power."
"Ah,"
Maynard's hand became a fist, "and what do you think the Pacific Project
can do then?"
Hijkman
considered. Then, softly: "Do you think Earth is planning war?"
On
Maynard's face there was a sudden expression of distaste. "Six billion
people. Six billion half-apes rather jammed into one system to
MOTHER EARTH 165
a near-explosion point, facing only two
hundred million of us, total. Don't you think it is a dangerous
situation." "Oh, numbers!"
"All
right. Are we safe despite the numbers? Tell me. I'm only an administrator, and
you're a physicist. Can Earth win a war in any way?"
Hijkman
sat solemnly in his chair and thought carefully and slowly. Then he said:
"Let us reason. There are three broad classes of methods whereby an
individual or group can gain his ends against opposition. On an increasing
level of subtlety, those three classes can be termed the physical, the
biological, and the psychological.
"Now
the physical can be easily eliminated. Earth does not have an industrial
background. It does not have a technical know-how. It has very limited
resources. It lacks even a single outstanding physical scientist. So it is as
impossible as anything in the Galaxy can be that they can develop any form of
physico-chemical application that is not already known to the Outer Worlds.
Provided, of course, that the conditions of the problem imply single-handed
opposition on the part of Earth against any or all of the Outer Worlds. I take
it that none of the Outer Worlds intends leaguing with Earth against us."
Maynard
indicated violent opposition even to the suggestion, <cNo, no,
no. There is no question of that. Put it out of your mind."
"Then
ordinary physical surprise weapons are inconceivable. It is useless to discuss
it further."
"Then what about your
second class, the biological."
Slowly,
Hijkman lifted his eyebrows: "Now that is less certain. Some Terrestrial
biologists are quite competent, I am told. Naturally, since I am myself a
physicist, I am not entirely qualified to judge this. Yet I believe that in
certain restricted fields, they are still expert. In agricultural science, of
course, to give an obvious example. And in bacteriology. Um-m-m—"
"Yes, what about
bacteriological warfare."
"A
thought! But no, no, quite inconceivable. A teeming constricted world such as
Earth cannot afford to fight an open latticework of fifty sparse worlds with
germs. They are infinitely more subject to epidemics, that is, to retaliation
in kind. In fact, I would say that given our living conditions here on Aurora
and on the other Outer Worlds, no contagious disease could really take hold.
No, Maynard. You can check with a bacteriologist, but I think he'll tell you
the same."
Maynard said: "And the
third class?"
l66 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"The psychological? Now that is
unpredictable. And yet the Outer Worlds are intelligent and healthy communities
and not amenable to ordinary propaganda, or for that matter to any form of unhealthy
emotionalism. Now, I wonder—"
"Yes?"
"What if the Pacific Project is just
that. I mean, a huge device to keep us off balance. Something top-secret, but
meant to leak out in just the right fashion, so that the Outer Worlds yield a
little to Earth, simply in order to play safe."
There was a longish silence.
"Impossible,"
burst out Maynard, angrily.
"You
react properly. You hesitate. But I don't seriously press the interpretation. It is merely a
thought."
A longer silence, then Hijkman spoke again:
"Are there any other questions?"
Maynard started out of a reverie, "No .
. . no—" The wave broke off and
a wall appeared where space had been a moment before.
Slowly,
with stubborn disbelief, Franklin Maynard shook his head.
Ernest Keilin mounted the stairs with a
feeling for all the past centuries. The building was old, cobwebbed with
history. It once housed the Parliament of Man, and from it words went out that
clanged throughout the stars.
It was a tall building. It
soared—stretched—strained. Out and up to the stars, it reached; to the stars
that had now turned away.
It no longer even housed the Parliament of
Earth. That had now been switched to a newer, neoclassical building, one that
imperfectly aped the architectural stylisms of the ancient pre-Atomic age.
Yet
the older building still held its great name. Officially, it was still Stellar
House, but it only housed the functionaries of a shriveled bureaucracy now.
Keilin
got out at the twelfth floor, and the lift dropped quickly down behind him. The
radiant sign said smoothly and quietly: Bureau of Information. He handed a
letter to the receptionist. He waited. And eventually, he passed through the
door which said, "L. Z. Cellioni—Secretary of Information."
Cellioni was little and dark. His hair was
thick and black; his
MOTHER EARTH 167
mustache
thin and black. His teeth, when he smiled, were startlingly white and even—so
he smiled often.
He was smiling now, as he rose and held out
his hand. Keilin took it, then an offered seat, then an offered cigar.
Cellioni said: "I am very happy to see
you, Mr. Keilin. It is kind of you to fly here from New York on such short
notice."
Keilin
curved the corners of his lips down and made a tiny gesture with one hand,
deprecating the whole business.
"And
now," continued Cellioni, "I presume you would like an explanation
of all this."
"I wouldn't refuse
one," said Keilin.
"Unfortunately,
it is difficult to know exactly how to explain. As Secretary of Information, my
position is difficult. I must safeguard the security and well-being of Earth
and, at the same time, observe our traditional freedom of the press. Naturally,
and fortunately, we have no censorship, but just as naturally, there are times
when we could almost wish we did have."
"Is
this," asked Keilin, "with reference to me? About censorship, I
mean?"
Cellioni
did not answer directly. Instead, he smiled again, slowly, and with a remarkable
absence of joviality.
He
said: "You, Mr. Keilin, have one of the most widely heard and influential
talecats on the video. Therefore, you are of peculiar interest to the
government."
"The
time is mine," said Keilin, stubbornly. "I pay for it. I pay taxes on
the income I derive from it. I adhere to all the common-law rulings on taboos.
So I don't quite see of what interest I can be to the government."
"Oh,
you misunderstand me. It's my fault, I suppose, for not being clearer. You
have committed no crime; broken no laws. I have only admiration for your
journalistic ability. What I refer to is your editorial attitude at
times."
"With respect to what?"
"With
respect," said Cellioni, with a sudden harshness about his thin lips,
"to our policy toward the Outer Worlds."
"My
editorial attitude represents what I feel and think, Mr. Secretary."
"I
allow this. You have your right to your feelings and your thoughts. Yet it is
injudicious to spread them about nightly to an audience of half a
billion."
l68 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"Injudicious, according to you, perhaps.
But legal, according to anybody."
"It is sometimes necessary to place good
of country above a strict and selfish interpretation of legality."
Keilin tapped his foot
twice and frowned blackly.
"Look," he said,
"put this frankly. What is it you want?"
The
Secretary of Information spread his hands out before him. "In a
word—co-operation! Really, Mr. Keilin, we can't have you weakening the will of
the people. Do you appreciate the position of Earth ? Six billions, and a
declining food supply! It is insupportable! And emigration is the only
solution. No patriotic Earthman can fail to see the justice of our position. No
reasonable human being anywhere can fail to see the justice of it."
Keilin
said: "I agree with your premise that the population problem is serious,
but emigration is not the only solution. In fact, emigration is the one sure
way of hastening destruction.
"Really? And why do
you say that?"
"Because
the Outer Worlds will not permit emigration, and you can force their hand by
war only. And
we cannot win a war!'
"Tell
me," said Cellioni softly, "have you ever tried emigrating. It seems to me you could qualify. You are quite
tall, rather light-haired, intelligent—"
The video-man flushed. He
said, curdy: "I have hay fever."
"Well,"
and the secretary smiled, "then you must have good reason for
disapproving their arbitrary genetic and racist policies."
Keilin
replied with heat: "I won't be influenced by personal motives. I would
disapprove their policies, if I qualified perfecdy for emigration. But my
disapproval would alter nothing. Their policies are their policies, and they can enforce them. Moreover, their policies have
some reason even if wrong. Mankind is starting again on the Outer Worlds, and
they—the ones who got there first—would like to eliminate some of the flaws of
the human mechanism that have become obvious with time. A hay fever sufferer is a bad egg—genetically. A cancer prone even more so. Their prejudices
against skin and hair colors are, of course, senseless, but I can grant that
they are interested in uniformity and homogeneity. And as for Earth, we can do
much even without the help of the Outer Worlds."
"For instance,
what?"
"Positronic robots and hydroponic
farming should be introduced, and—most of all—birth control must be instituted.
An intelligent
MOTHER EARTH 169
birth control, that is, based on firm
psychiatric principles intended to eliminate the psychotic trends, congenital
infirmities—" "As they do
in the Outer Worlds—"
"Not
at all. I have mentioned no racist principles. I talk only of mental and
physical infirmities that are held in common by all ethnic and racial groups.
And most of all, births must be held below deaths until a healthful equilibrium
is reached."
Cellioni
said, grimly: "We lack the industrial techniques and the resources to
introduce a robot-hydroponic technology in anything less than five centuries.
Furthermore, the traditions of Earth, as well as current ethical beliefs forbid
robot labor and false foods. Most of all, they forbid the slaughter of unborn
children. Now come, Keilin, we can't have you pouring this out over video. It
won't work; it distracts the attention; it weakens the will."
Keilin broke in, impatiently: "Mr.
Secretary, do you want war?"
"Do I want war? That is an impudent question."
"Then
who are the policy-makers in the government who do want war? For instance, who is responsible for the calculated rumor of
the Pacific Project."
"The Pacific Project? And where did you
hear of that?"
"My sources are my secret."
"Then I'll tell you. You heard of this
Pacific Project from More-anu of Aurora on his recent trip to Earth. We know
more about you than you suppose, Mr. Keilin."
"I
believe that, but I do not admit that I received information from Moreanu. Why
do you think I could get information from him? Is it because he was
deliberately allowed to learn of this piece of trumpery."
"Trumpery?"
"Yes. I think Pacific Project is a fake.
A fake meant to inspire confidence. I think that the government plans to let
the so-called secret leak out in order to strengthen its war policy. It is
part of a war of nerves on Earth's own people, and it will be the ruin of Earth
in the end.
"And
I will take this theory of mine to the people." "You will not, Mr.
Keilin," said Cellioni, quietly. "I will."
"Mr.
Keilin, your friend, Ion Moreanu is having his troubles on Aurora, perhaps for
being too friendly with you. Take care that you do not have equal trouble for
being too friendly with him."
170 journey
to infinity
"I'm
not worried." The video man laughed shortly, lunged to his feet and strode
to the door.
Keilin
smiled very gently when he found the door blocked by two large men: "You
mean I am under arrest right now."
"Exactly," said
Cellioni.
"On what charge?"
"We'll think of some
later."
Keilin left—under escort.
On Aurora, the mirror image of the
afore-described events was taking place, and on a larger scale.
The
Foreign Agents Committee of the Gathering had been meeting now for days—ever
since the session of the Gathering in which Ion Moreanu and his Conservative
Party made their great bid to force a vote of no confidence. That it had failed
was in part due to the superior political generalship of the Independents, and
in some part due to the activity of this same Foreign Agents Committee.
For months now the evidence had been
accumulating, and when the vote of confidence turned out to be sizably in favor
of the Independents, the Committee was able to strike in its own way.
Moreanu was subpoenaed in his own home, and
placed under house arrest. Although this procedure of house arrest was not,
under the circumtances, legal—a fact emphatically pointed out by Moreanu —it
was nevertheless successfully accomplished.
For
three days Moreanu was cross-examined thoroughly, in polite, even tones that
scarcely ever veered from unemotional curiosity. The seven inquisitors of the
Committee took turns in questioning, but Moreanu had respite only for
ten-minute intervals during the hours in which the Committee sat.
After three days, he showed the effects. He
was hoarse with demanding that he be faced with his accusers; weary with
insisting that he be informed of the exact nature of the charges; throat-broken
with shouting against the illegality of the procedure.
The Committee finally read statements at him—
"Is this true or not?
Is this true or not?"
Moreanu
could merely shake his head wearily as the structure spidered about him.
He challenged the competency of the evidence
and was smoothly informed that the proceedings constituted a Committee
Investigation and not a trial—
MOTHER EARTH 171
The
chairman clapped his gavel finally. He was a broad man of tremendous purpose.
He spoke for an hour in his final summing up of the results of the inquiry, but
only a relatively short portion of it need be quoted.
He
said: "If you had merely conspired with others on Aurora, we could
understand you; even forgive you. Such a fault would have been held in common
with many ambitious men in history. It is not that at all. What horrifies us
and removes all pity is your eagerness to consort with the disease-ridden,
ignorant and subhuman remnants of Earth.
"You,
the accused, stand here under a heavy weight of evidence showing you to have
conspired with the worst elements of Earth's mongrel population—"
The
chairman was interrupted by an agonized cry from Moreanu, "But the motive!
What motive can you possibly attribute—"
The
accused was pulled back into his seat. The chairman pursed his lips and
departed from the slow gravity of his prepared speech to improvise a bit.
"It is not," he said, "for
this Committee to go into your motives. We have shown the facts of the case.
The Committee does
have evidence—" He paused, and looked along the
line of the members to the right and the left, then continued. "I think I
may say that the Committee has evidence that points to your intentions to use
Earth man power to engineer a coup that would leave you dictator over Aurora.
But since the evidence has not been used, I will not go further into that,
except to say that such a consummation is not inconsistent with your characters
displayed at these hearings."
He
went back to his speech. "Those of us who sit here have heard, I think, of
something termed the 'Pacific Project/ which, according to rumors, represents
an attempt on the part of Earth to retrieve its lost dominions.
"It is needless to emphasize here that
any such attempt must be doomed to failure. And yet defeat for us is not
entirely inconceivable. One thing can cause us to stumble, and that one thing
is an unsuspected internal weakess. Genetics is, after all, still an imperfect
science. Even with twenty generations behind us, undesirable traits may crop up
at scattered points, and each reresents a flaw in the steel shield of Aurora's
strength.
"That is the Pacific Project—the use of our own
criminals and
I72 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
traitors
against us; and if they can find such in our inner councils, the Earthmen might
even succeed.
"The
Foreign Agents Committee exits to combat that threat. In the accused, we touch
the fringes of the web. We must go on—"
The speech did, at any
rate.
When
it was concluded, Moreanu, pale, wild-eyed, pounded his fist, "I demand my
say—"
"The accused may
speak," said the chairman.
Moreanu
rose and looked about him for a long moment. The room, fitted for an audience
of seventy-five million by Community Wave, was unattended. There were the
inquisitors, legal staff, official recorders— And with him, in the actual
flesh, his guards.
He
would have done better with an audience. To whom could he otherwise appeal? His
glance fled hopelessly from each face it touched, but could find nothing
better.
"First,"
he said, "I deny the legality of this meeting. My constitutional rights
of privacy and individuality have been denied. I have been tried by a group
without standing as a court, by individuals convinced, in advance, of my
guilt. I have been denied adequate opportunity to defend myself. In fact, I
have been treated throughout as an already convicted criminal requiring only
sentence.
"I
deny, completely and without reservation, that I have been engaged in any
activity detrimental to the state or tending to subvert any of its fundamental
institutions.
"I
accuse, vigorously and unreservedly, this Committee of deliberately using its
powers to win political battles. I am guilty not of treason, but of
disagreement. I disagree with a policy dedicated to the destruction of the
larger part of the human race for reasons that are trivial and inhumane.
"Rather
than destruction, we owe assistance to these men who are condemned to a harsh,
unhappy life solely because it was our ancestors and not theirs who happened to
reach the Outer Worlds first. With our technology and resources, they can yet
re-create and redevelop—"
The
chairman's voice rose above the intense near-whisper of Moreanu: "You are
out of order. The Committee is quite prepared to hear any remarks you make in
your own defense, but a sermon on the rights of Earthmen is outside the
legitimate realm of the discussion."
The hearings were formally closed. It was a
great political victory for the Independents; all would agree to that. Of the
members
MOTHER EARTH I73
of the Committee, only Franklin Maynard was
not completely satisfied. A small nagging doubt remained. He wondered—
Should
he try one last time ? Should he speak once more and then no more to that queer
little monkey ambassador from Earth? He made his decision quickly and acted
upon it instantly. Only a pause to arrange a witness, since even for himself an
unwitnessed private communion with an Earthman might be dangerous.
Luiz Moreno, Ambassador to Aurora from Earth,
was, to put not too fine a point on it, a miserable figure of a man. And that
wasn't exactly an accident. On the whole, the foreign diplomats of Earth tended
to be dark, short, wizen, or weakly—or all four.
That
was only self-protection since the Outer Worlds exerted strong attraction for
any Earthman. Diplomats exposed to the allure of Aurora, for instance, could
not but be exceedingly reluctant to return to Earth. Worse, and more
dangerous, exposure meant a growing sympathy with the demigods of the stars and
a growing alienation from the slum-dwellers of Earth.
Unless,
of course, the ambassador found himself rejected. Unless, he found himself
somewhat despised. And then, no more faithful servant of Earth could be
imagined, no man less subject to corruption.
The Ambassador to Earth was only five foot
two, with a bald head and receding forehead, a pinkish affectation of beard and
red-rimmed eyes. He was suffering from a slight cold, the occasional results
whereof he smothered in a handkerchief. And yet, withal, he was a man of
intellect.
To
Franklin Maynard, the sight and sound of the Earthman was distressing. He grew
queasy at each cough and shuddered when the ambassador wiped his nose.
Maynard
said: "Your excellency, we commune at my request because I wish to inform
you that the Gathering has decided to ask your recall by your government."
"That
is kind of you, councilor. I had an inkling of this. And for what reason?"
"The reason is not within the bounds of
discussion. I believe it is the prerogative of a sovereign state to decide for
itself whether a foreign representative shall be persona grata or not. Nor do I think you really need
enlightenment on this matter."
174 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"Very
well, then." The ambassador paused to wield his handkerchief and murmur
an apology. "Is that all?"
Maynard
said: "Not quite. There are matters I would like to mention. Remain!"
The
ambassador's reddened nostrils flared a bit, but he smiled, and said: "An
honor."
"Your
world, excellency," said Maynard, superciliously, "displays a
certain belligerence of late that we on Aurora find most annoying and unnecessary.
I trust that you will find your return to Earth at this point a convenient
opportunity to use your influence against further displays such as recently
occurred in New York where two Aurorans were manhandled by a mob. The payment
of an indemnity may not be enough the next time."
"But
that is emotional overflow, Councilor Maynard. Surely, you cannot consider
youngsters shouting in the streets to be adequate representations of
belligerence."
"It
is backed by your government's actions in many ways. The recent arrest of Mr.
Ernest Keilin, for instance."
"Which is a purely
domestic affair," said the ambassador, quietly.
"But
not one to demonstrate a reasonable spirit toward the Outer Worlds. Keilin was
one of the few Earthmen who until recently could yet make their voices heard.
He was intelligent enough to realize that no divine right protects the inferior
man simply because he is inferior."
The
ambassador arose: "I am not interested in Auroran theories on racial
differences."
"A
moment. Your government may realize that much of their plans have gone awry
with the arrest of your agent, Moreanu. Stress the fact that we of Aurora are
much wiser than we have been prior to this arrest. It may serve to give them
pause."
"Is
Moreanu my agent ? Really, councilor, if I am
disaccredited, I shall leave. But surely the loss of diplomatic immunity does
not affect my personal immunity as an honest man from charges of
espionage."
"Isn't that your
job?"
"Do
Aurorans take it for granted that espionage and diplomacy are identical? My
government will be glad to hear it. We shall take appropriate
precautions."
"Then
you defend Moreanu? You deny that he has been working for Earth."
MOTHER EARTH 175
"I
defend only myself. As to Moreanu, I am not stupid enough to say
anything."
"Why stupid?"
"Wouldn't
a defense by myself be but another indictment against him? I neither accuse nor
defend him. Your government's quarrel with Moreanu, like my government's with
Keilin—whom you, by the way, are most suspiciously eager to defend—is an
internal affair. I will leave now."
The
communion broke, and almost instantly the wall faded again. Hijkman was looking
thoughtfully at Maynard.
"What do you think of
him?" asked Maynard, grimly.
"Disgraceful
that such a travesty of humanity should walk Aurora, I think."
"I agree with you, and
yet . . . and yet—"
"Well?"
"And yet I can almost find myself able
to think that he is the master and that we dance to his piping. You know of
Moreanu?" "Of course."
"Well,
he will be convicted; sent to an asteroid. His party will be broken. Offhand,
anyone would say that such actions represent a horrible defeat for
Earth."
"Is there doubt in
your mind that such is the case?"
"I'm
not sure. Committee Chairman Hond insisted on airing his theory that Pacific
Project was the name Earth gave to a device for using internal traitors on the
Outer Worlds. But I don't think so. I'm not sure the facts fit that. For
instance, where did we get our evidence against Moreanu?"
"I certainly can't
say."
"Our
agents, in the first place. But how did they get it? The evidence was a little too convincing. Moreanu could have guarded himself better—"
Maynard
hesitated. He seemed to be attempting a blush, and failing. "Well, to put
it quickly, I think it was the Terrestrian Ambassador who somehow presented us
with the most evidence. I think that he played on Moreanu's sympathy for Earth
first to befriend him and then to betray him."
"Why?"
"I
don't know. To insure war, perhaps—with this Pacific Project waiting for
us."
I76 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"I don't believe
it."
"I
know. I have no proof. Nothing but suspicion. The Committee wouldn't believe
me either. It seemed to me, perhaps, that a last talk with the ambassador might
reveal something, but his mere appearance antagonizes me, and I find I spend
most of my time trying to remove him from my sight."
"Well,
you are becoming emodonal, my friend. It is a disgusting weakness. I hear that
you have been appointed a delegate to the Interplanetary Gathering at
Hesperus. I congratulate you."
"Thanks," said
Maynard, absently.
Luiz Moreno, ex-Ambassador to Aurora, had
been glad to return to Earth. He was away from the artificial landscapes that
seemed to have no life of their own, but to exist only by virtue of the strong
will of their possessors. Away from the too-beautiful men and women and from
their ubiquitous, brooding robots.
He
was back to the hum of life and the shuffle of feet; the brushing of shoulders
and the feeling of breath in the face.
Not
that he was able to enjoy these sensations entirely. The first days had been
spent in lively conferences with the heads of Earth's government.
In
fact, it was not till nearly a week had passed, that an hour came in which he
could consider himself truly relaxed.
He
was in the rarest of all appurtenances of Terrestrial Luxury— a rooi garden.
With him was Gustav Stein, the quite obscure physiologist, who was,
nevertheless, one of the prime movers of the Plan, known to rumor as the
Pacific Project.
"The confirmatory tests," said
Moreno, with an almost dreadful satisfaction, "all check so far, do they
not?"
"So far. Only so far. We have miles to go."
"Yet
they will continue to go well. To one who has lived on Aurora for nearly a year
as I have, there can be no doubt but that we're on the right track."
"Um-m-m. Nevertheless,
I will go only by the laboratory reports "
"And
quite rightly." His little body was almost stiff with gloating.
"Some day, it will be different. Stein, you have not met these men, these
Outer Worlders. You may have come across the tourists, perhaps, in their
special hotels, or riding through the streets in inclosed cars, equipped with
the purest of private, air-conditioned atmospheres
MOTHER EARTH 177
for
their well-bred nostrils; observing the sights through a movable periscope and
shuddering away from the touch of an Earthman.
"But
you have not met them on their own world, secure in their own sickly, rotting
greatness. Go, Stein, and be despised a while. Go, and find how well you can
compete with their own trained lawns as something to be gently trod upon.
"And
yet, when I pulled the proper cords, Ion Moreanu fell—Ion Moreanu, the only man
among them with the capacity to understand the workings of another's mind. It
is the crisis that we have passed now. We front a smooth path now."
Satisfaction! Satisfaction!
"As
for Keilin," he said suddenly, more to himself than to Stein, "he can
be turned loose, now. There's little he can say, hereafter, that can endanger
anything. In fact, I have an idea. The Interplanetary Conference opens on
Hesperus within the month. He can be sent to report the meeting. It will be an
earnest of our friendliness—and keep him away for the summer. I think it can be
arranged."
It was.
Of
all the Outer Worlds, Hesperus was the smallest, the latest setded, the
furthest from Earth. Hence the name. In a physical sense, it was not best
suited to a great diplomatic gathering, since its facilities were small. For
instance, the available community-wave network could not possibly be stretched
to cover all the delegates, secretarial staff, and administrators necessary in
a convocation of fifty planets. So meetings in person were arranged in
buildings impressed for the purpose.
Yet
there was a symbolism in the choice of meeing place that escaped practically
nobody. Hesperus, of all the Worlds, was furthest removed from Earth. But the
spatial distance—one hundred parsecs or more—was the least of it. The important
point was that Hesperus had been colonized not by Earthmen, but by men from the
Outer World of Faunus.
It
was therefore of the second generation, and so it had no "Mother
Earth." Earth to it was but a vague grandmother, lost in the stars.
As
is usual in all such gatherings, little work is actually done on the session
floors. That space is reserved for the official soundings of whatever is primarily
intended for home ears. The actual swapping and horse-trading takes place in
the lobbies and at the lunch-tables and
178 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
many
an irresolvable conflict has softened over the soup and vanished over the nuts.
And yet particular difficulties were present
in this particular case. Not in all worlds was the community-wave as paramount
and all-pervading as it was on Aurora, but it was prominent in all. It was,
therefore, with a certain sense of outrage and loss that the tall, dignified
men found it necessary to approach one another in the flesh, without the
comforting privacy of the invisible wall between, without the warm knowledge of
the breakswitch at their fingertrips.
They
faced one another in uneasy semi-embarrassment and tried not to watch one
another eat; tried not to shrink at the unmeant touch. Even robot service was
rationed.
Ernest
Keilin, the only accredited video-representative from Earth, was aware of some
of these matters only in the vague way they are described here. A more precise
insight he could not have. Nor could anyone brought up in a society where human
beings exist only in the plural, and where a house need only be deserted to be
feared.
So
it was that certain of the most subtle tensions escaped him at the formal dinner
party given by the Hesperian government during the third week of the
conference. Other tensions, however, did not pass him by.
The
gathering after the dinner naturally fell apart into little groups. Keilin joined the one that contained
Franklin Maynard of Aurora. As the delegate of the largest of the Worlds, he
was naturally the most newsworthy.
Maynard
was speaking casually between sips at the tawny Hesperian cocktail in his
hand. If his flesh crawled slightly at the closeness of the others, he masked
the feeling masterfully.
"Earth,"
he said, "is, in essence, helpless against us if we avoid unpredictable
military adventures. Economic unity is actually a necessity, if we intend to
avoid such adventures. Let Earth realize to how great an extent her economy
depends upon us, on the things that we alone can supply her, and there will be
no more talk of living space. And if we are united, Earth would never dare
attack. She will exchange her barren longings for atomic motors—or not, as she
pleases."
And
he turned to regard Keilin with a certain hauteur as the other found himself
stung to comment:
"But
your manufactured goods, councilor—I mean those you ship to Earth—they are not given us. They are exchanged for agricultural products."
MOTHER EARTH 179
Maynard
smiled silkily. "Yes, I believe the delegate from Tethys has mentioned
that fact at length. There is a delusion prevalent among some of us that only
Terrestrial seeds grow properly—"
He
was interrupted calmly by another, who said: "Now I am not from Tethys,
but what you mention is not a delusion. I grow rye on Rhea, and I have never
yet been able to duplicate Terrestrial bread. It just hasn't got the same
taste." He addressed the audience in general, "In fact, I imported
half a dozen Terrestrians five years back on agricultural laborer visas so they
could oversee the robots. Now they can do wonders with the land, you know.
Where they spit, corn grows fifteen feet high. Well, that helped a little. And
using Terres-trian seed helped. But even if you grow Terrestrian grain, its
seed won't hold the next year."
"Has
your soil been tested by your government's agricultural department?"
asked Maynard.
The Rhean grew haughty in his turn: "No
better soil in the sector. And the rye is top-grade. I even sent a hundredweight
down to Earth for nutritional clearance, and it came back with full
marks." He rubbed one side of his chin, thoughtfully: "It's flavor
I'm talking about. Doesn't seem to have the right—"
Maynard
made an effort to dismiss him: "Flavor is dispensable temporarily. They'll
be coming to us on our terms, these little-men-hordes of Earth, when they feel
the pinch. We give up only this mysterious flavor, but they will have to give
up atom-powered engines, farm machinery, and ground cars. It wouldn't be a bad
idea, in fact, to attempt to get along without the Terrestrian flavors you are
so concerned about. Let us appreciate the flavor of our home-grown products
instead—which could stand comparison if we gave it a chance."
"That
so?" the Rhean smiled. "I notice you're smoking Earth-grown
tobacco."
"A habit I can break
if I have to."
"Probably
by giving up smoking. I wouldn't use Outer World tobacco for anything but
killing mosquitoes."
He
laughed a trifle too boisterously, and left the group. Maynard stared after
him, a little pinch-nosed.
To
Keilin, the little byplay over rye and tobacco brought a certain satisfaction.
He regarded such personalities as the tiny reflection of certain
Galactotolitical realities. Tethys and Rhea were the largest planets in the
Galactic south, as Aurora was the largest in the Galactic north. All three
planets were identically racist, identically exclul8o JOURNEY TO INFINITY
sivist.
Their views on Earth were similar and completely compatible. Ordinarily, one
would think that there was no room to quarrel.
But Aurora was the oldest of the Outer
Worlds, the most advanced, the strongest militarily—and, therefore, aspired to
a sort of moral leadership of all the Worlds. That was sufficient in itself to
arouse opposition, and Rhea and Tethys served as focal points for those who did
not recognize Auroran leadership.
Keilin
was somberly grateful for that situation. If Earth could but lean her weight
properly, first in one direction, then in the other, an ultimate split, or even
fragmentation—
He
eyed Maynard cautiously, almost furtively, and wondered what effect this would
have on the next day's debate. Already, the Auroran was more silent than was
quite polite.
And
then some under-secretary or sub-official threaded his way through the clusters
of guests in finicking fashion, and beckoned to Maynard.
Keilin's
following eyes watched the Auroran retreat with the newcomer, watched him
listen closely, mouth a startled "What!" that was quite visible to
the eye, though too far off to be heard, and then reach for a paper that the
other handed him.
And
as a result the next day's session of the conference went entirely differently
than Keilin would have predicted.
Keilin
discovered the details in the evening video-casts. The ter-restrian government,
it seemed, had sent a note to all the governments attending the conference. It
warned each one bluntly that any agreement among them in military or economic
affairs would be considered an unfriendly act against Earth and that it would
be met with appropriate countermeasures. The note denounced Aurora, Tethys,
and Rhea all equally. It accused them of being engaged in an imperialist
conspiracy against Earth, and so on—and on—and on.
"Fools!"
gritted Keilin, all but butting his head against the wall out of sheer chagrin.
"Fools! Fools! Foolsl" And his voice died away sdll muttering that
same one word.
The next session of the conference was well
and early attended by a set of angry delegates who were only too eager to grind
into nothingness the disagreements still outstanding. When it ended, all matters
concerning trade between Earth and the Outer Worlds had been placed in the
hands of a commission with plenary powers.
Not even Aurora could have expected so
complete and easy a vie-
MOTHER EARTH l8l
tory,
and Keilin, on his way back to Earth, longed for his voice to reach the video,
so that it could be to others, and not to himself only, that he could shout his
disgust.
Yet on Earth, some men
smiled.
Once back on Earth, the voice of Keilin
slowly swirled under and down—lost in the noisier clamor that shouted for
action.
His
popularity sank in proportion as trade restrictions grew. Slowly, the Outer
Worlds drew the noose tighter. First, they instituted a strict application of
a new system of export licensing. Secondly, they banned the export to Earth of
all materials capable of being "used in a war effort." And finally
they applied a very broad interpretation indeed of what could be considered
usable in such a connection.
Imported
luxuries—and imported necessities, too, for that matter— vanished or priced
themselves upwards out of the reach of all but the very few.
So
the people marched, and the voices shouted and the banners swung about in the
sunlight, and the stones flew at the consulates—
Keilin shouted hoarsely and
felt as if he were going mad.
Until,
suddenly, Luiz Moreno, quite of his own accord, offered to appear on Keilin's
program and submit to unrestricted questioning in his capacity as ex-Ambassador
to Aurora and present Secretary without Portfolio.
To
Keilin it had all the possibilities of a rebirth. He knew Moreno —no fool, he.
With Moreno on his program, he was assured an audience as great as his
greatest. With Moreno answering questions, certain misapprehensions might be
removed, certain confusions might be straightened. The mere fact that Moreno
wished to use his—his—
program as sounding board
might well mean that already a more pliant and sensible foreign policy might
have been decided upon. Perhaps Maynard was correct, and the pinch was being
felt and was working as predicted.
The
list of questions had, of course, been submitted to Moreno in advance, but the
ex-Ambassador had indicated that he would answer all of them, and any follow-up
questions that might seem necessary.
It
seemed quite ideal. Too ideal, perhaps, but only a criminal fool could worry
over minutiae at this point.
There
was an adequate ballyhoo—and when they faced one another across the little
table, the red needle that indicated the number of video sets drawing power on
that channel hovered well over the two l82 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
hundred
million mark. And there was an average of 2.7 listeners per video set. Now the theme; the official introduction.
Keilin rubbed his cheek slowly, as he waited
for the signal.
Then, he began:
Q.
Secretary Moreno, the question which interests all Earth at the moment,
concerns the possibility of war. Suppose we start with that. Do you think there
will be war?
A.
If Earth is the only planet to be considered, I say: No, definitely not. In
its history, Earth has had too much war, and has learned many dmes over how
little can be gained by it.
Q.
You say, "If Earth is the only planet to be considered—" Do you imply
that factors outside our control will bring war?
A. I
do not say "will"; but I could say "may." I cannot, of
course speak for the Outer Worlds. I cannot pretend to know their motivations
and intentions at this critical moment in Galactic history. They may choose war. I hope not. If so be that they do, however, we will defend
ourselves. But in any case, we will
never attack; we will not strike the first blow.
Q.
Am I right in saying, then, that in your opinion there are no basic differences
between Earth and the Outer Worlds, which cannot be solved by negotiation?
A.
You certainly are. If the Outer Worlds were sincerely desirous of a solution,
no disagreement between them and us could long exist.
Q. Does that include the
question of immigration ?
A.
Definitely. Our own role in the matter is clear and beyond reproach. As matters
stand, two hundred million human beings now occupy ninety-five percent of the
available land in the universe. Six billions—that is, ninety-seven percent of
all mankind—are squeezed into the other five percent. Such a situation is
obviously unjust and, worse, unstable. Yet Earth, in the face of such
injustice, has always been willing to treat this problem as soluble by degrees.
It is still so willing. We should agree to reasonable quotas and reasonable
restrictions. Yet the Outer Worlds have refused to discuss this matter. Over a
space of five decades, they have rebuffed all efforts on the part of Earth to
open negotiations.
Q.
If such an attitude on the part of the Outer Worlds continues, do you then think there will be war?
A. I
cannot believe that this attitude will continue. Our government will not cease
hoping that the Outer Worlds will eventually re-
MOTHER EARTH 183
consider
their stand on the matter; that their sense of justice and right is not dead,
but only sleeping.
Q.
Mr. Secretary, let us pass on to another subject. Do you think that the United
Worlds Commission set up by the Outer Worlds recently to control trade with
Earth represents a danger to peace?
A. In the sense that its actions indicate a
desire on the part of the Outer Worlds to isolate Earth, and to weaken it
economically, I can say that it does.
Q. To what actions do you
refer, sir?
A.
To its actions in restricting interstellar trade with Earth to the point where,
in credit values, the total stands now at less than ten percent of what it did
three months ago.
Q.
But do such restrictions really represent an economic danger to Earth ? For
instance, is it not true that trade with the Outer Worlds represents an almost
insignificant part of total Terrestrian trade ? And is it not true that the
importations from the Outer Worlds reach only a tiny minority of the population
at best ?
A.
Your questions now are representative of a profound fallacy which is very
common among our isolationists. In credit values, it is true that interstellar
trade represents only five percent of our total trade, but ninety-five percent
of our atomic engines are imported. Eighty percent of our thorium, sixty-five
percent of our cesium, sixty percent of our molybdenum and tin are imported.
The list can be extended almost indefinitely, and it is quite easy to see that
the five percent is an extremely important, a vital, five percent.
Furthermore, if a large manufacturer receives a shipment of atomic
steel-shapers from Rhea, it does not follow that the benefit redounds only to
him. Every man on Earth who uses steel implements or objects manufactured by
steel implements benefits.
Q.
But is it not true that the current restrictions on Earth's interstellar trade
have cut our grain and cattle exports to almost nothing? And far from harming
Earth, isn't this really a boon to our own hungry people?
A.
This is another serious fallacy. That Earth's good food supply is tragically
inadequate is true. The government would be the last to deny it. But our food
exports do not represent any serious drain upon this supply. Less than one
fifth of one percent of Earth's food is exported, and in return we obtain, for
instance, fertilizers and farm machinery which more than make up for that
small loss by increasing
184 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
agricultural
efficiency. Therefore, by buying less food from us, the Outer Worlds are
engaged, in effect, in cutting our already inadequate food supply.
Q.
Are you ready to admit, then, Secretary Moreno, that at least part of the blame
for this situation should rest with Earth itself? In other words, we come to my
next question: Was it not a diplomatic blunder of the first magnitude for the
government to issue its inflammatory note denouncing the intentions of the
Outer Worlds before those intentions had been made clear at the Interplanetary
Conference?
A. I think those intentions
were quite clear at the time.
Q. I
beg pardon, sir, but I was at the conference. At the time the note was issued,
there was almost a stalemate among the Outer World delegates. Those of Rhea and
Tethys strongly opposed economic action against Earth, and there was
considerable chance that Aurora and its bloc might have been defeated. Earth's
note ended that possibility in-standy.
A. Well, what is your
question, Mr. Keilin?
Q.
In view of my statements, do you or do you not think Earth's note to have been
a criminal error of diplomacy which can now be made up only by a policy of
intelligent conciliation ?
A. You use strong language. However, I cannot
answer the question directly, since I do not agree with your major premise. I
cannot believe that the delegates of the Outer Worlds could behave in the manner
you describe. In the first place, it is well known that the Outer Worlds are
proud of their boast that the percentage of insanity, psychoses, and even
relatively minor maladjustments of personality are almost at the vanishing
point in their society. It is one of their strongest arguments against Earth,
that we have more psychiatrists than plumbers and yet are more pinched for want
of the former. The delegates to the conference represented the best of this
so-stable society. And now you would have me believe that these demigods would,
in a moment of pique, have reversed their opinions and instituted a major
change in the economic policy of fifty worlds. I cannot believe them capable of
such childish and perverse activity, and must therefore insist that any action
they took was based not upon any note from Earth, but upon motivations that go
deeper.
Q.
But I saw the effect upon them with my own eyes, sir. Remember, they were
being scolded in what they considered to be insolent language from an inferior
people. There can be no doubt, sir, that as
MOTHER EARTH 185
a whole, the men of the Outer Worlds are a
remarkably stable people, despite your sarcasm, but their atdtude toward Earth
represents a weak
point in this stability.
A. Are you asking me questions, or are you
defending the racist views and policies of the Outer Worlds?
Q. Well, accepting your viewpoint that
Earth's note did no harm, what good could it have done? Why should it have been
sent?
A. I
think we were justified in presenting our side of the question before the bar
of Galactic public opinion. I believe we have exhausted the subject. What is
your next question, please? It is the last, isn't it?
Q.
It is. It has recently been reported that the Terrestrian government will take
stern measures against those dealing in smuggling operations. Is this consistent
with the government's view that lowered trade relations are detrimental to
Earth's welfare?
A.
Our primary concern is peace, and not our own immediate welfare. The Outer
Worlds have adopted certain trade restrictions. We disapprove of them, and
consider them a great injustice. Nevertheless, we shall adhere to them, so
that no planet may say that we have given the slightest pretext for
hostilities. For instance, I am privileged to announce here for the first time
that in the past month, five ships, traveling under false Earth registry, were
stopped while being engaged in the smuggling of Outer World materiel into
Earth. Their goods were confiscated and their personnel imprisoned. This is an
earnest of our good intentions.
Q. Outer World ships?
A. Yes. But traveling under
false Earth registry, remember.
Q. And the men imprisoned
are citizens of the Outer Worlds?
A. I
believe so. However, they were breaking not only our laws, but those of the
Outer Worlds as well, and therefore doubly forfeited their interplanetary
rights. I think the interview had better close, now,
Q. But this—
It was at this point that the broadcast came
to a sudden end. The conclusion of Keilin's last sentence was never heard by
anyone but Moreno. It ended like this:
"—means war."
But
Luiz Moreno was no longer on the air. So as he drew on his gloves, he smiled
and, with infinite meaning, shrugged his shoulders in a little gesture of
indifference.
There were no witnesses to
that shrug.
l86 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
The Gathering at Aurora was still in session.
Franklin Maynard had dropped out for the moment in utter weariness. He faced
his son whom he now saw for the first dme in naval uniform.
"At least you're sure of what will happen, aren't you?"
In
the young man's response, there was no weariness at all, no apprehension;
nothing but utter satisfaction. "This is it, dad!"
"Nothing
bothers you, then? You don't think we've been maneuvered into this."
"Who cares if we have?
It's Earth's funeral."
Maynard
shook his head: "But you realize that we've been put in the wrong. The
Outer World citizens they hold are law-breakers. Earth is within its
rights."
His
son frowned: "I hope you're not going to make statements like that to the
Gathering, dad. I don't see that Earth is justified at all. All right, what if
smuggling was going on. It was just because some Outer Worlders are willing to
pay black market prices for Terrestrial food. If Earth had any sense, she could
look the other way, and everyone would benefit. She makes enough noise about
how she needs our trade, so why doesn't she do something about it. Anyway, I
don't see that we ought to leave any good Aurorans or other Outer Worlders in
the hands of those apemen. Since they won't give them up, we'll make them.
Otherwise, none of us will be safe next time."
"I see that you've
adopted the popular opnions, anyway."
"The
opinions are my own. If they're popular opinion also, it's because they make
sense. Earth wants
a war. Well, they'll get
it."
"But
why do they want a war, eh? Why do they force our hands? Our entire economic
policy of the past months was only intended to force a change in their attitude
without war."
He
was talking to himself, but his son answered with the final argument: "I
don't care why they wanted war. They've got it
now, and we're going to smash them."
Maynard
returned to the Gathering, but even as the drone of debate re-filled the room,
he thought, with a twinge that there would be no Terrestrian alfalfa that year.
He regretted the milk. In fact, even the beef seemed, somehow, to be just a
little less savory—
The
vote came in the early hours of the morning. Aurora declared war. Most of the
worlds of the Aurora bloc joined it by dawn.
In the history books, the war was later known
as the Three Weeks' War. In the first week, Auroran forces occupied several of
the trans-
MOTHER EARTH 187
Plutonian
asteroids, and at the beginning of the third week, the bulk of Earth's home
fleet was all but completely destroyed in a battle within the orbit of Saturn
by an Aurora fleet not one-quarter its size, numerically.
Declarations of war from the Outer Worlds yet
neutral followed like the pop-pop of a
string of firecrackers.
On
the twenty-first day of the war, lacking two hours, Earth surrendered.
The negotiations of peace terms took place
among the Outer Worlds. Earth's activities were concerned with signing only. The
conditions of peace were unusual, perhaps unique, and under the force of an
unprecedented humiliation, all the hordes of Earth seemed suddenly struck with
a silence that came from a shamed anger too strong for words.
The terms mentioned were perhaps best
commented upon by a voice
on the Auroran video two days after they were made public. It can be quoted in
part:
".
. . There is nothing in or on Earth that we of the Outer Worlds can need or
want. All that was ever worthwhile on Earth left it centuries ago in the
persons of our ancestors.
"They
call us the children of Mother Earth, but that is not so, for we are the
descendants of a Mother Earth that no longer exists, a Mother Earth that we brought with us. The
Earth of today bears us at best a cousinly relation. No more.
"Do
we want their resources? Why, they have none for themselves. Can we use their
industry or science? They are almost dead for lack of ours. Can we use their
man power? Ten of them are not worth a single
robot. Do we even want the dubious glory of ruling them? There is no such
glory. As our helpless and incompetent inferiors, they would be only a drag
upon us. They would divert from our own use food, labor, and administrative
ability.
"So
they have nothing to give us, but the space they occupy in our thought. They
have nothing to free us from, but themselves. They cannot benefit us in any way
other than in their absence.
"It
is for that reason, that the peace terms have been defined as they have been.
We wish them no harm, so let them have their own solar system. Let them five
there in peace. Let them mold their own destiny in their own way, and we will
not disturb them there by even the least hint of our presence. But we in turn
want peace. We in turn
l88 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
would
guide our own future in our own way. So we do not want their presence. And with that end in view, an Outer World fleet will patrol
the boundaries of their system, Outer World bases will be established on their
outermost asteroids, so that we may make sure they do not intrude on our
territory.
"There
will be no trade, no diplomatic relationships, no travel, no communications.
They are fenced off, locked out, hermetically sealed away. Out here we have a
new universe, a second creation of Man, a higher Man—
"They
ask us: What will become of Earth? We answer: That is Earth's problem.
Population growth can be controlled. Resources can be efficiently exploited.
Economic systems can be revised. We know, for we have done so. If they cannot,
let them go the way of the dinosaur, and make room.
"Let them make room,
instead of forever demanding room!"
And so an impenetrable curtain swung slowly
shut about the Solar System. The stars in Earth's sky became only stars again
as in the long-dead days before the first ship had penetrated the barrier of
light's speed.
The government that had made war and peace
resigned, but there was no one really to take their place. The legislature
elected Luiz Moreno—ex-Ambassador to Aurora, ex-Secretary without Portfolio— as
President pro
tern, and Earth as a whole
was too numbed to agree or disagree. There was only a widespread relief that
someone existed who would be willing to take the job of trying to guide the
destinies of a world in prison.
Very
few realized how well-planned an ending this was, or with what calculation,
Moreno found himself in the president's chair.
Ernest Keilin said hopelessly from the video
screen: "We are only ourselves now. For us, there is no universe and no
past—only Earth, and the future."
That
night he heard from Luiz Moreno once again, and before morning he left for the
capital.
Moreno's presence seemed incongruent within
the stiffly formal president's mansion. He was suffering from a cold again, and
snuffled when he talked.
Keilin regarded him with a self-terrifying
hostility; an almost sing-
MOTHER EARTH 189
ing
hatred in which he could feel his fingers begin to twitch in the first gestures
of choking. Perhaps he shouldn't have come— Well, what was the difference; the
orders had been plain. If he had not come, he would have been brought.
The new president looked at him sharply:
"You have to alter your attitude toward me, Keilin. I know you regard me
as one of the Grave-diggers of Earth—isn't that the phrase you used last
night?—but you must listen to me quietly for a while. In your present state of
suppressed rage, I doubt if you could hear me."
"I will hear whatever
you have to say, Mr. President."
"Well—the
external amenities, at least. That's hopeful. Or do you think a video-tracer is
attached to the room?"
Keilin merely lifted his
eyebrows.
Moreno
said: "It isn't. We are quite alone. We must be alone, otherwise how could I tell you safely that it is being
arranged for you to be elected president under a constitution now being
devised. Eh, what's the matter?"
Then
he grinned at the look of bloodless amazement in Keilin's face. "Oh, you
don't believe it. Well, it's past your stopping. And before an hour is up,
you'll understand."
"I'm
to be president?" Keilin struggled with a strange, hoarse voice. Then,
more firmly: "You are mad."
"No. Not I. Those out there, rather. Out
there in the Outer Worlds." There was a sudden vicious intensity in
Moreno's eyes, and face, and voice, so that you forgot he was a little monkey
of a man with a perpetual cold. You didn't notice the wrinkled sloping forehead.
You forgot the baldish head and ill-fitting clothes. There was only the bright
and luminous look in his eyes, and the hard incision in his voice. That you noticed.
Keilin
reached blindly backward for a chair, as Moreno came closer and spoke with
increasing intensity.
"Yes,"
said Moreno. "Those out among the Stars. The godlike ones. The stately
supermen. The strong, handsome master-race. They are mad. But only we on Earth know it.
"Come,
you have heard of the Pacific Project. I know you have. You denounced it to
Cellioni once, and called it a fake. But it isn't a fake. And almost none of it
is a secret. In fact, the only secret about it was that almost none of it was a
secret.
"You're
no fool, Keilin. You just never stopped to work it all out. And yet you were on
the track. You had the feel of it. What was
I90 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
it
you said that time you were interviewing me on the program? Something about the
attitude of the Outer Worldling toward the Earthman being the only flaw in the
former's stability. That was it, wasn't it? Or something like that? Very well,
then; good! You had the first third of the Pacific Project in your mind at the
time, and it was no secret after all, was it?
"Ask yourself, Keilin—what was the
attitude of the typical Auroran to a
typical Earthman ? A feeling of superiority ? That's the first thought, I
suppose. But, tell me, Keilin, if he really felt superior, really superior, would it be so necessary for him to call such continuous attention
to it. What kind of superiority is it that must be continuously bolstered by
the constant repetition of phrases such as 'apemen,' 'sub-men,' 'half-animals
of Earth,' and so on ? That is not the calm internal assurance of superiority.
Do you waste epithets on earthworms? No, there is something else there.
"Or
let us approach it from another tack. Why do Outer World tourists stay in
special hotels, travel in inclosed ground-cars, and have rigid, if unwritten,
rules against social intermingling? Are they afraid of pollution? Strange then
that they are not afraid to eat our food and drink our wine and smoke our
tobacco.
"You see, Keilin, there are no
psychiatrists on the Outer Worlds. The supermen are, so they say, too well
adjusted. But here on Earth, as the proverb goes, there are more psychiatrists
than plumbers, and they get lots of practice. So it is we, and not they, who
know the truth about this Outer World superiority-complex; who know it to be
simply a wild reaction against an overwhelming feeling of guilt.
"Don't
you think that can be so ? You shake your head as though you disagree. You
don't see that a handful of men who clutch a Galaxy while billions starve for
lack of room must
feel a subconscious guilt,
no matter what? And, since they won't share the loot, don't you see that the
only way they can justify themselves is to try to convince themselves that
Earthmen, after all, are inferior, that they do not deserve the Galaxy, that a
new race of men have been created out there and that we here are only the
diseased remnants of an old race that should die out like the dinosaur, through
the working of inexorable natural laws.
"Ah,
if they could only convince themselves of that, they would no longer be guilty,
but merely superior. Only it doesn't work; it never does. It requires constant
bolstering; constant repetition, constant reinforcement. And still it doesn't
quite convince.
MOTHER EARTH 191
"Best
of all, if only they could pretend that Earth and its population do not exist
at all. When you visit Earth, therefore, avoid Earth-men; or they might make
you uncomfortable by not looking inferior enough. Sometimes they might look
miserable instead, and nothing more. Or worse still, they might even seem
intelligent—as I did, for instance, on Aurora.
"Occasionally,
an Outer Worlder like Moreanu did crop up, and was able to recognize guilt for
what it was without being afraid to say so out loud. He spoke of the duty the
Outer Worlds owed Earth— and so he was dangerous to us. For if the others
listened to him and had offered token assistance to Earth, their guilt might
have been assuaged in their own minds; and that without any lasting help to
Earth. So Moreanu was removed through our web-weaving, and the way left clear
to those who were unbending, who refused to admit guilt, and whose reaction
could therefore be predicted and manipulated.
"Send
them an arrogant note, for instance, and they automatically strike back with a
useless embargo that merely gives us the ideal pretext for war. Then lose a
war quickly, and you are sealed off by the annoyed supermen. No communicadon,
no contact. You no longer exist to annoy them. Isn't that simple? Didn't it
work out nicely?"
Keilin
finally found his voice, because Moreno gave him time by stopping. He said:
"You mean that all this was planned ? You did deliberately instigate the war for the purpose of sealing Earth off
from the Galaxy? You sent out the men of the Home Fleet to sure death because
you wanted defeat ? Why, you're a monster, a . . . a—"
Moreno
frowned: "Please relax. It was not as simple as you think, and I am not a
monster. Do you think the war could simply be—instigated? It had to be
nurtured gently in just the right way and to just the right conclusion. If we
had made the first move; if we had been the aggressor; if we had in any way put
the fault on our side— why they of the Outer Worlds would have occupied Earth,
and ground it under. They would no longer feel guilty, you see, if we committed a crime against them. Or,
again, if we fought a protracted war, or one in which we inflicted damage, they
could succeed in shifting the blame.
"But
we didn't. We merely imprisoned Auroran smugglers, and were obviously within
our rights. They had to go to war over it because only so could they protect
their superiority which in turn protected them against the horrors of guilt.
And we lost quickly. Scarcely an Auroran died. The guilt grew deeper and
resulted in exactly the peace treaty our psychiatrists had predicted.
192 journey to infinity
"And
as for sending men out to die, that is a commonplace in every war—and a
necessity. It was necessary to fight a battle, and, naturally, there were
casualties."
"But
why?" interrupted Keilin, wildly. "Why? Why? Why does all this gibberish seem to make sense to you? What have we
gained? What can we possibly gain out of the present situation?"
"Gained,
man? You ask what we've gained? Why, we've gained the universe. What has held
us back so far? You know what Earth has needed these last
centuries. You yourself once outlined it forcefully to Cellioni. We need a
positronic robot society and an atomic power technology. We need chemical
farming and we need population control. Well, what's prevented that, eh? Only
the customs of centuries which said robots were evil since they deprived human
beings of jobs, that population control was merely the murder of unborn
children, and so on. And worse, there was always the safety valve of emigration
either actual or hoped-for.
"But
now we cannot emigrate. We're $tuc\ here.
Worse than that, we have been humiliatingly defeated by a handful of men out in
the stars, and we've had a humiliating treaty of peace forced upon us. What
Earthman wouldn't subconsciously burn for revenge, and what human motivation is
stronger than the desire for revenge. Self-preservation has frequently
knuckled under to that tremendous yearning to 'get even.'
"And
that is the second third of the Pacific Project, the recognition of the
revenge motive. As simple as that.
"And
how can we know that this is really so? Why, it has been demonstrated in
history scores of times. Defeat a nation, but don't crush it entirely, and in a
generation or two or three it will be stronger than it was before. Why? Because
in the interval, sacrifices will have been made for revenge that would not have
been made for mere conquest.
"Think! Rome beat Carthage rather easily
the first time, but was almost defeated the second. Every time Napoleon
defeated the European coalition, he laid the groundwork for another just a
little bit harder to defeat, until he himself was crushed by the eighth. It
took four years to defeat Wilhelm of medieval Germany, and six much more
dangerous years to stop his successor, Hitler.
"There
you are! Until now, Earth needed to change its way of life only for greater
comfort and happiness. A minor item like that
MOTHER EARTH 193
could
always wait. But now it must change for revenge and that will not wait. And I
want that change for its own sake.
"Only—I
am not the man to lead. I am tarred with the failure of yesteryear, and will
remain so until, long after I am bone-dust, Earth learns the truth. But you . .
. you, and others like you, have always fought for
the road to modernization. You will
be in charge. It may take a hundred years. Grandchildren of men unborn may be
the first to see its completion. But at least you will see the start.
"Eh, what do you say?"
Keilin
was fumbling at the dream. He seemed to see it in a misty distance—a new and
reborn Earth. But the change in attitude was too extreme. It could not be done
just yet. He shook his head.
He
said: "What makes you think the Outer Worlds would allow such a change,
supposing what you say to be true. They will be watching, I am sure, and they
will detect a growing danger and put a stop to it. Can you deny that?"
Moreno
threw his head back and laughed noiselessly. He gasped out: "But we have
still a third left of the Pacific Project, a last, subde and ironic third—
"The Outer Worlders call the men of
Earth the subhuman dregs of a great race, but we are the men of Earth.
Do you realize what that
means? We live on a planet upon which for a billion years, life —the life that
has culminated in Mankind—has been adapting itself. There is not a microscopic
part of Man, not a tiny working of his mind, that has not as its reason some
tiny facet of the physical make-up of Earth, or of the biological make-up of
Earth's other life-forms, or of the sociological make-up of the society about him.
"No other planet can
substitute for Earth, in
Man's present shape.
"The
Outer Worlders exist as they do, only because pieces of Earth have been
transplanted. Soil has been brought out there; plants; animals; men. They keep
themselves surrounded by an artificial Earth-born geology which has within it,
for instance, those traces of cobalt, zinc, and copper which human chemistry
must have. They surround themselves by Earth-born bacteria and algae which have
the ability to make those inorganic traces available in just the right way and
in just the right quantity.
"And
they maintain that situation by continued imports—luxury imports, they call
it—from Earth.
"But on the Outer
Worlds, even with Terrestrian soil laid down
194 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
to
bedrock, they cannot keep rain from falling and rivers from flowing, so that
there is an inevitable, if slow, admixture with the native soil; an inevitable
contamination of Terrestrian soil bacteria with the native bacteria, and an
exposure, in any case, to a different atmosphere and to solar radiations of
different types. Terrestrian bacteria disappear or change. And then plant life
changes. And then animal life.
"No
great change, mind you. Plant life would not become poisonous or nonnutritious
in a day, or year, or decade. But already, the men of the Outer Worlds can
detect the loss or change of the trace compounds that are responsible for that
infinitely elusive thing we call 'flavor.' It has gone that far.
"And
it will go further. Do you know, for instance, that on Aurora, nearly one half
the native bacterial species known have protoplasm based on a fluorocarbon
rather than hydrocarbon chemistry. Can you imagine the essential foreignness of
such an environment ?
"Well,
for two decades now, the bacteriologists and physiologists of Earth have
studied various forms of Outer World life—the only portion of the Pacific
Project that has been truly secret—and the transplanted Terrestrian life is
already beginning to show certain changes on the subcellular level. Even among the humans.
"And
here is the irony. The Outer Worlders, by their rigid racism and unbending
genetic policies are consistently eliminating from among themselves any
children that show signs of adapting themselves to their respective planets in
any way that departs from the norm. They are maintaining—they must maintain as a result of their own thought-processes—an artificial
criterion of 'healthy' humanity, which is based on Terrestrian chemistry and
not their own.
"But now that Earth has been cut off
from them; now that not even a trickle of Terrestrian soil and life will reach
them, change will be piled on change. Sicknesses will come, mortality will
increase, child abnormalities will become more frequent—"
"And then?" asked
Keilin, suddenly caught up.
"And
then? Well, they are physical scientists—leaving such inferior sciences as
biology to us. And they cannot abandon their sensation of superiority and
their arbitrary standard of human perfection. They will never detect the change
till it is too late to fight it. Not all mutations are clearly visible, and
there will be an increasing revolt against the mores of those stiff Outer World
societies. There will be a century of increasing physical and social turmoil
which will prevent any interference on their part with us.
MOTHER EARTH I95
"We
will have a century of rebuilding and revitalization, and at the end of it, we
shall face an outer Galaxy which will either be dying or changed. In the first
case, we will build a second Terrestrian Empire, more wisely and with greater
knowledge than we did the first; one based on a strong and modernized Earth.
"In
the second case, we will face perhaps ten, twenty, or even all fifty Outer
Worlds, each with a slightly different variety of Man. Fifty humanoid species,
no longer united against us, each increasingly adapted to its own planet, each
with a sufficient tendency toward atavism to love Earth, to regard it as the great
and original Mother.
"And
racism will be dead, for variety will then be the great fact of Humanity, and
not uniformity. Each type of Man will have a world of its own, for which no
other world could quite substitute, and on which no other type could live quite
as well. And other worlds can be settled to breed still newer varieties, until
out of the grand intellectual mixture, Mother Earth will finally have given
birth not to merely a Terrestrian, but to a Galactic Empire."
Keilin said, fascinated:
"You foresee all this so certainly."
"Nothing
is truly certain; but the best minds on Earth agree on
this. There may be unforeseen stumbling blocks on the way, but to remove those
will be the adventure of our great-grandchildren. Of our adventure, one phase has been successfully concluded; and another phase
is beginning. Join us, Keilin."
Slowly,
Keilin began to think that perhaps Moreno was not a monster after all—
Yielding
slowly under the pressure of innumerable marauders, Earth drew bac\ upon
herself. The Solar Empire disintegrated piecemeal as the home* land prepared
for the final battle. Terrestrial patrols still manned outposts, but their
recall was only a matter of time. They could leave behind, however, the spares of freedom which, should Earth itself fall, someday could burst into the
flame of another renaissance.
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS
by
C. L. Moore
B |
lue Venusian twilight filled the room where Quanna sat combing her hair before the
glass. It was very quiet here. Quanna drew the long, pale strands through her
comb with a somnolent rhythm, meeting her own eyes in the mirror. Reflected
there she could see the windows behind her, blowing curtains that veiled the
tremendous blue peaks which walled in Darva from the world. From far away a
thunderous echo of avalanche shook the evening air a little and rumbled into silence.
No
one—not even another Venusian—could have guessed what was going on behind the
pale, translucent oval of Quanna's face, the unchanging dark eyes. She wore a
blue-green robe the color of the evening sky over Darva, and in the blue dusk
her hair took on a faintly greenish cast. She was thinking of murder.
Behind
her the door creaked. A man in uniform came into the room wearily, running his
fingers through his black hair. The green star of Earth glittered on his tunic
He grinned at Quanna.
"Get
me a drink, will you?" he asked her in English. "Lord, how dred I
am!"
Quanna was on her feet in a rustle of satin
and a cloud of faint perfume. Her green-blond hair was so fine it seemed to
float upon the air as she turned. If ever there was any betrayal of feeling
upon Quan-na's pale Venusian face, it showed tenderness when she looked at
James Douglas, commander of the last Terrestrial Patrol left on Venus.
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS I97
"Come
and lie down," she said in her gentlest voice. Her English was almost as
easy as his own. "You do need a drink, poor darling. You've been working
late again, Jamie?"
He
nodded, letting her draw him to the deep couch below the windows which opened
upon the high blue mountains and the roofs of Darva. She stood for a moment
watching his face as he relaxed with a sigh upon the cushions. The couch
creaked a little beneath him, for Douglas was a big man, built in the tradition
of his Scottish ancestors upon another world, almost a giant among the slim
Ve-nusians. He was barrel-chested, thick through the shoulders; and his heavy
black hair had gone frosty at the temples quite definitely in the last few
months. Jamie Douglas had had much to think about, in solitude, since the last
dispatches from Base came in.
He
buried his crooked nose in the glass Quanna brought and drank thirstily,
letting the cool, watered whiskey go burning down his throat.
"Nothing
like segir" he grinned up at the girl. "I'll miss it
when" —he caught himself—"if I'm ever recalled to Earth."
Quanna's
eyes veiled. An Earth woman would have pounced upon the implication in that
remark and dragged it into daylight. The Venusian girl waited. They both knew
she would weave it into conversation perhaps hours later, worming the
forbidden information out of him irresistibly, imperceptibly, as she had so
often done in the past. Douglas cursed himself silendy and gulped segir again.
Quanna's
gaze lingered on his face as he drank. Twenty years under the flowing
cloud-tides of Venus had not bleached his dark skin to pallor, but they had set
their own marks upon his face. The broken nose was a memory of a mountain
ambush in his subaltern days, and the long, fading scar above one ear an
insignia of the fight in which he had won his captaincy. Even as long ago as
that Imperial Earth had begun to feel her fingers slip upon her colonial
worlds, and there had been fierce fighting in the mountains of Venus. There
sdll was, but it would not last much longer—
Douglas
held out his emptied glass. "Another," he said, and loosened his
tunic collar. "I'm dred."
Quanna
laid a long, cool hand upon his forehead in a gesture of reticent tenderness
before she turned away to the little pantry where the ice and the segir were. The long folds of her robe hid what she was doing, but she did not
drop a tablet into the drink this time. There had been enough in the first, and
besides—besides she had information to draw out of him before she went away.
I98 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
She
pulled up a hassock and took her monochord harp from the wall after he had
begun on the second drink, and began to pluck a plaintive melody from the
single string, stopping it against its movable bridges with an intricate
fingering. Douglas nodded in time with the music and began to hum, smiling at
her.
"Funny,"
he mused. "You're a cosmopolitan, my dear, even if you've never stepped a
foot off Venus. Scottish ballad on a Martian harp, transposed to Venusian
melody. What an old song it is, Quanna." He began to sing the words
softly, his voice unmusical:
"The Otterburris bonny burn,
It's pleasant there to be,
But there is naught on Otterburn
To feed my men and me—"
He shook himself a little and quieted. Quanna
saw something dark and unhappy move across his face, and she struck one of two
quivering notes from the string and said in a voice pitched to the music, so
that it scarcely broke the silence at all:
"I'd like to see
Earth, Jamie. Could I go back with you?"
"I
wish you could," he answered in a low voice. "It won't be easy, my
dear—I'll miss so much on Venus. I—"
He sat up suddenly and scowled at her under black brows. "That wasn't
fair, Quanna! You wouldn't catch me like that if I weren't tired. Oh, yes, damn
it, I suppose you'll have to know soon, anyhow. Orders came today. We're going
back."
"The
last of the Patrols," murmured Quanna, still stroking the harp to faint
music. "Venus will be free again, Jamie?"
His
heavy brows drew down again above the crooked nose. "Free?" he said
bitterly. "Oh, yes, free for Vastari and his cutthroats, if that's what
you're thinking of. There'll be no more safety anywhere on Venus, if that's
what freedom means to you. All this culture we've tried to build up in our
three hundred years will crash in—oh, three hundred days, or less, once the
protection of the Patrol fails. You'll have barbarism back again, my sweet. Is
that what freedom means to a Venusian?"
She smiled at him, her face pale in the
gathering twilight. "Jamie, Jamie," she rebuked him gently. "Our
ways were good enough before the Earthmen came. And you'll be going home—" He set down his glass half
emptied, as if the thought had closed
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 199
his
throat. Looking out between the long, swaying draperies, he said heavily:
"Oh, sure— I was born there, forty-odd years ago. I suppose it's home.
But—I'll miss Venus, Quanna." He reached out for her and. "I'll miss
you— I . . . I'm sleepy, Quanna. Play 'Otterburn' again, will you, my dear? I
think I'll have a nap before dinner."
When
Douglas was breathing evenly, Quanna put a pillow straighter under his black
head, pulled a light coverlet over him and hung the harp away. In her bedroom
she took down a velvet cloak of deep emerald-green and changed her sandals to
riding boots of soft leather.
With
the dark cloak hooding her, she paused by the door and touched a panel that
slid inward without a sound. Not even the Earth-man who designed the house knew
about that panel, or about many other secret things which the Venusian workmen
had built into the headquarters of the Terrestrial Patrol.
Quanna took a pistol from a shelf inside the
panel and buckled it about her waist over the satin gown she wore. Her fingers
lingered on a long, flat box on the shelf and she drew it out hesitantly,
glancing over her shoulder around the empty room.
Inside
the box, bedded in velvet, lay a dagger with a silver haft and a long glass
blade. Quanna took it out of its nest and tilted the crystal to the light.
Venusian characters were traced in water colors on the blade. On one side they
declared in crimson, "Vastari Shall Be King," and on the other were
the simple characters that spelled a name, "James Douglas." By a
coincidence, the Venusian name for Douglas had the same meaning as his Scottish
patronym in the ancient Gaelic—Dhu Glas. Both meant "the dark man."
The
dagger Quanna held was a ceremonial weapon, that could be used only once. It
had never been used—yet. The crimson lettering would wash off at the first
touch of any moisture. And the blade would splinter in its wound. It was meant
to splinter. It had been given to Quanna six months past, with great ceremony.
She should have used it long ago.
She laid it back in its box and closed the
panel quickly. She woke in the blue night sometimes, trembling, out of dreams
about that glass dagger.
She
drew the green cloak about her and went out swifdy. No one but the Venusian
servants saw her pass, and they made furtive obeisance and looked after her
with reverent eyes. So did the grooms in the stable where her saddled horse
stood waiting. One of them said,
200 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"The
waterfall cave, lady, up toward Thunder Range," and gave her the grave
salute due Venusian rank. Quanna nodded and took the reins.
The
Earth officer on duty at the outer gate never saw her pass. His men drew his
attention away just long enough for the cloaked figure on the padding dark
horse to slip like a shadow out of the gate, and the young Earthman could have
sworn afterward that no one had gone that way.
The
horse took to the rising trail outside Darva with its padded gait that has a
rocking-chair smoothness. Even the horses of Venus go furtively, on silent
feet. This one climbed steadily up the twisting trail through the blue dusk
which passes for night in the zone where Darva lies.
Night
and day have only roughly equivalent terms in the Venusian tongues, but there
is a slow rhythm of thermals over a broad belt of Dayside, caused by the libration
of the planet, that gives something corresponding to them. There are periods of
dim-blue chill, and periods of opalescent noons when the sun is a liquid blaze
behind high mists. The intervals are months long in some parts of Dayside, but
here the tremendous mountains create air currents of their own, and the
cloud-tides have a much briefer rhythm, though still too varied to make
Venusians clearly understand night and day.
The
great blue mountains loomed purple and violet in the dusk as Quanna rode up the
trail. She could hear countless waterfalls tinkling and trickling away like
music all around her, a background to the slow, far-off thunder of a rockslide
that shook the cliffs with its echoes.
The
lifting crags that rushed straight up a thousand feet into the clouds were
shocking to Earth eyes even after a lifetime on Venus, but Quanna scarcely
noticed the familiar sheer cliffs of purple rock hanging like doom itself
above her as she climbed. She had been born among these cliffs, but she did not
mean to die here. If she had her way, she would die on another planet and be
buried under the smooth green soil of Earth, where sunlight and starlight and
moonlight changed in a clear sky she could not quite imagine, for all the tales
she had heard.
The
cavern she was seeking lay two hours high in the towering peaks above Darva. No
one but a Venusian could have found it in less than days. Both Quanna and her
horse knew the path well enough, but it was a difficult climb even for them,
and when they came out into
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 201
the
cathedral-walled canyon where a thin waterfall swayed like smoke, the horse's
sides were heaving with the steepness of the climb.
In these narrow walls the waterfall made a
thunderous music. Quanna drew her cloak over her face and rode straight through
the smoking veil of water, into the Gothic arch of the cavern beyond. She
whistled three clear, liquid notes as she came, and heard answering music echo
from the walls, piercing the roar of the waterfall.
Around two bends firelight flickered. Quanna
slid off the horse into the waiting arms of servants, and went down a sparkling
sandy slope toward the fire. Light danced bewilderingly upon a fairyland of
crystalline columns which slow centuries had built of dripping water here. It
was an Aladdin cave of flashing jewels in the firelight.
Of
the group by the fire, all but one man rose as Quanna came forward, her scarlet
boots showing and fading with delicate precision beneath her emerald cloak.
Quanna had been trained meticulously in every rite that befits a Venusian
woman, and ceremonious behavior was not the least of her knowledge. Even her
gait was traditional as she approached the men before the fire.
They had risen—all but the hooded old one—not
in deference to her rank or her womanhood, for women are not held highly on
Venus, but because she was an important emissary bringing news of the enemy.
And had they had reason to think her news would be bad or her prestige in the
enemy camp lowered, they would not have risen. Under the elaborate ceremony of
Venusian courts is a basis of dog-eat-dog which shocks Earthmen. Venusians
scorn the unsuccessful and toady to the strong with a certain courtliness which
ingratiates even as it repels.
The
richly colored robes of the men made points of jewel colors dance along the
crystalline walls as they moved. A young man pushed impetuously out among them
and came forward, his crimson cloak swinging from supple shoulders, his long
fair hair swinging, too, as he came to meet the girl. The two of them were as
alike in looks as blood relation can make man and woman.
Quanna took both his hands with the exact
degree of deference which was due from her temporary man-status as important
spy. Vastari's face blazed with impatient eagerness as Quanna exhanged the
proper ceremonious greetings with the group of tribe leaders around the fire.
It amused her a little to let her royal brother wait upon her. She met the
fierce stares of the other men composedly, too accustomed all her life to
seeing that avid hope for disaster in every
202 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
face
to notice it much now. No Venusian rises to influence without knowing very well
the eager, searching stare of rivals hungry for a sign of weakness.
Last of all she smiled at the hooded figure
by the fire, who gave her back a greeting in a harsh, hissing voice that was
very pleasant to her ears.
"Well?" demanded Vastari, pulling
her to a seat upon cushions by the fire as the last ceremonies fell silent and
the leaders grouped wolfishly around to listen. "Well, how goes it,
sister? Is the glass knife broken yet?"
"Not yet," said Quanna, making her
voice low and confident. "The Earthmen have a fable about a goose that
laid golden eggs. It's still too soon to kill ours, brother. The Dark Man gave
me great news only a few hours ago." She used a Venusian term of time
measurement which is so complex that few Earthmen ever master it. Watching
the avid eyes fixed upon her all around the fire, she went on: "The last
Patrol is leaving Venus. The orders came in today."
Vastari
smacked his ringed hands together and cried out something exultant in a voice
too choked for articulation. The fire always smoldering behind his eyes blazed
up with all but perceptible violence.
"Leaving!"
he cried. "So they've come to it at last. Do you hear, all of you? That
means freedom! Venus under Venusian rule, after three hundred years of Earth
tyranny! Is it true, Quanna?"
"True
enough, surely," said a harsh voice behind him. They all turned. The
cloaked figure at the fireside had thrown back his hood from.a crest of white
hair and was smiling at them sadly now, horny lids drooping over his eyes.
"I've seen it coming all my life, children. Mars was great once, too, you
see." He lifted bony shoulders in a shrug.
"But
aren't you glad, Ghej?" Vastari spun toward him, scarlet cloak flying with
the modon. Everything he did had a quicksilver volatility. "The freedom we
were fighting for, put right in our hands? No more hiding in the mountains for
us, Ghej! No more Earth laws! A free Venus, after three hundred years of
tyranny!"
The old Martian lifted his peaked brows.
"Is
freedom always good, then? Freedom can mean anarchy, my boy."
Vastari
snapped his fingers impadently. "Out of anarchy, something may
grow," he said. "Under tyranny, nothing can. You'll help us, won't
you, Ghej?"
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 203
Ghej
looked up somberly under his triangular lids. "Against Earth? You don't
need help against the Imperial Planet, son. Earth has brought her own ruin upon
her, and nothing we can do will affect that. I know. I saw Mars fall."
He
put his chin in his hand and stared into the fire under heavy lids. Ghej had a
strange way of talking about the past of millenniums ago as if he himself had
been present. It was the result of the vivid three-dimensional pictorial
records by which all Martians learn their history in childhood.
Vastari's
face, as he turned away, was unconsciously eloquent with the impatience of the
young for the dreaming old.
One
of the tribe leaders leaned forward, jutting a scarred, wolfish face above his
robe of apricot velvet. His eyes glittered at Quanna.
"She
brings news the old Martian could have told us years ago," he declared,
his voice jealous and eager. "That same news my own spies will bring me
tomorrow from the city. What other reasons has she for calling herself our
equal ? I say, let her kill the Earthman and go back to the harem where she
belongs."
There
was a rising of voices around the fire, some few in agreement, most
deprecating not so much the sentiment as the crude way in which it had been
put. The true Venusian prefers his malice more deftly expressed.
Quanna faced them equably. Showing no
resentment—it did not behoove a woman to resent openly anything a man might say—
she declared in a voice pitched low:
"To
us in the city it doesn't look so simple, lord. With the right knowledge, we
may glean much from the Earthmen before they go."
The
scarred hillman pounded his velvet knee with a clenched fist. "I say fight
as we planned!" he roared. "Fight and conquer and loot, before they
can get away from us! It was good enough for our fathers, wasn't it? What do we
want a new plan for? Kill and loot, and all this waiting be damned!"
A babble of voices echoed him around the fire,
cut off in a moment by the brilliant scarlet of Vastari's leap, his red cloak
streaming. There was a flash of glittering colors in one swift arc and a thud
of weapon on flesh, all too quick for the eye or the brain to follow clearly.
Then
Vastari was standing over the huddled hillman, the scarlet cloak settling in
bright folds about him and his wickedly jewel-studded blackjack swinging ready
for another blow. The hillman nursed his
204 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
smashed
nose, blood running down beneath his hand to spatter upon apricot velvet.
Vastari's eyes glittered dangerously up at
the rest under lowered brows as he stood above the silenced rebel, head sunk
between his shoulders. The bloody blackjack swung in short, twitching arcs that
caught the firelight in jeweled glints.
"Has
Ystri any friends here?" he demanded softly. No one spoke. Vastari bent
and deliberately slapped Ystri's face twice, heavy blows that rocked his head.
The hillman was nearly twice Vastari's size, but he made no move to retaliate,
only crouched there masking his broken nose behind a bunched hand and glaring
up with reluctant respect in his eyes.
The same respect showed in every subdued face
around the fire as Vastari turned away with a certain swagger, hooking the
blackjack back in his belt, careless of the blood smear upon his satin tunic.
"This
isn't the way to freedom," Vastari said, reseating himself beside Quanna.
"If we quarrel among ourselves, we'll go the way so many went before us.
We're no guerrilla band, squabbling for loot! Freedom is worth a litde
sacrifice today if we can take all Venus tomorrow! It was not under slavery
that Earthmen conquered their empire. They were free men, fighting for
themselves. We must be free, too, if we can hope to conquer Venus. Free of
Earth rule and free of all petty greeds among ourselves. We aren't children,
snatching at toys. We're free-born leaders fighting to drive Earthmen off our
soil and rule Venus under Venusian law."
The fire of the crusader kindled in Vastari's
voice as he went on. "If Ystri had his way, he'd attack Darva and die. The
Earthmen have weapons we can't hope to conquer. And even if we did—what would
happen? Ystri and his kind would loot and run back to the mountains, each to
his separate stronghold, each with all he could carry. And presently each would
envy his neighbor's loot, and in a little while you'd all be back where I found
you, little nations too busy with your petty squabbles to unite against Earth
rule or the raiders from Dark-side or anything else that threatens you. Fools
like Ystri made Earth tyranny possible on Venus. Fools like Ystri will bring it
on us again if they ever return, unless I can unite us all. Union and freedom!
Think of it, men!"
Vastari
stood up and began to pace the shining floor with long, nervous strides. The
heads of his hearers turned to follow him as if hypnotized. His voice shook and
glowed with his passionate sincerity,
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 205
and
the bright light of avarice kindled in the eyes that followed his pacing.
"I
tell you, it will be worth fighting for! We must be rid of the Earthman, but we
mustn't ruin ourselves to drive him out. There will be much to do after he's
gone—leaving his weapons behind him. We must have those weapons! We can't
conquer Venus without them. And that's why Quanna must go back to Darva and
learn more of their plans. Somehow, we must possess what the Earthmen now possess,
if we intend to rule Venus as they did. That will take courage— cunning and
courage. And after that—"
Vastari paused, looking up into the glittering shadows of the ceiling with eyes
that saw something far away and wonderful. "After that—freedom and Venus
will be ours! The Earthmen fought for freedom long ago—and won it and conquered
the stars with it! Our turn is next. When the Earthmen were first fighting against
tyranny they sang an old battle song whose words might be our own. Quanna
learned it from her Earthman. I'd like you all to hear it. Quanna—"
She
bent her smooth fair head becomingly and began in a low, clear voice to chant
as well as she could in Venusian to the tune of a very old drinking song of
Earth, once the battle anthem of a nation that had fallen long ago. The
listening men sat silent, firelight glittering in their eyes. It was a curious
scene; surely the song had never been sung in a stranger setting than this
crystalline ice cavern with its pale, sparkling shadows, to these wolfish men
in the gorgeously colored robes.
"Oh, thus be it ever when free men shall
stand Between their loved homes and the tyrant's oppression"
sang
Quanna. Vastari's fanatic young face lighted up at the words; his lips moved
soundlessly, mouthing them.
"Then conquer we must. For our cause, it
is just, And this be our motto: 'In God is our trust!" And the
Star-Spangled Banner in triumph shall wave O'er the land of the free, and the
home of the brave!"
Behind the group the gray Martian listened
enigmatically, his leathery face sad.
206 journey to infinity
Jamie Douglas wakened to a room translucent
with the blue twilight of the ebbing cloud-tide. His mind was clear and
relaxed for a moment, as tranquil as the twilight in the room. Then memory came
back, and the familiar heaviness of spirit, and he sat up slowly, the crease
deepening between his black brows. Quanna sat by the window where the breeze
just lifted her fine, pale hair. When she heard him stir she turned,
tranquillity in every gentle motion she made.
"How
well you slept," she murmured, rising. "I couldn't bear to wake you, Jamie, you were so
soundly asleep. You must have been very tired, dear."
He leaned forward on the edge of the couch,
forearms crossed on knees so his big shoulders hunched. He looked up at her
under his brows rather as Vastari had looked up in the crystal cavern, but with
all the difference in the world in his dark, weary face.
"I had a dream," he said somberly.
"I thought I was back in Nor-ristown, at the edge of the Twilight Belt,
and the mountaineers were attacking. I thought a spear went through me, right
here—" He laid a hand on his
tunic just above the belt buckle. "It was so real it still hurt for a
moment after I woke up. But in the dream it didn't hurt at all. I thought it
nailed me to the wall, and I pulled it out and—"
He laughed and hesitated. "Dreams are silly things. I thought I led a
charge brandishing that bloody spear, and we drove the attackers back." He
laughed again, but looked up at her under the black brows with a dark and
somber gaze, no laughter in his eyes.
Quanna
shivered a little under her blue-green gown. "Don't look at me like
that," she said lightly. "It was only a dream. Wouldn't you like some
coffee, Jamie dear? You missed dinner, you know."
He ignored the question. "What was it
you were playing before I fell asleep? 'Otterburn,' wasn't it?" He hummed
the tune, and words came back to his memory.
"Oh, I have dreamed a dreary dream
Beyond the Isle of S1{ye; I saw a dead man win a fight, And I thin\ that man was I—"
"The Isle of Skye," he repeated
after a long moment. "I wonder! The old Isle of Skye's on Earth, but you
and I are on a new one now, Quanna. From Earth, wouldn't Venus be the Isle of
Skye?"
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 207
She
shook her head, the fine hair clouding about her face. "I can't picture it
at all. Stars! Shall I ever see them, Jamie?"
"Not from Venus. And Earth's no safe
place to be just now, my dear. No, you're safer on your Isle of Skye. As for me—" He shook his black head. "Now
if I believed in dreams as my people used to do, I'd take that one for an
omen." He stood up. "Did you say something about coffee? Lord, how I
must have slept!"
Quanna's
smile as she rose had the clarity of uttermost innocence. When she opened the
door the tall figure standing there with knuckles lifted to knock made her jump
a little.
"Lieutenant!" she
laughed. "You startled me."
"Commander here?" Lieutenant
Morgan, second in command at Darva Post, gave her an impassive stare from
sleepy, brown eyes.
"Come
in, Morgan," called Jamie from the room beyond. "All right, Quanna.
Run along and bring that coffee."
Morgan
entered with the loose-jointed, deceptive laziness that colored everything he
did.
"Don't
like that girl," he said, looking at the closed door under his lids.
Jamie
laughed. "You don't like any Venusian." "Damn right I don't.
You'll wake up with a knife in your ribs some day, commander."
Douglas said: "Not Quanna's knife."
"Think
not?" Morgan shrugged. "By the way, Vastari was up in the hills last
night." He glanced out of the window toward the great leaning cliffs above
Darva, where the light was broadening as the morning cloud-tide thinned. A long
rumble of rockslide shook the window frames as he spoke.
"Attack?" asked
Jamie.
"No,
just a powwow. They're up to something, commander." "Oh, I suppose
so. They usually are. Any ideas?" "Two to one they know we're
leaving. That means ambush somewhere on the way out." "Or attack
here?"
Morgan shook his head.
"Too risky. Vastari's no fool."
"Maybe
not open attack. But they'll hate to see us leaving with all our artillery.
Vastari'd like that for his campaigns in the mountains. He'll try to get it,
and he'll try hard"
"Preferably by foul means," put in
Morgan with a grin. "He—"
208 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
A gentle tap at the door interrupted him.
Quanna looked in dep-recatingly.
"A caller, commander," she said.
"The Martian trader, Ghej—" Jamie
stood up quickly. "Ghej! Come in, come in! It's good to see you. Quanna,
how about coffee for us all?"
The
cloaked gray figure came in with the odd little shuffle in his gait that is so
typically Martian. Jamie had a sudden Scots premonition that vanished in a
moment and left him deriding himself, but in that moment the gray-robed figure
had looked like Death shuffling in to greet him, holding out its hand. He
remembered his dream, and the buried Celtic credulity of his forebears rose
into the light just long enough for him to wonder if he were to leave Venus
after all, if his longing to stay were to be granted more grimly than he had
bargained for. The Isle of Skye, the morning star—
'7 saw a dead man win a fight, And I thinly that man was I—"
"Superstitious fool!" he
apostrophized himself half angrily, and held out his hand to Ghej.
"I
would not have liked to miss you, commander," said the Martian in his
precise English, accepting the chair Morgan pushed forward. "I hear you
are leaving Venus soon."
Jamie
threw up his hands in a gesture of despair. "Half Venus seems to have
heard about it already."
Ghej's
pointed upper lip drew down in his beaklike smile. "I have been
liquidating my assets for over a year now," he told them, "preparing
for this day" The smile grew one-sided and twisted down a bit sadly at the
corners. With his left hand he made the crook-sign of ancient Mars in the air.
"Remember?" he asked. "It happened to Mars, too. I know about
Rome and America and the other great fallen empires of Earth. I could see this
coming from a long way off. As you could see it, commander."
There
was unconscious sadness in Jamie's own smile. "Officially this is known as
'temporary consolidation,'" he told the Martian. Ghej lifted deprecating
brows and pulled the long upper lip down in a grimace. He was too polite to
say what all three men in the room were thinking.
This
is the end of the Solar Empire of Earth. This is the last Patrol, out of all
the strong networ\ that once bound the worlds to-
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 20O
gether
by unbreakable chains of men. The lin\s are loosening; the Empire is falling
apart. Earth evacuates the planet it has ruled for three hundred years. The
Green Star of Earth is an outworn emblem now. Barbarian hordes from the outer
world are pouring down upon the Imperial Planet, armed with the weapons Earth
taught them to ma\e, that Earth might be destroyed. Little by little her grasp
has let go. One by one the Patrols go home to defend the mother world. This is
the last.
"Venus will be a different world without
you/' said Ghej, smoothing his cloak over one knee. "It will be
interesting to see what happens to the Terrestrialized cities—all the clean,
broad streets, the markets, the busy shops—how long will they last?"
"Just
as long as it takes Vastari to burn them," Morgan declared bitterly.
Ghej nodded. "Vastari probably justifies
himself in his own mind. They say he has reason to hate Earth, you know. He'll
want to destroy everything on Venus that has a Terrestrial background."
"Three
hutidred years of Earth rule," mused Jamie. "Three hours in the life
of the race! Sometimes I wonder if twenty centuries would have been enough to
make an impression on these people. Sometimes I wonder if everything we've done
on Venus hasn't been wholly in vain for both worlds. Six months after we've
gone, the Terrestrialized cities will be gone, too. What the fire leaves the
jungles will take over. Ce-mentine huts will rise where cementine huts stood
three hundred years ago, and there won't be a trace left of anything Earthmen
tried to do. No more cities where children can grow up in safety. No more protection
for the farms that provide against starvation in famine seasons. Oh, damn
Vastari!"
"He can't help being a
Venusian," said Ghej mildly.
Jamie
slapped his chair arms with impatient palms. "I know. It's just that—well,
I've been on Venus a long time now. I fought at the second siege of Norristown
when I was twenty. I flew with Cressy when he explored the Twilight Belt. Here
at Darva I've seen the city grow into something to be proud of. I got the
appropriations myself to build the storehouses that tided three whole tribes
over the last famine season. When I think of Vastari wiping it all out the
moment my back's turned, I could strangle him with my bare hands!"
"The
Venusians are like quicksilver, commander," Ghej said thoughtfully.
"They slip away from contact with the logic of other worlds."
210 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"I know. It's because they're still
barbarians, isn't it? Perhaps they'll always be barbarians. They have no words
in any of their languages for 'loyalty' or 'honor' or any of the high-sounding
ideals we live by. They have no values above the selfish animal values of survival.
They're incapable of civilized thoughts as we define civilization. I tell you,
Venus is stagnant already, for all her rawness. There's barbarism at both ends
of the social scale, you know, and the men of Venus have gone from one
barbarism to the other with no interval of true civilization between."
Jamie slapped the chair arms again.
"Think
of Norris, colonizing Venus. Can you imagine any Ve-nusian enduring such
hardships, simply for an ideal? Remember the first siege of Norristown? The
colonists could have taken ships for home any time that year, and abandoned
Venus and everything Norris and his men died to establish. But they didn't.
They stuck it out until the rescue ships came, a whole year late. Did you ever
read the story of that siege, Ghej ? Unceasing attack from the swamps and the
seas, unceasing fevers and disease from the unknown plagues of Venus. But the
colonists had a greater fever than anything Venus could inflict—the feverish
dream of empire that was sweeping the Solar System then.
"The soldiers died on the walls one by
one, and the civilians took up the battle. When the spaceship came in at last
with provisions, they found the women and children, the invalids and the
wounded manning the guns, and not one able-bodied fighting man left on his
feet.
"That burning idealism has no roots in
Venusian minds. And yet, you know, there's something irresistibly fascinating
about the planet and the people. It's raw and lusty. It's the future. Venus
from Earth is the morning star, and I think that's more than symbolism
now."
Jamie got up and walked to the window,
looking out over the roofs of Darva toward the tremendous blue mountains where
the cloud-tide thinned to let brightening daylight through.
"Back
on Earth I'll be a misfit. An outlander. Earth is a world of orderly gardens
and tamed seas and landscaped mountain ranges. The people are set in a pattern.
You know to a syllable just how they'll react to a given situation. It makes
you yawn to think of it when you've spent twenty years on Venus under these
gigantic mountains, where the people are as wild and unpredictable as the cloudbursts.
"I've forgotten the polite formulas of
Earth that cover every possi-
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 211
ble
situation. They've got a tight little society there and I won't fit into it anywhere."
Jamie was silent, and for a long moment no
one spoke. Jamie's mind went on:
"Not that it matters how Earth accepts
any of us colonials. I have an idea we've seen the last of our
little play-paradises with their formal rules. They don't tell us much here on
Venus, but the last news I heard was of barbarian bases spotted through Earth
like a plague, and barbarian invaders pouring down out of the sky in ships we
taught them how to build, with weapons we put into their hands many years
ago."
He
couldn't say that aloud, not even to Morgan. Certainly not to an outworld trader,
however well he knew Ghej, He couldn't say what had burned in his mind for so
many months now, the terrible fear that had come to him and to the civilized
world generations too late to save it.
For
the era of civilized man was ending. Jamie almost wished he hadn't had the
leisure to see it coming. He wished he hadn't read the old books, for he could
see the cycle closing as it had closed for other cultures long ago.
"They
say we're 'temporarily consolidating,'" he thought, staring out at the
great cloud-marbled mountains. "I know better. I've got a perspective here
they don't have at home, or won't admit having. I know the signs of rottenness, and the signs are plain on Earth. It'll
take a better race than modern man to win back what we're letdng
"And there is no such race. The
Venusians might have done it— but they won't now. Another few centuries and we
might have instilled some conception of what idealism means into those
slippery quicksilver minds. I don't know. We'll never do it now. And the Venusians
were our last hope.
"No
other race remains. The barbarians who are conquering Earth are decadent
barbarians. The other worlds of the empire are either old civilizations, more
tired even than we, or subhuman tribes which no amount of teaching could lift
much above apehood.
"And
so the greatest empire that mankind ever knew is crumbling from within, without
a hope of rebirth."
The
strong fragrance of coffee entering the room like a tangible presence broke the
little silence that had fallen upon the three men. Quanna came in smiling,
followed by servants with trays. Her deep,
212 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
quiet
eyes saw everything readable on the faces before her, though no eyes caught her
looking. She poured the coffee defdy.
When
she handed Ghej his cup she set a small silver platter of bread at his elbow,
according to the ceremonious Venusian custom, observed even among outworld people
on Venus. There, as on Earth, bread symbolizes the staff of life, and guests
are served with it whenever food is served and whether they intend to taste it
or not.
Ghej's horny-lidded eyes flickered at the
plate and then slanted a glance up at Quanna. She caught it wonderingly.
Something was afoot, then. Something concerning Jamie, for in the elaborate
symbolism which governs all Venusian living, bread is the emblem for leader or
head of the household.
"I think you misunderstand Vastari,
commander," said Ghej, sipping his coffee. "It's true that no
Venusian seems to comprehend what other worlds call idealism. But, in his own
mind, Vastari is probably quite sure of his Tightness. He talks of freedom, you know."
"Freedom to loot and
burn, and starve afterward!"
"Perhaps," Ghej nodded, and began
to toy with the silver knife that lay across the bread platter. "I think
so. But then I represent the past, gentlemen. My world died millenniums ago.
You yourselves are the present; your world is passing. Vastari is the future.
What he does with it only the future can show. You and I will not be here to
see." He shook his crested head and picking up the knife, drove it idly
halfway through the loaf of bread beside him. Under the horny lids he flickered
a glance up at Quanna.
"As
a trader among the mountain tribes, commander," he remarked irrelevantly,
"it has been my business for many years to fathom Venusian mentalities as
nearly as any outworlder can. I've seen a hillman, for instance, take revenge
for a blow by striking not at his attacker but at his attacker's enemy, in the
dead of night. None but a Venusian could clearly understand the tangle of
modves behind such a revenge—
"Excellent coffee, my
dear Quanna. May I have another cup?"
In the blue twilight of Jamie's bedroom
nothing moved but the softly blowing curtains. Jamie's regular, hoarse
breathing was the only sound except for an occasional, far-away thunder of
rockslide and the receding footsteps of the sentry who paced outside the
commander's quarters.
Jamie's sleep was deep. Quanna had seen to
that with the night-
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 213
cap
she had served him. Now she sat in the farthest corner of the room, where the
shadows hung as blue as if in some submarine cavern, far down under Venusian
seas. She sat in perfect stillness, unwinking eyes fixed upon the window beyond
which the shadow and the footsteps of the sentry passed and repassed.
She
was grateful to Ghej. She was not sure how he could have guessed about her
feeling for the commander, but she knew he had guessed. He was fit, almost, to
be a Venusian in his sensitive perception of nuances. She knew, too, how it
had amused him to tell her by symbolism and indirection under the very noses of
an oblivious audience that Ystri planned to murder Jamie. Yes, Ghej had lived
long enough on Venus to think almost like a Venusian himself.
As she waited here in the twilight for the
assassin she was not unduly perturbed. She knew enough of her race in general
and Ystri in particular to be sure he would come alone. He could not wholly
trust any coplotter not to betray him to Vastari, and he would want the glory
alone if he succeeded.
The
sentry's feet gritted up and down on the pavement outside; Jamie's heavy
breathing measured the silence in the room. Quanna sat unwinking and waited.
She could not have said what warned her when
the time came. Certainly no sound. But when the sentry's tread approached the
far end of his beat and a shadow slid up to the thin grille that masked the
windows, Quanna was at the grille and crouching low against it before the
shadow itself was aware of her. It must have been something of a shock to the
newcomer to find a second figure six inches away just inside the screen. The
shadow started back with a muffled gasp.
Quanna
breathed, "Ystri—look!" and let the light from the gateway shine for
an instant on the snub-nosed gun she held.
"Quick!" whispered Ystri, speaking
indistinctly because of his injured nose. "Let me in! The sentry—"
"No." Quanna's voice was flat. "I know what you want. Not tonight,
Ystri."
"Let
me in," Ystri demanded fiercely, "or the commander will know tomorrow
that you are a spy."
Quanna thought he meant that. His presdge had
been severely damaged by Vastari's blow; he might do anything to discredit her
and Vastari through her.
214 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"Not
tonight," she temporized. "I have plans— Afterward, you may kill
him."
"I don't trust you!" "Tomorrow—"
"Traitress!"
hissed Ystri. "Let me in! With him dead, there'll be confusion enough to
steal weapons, even take the town! In Vas-tari's name, let me in!"
"Not
tonight! Tomorrow I'll prove myself—kill him if you can, then. But not
here."
"Where then? You're
lying."
"It's
the truth. Tomorrow I'll bring him into a trap for you. The mangrove forest,
say? At cloud-ebb tomorrow?"
Ystri peered at her doubtfully in the blue
dimness through the grille. The sentry's returning feet grew louder on the
pavement, but Ystri hesitated for one last mistrustful moment.
"Is this the truth? Do you swear it by
Vastari?"
"I swear. I'll bring him into the
mangrove forest tomorrow, to kill if you can."
Ystri
scowled at her in the twilight, seeing a certain sincerity upon her face that
made him accept the promise reluctantly. That, and the gun gleaming dully in
reflected light.
"Tomorrow
at cloud-ebb, then—or you both die," he growled, and his shadow melted
from the grille without a sound. Quanna sat back on her heels and looked after
him, her eyes deep and expressionless.
"The mangrove forest?" Jamie's
voice was doubtful, but he turned his horse toward the upward path. "That
gloomy place? Sure you want to ride that way?"
Quanna
smiled at him under her hood of emerald velvet. "You said I could
choose—and it's our last ride together on Venus, Jamie dear."
"Oh,
all right. I always get my feet wet there, but—have it your way."
"I
think it's a lovely place, Jamie, Listen, Jamie, I'll sing to you— a going-away
song,"
The
Martian monochord harp hung at her saddle. She laid it across her green velvet
knee and began a soft Venusian chant with a ringing call at the end of each
stanza. Partly it was to amuse Jamie, partly to warn the hiding Ystri of their
coming. It would amuse Ystri
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 215
too,
in a grim sort of way, for this was a going-away song indeed, a Venusian dirge
for a man about to die.
The
mangrove forest lay high in a narrow canyon above Darva. Jamie and Quanna had
ridden here more than once before, for the pleasure of walking the narrow mossy
ways that wound over the water. The forest filled a valley between peaks veined
with waterfalls whose music tinkled all around the canyon. It was half swamp,
half lake of clear dark water out of which gigantic mangroves rose in arches
and columns and long green aisles. The labyrinthine paths wound intricately
over the great gnarled roots which stood above the water.
The
glassy surfaces gave back such faithful reflections that the forest seemed
double, suspended in green space. It was like walking in a dream to stroll
along the winding, mossy ways and watch one's own reflection swimming dimly
underfoot.
Not
even the padding Venusian horses could walk these paths. Jamie and Quanna
dismounted at the mouth of the canyon and entered the glassy forest in silence
except for the music Quanna stroked now and again from her harp. She was
watching for Ystri. He would not be easy to see, she knew. It was not for
nothing that she had worn her green cloak today, and he was certain to be
green-clad, too, and almost invisible in the bewildering reaches of the forest.
They had strolled a long way into the mirrory
labyrinth before a sliding motion among the trees caught Quanna's eye. She had
been sure he would come alone, and she could see now that she had not been
mistaken. She had been sure, too, that he would not use a gun. He wanted Jamie
dead for many reasons. The chiefest was to forestall Vastari of the glory of
that murder, and Ystri would want to use the long Venusian dagger for that
pleasure. And so he would have to creep close enough to stab Jamie in the back,
and there was no danger of a random shot across the water.
But
Ystri was wary. Jamie had an evil reputation among the outlaws and Ystri was
not one to risk having this particular quarry turn to face him before his blow
drove home. Quanna had to lead the way deeper and deeper into the forest, where
the great mangrove roots made paths broad enough so that no reflections showed
in the water, before the green moving shadow that was Ystri drew near.
If
Quanna's heart was beating harder under her emerald robe, no hint of it showed
in her face when she decided the time was near to do what must be done.
2l6 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"I've a surprise for you, Jamie
dear," she said, pausing to face him under a great vaulting arch of green.
"Will you wait for me a moment
here? I'll be back in five minutes." And then, because the danger was near
and great just then, she tiptoed and took his dark face between her hands and
kissed him quickly on the mouth.
Venusians
are not demonstrative people. Jamie stared after her as she turned swiftly
away, the green robe swirling. Her long, dark look and the unexpected kiss had
carried an air of foreboding that made him loosen the gun in his belt and watch
the forest around him with vague uneasiness, for no tangible reason. And that
result, perhaps, Quanna had foreseen, too, when she kissed him. There are double
motives behind most of the things Venusians do.
Quanna
went swiftly, on soundless feet, along a pathway
that twisted out of sight. Her green reflection went with her in the water,
smooth and stealthy. She was making a circle as directly as possible in these
winding ways, and in a few moments she saw ahead of her another green and
stealthy figure moving forward from tree to tree. Quanna smiled.
Jamie had lighted a cigarette. In the glassy stillness the click of his lighter was audible
from far away, and the pungency of the smoke spread through the heavy
fragrances of the water jungle. She could see his dark head down an aisle of
greenness; he had set his back to a tree
and was smoking desultorily, flicking ashes into the water and watching the
spreading circles that they made.
Ahead
of her the green shadow of Ystri slipped forward with a sudden rush, quick and deadly. A knife caught the light and glinted.
Quanna
covered the distance at a soft-footed run which the moss hushed. Her green
cloak unfolded like a hover of wings behind her and the flash from beneath it
rose an instant before the glimmer of steel in Ystri's fist rose.
There
is no sound quite like the solid thud of a dagger driven hilt-deep into flesh,
hard, with a full-armed swing. Jamie knew it from all other sounds and had spun
with his gun in his hand before Ystri himself knew quite what had happened to
him. Ystri must at first have felt only the heaviness of the blow which even
from behind was hard enough to knock the breath from his lungs. He gasped once
for air, and whirled to face Quanna, open-mouthed.
His
face contorted with fury when he realized what had happened and his second gasp
was for the breath to betray her, but she had struck
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 11J
deftly
and a gush of bright blood, startlingly bright, smothered the words on his
lips.
There
was no need for explanations. Jamie holstered his gun slowly, seeing that he
would not need it. Quanna's expressionless eyes watched Ystri fall, the glare
of fury in his eyes to the last as he mouthed futilely against the torrent of
blood frothing over the apricot velvet tunic which his green robe fell back to
reveal. There were old bloodstains there, too. It was the same tunic he had
worn in the cavern. She thought briefly that the blood-letting which her
brother had begun two days ago the sister had finished here.
Jamie
was staring at her questioningly over the body. It lay with one arm dragging in
the water; Quanna put out her foot and rolled it over without emotion. It slid
into the water with scarcely a splash and the mirrory surface closed over the
brilliant colors of apricot and green, bright fresh scarlet and the brown of
old blood. Above the spreading circles Quanna looked up to Jamie and smiled.
"I have saved your
life, Jamie," she said.
He bit his lip. Lives are not saved
gratuitously on Venus. It is a matter of investment, done deliberately with a
specific price in mind, and among Venusians if the price is refused the life is
forfeit, then and there or at any time thereafter, without penalty of a
blood-feud from the victim's relatives. This relentless code is as near,
perhaps, as Venusians come to maintaining an abstract ideal about anything at
all.
"I
suppose there's no use asking what's behind all this," said Jamie, nodding
at the water which had closed over Ystri's body.
Quanna lifted a brow. "Oh, that. I saw
him—I had a favor to ask of you. Is there a better way to buy it than
this?"
He
knew he would never be told any more of the story than that. No use asking. He
lifted his shoulders resignedly.
"You saved my
life," he acknowledged. "What to you want?"
"To
go back to Earth with you," she told him promptly. "You'll take me,
Jamie?"
He squinted a curious glance at her. She
might have asked for money, weapons, anything but an intangible like this. An
intangible he could not give her.
"Quanna," he said gently,
"don't you think I'd take you if I could?"
"You are commander.
What can stop you?"
"Look,
dear." He stepped forward over the bloodstains on the moss and laid his
hands on her shoulders. "Earth's a ...
an armed
218 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
camp.
No one's safe there now. You never saw cities bombed—you can't imagine the life
you'd have to lead if you came back with me."
"I'm not a child,
Jamie." She lifted unfathomable dark eyes to his.
"I
know—I know" He tried helplessly to make her understand. "But I'm not
going home for pleasure, Quanna. I'm going to fight. I think we'll have to go
on fighting there as long as ... as
long as we can. If I took you along, you'd be in constant danger. There'd be
forced march after forced march, front-line duty—life under siege at the very
best. And at worst—without me, what would become of you?"
"I'm willing to risk
all that, Jamie dear"
He
let his hands fall. "I can't, Quanna. Even if I could let you risk it, I'm
not free to handicap myself with a woman. I'm going home to fight, my dear.
Don't you understand? Earth is calling us back because of desperate need. I'm
a soldier of the Imperial Planet—I have no right to divide my efficiency in
half because I've a woman to look out for everywhere I go—"
"But
why must you go at all, Jamie?" She said it very gently. "What can
one man mean among so many? Why not stay here on Venus, with me?"
His black brows met above the crooked nose.
"If
I could make you understand that, my dear," he said wryly, "I
wouldn't half so much mind going."
And
so it went on, for a long while. To Quanna the words that Jamie used were often
as meaningless as the modves behind them. She wondered afterward that she had
not used the dagger which tradition gave her the right to use, upon this dark
and stubborn Terrestrial who was so intent upon destroying her happiness and
his own.
Long
and hotly they debated, standing over the bloodstain on the moss with the
forest glassily quivering all around them. When they turned home at last along
the reflecting pathways, Quanna went submissively, her hooded head bent at the
angle suitable to a Venusian woman in the presence of her lord, but she had not
surrendered.
She
would have to change her plan; that was all. If he would not take her of his free
will, then she would force him to it. She would find some lever stronger than
the one which had just failed her. For he knew and she knew that she would not
take the life she had saved. She had not killed Ystri for that.
Yes, she would find a lever, and she would
have no mercy in her
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 2IO,
use
of it, for it would take some intolerable force indeed to swerve Jamie from his
course.
When
the blue twilight was deepest over Darva and the Terres-trialized city slept,
Quanna went up the winding stair which led to the roof of the commander's
quarters. It was the dark of the cloud-flow, but she carried no light.
Artificial lighting is rare on Venus, which never knows true darkness on
Dayside. Quanna moved unerringly through the blue gloom upon the roof.
She
carried a sheaf of slender, hollow rods under her arm, and in one hand a basket
of decaying flowers. The heavy, noxiously sweet fragrance of their dissolution
is irresistible to several species of Venus' flying creatures, most of them poisonous.
Quanna
jointed her hollow rods together until she had a long, slender pole, about
whose upper end she twined garlands of the heavy-smelling, rotting blossoms,
working deftly in the near-darkness. Darva was hushed below her. From the
mountains behind her to the mountains before blew the fragrances of jungle
canyons; and the rumble of rock-slides thundered from far away.
Darva was built like a medieval fortress, a
walled plateau guarded by crenelated mural towers at regular intervals all
around the city. The commander's quarters were built into the upper end of the
wall, one with it, so that the roof upon which Quanna stood looked down sheerly
over wall and plateau edge, toward the tremendous blue mountains beyond the
river. She had taken refuge in a battlement and was waving her long,
flower-twined pole in slow circles.
In
an incredibly short time a whir of wings sounded in the deep, blue twilight and
a night-flying shape swept out of the dimness toward the pole. Quanna braced
herself against the battlement and continued to fish the air streams blowing
toward the cliffs. More wings—more swooping, dim shapes out of the twilight as
the cruising nocturnal creatures of the mountains began to catch that
intoxicating odor on the wind. Presently she was the center of a whirling,
dipping swarm of silent things, all making circles around the decayed flowers
like moths around a light, all in the uttermost silence except for the beat of
wings.
When she saw what she wanted, she lowered the
pole until the flowery tip was within reach, and she put out an intrepid hand
into the midst of the hovering creatures and seized a dark, winged horror by
the neck. It beat at her furiously with scaled pinions a yard long,
220 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
and
its thick, muscular, serpent body lashed at her face. Composedly— she had
handled the winged snakes since childhood—she put down the pole and went deftly
to work over the threshing thing whose great blue-6caled wings winnowed the air. The blue, reptilian
body wound and rewound about her forearms and venomous hissing punctuated the
wing beats. Quanna paid no attention. Deadly poison though the winged snakes
are, they can be safely handled by those who know how. This one bore a small,
pale brand on its flat head as token that it had been handled before.
When Quanna tossed it into the air a moment
later it shook outraged wings, dived at her once or twice with fierce hissings, and then hurled itself once more into the group still circling
about the rotted blossoms on the pole.
Quanna
went forward confidently, hesitated a moment, then reached out to seize another
of the circling things out of the flutter and confusion around the flowers.
This one she stroked with long, rhythmic motions until its scaled and writhing
body quieted in hypnotized inertia and the great wings folded into stillness.
She wrapped a scarf around them and then went forward to beat off the rest of
the swarm and cover the flowers with her cloak.
In a few minutes, when the sick-sweet
fragrance had dissipated upon the air, the noxious flying coven of poison
things began to disband, great, dark shapes sailing and swooping out in
widening circles until the blueness of the twilight swallowed them. Quanna smoothed
her disheveled hair and began to dismantle her fishing rod.
She
knew that when light began to broaden again over the mountains the branded
flying snake she had released would return to its home in the cliff above the
hidden fortress where she had been born. It would not be long before Vastari
had the message she had bound beneath its blue-scaled wing.
And
then—if Vastari trusted her enough—a certain species of hell would be unleashed
upon the citadel which Jamie Douglas still held for Imperial Earth.
When the alarm sirens exploded into sudden,
brazen wailing over Darva one twilight two days later, Quanna knew that Vastari
still trusted her. She stood by Jamie's mirror, watching him buckle on the
cuirass without which no one dared walk the battlements when Venu-sian spearmen
were below, and her dark gaze was somber.
Jamie, ducking into the breast-armor, was as
excited as she could
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 221
remember
seeing him. A Venusian attack was always exciting; the rippling drums and the
shrill, high keening of the seven-toned pipes get into the listeners' blood and
quicken the heartbeats in time with that wild, tuneless rhythm. Venusians do
not shout in battle. The pipes and drums are the only sounds of attack, clear,
inhuman music as if not men but something wild and rhythmic were attacking the
city.
"Damned
fools," declared Jamie, struggling with the straps of his cuirass.
"Here, help me, Quanna. Attacking with spears and slings— must be something
behind this. Recognize any of 'em Quanna? Is Vastari there? Lord, I'd like to
see him over a Knute before I go!"
Her eyes veiled. "You
hate him, Jamie?"
"Hate?" He paused to look at her,
smiling a little grimly. "Well, hardly that. He's a symbol, Quanna—a
symbol of barbarism. If I could see him dead before I go, I'd be sure of one
enemy less against Venusian civilization. Him and his babble about
freedom!" Jamie snorted. "There might be safety a little longer for
the people we leave behind if Vastari should die this evening. Well—" He shrugged and swung away. Quanna
followed him smoothly, her satin skirts whispering along the floor as she
walked.
They
stepped out into the cool evening light, into a subdued, hushed murmur of
activity. Except for the shrill, inhuman rhythm of the music outside, even
battle, on Venus, was—hushed. And the music was dying now as the attackers went
grimly into action.
Lieutenant
Morgan was waiting by the Armory door, a file of armed Earthmen with him. The
great, solid block of the Armory, and the lower walls of Darva, were the work
of Earthmen's hands only and their secrets known only to Terrestrials. The
Armory—heart and brain of Earth domination—was unlocked only in the presence of
the commanding officer, and it was not unlocked with keys. There was no chance
that Venusians might gain access to this vital ganglion of defense, or Quanna
would not have resorted to this last dangerous expedient of inviting attack
that the Armory be opened to her.
There
was no hope even of tricking the guarded combination of the door out of the few
officers who knew it, for strictly speaking, it was unknown even to them. The
elaborate precautions that guarded that secret were eloquent of its importance.
It had been implanted in the subconscious minds of a very few Terrestrials
while under the influence of neo-curare.
Morgan had just finished making a hypodermic
injection into the
222 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
arm of one of his men as Quanna and Jamie
came up. Neo-curare, dulling the conscious mind, releasing the subconscious—
"Ready?" asked Jamie crisply.
Morgan
glanced at his watch. "Ready, sir." He slid aside a tiny panel in the
door, uncovering a dial. The hands of the drugged soldier hid it; his dulled
eyes did not change, but his fingers began to move as Morgan said: "Armory
combination." This was the effective lock that guarded Earth weapons, the
lock for which no key could be stolen.
Even if Vastari could have kidnaped one of
the key men, neither he nor any Venusian knew the ingredients of the drug or
the proper dosage to administer. Yes—an effective lock. But not wholly proof
against traitors, Quanna told herself as she watched the weapons being brought
out with rapid efficiency.
One
of the Knute vibrators was being taken out of the Armory now. It looked like a
thick, closed umbrella. The crew of four—three to operate, one to aim—handled
the yard-long device with the carelessness born of long practice. Quanna had
watched that practice more than once, from hiding places that only Venusians
knew.
The
Knute vibrator was a device attuned to the delicate vibrations of the brain, a
wave-thrower that could disrupt the molecules of the mind, causing a mental
explosion that resulted in death. Quanna had learned the simple devices that
operated it during her first weeks in Darva. More important, she had learned of
the safety device, the vitally significant Gilson inert fuse. Eavesdropping in
the violet twilight one evening she had heard Lieutenant Morgan excoriate a
crew for testing the vibrator with the inert fuse in place.
"It's
the difference between bullets and blanks," his angry voice had floated up
to her out of the practice yard. "Once you put the Gilson in, you've got
dynamite in your hands." There had been much more, and Quanna remembered
it faithfully.
Without the inert fuse, the Knute vibrator
was not deadly. It threw off a vibration that had the same effect as inaudible
sound, causing reasonless confusion and terror in its victims. Dangerous wild
beasts could be driven off by its use, or killed with the Gilson inert fuse in
place.
Quanna
followed the crew that carried a Knute to the wall. They wore the usual outfit
of wall defenders, metal cuirasses, helmets, face masks with heavily glassed
goggles swinging at their belts.
there shall be
darkness 223
"There is dust on your lenses, men/* she
said, pointing to the nearest mask.
The
soldiers grinned down at her, a little flattered by the notice that she usually
reserved entirely for the commander. Quanna reached for a mask and polished the
eyepieces with a corner of the rainbow scarf that veiled her hair.
"You
may need to see clearly soon/' she told them with a serene upward glance.
"Let me have your mask, soldier. . . . Thank you,"
Afterward
she fell back and watched the men move up to the bat-tlemented tower top and
unfold the vibrator. She was not smiling; it had been easy enough, but she did
not feel like smiling this evening. The masks were well rubbed now with a
secretion from certain spider-like insects of the high mountains. Like some
Terrestrial creatures, the arachnid paralyzes its victims so that its larvae
can feed at leisure. It is the fumes that paralyze, and they would work swiftly
after the men had donned their masks and body-heat released the poison for the
mucous eye membrane to absorb.
After that, paralysis, instant and effective.
But paralysis of the body, not the brain. Because of that, Quanna knew that her
hours in Darva were numbered.
She paused for a moment in the door of the
commander's quarters to look back over Darva, which she might never see again.
The walled city was in a hum of ordered activity as guns were rushed to the
walls and defenders to positions in the mural towers. And always, she saw, it
was Terrestrials who did the ordering, Venusians who scurried obediently into
place. She could picture what Darva would look like in the first attack after the
Earthmen left. Terror, confusion, inefficiency. She was not sure even in her
own mind if she were glad for Vastari's sake or sorry for Jamie's that this
should be so.
But there was no time now for loitering. She
went in swiftly, moving on silent feet through the hurried confusion of
indoors. There was a certain tapestry-hung angle of a hallway in which she
paused while two servants hurried downstairs; then her fingers were flattening
against the smooth surface behind the tapestry and a panel slid open without a
sound. The Earthmen might suspect, but they could not know of the hidden
passages which Venusian masons had built in Darva.
She went upward in darkness, even her
cat-vision almost blind here. Halfway up she paused to find a long,
scarf-wrapped bundle in a
224 JOURNEY
TO INFINITY
cubbyhole.
The bundle squirmed faintly, giving off the musk scent of all night-flying
things on Venus, where no definite evolutionary cleavage has ever been made
between reptile and bird.
At
the head of the dark stairs she found another panel, and a little slit of light
widened in the wall. Blue twilight poured through, and the vague sounds of
Venusian battle. She could hear the heart-quickening beat of the tripping
drums below, the keening of the seven-toned pipes where Vastari's men were
making a desperate effort to scale the walls before the Earthmen's invincible
weapons could be turned upon them.
Quanna looked out on the turret where the
Knute vibrator was being set up. From here it could rake the base of the walls
with crossfire. The crew had not yet donned their masks, she saw. They were
unfolding the umbrellalike weapon, till on a high tripod of meshed wires stood
a conical torpedo of glass, mounted on a universal joint. From equidistant
points at the base of the tripod wires led out to control boxes, each with a
red push button.
"The
Gilson," said one of the men, and was handed the inert fuse, a short,
pencillike rod. Quanna watched him slip it into place. "Power."
A red button was pushed. The mesh base of the
Knute began to quiver—but only one section of it. Slowly the wavelike motion
spread out, till the whole section was shimmering like a veil.
"Now!"
The
next man pushed his button. The shimmer crawled on to his section. Then the
third—
Quanna
noticed that whenever one of the panels slowed in its rippling dance, the
guardian of that section pressed his button again, replenishing the power. The
three men bent over their tasks. The fourth handled the aiming of the
projector.
It
was not difficult. Quanna could not see its effect from her position, but she
read the faces of the men, and heard the shouts of Venu-sians from below the
tower. A spear clattered against the battlement.
"Masks,"
one of the men said, and slipped his into place. The others obeyed. Quanna
hugged the vaguely squirming bundle under her arm and waited tensely.
She
did not have a long wait. At the end of it she stepped out onto the tower top,
walking delicately among the inert but conscious men, lying awkwardly in the
attitudes in which they had fallen, unable to stir or speak. They watched her
with wide, glassy eyes.
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 225
She
waited for the vibrations of the Knute to subside. The arms folded up into
place easily enough and the device was not heavy to lift. As serenely as if the
shocked and horrified men were not watching, she unwrapped her scarf from the
great, scaled wings and serpent body of the flying creature she had captured
several twilights ago. A harness was already buckled around it; she fastened
the Knute into place as quickly as she could, for by now the silencing of this
tower's defense must already have been noticed.
She
tossed the freed serpent thing into the air. It hissed furiously and beat its
broad, iridescent wings against the weight of the thing lashed to it. It would
not fly far with that drag upon it, but there was no need of gaining distance
now. Heedless of arrows, she leaned over the parapet to watch what happened.
Shouts
rang out from below and from the wall defenders. Both sides had seen it now.
Quanna held her breath. The flying snake was stronger than she had thought. It
was carrying its burden out over the heads of the attackers, sinking slowly,
but forging grimly ahead. Now it was clear of the last tower—and it was
fluttering, confused falling. Another Knute had been focused upon it, she
realized.
It
dropped. A rush of Venusians, heedless of danger from above, closed over the
threshing, scaly wings, hiding them from view. The pipes suddenly shrilled high
and triumphantly. Quanna let her breath out in a long sigh.
Then
Jamie's voice, clear and resonant, shouted: "They've got a Knute I Open
the gates—"
She
flattened herself to the wall, straining to see the little troop of Earthmen
charging outward in a wedge toward the precious weapon. Quanna heard footsteps
hurrying up the stairway toward her, but she did not move. Would Vastari obey?
With this chance of killing Jamie—would he remember the surer plan and escape
with the deadly vibrator?
No—not deadly. But Vastari would not know that.
He would not guess the purpose of the Gilson inert fuse, or that Quanna had removed
the little tube and hidden it. But as for Jamie—fighting forward toward the
Knute—
A swarm of Venusians closed in between the
Terrestrial wedge and the vibrator. She could not see clearly what was
happening, and the footsteps were very close behind her now. She gave one last,
despairing glance over the parapet and whirled toward her panel. The paralyzed
Earthmen watched her go.
226 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
She was leaving few secrets behind her, she
reflected as she hurried down the dark steps inside. When the gun crew
recovered— But this had been the only way. And she must remain hidden now in
some other of the secret places in the walls until she could escape after the
gates were opened. It was a risky thing to trust Vastari with the weapon, but
not even in peace time could she have walked out of Darva carrying a Knute;
nor, of course, could she have captured the weapon except in the confusion and
emergency of attack.
And
this was only the beginning of the elaborate and cruel plan she had laid
against Jamie. She should be thinking of that now, but she was not. She was
seeing the battlefield as she had last glimpsed it, Jamie's bare, dark head
forging forward among the attackers, and the pipes shrilling triumph. Briefly
she remembered Jamie's ominous dream.
The rumble of a far-away landslide made slow
thunder through the streets of Darva as Jamie stood in the door of his
quarters, drawing on his gloves and watching the last Terrestrials upon Venus
form into marching order down the street. He did not look up at the high blue
mountains or out over the familiar roofs and terraces below. He would remember
Darva, he knew, with an aching sort of memory that would last as long as he
did. But he was not letting himself think at all. He was glad of Ghej beside
him, to keep his mind turned outward.
"Sure
you won't join us?" he asked for the last time, and again received the
beaky smile and the headshake with which the old Martian had answered that
question before.
"No,
I'll stay. The Solar System isn't too good a place to live in these days, but I
think Venus will be the least turbulent in our lifetime. It's the last refuge
from the barbarians, anyhow. I don't expect them on Venus yet awhile, perhaps
not during my life span—but they'll come, commander. They'll come." He
pressed his lips together and squinted under his triangular, horny lids as if
into a future he did not like at all. After a moment he shrugged. "No,
I'll stay. I'm adjusted here well enough." He touched the small gun that
showed at his belt when the gray robe swung back. "They respect me
here."
Jamie
smiled. He knew the old Martian was unexpectedly swift and accurate with that
small weapon.
"You'll
get along," he acknowledged, and then hesitated over a question he had to
ask and dreaded. "Do you • . . have you— About Quanna, I mean—"
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 227
Ghej
nodded. "Once I've seen her. In Vastari's camp. She's very unhappy,
commander. Venusians seldom show emotion, but I know, I think you haven't seen
the last of Quanna."
Jamie's
black brows met. "Lord, I hope I have! Though even now, I can't quite
believe she'd—" He let the
sentence die. "I wish I could get my hands on Vastari before I
leave!"
"Other
leaders would rise in his place," Ghej shrugged. "What Venus really
needs is—oh some common trouble to draw them all together. Here at the end, it
just occurs to me that if the Terrestrials had really oppressed Venusians, it
might have been the salvation of the race." He smiled dryly. "Too
late now."
A horn sounded in the
street below them. It was time to go.
The
calm-faced Home Guard watched them marching away. There was a wild, curiously
sad tempo to the music of the seven-toned pipes which played them out of Darva.
Jamie saw the first shadow of decay even before they reached the gate. For the
Home Guard, today, was not the fine line of soldiers he had reviewed last week.
Nothing blatant, of course—just a tunic loosened at the throat, a helmet askew
here, an unpolished buckle there, boots with dust on the toes— He looked away.
Another
distant rockslide shook its low thunder through the air as they reached the
gate. Jamie thought fancifully that the familiar, slow rumble was like the
sound of the crumbling Solar Empire which was letting go its last world colony
today. Behind them the wild, sad skirl of piping died away. Before them the
road wound up through foothills toward the pass. And so the last legion rode
out of Darva, not looking back.
Jamie
thought they would all hear that skirling music until they died, and the long,
low rumble of sliding rocks above peaceful Darva, and see the high blue
mountains whenever they closed their eyes. These last Terrestrials had been a
long dme on Venus now.
There
was decadence even in the marching of the Earthmen out of Darva, for a space
port had once kept the city in touch with the outside worlds. It closed a year
ago, when they moved the Seventeenth over nearer Darkside and the cost of the
port became prohibitive. And so the last Terrestrial Patrol left Venus afoot,
its officers mounted on padding horses, by a slow trade trail through the
mountains over which Earth's ships had once glided on sleek wings.
Civilization
had overreached itself in so many ways, thought Jamie. When the planes began to
fail for lack of material from home, they
228 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
had
realized one serious gap, too late to bridge now. They had never needed surface
transportation when the air was theirs, and now that the ships had failed—well,
they tramped the roads as if their race had never mastered the drive of wheels.
Jamie
was thinking inevitably of Quanna as they mounted the steep trail. He knew that
one stolen Knute would not be enough to sadsfy Vastari; there would be ambush
somewhere along the way to the spaceport. He had come to personify in Vastari
now all the qualities about Venus that irritated him most, and Quanna's
shocking defection—he could scarcely believe even now that she had done what
she had done—he, somehow, blamed Vastari, too, with the unreason of the
subconscious. There was much he could not understand even yet; he was not sure
he hoped more to see her or not to see her again before they left Venus.
The
sheer, turquoise heights of the mountains were leaning above them now. They
could look down, as they marched, over cloud-veiled distances at Darva showing
and vanishing and showing again through gaps, each time farther away, smaller,
more like a memory that recedes as time goes on.
Bright
reptiles squirmed from their path, scaled, flying things swept more noiselessly
than owls from their high nests as the Earth-men passed. The sound of falling
water was all around them, and the low, shaking thunder of distant landslides.
It
was a long journey over the mountain route toward the port. Somewhere along the
way, Vastari must certainly strike in a last, desperate effort to take their
weapons for himself. But, in spite of the difficulty and danger of the journey,
Jamie thought none of them was wholly sorry that it was long. They were, for
the last few days of their lives, alone in a high, blue world of turquoise rock
beneath the slow surge of the cloud-tide, and all of them knew they were
spending their last days on a world they loved and would not see again.
For
none of them had any illusions about the world they were returning to. The
barbarians of the outer worlds were, thought Jamie ruefully, the last plague
that Earthmen would have to suffer, a latter-day Black Death which neither
Earth civilization nor Earthmen would survive.
Suspense tightened as they drew nearer and
nearer the end of their journey, and still Vastari had not struck. Jamie had
fantastic dreams in which he thought Quanna had killed her brother to save the
Earth-men, but his rational mind knew better. That she had had more than
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 229
one
motive in stealing the Knute he was sure, but he did not expect to feel
pleasure when he learned what it was.
Darva
was far behind. Each day that passed drove it farther and farther into memory.
They all gave themselves up to the timeless present, knowing that each
succeeding moment of peace might be the last. And still Vastari delayed.
There
is a valley in the peaks a few hours this side of Port City. Countless tortuous
ravines run up from its floor through the steep cliffs around. Earthmen did a
little mining there in the old days, but nothing remains today except the great
scars upon the cliff faces and the long, dark blasts the rocketships left—marks
upon Venus that will far outlast the race that made them.
It
was so obvious a place for ambush that Jamie had been fairly sure Vastari would
not use it. That was probably one of the devious reasons behind the fact that
he did.
Jamie, riding at the head of the column, eyed
the labyrinth of ravines around him with wary eyes as they entered the valley.
The ravines looked curiously confusing. There was a shimmer over the whole
valley that reminded him suddenly of Mars. If he had not known himself on
Venus, he would have thought that heat waves were dancing between the
honeycombed walls of the valley.
Then
the shimmer began to spread, and a violet blindness closed softly across
Jamie's eyes; the sound of falling water from the peaks faded into a ringing
silence, and the valley was full of terror and confusion. Little mindless
horrors chased one another like ripples across his consciousness.
This was it. Even knowing that, it was
incredibly hard to shout across his shoulder: "Knute helmets!" and
fumble at his saddle for the limp pack of his own. The horse was beginning to
shiver under him, though the Knute vibrations were still too high to do more
than touch its animal brain. But for Jamie there was terror in everything, even
in the feel of the helmet he was shaking out of its pack. He had to grind his
teeth together to get the courage to pull it down over his head—he had the
dreadful certainty that it would smother him when he did.
The soft, metallic cloth went on smoothly,
its woven coils hugging his skull. There was a moment more of blindness and the
unpleasant ringing silence that might be hiding all sorts of terrible sounds.
Then something like a warmth in the very brain began to ooze inward from the
helmet, and the world came back into focus.
23O JOURNEY TO INFINITY
His first conscious thought after that, as he
tried to quiet his uneasy horse, was that the Knute had not been turned to
killing power— yet. The helmets were protection against the lesser power of the
vibrator, but they would not hold out long when the Gilson fuse turned the
Knute into a death weapon. Before that happened they would have to find and
silence it.
He swung his excited horse around, shouting
commands in a voice that echoed thinly in his own ears through the helmet,
knowing that though it would be a matter of moments to locate the source of the
vibrations, storming it up these twisting ravines in the face of what might at
any moment become deadly waves would be quite another matter.
Everything still shimmered a little—the
hills, the waterfalls, the face of Morgan hurrying up to give him the location
of the Knute.
"That
ravine, sir," he said, squinting over his lifted arm. "Between the
waterfalls, see?" His voice was thin and quivering through the helmet.
There was a strangely dreamlike air to the whole scene, as there always was
under the fire of a Knute. Everything seemed so unreal that it was hard to
bring his mind seriously to bear upon the problem of attack.
It was probably in a dream that Jamie thought
he saw Quanna come down the slanting valley, picking her way with delicate
steps and holding her familiar green velvet cloak up to clear her scarlet
shoes. She was carrying a white scarf like a flag.
Unexpectedly
the rainbow shimmering of the Knute began to fade. The illusion of unreality
trembled a moment longer over the valley and was gone, and Jamie blinked to see
the illusion of Quanna still there, looking up at him diffidently under her
emerald hood and holding the white scarf up like a banner.
He
kicked his horse into a trot and went forward a litde way to meet her, not at
all sure what he would say when he did. He could feel Morgan's eyes on his back
and was angrier at her just now for making him a fool before Morgan than for
anything she had done before.
He reined in silently and sat looking down at
her without a word. His black-browed scowl was forbidding. Quanna put all the
delicate submissiveness she could summon into her voice. She was twisting the
improvised white flag between her hands with a nervousness that might or might
not be assumed.
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 231
"Lord, will you hear a
message from Vastari?"
Her
voice was very sweet. There had been a time when Jamie might have softened to
hear it; lethargy was all that possessed him now. He said nothing, only nodded
shortly.
"I
have persuaded Vastari," she said, "that because I saved your life
once and still hold an unfulfilled promise from you, and because you have had a
warning already from the Knute, you will put down all your weapons if Vastari
lets you go free to the spaceport."
Jamie
laughed harshly. "How far do you think I trust Vastari— or you?"
"He could kill you," she reminded
him in her sweet, reflective voice. "You and most of your men. The Knute
is too well hidden to find soon, and too well barricaded to take in time, even
if you found it. I know how weak the helmets are against the killing strength
of the Knute. No, you must bargain, Jamie dear. But not with Vastari." She
came forward with a lovely, swaying motion to lay both narrow pale hands upon
his knee, tilting up her face.
"I
can't let you go without me, Jamie dear." Her voice quivered as musically
as a harp string. "This is the only way I know to make you listen. Jamie,
if you take me back to Earth with you, I can save you from Vastari. No,
listen!" Her fingers clasped his knee as she saw anger darken the face
above her. "Listen, Jamie! If you won't listen for your own sake, remember
your men. Earth needs them, Jamie— you've told me about that! Let me go back to
Vastari and say you'll give your weapons up—at the spaceport! I can make him
believe that. Let me ride with you. When we reach Port City—"
"What's
to prevent him killing us then?" demanded Jamie, his voice harsh. "He
won't let us out of range, for all your lies."
"Oh,
Jamie, believe me! Would I risk your life now, when I've saved it? I can
control Vastari—lean! But I can't tell you how. Jamie, I'll ride with you . . .
would I do that if there was any danger? Jamie . . . I . . . I—"
Her
face and her voice both quivered suddenly. He saw her lift her hands to her
eyes and a look of terror and confusion went over her features. The whole
valley began to swim again in a rainbow shimmer, and sound and sight distorted
faindy even with the helmet's protection. Vastari had turned the Knute on—on
Quanna and the Earth-men.
Bewilderment made Jamie's mind blank for a
moment. Why
232 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
would
even Vastari risk so safe a bargain as he thought his sister was making,
sacrifice her wantonly with the Earthmen for no reason at all? For no reason—
Then
he saw his own men moving to the left against the swaying backdrop of the
waterfalls that flanked Vastari's ravine, heard the shouts of their officers,
and knew that someone had blundered inexcusably. Morgan? Morgan who distrusted
Quanna and the commander's weakness, and had taken fatal advantage of the
delay to attempt storming the Knute up the ravine?
Jamie
had no way of knowing, and in spite of himself he was suddenly and savagely
glad that Morgan had done it—if he had. The weight was off Jamie now—he had no
impossible decision to make— whether to trust Quanna, whether to risk his men,
whether to surrender to her pleading as he wanted to do and dared not.
He
spurred his resdve horse and swung violently around to the ravine, shouting to
her over his shoulder: 'Til make my own bargain with Vastari I"
Quanna reeled back in a shower of sand from
the padded hoofs, screaming above the shouts of the charging soldiers:
"Jamie . . . Jamie, wait! He can't hurt you, Jamie! The Gilson—I have it!
Jamie, Jamie, you'll be killed!"
But if he heard any of that illogical cry he
did not believe or heed it. The soft thudding of hoof-beats in sand, and
Jamie's shouts mingling with the voices of his men, were all that came back to
her. She stood staring as the last Terrestrial Patrol on Venus made its last
sortie into the mountains in pursuit of outlaw natives.
The
range of the Knute followed them. Her own terror and confusion faded as the
vibrations died around her, but they did not fade entirely. She watched until
the last man vanished up the ravine between the waterfalls. Then, for lack of
anything else to do, she began to brush the sand from her cloak with long,
unconscious motions.
If
Venusians were given to tears, Quanna would have wept then. It had all gone so
well up to this vital point. The plan itself had been simple enough—to give
Vastari the emasculated Knute and let him ambush the Terrestrials, thinking he
could kill them with the vibrations when he chose. Vastari had not wanted to
bargain with the Earthmen, but she had convinced him of that necessity, too, in
the end. And she had been sure Jamie would surrender. She had seen it in his
face, deep down, under the anger and distrust—because he must take his men back
to Earth. He could not throw their lives away here for
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 233
an
ideal, and he had known he must surrender in the end, even if it meant lies and
a broken bargain at the spaceport.
Neither
he nor Vastari, of course, had guessed that the Knute was harmless to kill. She
had not trusted Vastari that far, and she had been right indeed. Anger shook
her briefly out of her lethargy. Vastari had been ready to sacrifice her,
then—if he must—her usefulness was ended now. He had no way of knowing that
under her robe she was clutching the Gilson fuse which made his weapon only a
dangerous toy.
She smiled a thin, malicious smile even in
the midst of her anxiety over Jamie. Vastari must be an astonished man just
now. His deadly weapon powerless, enemies charging up the ravine, his men
scattering before the gunfire of the Terrestrials—Vastari would be retreating
already. With the Knute or without it. The Venusians would not stand long
against Earthmen suddenly and uncannily impervious to the supposedly deadly
vibrations of the Knute,
But it might be long enough to ruin all that
Quanna had planned for. It might be long enough for an arrow or a spear to find
a chink of Jamie's cuirass. Vastari's men were such excellent spearmen—
And she could do nothing
now but wait.
Faintly,
far up among the twisting ravines, the noises of battle reached a climax and
wore themselves out. Quanna sat down on a flat stone close beside one of the
waterfalls, hearing the thin threnody of its music above the diminishing sounds
from overhead.
She
did not hear the nearer padding of a horse's hoofs coming up the valley until
it was nearly upon her, and a harsh, hissing voice said:
"Quanna!"
There was a subtle excitement in the voice that was not wholly explicable.
She
looked up, startled almost—but not quite—out of her self-possession. Then she
cried: "Ghej! What . . . why—"
He
smiled. "So Vastari did attack here," he nodded, glancing about the
trampled valley floor where the Terrestrials had thrown off their packs for
fighting in the mountains. "I was almost sure he would. The old cave's so
near, for one thing. What happened?"
She
told him, keeping her voice level. He sat listening, his hands folded on the
saddlebow and his opaque, old eyes piercing under the horny lids. When she had
finished he nodded gravely.
"Yes—I
knew it would be something like that the day you stole the Knute. There had to
be something other than simple theft in what you did. So it was all a bluff,
eh? Well—" He slanted an upward
234 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
glance
toward the labyrinth of ravines above them, and then swung off his horse a
little stiffly. "I'll wait with you until—something happens."
"But
why did you come?" Quanna returned belatedly to her first questions.
Ghej shook his crested
head.
"Something's
happened—I can't tell you yet."
She
looked at him curiously from under her lashes, and saw now on the leathery, old
face the same repressed excitement she had heard in his voice. Excitement, and
something like dread. But she knew there was no use in questioning him.
She
did not move again until she heard voices and sliding footsteps up in the
ravine. Then she got up and stood quite still in her green cloak against the
thin, green veil of the waterfall, waiting.
By
twos and threes, carrying their wounded, the Terrestrials came straggling back
to the valley. Jamie was not among them.
He
was almost the last to return. He came very wearily, alone, one arm hanging in
the improvised sling of his unbuttoned tunic and the blood still dripping from
what was probably an arrow wound.
Quanna
took one involuntary step toward him and then stopped. Jamie looked at her
phlegmatically, saying nothing. She saw in his face that he had ceased to
believe or trust anything she might do, and he was clinging to the protection
his lethargy offered him.
Then he saw Ghej, and his
face came alive again.
"Ghej ? What's
happened? Did you change your mind? I—"
"Tell
me first how the battle went," Ghej suggested. "And let Quanna dress
your arm. Were the arrows poisoned, Quanna?"
"Some were," said
Quanna. "May I help you, Jamie? Please."
He
shrugged and sat down on the flat stone. "All right. Dressings in any of
the packs. There's one lying over there."
She
went humbly to get it. When she returned Jamie was talking in a tired monotone
to the Martian. He submitted to her swabbing and bandaging without notice except
for a caught breath now and then.
"They
got away, of course," he was saying. "With the Knute. Had it
barricaded up the ravine, but not well enough. Depending on the vibrations, I
suppose, but the damned fools didn't know about the inert fuse and couldn't
step it up beyond the first strength."
"I
know." Ghej nodded. "Quanna has just told me—she had the Gilson fuse
herself, commander."
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 235
Quanna
looked up over the bandage she was fastening and met Jamie's starded eyes, an
uncertain little smile on her lips.
"I
tried to tell you," she reminded him gently. "You see, I really
didn't mean to have you killed."
His black scowl at her was mostly
bewilderment now. "But you said ...
I thought . . . I'm sorry, Quanna. But I still don't understand why—"
"Don't
try now." She laid a cool hand on his cheek. "No fever yet? Then I
think there was no poison. You'll be able to ride on to Port City, Jamie dear.
What about me?"
He
frowned a little and took the hand in his. "Not yet, Quanna. Before I go
I've got one score to settle. I'm going to find Vastari and get back that Knute
if it's the last thing I ever do."
Surprisingly,
part of the unconscious tension that showed on Ghej's face suddenly relaxed.
"Of course!" he exclaimed. "Find Vastari! Commander, I think I
can lead you to him."
Quanna
and Jamie stared at the old Martian incredulously. He had been in the
confidence of both enemy camps for so long, and each side had come to trust so
thoroughly in his impartial neutrality— After a moment Jamie said:
"Did I understand you,
Ghej ?"
"I
want to lead you to Vastari," reiterated the Martian impatiently. "I
think I know where he's gone. Venusians always scatter after a rout and meet
again later at the leader's hiding place. Vastari will have gone to an old cave
near here where he used to play as a boy. He's used it before for a rallying
point. But he should be alone there now for an hour or more. I know the place
well—it's quite near here. I'll-"
"But,
Ghej," interrupted Jamie, "I'm going to kill him. Don't you
understand? I know Vastari's your friend."
"I'll lead you to
him," Ghej persisted stubbornly.
"Forgive
me," hesitated Jamie, "but I've had too much treachery lately—or
thought I had." He flashed a glance at Quanna. "You've never interfered
with either side in this business, Ghej. I don't—"
"There'll
be no treachery," Ghej promised him. "I swear that, commander. I'll
lead you, alone, to Vastari. I promise he'll be alone, too. I promise that no
Venusians will interfere on his behalf. I promise all that by the symbol of
old Mars"—and he sketched the ancient crook-sign in the air.
236 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
Jamie
pinched his lip and stared at the old man under black brows. There was
something elaborately wrong here. He had been aware of the subtle excitement in
Ghej's manner ever since they had met, and he knew the Martian was concealing
something important. If Ghej was suddenly forsaking Vastari, there was every
reason to expect that he might betray Jamie, too—
And
yet to meet Vastari face to face before he left Venus was worth a risk. And he
had never known a Martian to lie by the sacred crook-symbol of the old world.
Sudden recklessness made him shrug and say:
"111
risk it, Ghej. Only FU warn my men first. They'll be after me if I'm not back
soon. You must tell me where the cave is, Ghej, so they can follow if I don't
come back."
Ghej nodded. "I can
trust you in that."
Quanna's
eyes had been following the conversation from face to face. All this talk of
promises and trust seemed foolhardy, particularly with the stakes involved. She
was utterly bewildered by Ghej's sudden about-face after a life of neutrality,
but she could see clearly enough that there was some strong motive behind it.
All
this was unimportant. The heartbreaking thing was that she had failed. She had
played her last trick upon Jamie and lost the game. There was no longer any
lever she could use to force her way upon the ship that would take him back to
Earth, unless—unless—
And
then a sudden, blazing idea burst upon her, and she saw how simply and easily
she might have avoided all the strategies of the past and gained her one desire
by a means so simple it had never occurred to her. For once Vastari knew she
had deliberately betrayed him to Jamie, her life would not be safe upon Venus
and Jamie would be bound in duty to take her away with him. The simplicity of
it was beautiful. Only—there must be witnesses to her treachery, so that the
story would spread among Vastari's men. Or else Vastari himself must not die—
"Let
me go with you," she asked the two men softly, her mind already spinning
with devious plans. They gave her a look of doubtful scrutiny. "I won't
interfere," she promised. "I've no love for Vastari, after what he
tried to do to me in the valley. Please let me go." Her voice took on the
note of irresistible pleading sweetness that Jamie remembered well, and he
grinned suddenly. But before he could speak:
"Very well," said Ghej, after a
moment of hesitation. "It might
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 237
be
well to have you there." She knew by that he was fitting her into whatever
scheme was in his own mind. She lowered her lids demurely and thanked them
both.
Vastari's hiding place was a narrow cavern
high up in the scarred valley wall, its mouth veiled by green vines thickly
abloom with purple trumpet flowers. Ghej left his two companions behind an
outcropping and went in alone. The two waited in silence for his return, each
too deeply immersed in speculation to speak yet about what still had to be said
between them.
Jamie
was too much exulted by the prospect of meeting Vastari at last to think as
much as he should of Ghej's inexplicable conduct, or of his own weariness or
the pain of his wounded arm. He had never performed an execution before, but he
felt no scruple now about shooting down an unsuspecting man in cold blood. It
would not be a man he killed in the cavern—it would be Venusian anarchy itself.
It would mean a little longer peace for the people of Darva and Port City and
the other Terrestrial settlements of these mountains. Since he could not leave
the cities those weapons which Earth must have, he could at least remove the
organized menace which made the weapons necessary.
He
was having a daydream. He was thinking that perhaps with Vastari dead, no new
leader would rise soon— Perhaps the Terres-trialized cities inside their
fortifications would be proof against scattered raids; perhaps in the face of
necessity those skilled workmen who had labored under Terrestrial orders might
labor of their own volition to reproduce the weapons Earth used to furnish
them. Perhaps—
"CommanderI" It was Ghej's whisper from beyond
their shelter. "He's alone. He has the Knute with him. Follow me,
commander."
Belated
caution made Jamie hesitate for one last moment. There was still that look of
intense, suppressed excitement about the old Martian, and the undernote of
sadness in his voice that Jamie had never heard before. He had a sudden memory
of that dream of his, and the curious notion which had followed it that Ghej
was gray-cloaked Death reaching out its hand for him.
"HurryI"
Ghej was at the cave mouth, beckoning. Jamie shrugged off all his wisdom and
shouldered after him through the fragrant, purple-flowered curtain into the
cool dimness beyond. Ghej was just ahead of him, Quanna just behind.
238 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
The cavern was heavy with the fragrance of
trumpet flowers and tremulous with green light filtering through the leaves. A
man in a scarlet cloak sat dejectedly upon a ledge opposite them, cradling the
folded umbrella of the Knute across his knees.
Vastari
looked up, startled, as the three figures blocked light from the cave mouth. He
could not quite make out who the other two were against the brightness, and he
blinked for a moment, trusting Ghej from long experience and not greatly
alarmed.
Jamie slid sidewise to put himself out of
silhouette against the light, and his gun hand rose so that green light
glittered on the barrel.
"In
the name of the Imperial Planet," he said clearly, his voice hollow and
echoing between the walls, "I condemn you to death, Vastari."
Ghej, flattened to the wall halfway between
them, laughed suddenly and said: "No!" in the hissing Martian
syllable of negation. His hand came out from under his cloak with sorcerous
speed, and the gun in it was not for Vastari, but for Jamie.
The commander stared down
incredulously.
"Drop
your gun, commander!" said Ghej, jerking his own weapon ominously.
Jamie let his fingers loosen. He was too
bewildered for a moment even to speak as his gun thudded to the sand. He had
been half expecting something like this, but it didn't make sense. Vastari's
quick Venusian brain, trained in trickery, leaped to swifter understanding.
"Oh,
no you don't!" he cried, and was in midair before the words were finished.
His red cloak and fair hair streamed as he sprang straight at Ghej. A bright
grin of triumph lighted his face as his ringed hand clawed at the Martian's
gun.
Ghej
stepped sidewise half a pace and his other hand flashed out from beneath his
cloak, moving almost too quickly for the eye to see that a small Venusian
blackjack swung in his fist. It struck Vastari an accurately glancing blow.
The
scarlet figure plunged past Ghej and sprawled upon the sandy floor. Across it
Ghej's gun rose to fix Jamie with a black-muzzled stare.
With
one lifted hand Jamie sketched the old crook-symbol of Mars in the air. He said
bitterly: "Remember? But I might have known—"
"I
meant it," Ghej declared, his voice strained and shaking a little.
"Wait."
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 239
Vastari was sitting up,
spitting out sand and vivid Venusian curses.
"Get
up," ordered Ghej. "Quanna, help him. Go back to the ledge, you two.
Commander, Vastari—I have something to say to you both."
Vastari spat a series of highly colored oaths
at him.
"I've gone to great trouble to save your
life, my boy," Ghej reminded him mildly. "I shall expect something
more from you than curses."
Jamie's brows rose. He was beginning to
understand at least a little. Vastari's attack upon his rescuer was clear
now—no Venusian willingly allows himself to be so obligated if he can avoid it,
particularly by a trick as flagrant as Ghej's had been.
"You owe me a promise now,
Vastari," Ghej went on. "Part of it is this—listen in peace to what I
have to tell you. Commander, this concerns you, too. I followed you from Darva
the day after you left. I rode very fast. Certain news had arrived which you
must know before you leave Venus. Vastari, you must hear, too." He
hesitated a moment. Then he drew a deep breath and said quietly: "The
barbarians have come."
There was a long moment of silence in the
cave. This time it was Jamie whose mind moved quicker. Vastari said:
"Barbarians? But what—" Jamie's monosyllable interrupted.
"Where?"
"At Yvaca. You know it, the walled
valley? They landed secretly a week ago and took the city. Word had just come
over the mountains when I left."
"Who are they?"
"The worst of the lot, commander. Mixed
breeds from half a dozen worlds. The vanguard of no one knows how many other
shiploads."
"The first plague spot," said
Jamie. There was silence a moment more. Then Vastari's voice, slurred a little
as if he were still bewildered from the blow:
"But what is it, Ghej ? I—"
"I've tricked you both," Ghej told
them, still holding his gun to meet any sudden impulse on the part of either
man. "You've been enemies for a long while, but you have a common enemy
now and you must listen to me.
"Vastari, the barbarians have come.
Venus is being attacked by outworld raiders for the first dme in three hundred
years."
"We'll drive them out," said
Vastari simply.
24O JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"These same barbarians are attacking
Earth," Ghej reminded him. "If the Imperial Planet can't keep them
off what can Venus do?"
"Fight," said
Vastari, his eyes on Ghej's gun.
"Not
alone. These aren't Terrestrials bent on conquest, my boy. They're bloodthirsty
degenerates of a hundred races with nothing but destruction and loot in their
minds. And they have weapons that even Earth can't improve on, because it was
Earth who gave them away, long ago. No, there's no hope for Venus at all now,
unless—" He looked appealingly
at Jamie. "Commander—"
Jamie shrugged. "They
need me at home, Ghej."
"They
need you here. I saw all this happen to Mars, commander. I know the signs.
We've never spoken of this before, although the thought has been between us
whenever we met. This is the twilight for you and me and Imperial Earth. Do you
honestly think civilization can survive what's happening on Earth now? There's
no germ of it in the decadent barbarians who are conquering there. Their future
is far in the past. Earth gave them a brief new grip on the tools of conquest,
and they're using them to destroy Earth, but when it's done they'll go on
decaying. They don't understand anything but destruction.
"My world died of an ill like this,
commander. Your world is dying of it. But perhaps we can save Venus. If we can't,
then this is the twilight of civilized man and he will not rise again."
"Venus?"
echoed Jamie scornfully. "It's twilight for Venus, too. What does Venus
know about civilization?"
Vastari
stared uncomprehendingly from one to the other, waiting his chance to spring at
Ghej's gun. Ghej said heatedly:
"Do you remember what I said when we
parted at Darva, commander? This is the one peril that might be strong enough
to draw all Venusians together against a common enemy—teach them the value of
unity and civilization. It's as if the gods were giving us one last chance. But
the barbarians won't wait, commander. Venus isn't ready. If you could only
stay, just for a little while—just long enough to teach them how to
fight—"
"Teach us how to fight 1" roared Vastari, springing to his feet. "Why,
you dried shell of an outworlder, we were born fighting! This is some trick of
the Earthmen to lure my men into the open. Why should we join with them just as
we're winning our freedom? We'll-"
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 241
"Freedom!"
Jamie derided him. "Freedom to loot and kill! What do you know about
freedom?"
"It's the right to live as we
choose!" declared Vastari fiercely. "The same right your people
fought for. Not to have tyrants making our laws, policing our towns, collecting
our taxes! We don't want you back, Earthman! We'll take our chances against
invaders—if that isn't another trick of Ghej's."
"Trick?"
Ghej echoed sadly. "My boy, will you have to lose your freedom before you
really know the meaning of the word ? You must earn freedom before you can
control it. You'd destroy yourself if you had what you call freedom now. Wait
until the barbarians come with their weapons. The barbarians are destruction
itself—wait until that
overtakes you, my boy, and
then remember what you had under the Earthmen!"
"Lies!" shouted Vastari. "Why
should we trust you or anyone in league with the tyrant Terrestrials? We can
fight for ourselves!"
All this, to Quanna, was wasted breath. The
Venusian mind wanders when talk turns to the abstracts, and Quanna had an
urgent problem of her own to solve. Under her velvet robe she was clutching
the Gilson fuse that would turn the Knute on the ledge beside her into a deadly
weapon. She thought she had found the way now to coerce Jamie—that was all her
mind had room for.
She was going to turn the killing force of
the vibrator upon Vastari. It would take a moment or two before the violence
of the vibrations shook his brain cells apart; in that time he would realize
that she was a traitor and her life thereafter would be forfeit upon Venus, for
Jamie's sake. He would have to take her back with him.
True, Vastari might die. She did not much
care if he did. After all, he had been equally ruthless when she stood in his
way in the valley among the Earthmen. If he died, then she would shout what she
had done to the echoing peaks around the cave, where she knew Vastari's men
were hiding. Some of them would hear. It would amount to a burning of bridges
that would leave Jamie no choice but to take her.
Imperceptibly she had been edging the folded
Knute onto her knee as Vastari shouted his defiance and hatred of Earthmen and
the Solar Empire. Ghej and Jamie were absorbed, too. In the green gloom of the
cavern her green robe made her a shadow on the wall. If Ghej saw her slip past,
he did not heed her. He was too deep in his hopeless argument with Vastari. And
Jamie's back was turned.
The Knute was heavy. She slid along the wall
and passed the cur-
242 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
tain
of flowering vines, breathing a little swiftly now. She was putting all hope in
this last, desperate cast.
The
Knute was not too difficult to set up. She had watched the Darva men do it many
times. Here, beyond the cave mouth, across a stretch of sand, was a parapet
behind which she could shelter long enough to do what she must without
interruption. She had the glass Gilson fuse ready to slip into place. And
now—now—
A
long shudder swept the purple flower trumpets before the cave. Then the rainbow
shimmer of the Knute settled down and all that stretch of wall and vine and
cave became unreal, a figment of dream dancing unsteadily before the eyes. She
knew that confused terror was invading the minds of the three men inside. She
called clearly, yet softly:
"Ghej, send out
Vastari. I am going to kill him."
There
was stunned silence for a moment from inside the cave. Then Ghej's voice,
quavering with the mind-shaking effect of the vibration:
"Quanna . . . Quanna,
have you gone mad?"
"I
mean it!" she called fiercely. "Send him out or I'll kill you all.
I've got the Gilson fuse, you know!" And she smiled secretly. Jamie would
not die, even if the full force of the Knute were turned into the cave. For
Jamie still wore his helmet, and it would resist the killing vibrations for the
few moments it took the others to die. She would be sorry to kill Ghej, but—
There
was silence in the unreal cavern, shimmering behind its shimmering vines. Too
long a silence. They were planning something.
"Send him out!" she called.
"Send him now! I'm putting in the Gilson fuse, Ghej! Commander! Do you
want to die with him?" Sdll silence.
Quanna
found the socket for the little glass pencil of the fuse. She fumbled a bit,
putting it in. It stuck the first time. Then there was a small click and she
felt a subtle change in the vibration of the Knute. Deeper, heavier. The purple
trumpets of the vine began to wilt, folding softly upon their stems. The
leaves crumpled. Death was pouring into the cave.
"The fuse is in,"
called Quanna. "Are you ready to die, Vastari?"
There
was a heavy step upon the cave floor. The curtain of withering vines swept
aside and a man stood in the doorway looking up at her. Jamie. His black head
bare of the shielding helmet. He stood
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 243
in
silence, feet planted wide, frowning at her somberly under heavy brows. He was
like a figure in a dream, shimmering in the full bath of the killing rays.
"Jamie, Jamie 1" Quanna sobbed, and
hurled the Knute backward off the parapet. Its rays swept up across the cliff
in a shimmering rainbow and the machine clattered down the slope in an
avalanche of pebbles, its death ray fanning the clouds.
Quanna
could not remember afterward stumbling down the rocks toward the cave. Her
first conscious awareness was of Jamie fending her unsteadily off his wounded
arm as he leaned against the cave wall with closed eyes, waiting for his brain
to stop shaking with the force of the Knute.
In the cave, Ghej and Vastari sat with heads
in hands, blind and sick, as the vibrations faded slowly inside their skulls.
Quanna was abstractly glad that they still lived. Now her treachery was
established without the need for outside evidence. But it had been a near
thing— too near, for Jamie. She shivered a little, guiding him to a seat on the
ledge.
After a while Vastari lifted his head
unsteadily and gave Quanna a poisonous glare. She met it opaquely. His eyes
shifted to Jamie and he said in a bitter voice:
"Damn you, Earthman—I owe you my life!
Now what did you want badly enough to take that risk for me?"
"Nothing," Jamie
said wearily, not lifting his head. "Don't bother
me.
There was something so electric in the
breathless silence that followed that in a moment Jamie looked up to see what
was causing it. He met Vastari's look of blank amazement.
"Nothing?"
echoed Vastari in an incredulous voice. "Then why-"
"Oh, sure—I came here to kill you."
Jamie spoke in a tired and indifferent voice. "But things are different
now. Venus is going to need her leaders."
"But—you risked your life! No one ever
does that without a reason!"
Jamie looked at him in silence. He was not
sure himself just why he had done it. And there was no hope of making this
Venusian understand how he felt about the world to which he had given twenty
years and all his hopes and interests, the world upon which mankind might have
found its ultimate future—
244 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"You
could command me to join forces with you, if you wanted that." Vastari was
still groping.
"You'd
be no good to me at the point of a gun," Jamie shrugged. "Fighdng the
barbarians will be a full-time job. I wouldn't want an ally I won like
that."
Vastari
sat very still, considering Jamie with fathomless eyes. Perhaps Ghej's
warnings had frightened him more than his pride had let him admit. Perhaps he
had been waiting for a chance to surrender gracefully. Perhaps this first
encounter with genuine selflessness honestly impressed him. There was no
guessing what went on behind that expressionless face. But at last Vastari said
slowly:
"My
life belongs to you until I redeem it, Earthman. I am pledged to Ghej, too.
Will it satisfy you both if I offer my men and myself as your sworn allies
until the invaders are driven away?"
Ghej's
hooded head came up for the first time since the vibrations had filled the
cave. He stared long and unblinkingly at the young Venusian. Jamie was staring,
too. Presently Jamie's eyes shifted to Ghej, and the two exchanged a long,
questioning look in which hope was slowly dawning. After a moment Ghej said in
a shaken voice:
"Venus is the morning
star from Earth this time of year."
Jamie smiled. It was his own figure of
speech, coming spontaneously into the Martian's mind. But he only said
practically:
"It would mean much
hard work, Vastari. Much sacrifice."
Vastari said with dignity:
"Tell me what you need."
"More than you can give, perhaps. You
can't fight the barbarians with spears. Even if you drove this group out by a
miracle, there'll be more. You'll need modern weapons. There are men in the
Terrestri-alized cities who know how to make them, but they need supplies.
That'll mean law and order, Vastari. You can't get raw materials or transport
them in an anarchy where every brawling tribe has the 'freedom' to do as it
likes. You'll have to forget all quarrels, forget personal jealousies, forget
greed and loot and fighting. It'll mean back-breaking labor, night and day.
You've got to work the mines and the machines again, hard and fast. We'll help
all we can. We'll see that your trained workmen are taught what little else
they may need to know, before we leave. But we must leave soon, Vastari."
Vastari
was watching the Earthman's face with narrowed eyes, searching for some sign of
the trickery he could not yet believe wholly absent. His quicksilver mind was
turning the points over as Jamie brought them up, but nowhere, apparently,
could he find anything that
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 245
might
be two-edged. Finally he nodded, sdll with that puzzled look. "Very well,
it shall be done."
Yes,
thought Jamie, with Ghej's help it might yet be done, after all. The Venusians
were so childlike in so many ways, irresponsible, unable to see beyond the
needs of the next moment. But Vastari, with his dream of freedom, distorted
though it was, proved them more capable of pursuing an ideal than Jamie would
ever have believed. And if the barbarians frightened them enough, perhaps they
might work together to destroy them. And the work together, the common danger
—would it be enough to build a civilization on? Jamie knew he would never hear
the answer to that question.
The walled valley of Yvaca was doubly walled
with flame. From the last Terrestrial spaceship left on Venus, slanting down
toward it on broad, steel wings, it looked like the valley of hell. Only the
high-walled Terrestrial city of Yvaca remained now; all around it the native
village that filled the valley had been fired by the invaders to keep the
Venusians at bay. But there was one ship left on Venus, and Yvaca was still
vulnerable from the air.
In the deep night twilight flame lapped high
about the city walls and lighted the low clouds over Yvaca with a sullen,
sulphurous glow. Looking down from that height as the ship slid down a long
aerial incline above the peaks, Jamie could not see the Venusian mountaineers
ringing Yvaca. But he knew they were there. He spoke into a microphone and
felt the floor slant more sharply as Yvaca seemed to rise at a tilted angle in
the port before him.
In
the heart of the city, ringed by blackened ruins, lay the invader's spaceship.
They had brought it down in one careless sliding crash that demolished three
city blocks. A pale stab of light shot upward from the city as the barbarians
sighted the swooping ship; Jamie could see small, distorted figures running for
their ruin-cradled vessel, and his teeth showed in a hard grin as lightning
flamed downward from the ship. There was something horrible about the
barbarians even from this height; their warped, degenerate shapes were vicious
parodies of men.
Blue fire fanned downward again from the
Earth ship and touched the other vessel with a gout of flame. Half of it flew
into glittering flinders that made the air sparkle over Yvaca. And now, thought
Jamie, there was one ship left on Venus. The first of them had come from Earth
for conquest. This last, he told himself, would set Venusians free of more
than Earthly domination before it left.
246 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
The
pale, stabbing ray of the barbarians' weapon shot skyward again, and the
Terrestrial ship slid deftly sidewise as the ray shaved it, raking the city
below with fingers of blue light that were tipped with flame wherever they
touched Yvaca.
From
this height there was silence in the vessel. Jamie knew that below him, in the
red inferno of the valley, cliff echoed to bellowing cliff with the roar of
gunfire and the crash of sliding walls and the deep-throated soughing of flame.
But he would never hear the sounds of Venus any more. Already the city below
was afire. Those who escaped would find Venusians waiting in a grim circle
around the valley. The first plague spot of the malady that was killing Earth
was being wiped out here in flame.
There
would be other spots, perhaps very soon. It might be well for Venus if they
came soon, to keep the knowledge of peril fresh in careless minds. For Venus
would have to meet the next attacks unaided. Remembering the feverish activity
now in progress among the mountain cities, Jamie thought Venus might meet them
well. He could not be sure about that, of course. He would have to leave Venus,
never knowing.
He
spoke again into the microphone and the ship banked for the last time over
flaming Yvaca under the glowing clouds. No more rays leaped skyward from the
city. The barbarians were in full flight. His work was done.
Cool
hands upon his cheeks roused Jamie from his contemplation of the inferno below
as the ship swung away. He looked up and smiled wearily into Quanna's face.
"Your
last look at Venus, my dear," he told her, nodding down. She gave him a
puzzled, little frown under delicate brows.
"It's
not too late yet, Jamie. Oh, why wouldn't you stay ? It would have been so easy to let the rest go on. You and I on Venus
might have ruled the world!"
He
shook his head helplessly. "I'm not a free man, Quanna. Less now than
ever. I've a duty to Venus as well as to Earth—I've got to help hold the barbarians off until Venus is ready for them.
Earth needs every man and every gun, but not to save herself. Earth doesn't
know it, and I don't suppose she ever will, but her duty now is to keep the
barbarians busy for Venus' sake—"
He looked up at the girl's
uncomprehending face and smiled. "Never mind. Go get your harp, Quanna,
and sing to me, will you ? We'll sit here and watch the last of Venus— Look, we're coming into daylight already."
THERE SHALL BE DARKNESS 247
Far
behind them the sullen glow of burning Yvaca faded as they ncared the edge of
the cloud-tide. Diluted sunlight was pouring down upon the tremendous turguoise
mountains and the leaning cliffs astream with waterfalls, all the high, blue
country they would never see again. Quanna strummed her Martian harp sofdy.
"I'll probably be court-martialed,"
Jamie mused, his eyes on the mountains falling away below. "Or—maybe not.
Maybe they'll need fighting men too badly for that. Fm doing you no service,
Quanna, or myself, either. For your sake I wish you could have stayed."
"Hush,"
said Quanna, and struck the harp string. "Ill sing you 'Otterburn' again.
Forget about all that, my dear. Listen." And her thin, sweet voice took up
the ballad.
"The Otterburn*s a bonny burn,
It's pleasant there to be,
But there is naught on Otterburn To feed my men and me—"
Jamie laughed suddenly, but he shook his head
when she lifted questioning eyes. He had remembered his dream again, and
unexpectedly it made fantastic sense that perhaps only a Celt might have read
into the dream and the song that had inspired it. He hummed the stanza again:
"Oh, I have dreamed a dreary dream
Beyond the Isle of Stye,
For I saw a dead man win a -fight And I thin\ that man was I."
The clouds below were thickening now between
him and the great blue mountains of Venus that slanted away below. The Isle of
Skye, the morning star. The hope of civilized man. He was leaving the future
behind him, if mankind had any future at all. James Douglas was a dead man
indeed, sailing out into the nighttime of space toward a dying world where
nothing but death waited for him. But he left the Isle of Skye behind, and on
it a battle won against the powers of evil. If ever a dead man won a fight,
thought Jamie, I think that man was I.
The ship drove on into darkness.
U\e
mist before the dawn, the reign of terror at last melted away. The barbarians,
exhausted, their plunder spent, were finally absorbed by the old culture which
they would have destroyed. Self-sufficient feudal communities sprang up and
squabbled with one another. In jjoo freedom existed only within the
sanctuaries, where groups of men,
possessing nothing, nurtured their ideals. Here the hope of the future awaited
its chance.
TABOO
by
Fritz Leiber
wTn the name of the Great Heritage, I claim refuge!" X The
voice was strong and trumpet-clear, yet with a curious note of mockery. The
face was in shadow, but the embers of a smoky sunset outlined, with smudged
brush-strokes of blood, the giant figure. The left hand lightly gripped the
lintel of the low doorway for support. The right hung limp—Seafor noted that there
the sunset red merged into real blood, which now began to drip upon the floor.
Seafor
looked up. "If I am not mistaken," he said, "you are Amine, the
outlaw—"
"When there was law, or rather, the
illusion of law, which there hasn't been, in my lifetime," interjected the
other, in an amused rumble.
"—who has ravaged a hundred petty
domains," Seafor continued imperturbably, "who has thieved, kidnaped,
and killed without mercy, whose trickery and cunning have already become a
legend, and who does not care one atom in chaos for the Great Heritage which he
now invokes to save his life."
"What difference does that make?"
Amine chuckled. "You have to grant me refuge if I claim it. That's your
law." He swayed, gripped the lintel more strongly, and looked behind him.
"And if you don't cut your speech of welcome pretty short, it'll be my
funeral oration. Fm still fair prey, you know, until I'm inside the door."
There was a sudden humming in the murky sky.
A narrow beam
TABOO 249
laced
down, firing the air to incandescence, making a great gout of blinding light
where it struck the ground a dozen yards away. Immediately came thunder, a
puff of heat, and the smell of burning. Seafor fell back a step, blinking. But
in the empty hush that followed the thunder, his reply to Arnine sounded as
cool and methodical as his previous remarks.
"You
are right, on all counts. Please come in." He moved a little to one side
and inclined his head slightly. "Welcome, Arnine, to Bleaksmound Retreat.
We grant you refuge."
The
outlaw lurched forward, yet with something of the effect of a swagger. As he
passed Seafor, there came from beyond the door a groan of the sort that sets
the teeth on edge. Seafor looked at him sharply.
"You have a
companion?"
The
outlaw shook his head. He turned, so that the ruddy sunset glow highlighted his
lean, big-featured face—a dangerous, red-haired god, a hero with a fox
somewhere among his ancestors.
"Some
beast, perhaps, singed by the blast," he hazarded, and showed his teeth in
a long, thin smile.
Seafor made no comment. "Hyousikl
Teneks!" he called. "We have a guest. Attend to his hurts. Relieve
him of his weapons." Then he took down from the wall a small transparent
globe with a dark cylindrical base and went outside.
It was a ragged and desolate landscape that
opened up for Seafor. The crimson band of sky edging the horizon heightened the
illusion that a forest fire had recently burned through it. Dead and sickly
trees were outlined blackly.
Seafor^skirted
the blasted patch, holding up the globe, in which a curled wire now glowed
brightly. The humming returned. He did not look up, but he moved the luminous
globe back and forth to call attention to it.
The
groan was repeated. A metallic shimmer caught Seafor's eyes. A few steps
brought him to the wreck of a small flier. Beside it, in an unnaturally
contorted posture, was sprawled a small figure clad in rich synthetics.
Seafor
unlashed the small wrists, and did a little to ease the broken ankle. The boy
shuddered and tried to draw away. Then his eyes opened.
"Seafor! Seafor of Bleaksmound!"
There was surprise in the
25O JOURNEY TO INFINITY
shrill
voice. He stared and plucked at Seafor's sleeve with his skinny fingers.
The
humming increased. It was as if the buzzing of one giant wasp had brought
others.
"You're
safe now," said Seafor. "Arnine's gone. Your father's men will be
here very soon."
The
boy's fingers tightened. "Don't let them take me," he whispered
suddenly.
"Don't you understand
? I said your father's men."
The
boy nodded. "Please don't let them take me," he repeated in the same
imploring whisper. "I want to stay with you, Seafor. I want to stay at
Bleaksmound."
Within
seconds of each other, four fliers grounded, their repulsors scattering clods
of black soil. From each, two men sprang.
The
boy tugged frantically at Seafor's arms, as if by that means he could force a
nod or a reassuring smile. Then a kind of boyish cunning brightened his eyes.
"Refuge, Seafor," he whispered.
"I claim refuge."
Seafor
did not reply and his expression remained impassive, but he hooked to his belt
the globe which he had previously set down, and carefully lifted the boy in his
arms.
The
men hurried up. They wore identical emblems on their blue synthetic coveralls
and skull-tight hoods. They carried blasters. They seemed like soldiers, except
for a lack of discipline and a kind of animal bleakness that darkened their
faces like a tangible film. Because of that film, they did not even seem
human—quite.
Seafor's
gray robe was crude and beggarly compared with their sleek clothing, but his
pale, stern, ascetic face, like something carved from ivory, shone with a light
that further darkened theirs.
Now
that they faced him, a certain confusion became apparent in their manner.
"We're Ayarten of Rossel's men,"
one of them explained. "That's his son you've got there. Arnine the outlaw
kidnaped him, intending ransom. We brought down his flier."
"I know that,"
said Seafor.
"We're grateful to you, outsider, for
the help you've given Ayar-ten's son," the other continued. He stepped
forward to take the boy, but his manner lacked assurance.
Seafor
did not reply. The boy clung to him. He turned and walked toward the dark,
square mass of Bleaksmound.
TABOO 25I
"We
must take the boy home to his father," the other protested* following a
step. "Give him to us, outsider."
"He
has claimed refuge," Seafor told them without turning hi* head, and walked
on.
They
conferred together in whispers, but no action came of it. They watched the
luminous globe jog gently up the hill, casting a huge fantastic shadow.
"Gives
you the shivers," muttered one. "Dead men. That's what they're like.
Dead men."
"You
can't figure them out. Think of getting light by heating a wire inside a ball
of dead air. Like our primitive ancestors. And when there's atom power
a-plenty!"
"But
they give up atom power, you know, when they give up everything else—when they
die to the world."
"Imagine
the boy asking for refuge. Scared out of his wits, I suppose. Never catch me
doing that."
"I always thought
young Ayten was a queer boy."
"Ayarten
won't like this when we tell him. He won't like it at all —not with Amine
taking shelter in the same place. He'll be angry."
"Not our fault,
though."
"We'd better hurry.
Set the cordon. Report to Ayarten."
Burly, blue-tinged shadows, they dispersed to
their fliers.
Seafor
handed the boy to two of his gray-robed brethren, who had a stretcher ready, and preceded them to the infirmary. He met Amine coming
out of the weapon room under escort, and noted the greedy look on the outlaw's
face.
"Remarkable collection you have
there," said Amine. "Some of the fine old models they don't turn out
any more. And so many!"
"Some
people die in refuge," Seafor explained. "A few become outsiders. And
some go away without reclaiming their weapons."
Arnine's
ruddy-gold eyebrows arched skeptically. He seemed on the point of launching a
satirical reply when he nodced the stretcher.
Seafor motioned the bearers on to the
infirmary. "Do you feel up to having dinner in the refectory?" he
asked.
The
outlaw laughed boisterously, as if the idea of his being too sick to eat was
very humorous indeed. His arm was in a sling and the feline springiness had
returned to his stride. Seafor accompanied him back along the gloomy corridor.
"Is it your intention to become the
accomplice of a kidnaper?"
252 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
Amine
asked in amused tones a moment later. He showed no embarrassment at his
previous lie having been uncovered. "The boy claimed refuge/' Seafor said.
"They'd
have found him soon enough, and that would have satisfied Ayarten. But the way
it is now— Well, you're lucky that the border war with Levensee of Wols is
keeping Ayarten's hands full. Still, even that may not be enough." He
shrugged his good shoulder.
An
elderly man turned into the corridor some distance ahead of them. He wore a
green uniform of archaic cut, faded and frayed but very neat. Disks of a
greenish metal formed the chief insignia.
"The
President of the Fourth Global Republic," Seafor replied in answer to
Arnine's immediate question. "Been in refuge here for the past year."
The
outlaw expressed incredulity. "Why, if that were the case, he'd have to be
two hundred . . . two hundred fifty years old."
"Not
at all. When the last elected president died, he exercised his power to appoint
an emergency successor to serve until elections could be resumed. Several of
his cabinet members held the office. When the last of those died, he handed on
the executive authority to some faithful subordinate—perhaps a secretary or
bodyguard. It's gone on that way ever since."
Amine roared with laughter. "Do you mean
to say that that old chap still thinks of the state of the world as merely an
emergency temporarily interrupting the majestic and tranquil course of the
Fourth Global Republic? Is he grooming
a secretary to succeed him?"
Seafor
shook his head. "He was alone when he came here. He is a very old man. He
has decided to sign over his authority to me, when he dies."
Arnine's laughter became Gargantuan.
"One more worthless tradition for you to guard! One more trinket tossed
into the rubbage bag of the Great Heritage!" He looked at the man ahead
more closely. "I see a blaster. Isn't that against your rules?"
"As
commander in chief of the Earth's armed forces, we have granted him certain
extraordinary privileges," Seafor replied imper-turbably.
Amine shrugged his shoulder, indicating that
it was impossible to find a laugh big enough to do justice to that jest. They
had caught upi with the old man now, and Seafor introduced them.
"Your excellency—Amine
the outlaw."
The old man inclined his head politely.
"It is always good to;
TABOO 253
meet
a fellow citizen. Though I warn you, sir, that when peace is restored I will
have to proceed against you with the utmost severity." There was a grave
twinkle in his eyes. "Still, no need to dwell upon such subjects now.
Perhaps you can give me news of what's happening outside this little corner of
the Republic. Surely an outlaw ought to get around." His voice became
thoughtful. "No one seems to travel any more—perhaps because it's so
easy."
Arnine
seemed to derive amusement from replying in the same quaintly polite veins.
Seafor left them talking amiably and returned to the infirmary.
A
gray-robed doctor was setting the broken ankle. Unmindful of his sharp command
the boy tried to sit up.
"Can I stay here,
Seafor?" he called anxiously.
Seafor nodded. "For
the present, at least. Now be quiet."
He
stood beside the bed until the doctor had finished. Then he looked down at the
small damp face and asked, "Why do you want to stay here, Ay ten? Why
don't you want to go home?" A faint smile touched his thin, pale lips.
The doctor went out.
The
boy frowned, trying to find the right answer. A look of fear came into his
eyes. "I don't want to go home because . . . because they're not human
beings—not father or his women, or any of them. They're—animals."
"All human beings are
animals," said Seafor softly.
"When
I was little, I thought they were gods," said the boy. "I took it for
granted we were all gods. Why shouldn't I ? Things that take you up in the sky
at the touch of a finger, transformers that synthesize food and clothes and
dwelling domes, weapons that annihilate, picture tapes that tell you how to do
things—all that and more!
"But
gradually I realized that something must be wrong. All those wonderful things
didn't square with our cramped lives, with the endless jealousies and quarrels
and killings. Nobody ever had a new idea. Nobody ever seemed to think. Nobody
could answer my real
questions—neither could the
picture tapes. They couldn't tell me why the world seemed to end at the
boundaries of Rossel, why we almost never saw strangers, except to kill them,
why, with all those wonderful powers, we lived like beasts in a cave!"
His
face was flushing with the excitement and relief of talking out his thoughts.
Quietly Seafor laid his hand on the small shoulder.
"For a long time I
told myself that it must be a kind of test," the
254 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
boy
continued, "that they were seeing if I was worthy of the domain of Rossel,
and that some day, when I had proved myself, a door would open and I would walk
into the real world, the big friendly world I knew must exist somewhere.
"Now
I know there is no door. The real world doesn't exist—except for you
outsiders, in some way that I don't understand. And you've given up all the
things that we possess." He caught hold of Seafor's wrist. "Why is
that? And why, with all our powers, do we live like animals?"
Seafor waited a moment before he spoke.
"There was a real world," he said. "There's still a little of it
left, and some day it will all come back. Civilization came because men needed
each other. They found that life was easier and better if they traded
together—not only the necessities of life but also the things that can't be
weighed or measured and that haven't a definite barter value, like the beauty
of a song, or the joy of dancing, or the understanding of each other's troubles
and hopes.
"As civilization grew, that mutual
dependency increased and became infinitely complicated. Each man's life and
happiness was the work of millions of his fellow workers.
"But there were forces working in the
opposite direction. Man was learning to synthesize materials and make use of
universal power sources. Wars accelerated this process, by periodically
shutting off supplies of essential raw materials.
"That
trend reached its ultimate development with the perfecting of atomic power and
the invention of multipurpose transmutators capable of supplying all the
necessities of life anywhere.
"At
almost any other time that development would have been a great boon, freeing
man's energies for more intensive participation in the social quest. But the shadow
of the Second Global Empire still darkened the Fourth Global Republic, and
interplanetary war with the Venusian and Martian colonies sapped its strength.
The Great Migrations began. There was an endless, seemingly purposeless
surging of populations among the three planets, attended by wanton massacres.
"The
end product was stagnation. Distrust in the very forces that brought
civilization into being. Humanity turned in upon itself, mentally and
physically. Small communities came into existence, each built around some
leader who had a little more energy and determination left than any of his
fellows. The stragglers were killed, or they drifted into such communities—and
stayed there. Men were tired.
TABOO 255
They
wanted only to attach themselves to a single locality—to the soil. A vegetative
cycle succeeded a cycle of movement.
"In
any previous age, hunger and want would have broken that unwholesome
equilibrium. But now each little community was independent of trade, so far as
the necessities of life were concerned. And as for the things that have no
definite barter value—disillusioned men could get along without them.
"The
jealousies and rivalries and suspicions of small-community existence came to
make up the whole of life. Strangers were persecuted. There was almost
continual warfare between neighboring communities, but it remained a petty,
spiteful warfare, incapable of giving rise to widespread conquest and the
establishment of nations, because it lacked any enduring economic motivation.
"That's the sort of
world you've been born into, Ayten."
The
boy said nothing. Seafor continued, "A few men realized what was being
lost. They saw all of Earth's cultural heritage sliding into oblivion, save the
bare minimum needed for the new self-maintaining mode of life. Reading and
writing, for example, were going into the discard—picture tapes were sufficient
to transmit the necessary education.
"These
men found that they could not change the small-community system of life from
within. So long as they remained part of it, they would have to conform to its
savage and inhospitable laws. So they got out of it. They gave up atomic power.
They gave up all valued possessions. Only by paying that price could they
purchase even the most shadowy immunity from attack. They formed small communities.
They devoted themselves to preserving the cultural heritage and to maintaining
the ideals of universal brotherhood and of individual honor and integrity. They
became the outsiders."
Ayten whispered, "I
want to be an outsider."
Seafor
nodded with a frown. "I tell you what," he said finally. "You
can live with us as a novice, and work and study for a year. Then, if you're
still determined, we'll talk it over again."
Ayten smiled.
In the refectory, Arnine's brown-and-gold
tunic made a gaudy break in the long rows of gray, as did the clothing of the
other refugees.
Seafor paused by Amine. "How does it
taste after a diet of synthetics?"
The outlaw turned around.
"Inferior, of course. But I've been in
256 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
refuge
before. Where do you get such garbage?" he inquired pleasantly.
"Most of it we grow in shallow tanks on
the root"
"Swamp plants, I suppose?"
"No. They originally grew in dirt."
Arnine's
long lips curled in mild and somewhat humorous disgust. There came the faint
chiming of the bell over Bleaksmound's door. "How's the boy?" he
asked suddenly. "Only slightly hurt? As I thought. You'll be sending him
back to his father, of course?"
"On the contrary. He has decided to
become a novice."
Amine stared at him through half-shut eyes.
"You play a strange game," he said finally. "Turning a kidnaping
into a conversion! It turns out that / am your accomplice! Do you realize the trouble you're brewing? Outsiders exist
only on sufferance, you know."
"You
mean I should honor your claim of refuge, but not his?" Seafor's eyes were
enigmatic.
An outsider approached Seafor from the hall.
"Ayarten of Rossel is at the door. He desires to speak to you."
"You see?" said Amine sardonically.
"The way things are going, neither claim of refuge is likely to amount to
much. Let me known the terms of his ultimatum."
Seafor
went out. Swifdy the refectory emptied as the outsiders went off to their
tasks. Two remained, ostensibly to converse with Amine. The outlaw, prowling
restlessly between the empty benches, did not make their task any easier. His
ears were cocked all right, but for noises outside the refectory rather than in
it. His movements were aimless, seemingly, but when Seafor returned he was
standing by the door.
"He gives us until dawn," said
Seafor, "to give up the boy." "And if you refuse?"
"He threatens to make an example of
Bleaksmound."
"You
see?" said Amine. "He didn't let his border war with Levensee hold
him back."
"I
was not counting on that," said Seafor. "Though it strikes me that he
is unwise in drawing off so many of his men for the cordon he is setting around
Bleaksmound."
"And
you will refuse to give up the boy?" Arnine's voice was edged with anger.
"I
gave the boy my word that he could stay in refuge," said Seafor. "In
the days of the great civilizations, mankind could afford some
TABOO 257
weaknesses
in the individual moral fiber, because the general progressive trends were
strong enough to nullify individual treacheries. But now trust in a man's word
has become part of the almost forgotten heritage. If we cannot keep that alive,
then all the outsiders' work is vain."
Amine laughed, but unpleasantly.
"Very
well," he said. "In that case I shall leave Bleaksmound, for obvious
modves of self-preservation."
"Ayarten has set too strong a
cordon," said Seafor. "You wouldn't be able to."
"That
is for me to judge. Please give orders that my weapons be restored. I leave at
once."
Seafor shook his head. "You are our
guest. We cannot let you go so soon."
"You mean to hand me over to
Ayarten?" "No. You claimed refuge. You shall have it."
Seafor's sleep turned into a restless,
rocking darkness, alive with menace. There was a hand at his shoulder. Someone
was shaking him awake. He sat up.
"Ayarten has come?"
"No,
but Amine has escaped. Knocked us down. Darted down a side corridor. Can't be
found."
He
recognized the voice of Hyousik, one of the two outsiders he had set to guard
the outlaw. He threw on his gray robe and hurried out.
Bleaksmound
was alive with movement, like a nest of gray ants in which a spider is loose.
Seafor made for the infirmary. It was as he expected. Young Ayten was gone.
From
ahead came the hiss of a blaster. Seafor hurried to the entry hall.
Amine
stood with his back to the outer door. In his good hand he held a blaster. The
other was out of the sling and fresh blood stained the bandages. At his feet
lay young Ayten, unconscious. Arnine's face was racked with pain but he smiled
tautly.
Seafor strode toward him. When there was only
a few feet between them, Amine leveled the blaster.
"The
first was only a warning," he said. "This time it will be for
business."
Seafor stopped.
258 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"I
mean to bargain for my life with Ayarten," Amine continued. "Later
you will realize that it was for your good, too."
Behind Seafor the circle of silent gray-robed
figures parted to make way for an old man in faded green.
"Who
dares do violence in Bleaksmound Retreat?" The voice of the President of
the Fourth Global Republic quavered, but a note of iron determination came
through. "My authority holds here. Outlaw, put down your weapon." He
fumbled with trembling hand for the blaster at his hip.
A
ray of blinding light touched the old man, pierced him. Amine laughed.
In
that instant, Seafor lunged forward. The ray shifted, nicked the gray robe,
sizzled against the stone floor. Then Amine was down, grunting with pain
because Seafor had thrown him so that he fell on his wounded arm. With both
hands Seafor gripped the blaster, wrested it from him, sent it spinning across
the floor.
Amine
stopped struggling. "You've wrecked your own last chance of safety,"
he said.
Seafor knelt on his chest. "And you have
murdered. We have law here, although it holds good only within these walls. Our
penalty for murder is lifelong imprisonment."
The bell began to clang
deafeningly.
Through his weakness and
pain, Amine smiled.
"I
think that penalty has been commuted to sudden death—likely for all of us. You
know who that is. Dawn has come."
The
door opened. It was Ayarten of Rossel, burly, mean-visaged, clad in cloth of
gold. But he staggered, his face was chalk-white, the cloth of gold was torn.
He did not see his son
lying at his feet.
"Refuge!"
he cried. "Levensee of Wols has struck. He has seized my domain. Those of
my men that remained have gone over to him. I claim refuge!"
Emancipated
in 8200 by the Tragon of Milay who established his council of \ings by
military and diplomatic feats, the people of Earth once more had one world.
Commerce revived rapidly and the organization of the corporation reappeared.
By the year 9000 all corporations had grouped themselves into
separate communal entities, with Power Center the greatest. One element, individual freedom, was lacking to ma\e the cycle complete.
OVERTHROW
by
Cleve Cartmill
C |
hief of Police Josh Cameron focused the blur on his screen.
"Outlaws 1" he muttered. "How
in the bloody—" He touched a button labeled "pilot." It glowed
instantly and he said, "Go up!"
"We're
at thirty thousand now," the pilot's voice complained. "This is no
stratoliner."
"Ask the captain to come here,
please." "Yes, sir."
Cameron
watched the slim image grow in size until Captain Jorge-son squeezed through
the narrow entrance of the guard cubicle. Cameron saluted.
"Will you be so good, sir? We're in a
jam, I'm afraid. Look!"
Captain
Jorgeson fixed the screen with a bright-blue glance. His great hands knotted.
His face flamed red as his hair.
"I'll be a son of an actor!" he
grated. "It leaked out again!" He glared at Cameron. "Well? You
came along especially to prevent this. Nobody knew about it but you, me, and
the pilot. What have you to say for yourself?"
A
slow flush seeped up Cameron's dark throat and overspread his tan. His black
eyes went coldly blank.
"On
this plane," he said with slow emphasis, "you are the law.
2ó0 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
May
I remind you that our positions will be reversed when we return to Plastic
Primer'
"ƒƒ
we return, sir!" the captain flared. "Don't pull official dignity on
me, Cameron. I'm trying to get the truth. Did you open your mouth to anyone about this mission?"
"Of course not! Am I a
fool?"
"We'll see. Well,
you're the guard. Get us through."
"With
not even a point-blank disintegrator? You expect a great deal, captain."
"You'd better
deliver," Captain Jorgeson said grimly.
When
the big red-haired man had gone, Cameron turned gloomy dark eyes on the screen.
The rakish silhouette grew so swiftly that he caught his breath. What speed!
The forces of law and order were far behind the outlaws in this respect, and
Cameron found himself wondering again why they did not attack one or more of
the Centers.
Yet
they never tried, and this made him vaguely uneasy whenever he thought of the
outlaws. They made their own rules, or lived by none. They raided freight
planes, they rarely came off second best in brushes with the military, and they
had sources of informadon which were frightening.
This
shipment, for example, had been Plastic Center's most highly guarded secret. No
more than a half dozen officials had known about it. It was inconceivable that
any of them had ratted. Somebody had, unless this encounter were pure accident;
and the purpose clearly apparent in the outlaw's direct approach threw cold
water on that flicker of hope.
It
was dashed with cold finality when a precise voice came through Cameron's
monitor:
"Down, or I'll cut you
in two. At once, please."
No
questions. Just a command. The speaker didn't want to know where Fleetfin was headed, who was aboard, or what time it
was.
"Who are you?"
Captain Jorgeson blustered.
Cameron
watched the grille of his monitor as if he could conjure the voices into faces
and legs.
"I
don't want to kill you," the frosty voice replied,
"but I'm not in the least sentimental. I shall give you thirty minutes to
land at Dead Horse Spring, two points to port. You'll have to—"
Fleetfin
shuddered slightly, and
Cameron cursed the captain's stubborn idiocy. He touched another button on his
panel.
"Down, damn you!"
he ordered. "We'll settle the question of
OVERTHROW 26l
authority
later. I order you down. You can't fight that ship. Cease firing!"
The
outlaw's voice broke in, crisp with annoyance. "You can see that Fm
shielded. One more blast from you and you begin second-guessing in hell."
Captain
Jorgeson, a red-topped mountain of wrath in the cubicle doorway, roared at
Cameron.
"Who's giving orders
here? The council will—"
"Oh,
dry up!" Cameron said. "I told you we'll fight it out later. I don't
want to be on a killed-in-action list. There's nothing you can do, anyway, but
go down. He's shielded. Why make him sore by shoodng at him?"
"You're under
arrest!" Jorgeson snarled.
Cameron
bowed sardonically at the departing footsteps and sat back to await the
landing.
Clouds
which might have come straight out of Textile Center seemed to drift upward,
and presently Dead Horse Spring was visible in miniature far below. It rose
steadily toward them, as did the pocked desert. They were soon on its face and
the long black ship drifted gently toward them.
"All outside,"
came the outlaw's voice.
Cameron
joined the captain and the young, bright-eyed pilot as they stepped out into
the pungent heat. The odor of sage was hot in their nostrils and they shielded
their eyes from sand glare as the outlaw craft settled fifty yards away.
Cameron
noted a phenomenon, then. Some twenty feet before him, the surface of the
desert was marked by a line no more than an inch in width. It was no mark such
as paint would make, it was not a line of vegetation, it was a line drawn
by—nothing. The sand itself writhed within this narrow space, and the boiling
demarcation stretched off to either side as far as the eye could see. It was as
if a million tiny animals burrowed from underneath in geometric formation.
He
flicked a dark glance at his companions, but their gaze was fixed on the figure
who emerged from the long plane.
This
was a man, like other men, dressed in the garb of an ordinary citizen. His
shorts, sandals, and shirt would have passed without notice in any crowd. But
not his bearing, not his face.
Whereas
the ordinary citizen went stolidly about his directed business, this man walked
like an official, or a commander. Whereas the eyes of an ordinary citizen were
usually blank and withdrawn, this
262 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
man's
sparked. He was dark and hawklike, and completely at ease as he approached,
despite the fact that he was unarmed.
His
wide thin mouth curled up at one corner as he examined the trio. "I am
happy," he began in courteous phrases of the day, "to see you. May I
be of service?"
"Your
offer," the captain replied automatically, "is most kind, and
reciprocated." Having disposed of the amenities, Captain Jorgeson roared,
"What the—"
The outlaw lifted a dark hand. "In good
time, captain. Please notice the agitadon here in the sand." He pointed
to the narrow, writhing line which Cameron had already seen. "That marks
the location of my defensive weapon. You see that I am unarmed. I warn you not
to attack, for if you touch this screen you will simply—vanish. I am quite
serious," he added, as Captain Jorgeson began to grin. "Don't—"
He
broke off as Jorgeson whipped a Payne coagulator from its holster and
depressed the activator. He waited, calmly, until the captain, with a baffled
expression, lowered his weapon.
"Don't touch it,"
he continued.
"It's a bluff!" Jorgeson said
quietly to Cameron and the pilot. "There isn't any such weapon. Let's get
him."
The big redhead led the charge in a plunging
rush and the young pilot was on his heels. Cameron stood motionless. He decided
that if the outlaw really had such a weapon, attack was useless. If not, let
the others prove it.
Jorgeson reached the area—and exploded. It
was just that, Cameron thought. It sounded like an old-style bomt>—a
muffled boom,
a brilliant flash, and
silence. The silence was infinitesimal, for the young pilot could not check his
momentum.
He
tried. He dug his heels into the sand. He screamed once, just before he slid
into the writhing line. Then he exploded.
Cameron staggered from the second concussion,
and in the ensuing silence tensed himself against falling debris. What goes up
comes down. But nothing came, not even a button from Jorgeson's uniform.
There
was utter silence except for the whisper of wind in dry, thin vegetation. The
two dark men looked at each other.
In
the stranger's eyes was dark sorrow, and his mouth was serious. In Cameron's
heart was a touch of awe. Such things were impossible.
The stranger spoke first. "I haven't
decided whether you're intelligent, soldier, or whether your reflexes are
slow. Do you know?"
"What is it you
want?" Cameron asked.
OVERTHROW 263
"Your cargo, of course. All seventeen
crates of Baltex." Cameron caught his breath. "How—"
"How do I know? That, my friend, would
be telling. I do know, and that is the important fact. Will you stack the
crates outside your ship ? Then you may go. I'm sorry about the other two. They
really suicided, though."
Cameron weighted the factors. He couldn't get
through that diabolical screen, whatever it was. He couldn't escape, not in
this tramp freighter. He shrugged.
"I guess you have me."
"You are intelligent!" the stranger exclaimed. "Then why in the name of
Heaven are you still in a Center? Why aren't you with us?" Cameron
sneered. "With outlaws?"
The stranger's face lost animation. It became
just a face. "Get at it, then!" he snapped.
Cameron lugged the crates one at a time out
of the freight compartment and stacked them on the sand. After a half-hour of
this, his uniform was splotched with sweat, his whole body wringing wet. He set
the final crate atop the pile and faced the stranger.
"Now what?"
"Oh, on your way, soldier. Take back
this message. If so much as one more woman is taken from outside any Center,
the whole will suffer. Tell your superiors about this screen of contraterrene
energy. It's impregnable. Maybe you can scare 'em, for their own good."
"They don't scare easy."
"They can die easily then."
Cameron
looked at the dark stranger for some time, fixing each feature in his memory.
He decided that there was little danger of forgetting him, for the man's
features were like Cameron's own—wide, dark eyes, black hair, prominent nose,
wide mouth, and a slim, wiry body.
"I'll see you some day," Cameron
promised.
The dark stranger said nothing and Cameron
presently shifted his eyes. He entered Fleetfin and
took off.
When
he was at cloud level he saw the stranger enter the long black craft. It
maneuvered near the cargo, remained quiedy undl lost from sight.
"Somebody," Cameron said aloud,
"will pay for this." Every man on his force should be assigned to
tracing the leak in some department along the production line. No, he
reflected, the leak
264 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
must
be near the top, for the outlaw knew the nature and amount of cargo. He had
intersected Fleetfin's course as unerringly as if he had written the
sealed orders.
Tracing the leak was a one-man job and he
should be the man. The big shots in Power Center would scream their silly heads
off at the loss of their purchased cargo, and would try, perhaps, to toss Cameron
to the council. But if he could produce a spy he should save himself and
protect further secret cargo.
Another
point in his report, he decided, would also create havoc. Women. He smiled
grimly as his mind's ear picked up the anguished protests of entertainment
tycoons. Without the vivacious, beautiful oudaw hostesses, the entertainment
profits' curve was headed for a nose dive. They must agree to the outlaw's
ultimatum, Cameron thought, for that screen was a definite menace.
He thought of the noise a man makes when he
explodes, and shuddered. They'd have to stop their piracy, whether they liked
it or not. No more raiding parties at night, no more spotting an oudaw camp, no
more stalking a particular beauty along the path to a spring or river.
Cameron sighed. He'd had a lot of fun in the
palaces of joy. It would be hard shrift to do without those colorful nights.
A
warning signal on his klystron brought him back to the job of piloting. Plastic
Center's shield was, according to meter reading, a thousand yards ahead. He
searched through the pilot's papers for the collapse combinadon.
He found it and depressed eight numbered keys
on the panel. He held these down and accelerated. When he had gone five
thousand yards he released the keys. He was now well inside Plastic Center, and
the earth below was a riot of irrigated green.
Far
ahead were the pastel domes of Plastic 3.9, the
outlying subsidiary of Plastic Prime. He passed over this and others at full
speed, and was at the main landing port in an hour.
At ten o'clock on the following morning,
Cameron left his apartment for the council chambers. He was thoughtful as a
taxi whisked him over gleaming rooftops. He wasted no glance on the maelstrom
of movement below, ordinarily a picture of aesthetic pleasure. He took no
notice of the patterned movement of aircraft.
For he had been summoned to appear before the
council.
Summoned.
OVERTHROW 265
So
many others, he knew, had been summoned in this manner, and had been reduced to
the status of ordinary citizen, doomed to perform the routine tasks of
production—to run the machines that manufactured the products that other
Centers wanted in trade for products that Plastic needed to augment its own.
Ordinary citizen.
Then
he shrugged. This must be an exceptional case. They wanted a report, perhaps.
Or they wanted his testimony so that a criticism could be lodged against the
guilty party—the leak.
He paid
the taxi pilot, walked from the landing roof to a moving ramp and rode it to a
lower level. He went down a deserted corridor— deserted because nobody came
here unless ordered—to the council-chamber door. He stood on the identification
plate until the door slid upward. He entered the chamber.
The
council members looked at him gravely, their gravity accentuated by their
formal robes of democracy. Cameron took the witness chair and faced them.
"Gentlemen, I am happy
to see you. May I serve you?"
"Your
offer," the bearded chairman intoned formally, "is most kind, and
reciprocated." His manner changed. "What have you to say for
yourself?"
Cameron blinked. "Say?
For myself? What do you mean?"
A
snicker circled the council table. Young and old, these elected members seemed
to be amused at Cameron's question. Their amusement had a sinister overtone.
"We
have evidence," the chairman explained, "which points to you as the
person who gave information to the outlaws and co-operated with them in
confiscating vital materials. Secondarily, you are indicated as the person who
killed two useful citizens of Plastic Prime."
Cameron's jaw dropped.
"But my report—"
"Has
been examined, and the scene investigated. What did you do with the
bodies?"
"They—exploded. I
described it."
"Josh Cameron," the chairman said
earnestly, "I must warn you that you are in a precarious position. The
fantastic tale you spun only does you harm. We want the truth before we reach a
decision." He held a thin hand palm outward. "Not that we shall not
lodge a criticism. That has been decided. But the exact type of criticism will
be determined by your defense."
"But
you have the truth 1" Cameron protested. "I wrote it out in
detail."
266 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
Their laughter was hearty, but not gay. It
cackled at him, sharply.
"Captain
Jorgeson's last notation on his log," the chairman said, "was
'Cameron ordered me down.' That shows you were in collusion with the outlaws.
What did you do with the bodies ? If Captain Jorgeson and the pilot were taken
captive, tell us. That would be believable, and would effect our
criticism."
Cameron's jaw set. "I'm the chief of
police. I have the interests of this Center at heart. Look at my record. Would
I invent some tale? Have you any previous indication of disloyalty? You have
not. I'm telling the truth."
"It is our opinion that you are
lying."
"But why? Why? What
could I gain?"
"That is what you will tell us."
"Listen,"
Cameron said. "On my honor I'm telling the truth. If I had been in
collusion with the outlaws I wouldn't have come back. I'd have known you
wouldn't believe me. But now you must. The whole thing happened as I said in my
report. They have that weapon. You must believe me."
"As
you describe the outlaw," the chairman said, "he appears to be a man
of education and intelligence. Now, we know what the outlaws are. You can't
expect us to accept the idealized portrait you drew."
"How
about the women we've stolen?" Cameron demanded. "Are they brutish,
moronic, giantesses? Do they look as if they eat their young?"
"We
have no personal data on these women," the chairman said with dignity.
"We do not habituate places in which they are said to be employed."
"You should!" Cameron snapped. He
stamped out. At the door, he turned. He didn't say anything. He glared
contemptuously for a moment before he went away.
Josh Cameron, ordinary citizen.
He
was still Chief Cameron when he answered the summons at his apartment door, but
when the heavy features of Captain Robert Fane filled the identity screen, he
knew. He didn't see the accompanying soldiers, but he knew.
He
twisted his mouth in bitter realization and touched the door control. Fane and
his detail stepped inside, hands on their Payne coag-ulators.
"I am happy to see you," Cameron
said. "May I be of service?"
OVERTHROW 267
Captain
Fane mushed the formal answer. "Yourofferiskindand-reciprocated." His
blocky face set. "Where are the uniforms, guns and other properties of
Plastic Center?" He threw a bundle at Cameron's feet. "There are
your new clothes. I want what you are wear-ing."
Cameron
touched a button in the master panel and the walls slid up from his clothes
closet and arsenal. "All right," he said. "Have at it."
Fane purpled, jerked out his side arm. He
leveled it at Cameron, who flinched in astonished alarm, then lowered it. His
heavy face did not relax, but his words had a touch of informality.
"The next time you do not pay proper
respect to your betters you will probably die."
Cameron
bowed his head. It was hard, for he had not known this status before. He had
been typed as an official at birth and had received homage all his life. He
knew how to behave as an ordinary citizen, but the knowledge was intellectual,
not instinctive. With effort, then, he bowed as befitted him.
"You are kind," he said. "My
conduct was inexcusable, but I crave leniency. My new station is unfamiliar as
yet."
"You won't get a second chance,"
Fane snapped. "Enough of this chatter—off with your clothes!"
While the soldiers gathered up his emblems of
office and social rating, Cameron shucked out of his fine, soft garments of
blue Nolyn and into Textile Center's standard product. When he was dressed, he
waited.
He waited without resentment, eyes downcast.
Without question, without objection as the soldiers cleared his wall tables. A
pang of regret tore at him when they bundled his precious reading tapes and
tossed them on the heap. But he said nothing.
Humility
clothed him, all right, but a plan formed slowly in his head. He knew that a
few days' grace were his while the military court decided on the niche he
should fill in industry. The court had acted immediately on the criticism of
the council—that was automatic. But judicial machinery ground slowly, and
freedom of action—within established limits—would be his while they checked
his aptitude and intelligence ratings and co-ordinated these with labor-type
needs.
If
he could run the spy to earth, the person who had notified the outlaws of that
precious shipment of Baltex, and hale him before the council—he might be Chief
Josh Cameron again.
268 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
So he bowed his head and listened with one
ear to anticipated instructions. "You will be notified, Cameron, as to
your job. In the meantime you know the restrictions on persons in your
position. You will not attempt to leave Plastic Prime. You will not spend any
money. You will not engage in any remunerative activity. The penalty, as you
well know, is death."
Cameron
did not raise his eyes when they left. He maintained his attitude of respect
even after they had long since gone, but his brows furrowed in concentration.
He
itemized in his mind the persons who might have known of Fleetfin's schedule and cargo. They amounted to a bare
half dozen, and among them, he was convinced, was the traitor.
He
could start his investigation at the top with Martin Grueter, or at the bottom
with Loren Bradley. It would not occur to Captain Robert Fane that he would
break parole. A clerk might, if reduced to ordinary citizen; a taxi driver
might. But not an official who knew too well the ruthless aftermath of
disobedience. This, Cameron thought, would be Fane's attitude. It would have
been his own.
More
than likely, then, he wouldn't be watched. He certainly wouldn't be reported by
those on whom he proposed to call. They would automatically assume that he had
permission.
He
grinned faintly and punched a taxi summons. Then he went up on the roof and
waited by the landing area until a small plane slipped out of the lower traffic
lane.
"Hump yourself!"
the driver snapped. "I ain't got all day."
Cameron
whipped a hand to his hip, but grinned wryly as he touched rough brown cloth
instead of the hard plastic of a coagulator.
"Sorry,"
he said, and jumped in before the driver could change his mind and dart away,
"Take me to Factory 6," he
ordered.
The
driver did a slow burn. He turned, with sinister deliberation, a fact twisted
by controlled fury. " 'Take me to Factory 6!'" he mimicked savagely. "And does your excellency want me to
wait? Just who do you think you are, scum? You deadheads gimme a oscillatin'
ache. Sign this!"
He shoved a record pad at Cameron. Cameron
scrawled a signature with the stylus. "You get paid for carrying me. Why
all the screams?"
"It's your airs I don't like, scum.
You'd think you was—" The driver broke off, screwed his face into an
expression of half recognition. "Say. I've seen you before. You—"
His expression altered to
OVERTHROW 269
one
of glee, with teeth. "Well, well! If it ain't the chief! Yessir, and will
the boys love this! My, my! Demoted an' everything. A lot of people are going
to dance tonight."
Cameron's
dark face froze. He expected to be flicked on the raw to a certain extent, but
there were limits. He said coldly, "I'll remember that when I get my
uniform back."
The
driver, in his turn, froze. Such a feat as Cameron predicted was rare, but not
unknown. As everybody knew, a number of flat-mouthed taunters of similar
unfortunates had been forced to eat their words—and found them fatally
indigestible.
Yet
it was not fear alone that flickered behind the hard surface of his eyes. There
was surliness and smoldering hatred. Cops shoved you around. Cops told you when
to go home. Cops commandeered your taxi if they felt like it. They were worse
than soldiers, being underlings of the military.
The driver turned away, touched the drive,
bank, and left keys on his panel and slipped into the local traffic flow. He
cut out of the stream over Factory 6, drifted into the gleaming landing area
and watched without comment as Cameron took a descending ramp into the squat
building.
As
Cameron had thought, he attracted no nodce. Others in civilian-brown,
clerk-gray, police-blue, military-red, and executive-purple looked through him
as they went about their appointed tasks. They didn't see him.
He
stood on the identification plate of Martin Grueter's office until the hearty
voice boomed: "Son of an artist, look who's here!" and the door slid
up.
Grueter
was in the middle of a conference with underlings in gray and purple, but
Cameron's entrance disrupted the business at hand. All faces turned smiling
toward the door.
The smiles, one after
another, became fixed, then faded.
"I
am happy to—" the white-headed Grueter began. He broke off as he noted
Cameron's costume. His kind mouth set, his eyes steadied, hardened.
"Get out of
here," he said quietly.
Cameron's
eyes touched on each member of the group and found no friendliness. Not even in
Ann Willis, whom he knew well.
Her
eyes, the same purple as her brief tunic, were as hard as Grueter's, who
repeated, still quiedy:
"Get out of
here."
27O JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"Listen
to me, Martin," Cameron said quickly. "Fve been discharged on false
evidence. You can help. I've got to—" "Get out of here."
"Somebody tipped off the—" "Get—OUT!"
The
eyes had changed, subtly. Cameron understood. They had tolerated his entrance
because of past relations. From their viewpoint the amenities had been
observed. Any further intrusion from him and one of them would kill him.
He bowed his head. "I crave leniency. An
error."
He backed out into the corridor and the door
slid shut.
He
stood thoughtful while the stream of workers and officials flowed around him,
trying to decide on his next move. He felt no blame for Grueter or Ann. With
others present they dared not show him more courtesy than they would any other
citizen. The social gap must be maintained.
But if he caught one of them alone—
He
walked down a short corridor, around a right-angled turn, to Ann Willis'
office. He could wait, unobserved.
He
stood at the window, as if watching the movement of planes on the loading field
below was his assignment. Among these was Fleetfin, into which brown-clad men and women lugged
small square crates. Cameron wondered if this was another shipment of Baltex;
wondered, too, what Baltex might be and why it was so expensive.
Only
a few crates were shipped to Power Center each month, and paid for more public
and official planes than in any of the other Centers. A few of the factories
in Textile Center, for example, were always taxed to capacity, turning out the
tithe to Power. Textile Center traffic, according to espionage reports, was
three point two per cent below Plasdc. Food and Luxury Centers averaged
slightly more, but they worked twenty-four hours a day.
What
was the precious stuff, then, and what did Power Center do with it? Oh, well,
it was their secret, and none had divined it—unless the outlaws knew.
The
outlaws knew a great deal, as Cameron was beginning to suspect. He had not
bothered his head particularly about them before— that was out of his province.
As long as they stayed in the unmapped areas between Centers, and as long as
they did not encroach upon his personal comforts, he regarded them much as
everyone else—unlet-
OVERTHROW 271
tered
savages living like beasts. But he had never really believed in the stories of
cannibalism.
After his unfortunate meeting with the dark
stranger, though, thoughts of the outlaws had busied his mind to a considerable
degree. The man was not savage, illiterate, brutal, cannibalistic. He did not
fit at all into descriptions circulated by the Bureau of Information.
For
the first time in his life, Cameron felt uneasy as he considered the eternal
verities he had been taught since he entered School for Officials. The feeling
was not one of doubt—not yet. He was simply uneasy as shadowy questions
swirlfcd unformed in his head.
Was
the man an outlaw? Was he from some other Center, pirating the most valuable
product in the United States? It seemed unlikely, for he had laid down an
ultimatum. No more women for Luxury Center.
In addition, the weapon he had used pointed
to his being an outlaw, for if any other Center possessed that secret it would
soon rule the others as Power Center had ruled before the collapse of Jorg
Duvain's dictatorship.
Cameron
flushed with anger as he thought of that invisible—and apparently
invincible—screen. He must look into that. At his leisure if he could produce
the spy who, he felt certain, was in this factory. If he failed in this he must
produce proof of the weapon in order to vindicate himself before the council.
Cameron stood for almost an hour at the
window. Orderly confusion on the loading field held half his attention. The
other half was on the corridor.
When he heard footsteps he half turned so as
to see whoever came around the corner and at the same time seem vigilant on his
extemporaneous self-assignment. They came briskly clicking along the Neo-plast
floor, and brought slim-legged Ann Willis into view. Cameron turned full toward
her then and waited.
When she recognized him she halted,
frozen-eyed. Her pose, Cameron thought, was not indicative of displeasure—she
listened, rather. She held herself tense and still for a full five seconds
before she allowed her lips to relax.
"You're being foolish," she said
softly. "But come in."
He followed her inside and took a chair at
her invitation. He waited for a formal greeting and was somewhat surprised when
she plunged briskly into conversation. True, he was an ordinary citizen,
272 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
in
brown, but she knew better. She knew he had worn police-blue all his life.
"What do you want?" she asked
curdy.
Cameron
told her. "There is a spy somewhere close to the top here. He has cost me
my job. I have, as you know, a day or two at least in which to find him. I want
to know who knew of Fleetfin's
schedule and cargo. One of
the names on that list will be a spy."
"How many names do you know?" she
asked.
"Four.
Grueter, Captain Jorgeson, the pilot, myself. There must be others. Fm not the
spy, Jorgeson and the pilot died in defense of the cargo, and I hardly think
Grueter would fit."
"What was the cargo?"
Cameron's
eyes narrowed. "Don't you know?" he asked, astonished.
"Fm not in traffic"
"Then I don't know who else."
She was quiet, tapping coral nails on her
desk. Her eyes turned a deeper purple with thought. Presently, she looked at
him for a long time.
"You were tried," she said,
"and found guilty." Cameron snorted. "TriedI I was informed that I'd been found guilty."
She shrugged this away. "You have broken
your parole." "But it won't matter if I can prove my innocence. You
know that."
"I know that you have been found guilty
by a legal court. I know that it is my duty to report you."
Cameron's jaw dropped. "What's got into
you, Ann? We were friends. You know you'd be sending me to my death."
Her
gaze did not waver, her mouth did not relax. She continued to tap the shining
desk top.
"I am first of all a loyal citizen of
Plastic Prime. Whatever threatens it in any way is dangerous, from my
viewpoint. You've broken rules of behavior."
"But they won't even ask questions if a
report comes from youl I'll be dead in three seconds."
"As you should be."
As Ann Willis reached for her phone, Cameron acted
instinctively. With one hand he slapped her fingers from the instrument and
with the other, even as she reached for her coagulator, he hit her on the chin.
OVERTHROW 273
All
his strength, backed by the momentum of his leap, went into the blow, and she
dropped to the floor.
He
stripped off her side arm then examined her for life. He found that he had not
broken her neck as he had thought at first. And he knew that he should have.
He
stood, looking down at her lithe slenderness. Alive, she was his own death
warrant. Therefore, she should die. He picked up the coagulator.
He
didn't point it. He knew that he would not. He knew, in a surge of
self-contempt, that he could not. Some atavistic reversion, no doubt, and all
the more contemptible for that. His contemplation of the girl was not
aesthetic. He wasted no appreciation of her curves. He felt only that he was a
fool.
If
he didn't kill her he should have to run for it. Where ? He could hide in
Luxury Center for a while, but nowhere else. As soon as she recovered she would
send Josh Cameron's personal data to all Centers, but authorities in Luxury
were lax. They'd make a half-hearted search in the tourist spots and then wait
for him to show himself.
He
told himself that she must be killed or his own life was forfeit. He told
himself this several times. Yet he did not move his arm, did not aim the
weapon.
No,
he was going to let her live, and eventually bring him to death. For, even
though a trip to Luxury, provided he could get out of Plastic, would offer
brief respite, he could not find the spy. The spy was here, and without an ally
on the ground Cameron could not run him to earth. He could have no ally. He,
ordinary citizen, had struck the purple uniform. All hands were now against
him.
With
some despair and hopelessness he began to search the office for a disguise. In
her closet hung several of her own outfits, but he could wear none of these.
Not that he couldn't masquerade as a woman—though rather flat-chested; he could
do it, but not in these costumes. For any woman with knees like his would wear
a long tunic. Let him appear in public as a female with these knobs exposed and
even a child would know something was wrong.
One
course was open. It was one of desperation, but he could not pick and choose.
He searched her desk, found a small scissors, and cut a purple star from her
skirt. He pinned this to the belt of his shorts and slung the coagulator on his
hip. He was a reasonable facsimile of an executive messenger, and the weapon
gave authority to the disguise.
He took her purple pass from her tunic
pocket, stowed it in one of
274 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
his
own. Then he tied and gagged Ann Willis. He was careful about this. He needed
about thirty minutes to catch the next passenger plane. After he was aboard, it
mattered little when she was free and conscious. When the alarm went out they
would go first to his own apartment. By the time they had checked the ports he
should be lost in the pleasure-seekers of Luxury Center. So he tied her well.
When the plane had been clear of Plastic
Center's shield for an hour, Cameron had examined each of the passengers and
was satisfied that he was free of suspicion. A few eyes had looked at him with
interest, but when they touched on his makeshift star and coagulator, they had
become blank with acceptance of things ordinary.
One
pair only shifted back to him now and then, but these were red-rimmed from
caltra, and Cameron felt sympathy for their twisted owner—if he felt anything.
The young man wore the honorary purple of those who had not been warned in time
that the drug was not harmless, as advertised, and Cameron attached no
importance to the glances directed at him. Caltra victims did strange things.
His
complacence was shattered somewhat when the young man staggered along the aisle
to the empty seat beside Cameron and fell into it. Cameron's desire to be left
alone was passive, but it shrieked along jittery nerves. Yet he controlled
himself, took his cue.
"I
am happy to see you," he said respectfully. "May I offer my
service?"
The
young man clipped out the formal reply. Then, "Been watching you,"
he said.
Cameron's dark face remained placid.
"Yes?" "You want a job?"
Cameron examined the red-rimmed eyes for
signs of double meanings. Then he touched his purple star. "I have a
job."
The
young man shrugged this away. "Delivering a message isn't a career. I'll
fix it so I can hire you. I'll pay you in money, not credits."
Cameron
murmured, "You tempt me," and began a tale of fanciful reasons why he
was not free to take any employment from a private source while he concentrated
on this unexpected situation. With an eye on the Sierras, over which they were
flying westward, he spun a smooth tale of his own importance in the scheme of
things.
His private thought had a tone of
hopelessness. If this young man
overthrow 275
were determined to hire him, for whatever
purpose, Cameron could not stall beyond a certain point. He could not prevent
inquiries, not in civilian brown. And he could not allow inquiries—and live.
The
young man interrupted his tale. "Don't be a fool! Any halfwit can replace
you. I like your looks and can pay more than your job pays. What's your name,
and who employs you?"
Cameron
touched his star again. "I claim secrecy."
The
young man bowed. "That is your privilege. But what is your name?"
"Jay—Cameron."
"J
for what? John?"
"Jay.
J-a-y."
"All
right, Jay Cameron. What are you paid?" Cameron named a reasonable sum.
"I'll double it," the young man said. "For what? What would I
do?"
"Help
me. Accompany me. Protect me, if necessary. I am headed for dangerous
territory."
Cameron
raised his eyebrows. The young man leaned near and whispered, "I'm going
into outlaw country."
Cameron
shook his head. "I don't want to be disenfranchised. I'm a loyal
citizen."
This was the normal reaction, and his
companion seemed to find it so. "Sure, sure," he said impatiently.
"So am I. But I'm also a man, and I don't like my physical condition. It
happened through no fault of mine. I was told caltra was
non-habit-forming—which is true—and that it was harmless—which was a foul
lie."
"But
Food Center didn't know that," Cameron pointed out, "when they
offered it as a substitute for morphine."
"The
effect was the same—on me. I'm not sore at anybody. I just want to be
cured."
"But
there is no cure. The effects are permanent."
The young man smiled. "I saw a case—
Never mind. I'll tell you when you're
working for me. What do you say?"
Cameron
saw a way out. "I'm going to Luxury," he said, "on business.
After I've finished I can talk to you."
"Good!
I'll meet you at . . . oh, you name it."
"Rosie's?"
"On the canal side? Right. My name, by
the way, is Harvey Willis. Plastic Prime."
276 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
Cameron
shriveled a little. Willis. Plasdc Prime. Intellectually, he felt certain that
Ann Willis and this twisted wreck had nothing but the accident of name in
common. But the emotional shock, since he had violated her purple sanctity a
short hour before, almost destroyed his composure. He was quiet for a few
moment until his hands relaxed.
Not
only, he reflected, would he not meet this man in Rosie's, but he would also
throw a scare into him, make him wish to forget Josh Cameron.
"It is my duty to report you, Mr.
Willis. You're planning a violation of the law."
Willis smiled tolerantly. "They wouldn't
do anything to me. I'm a caltra victim. You know that I'm immune. But aside
from ethical considerations, Cameron, let me ask you something. Are you colorblind?"
Cameron's jaw dropped. "Huh?"
"You've
probably forgotten an important fact," Willis went on obscurely.
"That fact is the varied effect of caltra. It does strange things to its
victims. It has made me superhumanly sensitive to gradations in color. And
so—" He leaned nearer and whispered, "I know that your messenger's
star is a phony."
Cameron's face didn't move.
"Your
complexion," Willis went on pleasantly, "is a trifle whiter. I tell
you honestly, Cameron, I can read these signs. I don't need to be a psychologist.
You're scared. You know, of course, that it is my duty to report you"
"Go ahead."
Willis screwed up his face. "Your tone
sounds all right to me. If I were blind I'd say I'd made a mistake. But there's
an additional whiteness. You see, my approach was not impulsive. I didn't pick
you without a great deal of thought. First of all, I noticed the star. It's
almost the same shade as the bona fide, but not quite. So I knew you were
disguised. Now anyone wearing brown who will take such a desperate measure is
not only in trouble, but he has initiative and courage. I may have need of
those qualities. And you can't refuse me, Cameron. A word from me and you'll be
held at the landing port."
"But you took caltra,
and are, therefore, crazy."
"True.
But they will investigate you, nonetheless, with many apologies. 'Merely
routine,' they will say. 'We hope you won't hold it against us, because you are
an executive messenger on a mission of importance?' Can you stand
investigation, Cameron?"
OVERTHROW 277
Cameron
smiled wryly, "Caltra didn't impair your argumentative faculdes. At
Rosie's, then?"
"I
think," Willis said, "we'd better not separate. You aren't on an
executive mission, or any other kind. If you get away from me I may never see
you again, I could get someone else at Luxury, of course, but I'd rather have
you, for reasons I've stated,"
Cameron
frowned. "You put me in a bad position. If you should be right—assume it
for the sake of argument—and I admit it, you have a hold over me which might cost me my life. If I deny it you'll cause me
to be held up, and maybe cost me my job. You'll interfere with my mission, in
any event."
Willis shrugged. "You
must make the choice."
Cameron
brooded out the window. They had left the Sierras behind and in a few moments
would arrive at the canal-striped city, Luxury Prime. Before that time he must
come to a decision. Not a decision on his course of action, for Willis had
him. He must string along.
No, he had no choice there. What he needed
now was a story, one that would salvage something of independence and
self-respect. He considered plausible lies. He could say, for example, that the
circumstances which Willis had created forced him to accede to the young man's
demands. If he were held for investigation, his mission would be unsuccessful
and he would lose his job. Therefore, he would be better off to grab Willis'
offer and thus save a means of livelihood. No, that was weak.
He
turned to Willis. He had a story now. "I'll have to trust you."
Willis made a gesture. "That's up to you." He seemed amused.
"No," Cameron said. "I must. Will you swear by the purple to
treat it confidentially?" "Surely. I swear."
"Then lean closer. I must whisper."
He did so. "I am not an executive messenger. You were quite right. Nor am
I a civilian. I have a right to wear another color. I am on a highly
secret errand, and as long as your route coincides with mine I'll go with
you."
"Why,"
Willis asked, "the artificial star? If you're on official business you
could get the real thing."
"And
fill out an application for anybody to see?" Cameron smiled. "Not
much. Only one other person knows what I'm about. You're the third."
Willis was apparendy convinced. Cameron had
no way of knowing
278 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
the
mental reservations the young man made. He had to accept Willis' vows of
secrecy, his protestations of belief, his offers of assistance.
He watched Willis stagger back to his seat
with the peculiar gait of the caltra victim and tried to still the uneasiness
which threatened to engulf him.
Red was the hue of hunting. The military were
after somebody and Cameron thought he knew the name. Though he had been bitter,
upon arrival at Luxury, at the liaison he was unable to avoid, he soon had
reason to bless it.
For the pleasure palaces were no sooner
lighted and opened for the evening than red uniforms added their sinister note
to the general gaiety. Alone, Cameron reflected, he should have been
questioned. But he was employed and his employer could answer questions.
Chief
among his blessings, then, were the ravages of caltra upon Harvey Willis.
Nobody bothered to question. If he wanted a valet— and Cameron became obviously
that—they assumed he had the permission of authority. Additionally, the
general attitude toward caltra sufferers imparted a certain immunity to
formality. The guy must be nuts. No telling what he'd say.
So the search swirled and eddied around
Cameron. At the gaming tables, where Willis won a tidy sum on a Galactic Wheel;
on the canals, where their power canoe was unmolested; at Rosie's and similar
houses, where their badinage with former outlaw girls was uninterrupted.
The
soldiers gave them casual glances—and passed on. Cameron ached to question one,
to learn if the net was out in all Centers for him, if Ann Willis had spread
the word, if he were to be killed on sight. He was morally certain that such
was the case, and shrank inwardly each time a military eye raked him. His star
and weapon he had discarded upon arrival. They would be the focal point of the
search. He had thrown the star away and hidden the coagulator under his shirt.
He
strove with all his faculties to maintain the appearance of a hired companion
to Willis on a pleasure tour of the spots. He steadied the young man as they roved
about this hall or that; he helped him into hired canoes when they moved on to
another; he held their pace down to the leisured movement of Luxury Center, so
snaillike in comparison to other Centers.
Here,
efficiency was subordinated to enjoyment. In Luxury Prime, all business was
directed toward comfort of visitors. Proprietors bowed
OVERTHROW 279
and
pleasantly relieved gamblers of their vacation funds. Canoe chauffeurs were
vocal upon the beauties of their environment. Girls in the licensed houses were
gentle, intelligent, and as willing to argue economic, astronomical or
mathematical problems as to engage in any other pastime.
Nothing was allowed to mar the periodical
visits of customers. Here were no actors, artists, or other social nonentities.
They were segregated in subsidiary communities. From Luxury i emanated all
stereocasts; Luxury 2 produced such sculpture as this or that
Center required; and so on. Those who were doomed to a life of artistic endeavor
kept their places. They did not mingle even with ordinary citizens.
Nothing, then, should have prevented Cameron
from enjoying himself, once he was satisfied that the military was apparently
not suspicious of him. But Harvey Willis worried him. Drifting with seeming
aimlessness from place to place, the young man led them gradually toward a
section not frequented by tourists. This was a district of small private bars,
designed for the army of workers and officials who lived in Luxury Prime.
Not that one was ever cautioned not to enter
its environs. No, one was allowed to enter all right. And having entered, was
tolerated. Nobody contributed to the casual visitor's entertainment. He could
buy a drink and drink it alone. Nobody was interested in how much money he
spent.
"We
don't belong down here," Cameron said as he helped Willis from a canoe to
a gloomy sidewalk.
Willis
expressed surprise. "Why not? The places are open for business."
Cameron explained.
"I have special privileges," Willis
said lightly. "I don't imagine there'll be a row. Besides, I have to
arrange my journey down here."
Cameron
pulled the young man to a halt. "Look here, Fd like to know what's up. If
I'm to be involved I'd like to know in what."
"I
told you," Willis said softly, "I'm going into outlaw country— to be
cured."
"But
that's impossible. I'm sorry but it is. You're due to be duped."
"I
know the popular theory," Willis said impatiently. "But there's a
doctor, an outlaw, who has figured out a cure."
280 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"Outlaws," Cameron scoffed,
"know nothing of medicine. Besides, he could get amnesty if he had
something like that. He could move right into Food Center's medical
department."
Willis
motioned toward a small bar, dimly lighted, and Cameron helped him to the door.
"Has it ever occurred to you," Willis asked as they approached,
"that he might not want to
go back?"
"God, no!"
The bar was deserted save for a rotund
barkeep with a laughter-scarred face and a paunch. He and Willis went through
an elaborate ritual of greeting before the two men sat at a small table. The
bartender wiped its spodess plastic top with an immaculate cloth and said:
"Gentlemen, I know you're visitors, but
I like the set of you. Tell you what. I'm the only bar owner in the country
with a little Scotch. Would you like a drink of it?"
Cameron
had heard of the liquor from his grandfather, who had boasted that the Camerons
had once made it, so long ago in Scotland that the date was forgotten. His dark
face lighted with remembered excitement.
Willis
likewise signified his acceptance, and two small glasses of amber liquid
presently sat before them, each ringed with a necklace of tiny bubbles. Cameron
sipped.
"Tastes like
smoke."
Willis closed his red-rimmed eyes after a
taste. "That, friend Cameron, is a drink with character. It's warplanes
slipping grimly through the night, it's a storm with sand in its teeth, it's a
pardon from the High Court. I like."
The liquid was filled with an intimate flame,
warming Cameron's stomach. He relaxed and seemed to view with great clarity his
own situation. He tossed the remainder into his throat and looked at Willis
with determination.
"I'm a coward," he announced.
"I'm running away. Me, a Cameron. I'm not running any longer, though. I'm
going back."
"To what?" Willis
asked sardonically. "I'll tell you. Death."
Cameron
flung up his head, nostrils flaring. "I can take 'em on, one at a time, or
all together. I'll use strategy, cunning, and finesse. I'll expose the spy.
I'll prove I had nothing to do with the dirty outlaws. They can't do this to
me! Then, when I'm chief again, I'll deal with the outlaws. You'll see,
you'll—"
OVERTHROW 28l
He slumped forward on the table and the
bartender came across the room.
"You haven't killed
him?" Willis asked.
The
bartender's paunch jiggled and his big face creased along worn lines. He
chuckled.
"Lord, no! He'll have a head big as a
pylon dome when he comes to, but he'll live."
"What did you give him, for heavens'
sake ? It took him almost as quickly as a coagulator. Speaking of which—"
Willis took Cameron's
weapon, questioning eyes on the bartender.
"A
long time ago, Mr. Willis, it was called a Mickey Finn. People used to drink
'em." He shook his head sadly. "Those must have been the good old
days, when men were really men."
"Is everything all
set?"
"The boys ought to be here in a couple
of minutes. You did all right, Mr. Willis. Pier is going to be pleased."
Willis shrugged. "Did Ann call in?"
4<Yup.
I wrote down the Shield combination. Says she's got a sore jaw. He must've
slugged her."
"I
don't know. She called me at the last minute, said to take the Luxury plane and
capture Cameron. What were all the soldiers doing tonight?"
"Rumor
that Pier's in town, I guess. We get 'em every few days. A couple were in here.
Gave me six credits to tip them off before anybody else."
They
were still chuckling when a quartet of men came in silently from the rear. With
quiet, unhurried efficiency, they carried Cameron away. They accommodated their
pace to Willis until they reached a large power canoe. They piloted this at
normal speed along the canal to a dark, deserted stretch. Here they hid the
canoe and carried Cameron across a field to a long, rakish craft which was
rising slowly from an underground hangar.
When
Cameron opened his eyes, some time later, one fact registered before vast
aches and pains invaded his consciousness. The face of the pilot was that of
the dark stranger who had robbed Fleetfin of
her precious Baltex.
Somewhere in the Pacific. That was all
Cameron knew about the island to which they took him.
282 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
It was broad and long and green. He could see
all this as they circled high above it at dawn of the following morning. It was
apparently deserted. Bright-green vistas, craggy brown hills and curved white
beaches met his eye through the observation port of the outlaw craft.
That
was all he knew, aside from the fact that the dark lean pilot was Pier Duvain,
outlaw chieftain, and that Harvey Willis was also a personage among the
outlaws. They told him nothing except to be quiet.
He
found this command easy to obey for his head was filled with pain and each
movement brought a myriad stabs to his joints. Even thinking was agony.
So
he took what restless slumber came his way, and in the foggy dawn looked down
on the island. Were they going to drop him there, with no company save its
native animals and insects? If so, why? What was he to them ?
The
lean plane knifed through the fog toward thick green trees and settled to earth
in a small clearing. From the sides of this men came running with armloads of
greenery, and before Cameron was ordered to disembark the craft was covered
with an effective screen of leaves. From above it was surely undetectable.
He
was escorted without comment into the forest, expecting anything but what he
saw.
For
here was a modern city, modeled along the lines of those Cameron had know all
his life, yet with subtle differences. The buildings were designed to blend
into their surroundings and were protectively colored. The streets followed
the natural contours of slopes and valleys, and looked like swaths of
vegetation.
The
principal difference was a feel of
camaraderie. Hundreds of persons were abroad, even at this early hour, and they
looked at you. That was the keynote—their eyes met yours. They didn't glance
furtively at your costume, ready to salute if necessary, and quickly away.
Their eyes were full of candor.
They spoke, too, in casual
greeting. They said, "Hello."
"Hello,
Pier," they called to the outlaw chief. And, "Hey, Harvey," to
Willis. "Haven't seen you in a long time."
Nor
did these people look brutal, or barbarous, as Cameron would have expected.
They were like anybody else save for their spirit of banter and their proud
glances.
OVERTHROW 283
Cameron was still with wonder and a
reorganization of conditioned ideas. He had been taught thus and so about the
outlaws; what he saw did not confirm the teaching. He was confused and went
quietly with his escort.
They
led him into a long low building with opaque plastic walls, down a corridor
bright with synthetic sunlight to a room which was built around a council
table. It was obvious that this room played an important part in outlaw
affairs, and Cameron studied it.
He
had seen its counterpart, generally speaking, in all the Centers. His own
office had been so constructed. But there were differences here, too, as there
were in the people. This plastic had never come from Plastic Center; nor the
floor covering from Textile; nor was the lighting characteristic of Power's
product.
Pier
Duvain dismissed the two crew members who had accompanied them, waved Cameron
and Willis to chairs, and sat across the polished table. His dark eyes held
surface amusement, but fires glowed deeply, and his tone was not as casual as
his words.
"I suppose you'd like
to ask some questions."
Cameron twisted his mouth.
"Fat lot of good it would probably
do."
"Oh,
yes," Duvain said. "You'll get answers. Correct, too. We'll be glad
to tell you anything."
Cameron
leaned forward. "All right. I'll ask you a question. What are you
intending to do with me?"
Duvain's
eyes were steady, unblinking, though not unpleasant. "That depends on you,
and is not a subject to concern us yet."
"Depends on me?
How?"
"We won't discuss it. Anything else,
however, I'm willing to talk about for—" He glanced at a wall clock.
"For twenty minutes." "Where are we?" Cameron asked.
"On an island in the Pacific."
"I
could see that." Cameron's voice rose. "You'll tell me everything,
you say. So I ask about what most concerns me, and you tell me nothing. Suppose
I don't ask questions. Suppose I just listen."
Harvey
Willis turned red-rimmed eyes and a conciliatory smile on Cameron. "Now,
now, friend, no need to get worked up."
"You and your outlaw
doctor!" Cameron grated.
Willis
shrugged. "I had to tell you something. That was as good as anything
else."
284 JOURNEY
TO INFINITY
"There isn't any doctor?"
Willis
hesitated. "I wouldn't say that, exactly. Let's say, rather, that he has
not been successful as yet."
His
captors were silent while Cameron frowned at his folded hands. They waited,
courteous but at ease, as if he were an honored guest. Presently he raised his
eyes to Duvain's.
"Look
here, I'm confused. This seems to be more than a matter of accident or
coincidence. For some reason you intercepted me and brought me here. Why
me?"
"We
need men like you, Josh Cameron. You have qualities of leadership. If you have
other qualities as well, you can be of assistance."
"In what?"
"In
overthrowing the master-slave system in the Centers. In making all men
equal."
"You're insane!"
Cameron said.
"Do you really believe
that, Cameron? Truly?"
Cameron
studied the dark lean face. He remembered his first impression as Duvain came
toward Fleetfin
from his own plane; remembered
the vitality, the arrogance, the self-assurance. These characteristics were
more pronounced here at close range and were subordinate to some calm
determination that radiated from steady eyes. Insane? Surely not.
"Well,"
Cameron hedged, "what else would you call such a proposition?"
"You could call it
fair. You could call it just."
Cameron
vented a short explosive sound of derision. "You sound like • . . when was
it? . . . the eighteenth, twenty-first, or some other early century. All men
equal! Fat chance!"
The outlaw wasjpleased.
"You know history?"
Cameron
remembered his pangs as Captain Robert Fane had confiscated his reading tapes.
He didn't mention them. "A little,'* he said.
"Good!
You won't have to go through elementary training then. You know that there was
a time when a man's costume, or badge, or whatever, did not rigidly limit him
to a certain social class. You remember?"
"They outgrew it,
though," Cameron replied.
"Didn't
they just!" Willis put in bitterly. "Look at me. I have a special
purple. So I'm useless—because of the uniform and not because of actual
disability. There are many productive jobs I could handle,
OVERTHROW 285
but
because I have this shade of uniform I'm barred from them. Look at you. You're
in civilian brown. Are you the same man you were?"
Cameron
frowned. "From the standpoint of the State, no. Fm not the same. I have no
authority any more."
"Are you the same
character, though? The same personality?"
"We-e-el,"
Cameron said. "I suppose so. Listen, I see where your argument is leading,
and I can't refute it on your grounds. But I still say it's wrong. We've been
going along pretty well for several hundred years in this way."
Willis
spread his twisted hands, palms upward, and shrugged his shoulders. "What
was good enough for father is good enough for you, eh? I can't argue with
stupidity."
Cameron
flushed, rose to his feet. "Quit patronizing me. Fm not a child, but I'm
not a half-crazy idealist, either. I don't subscribe to your theory. My primary
interest in you is what you're going to do with me. I'm your prisoner. Why do
you bother to argue ? I wouldn't if our positions were reversed."
"Sit
down, Cameron," Duvain said quietly. "I thought you were intelligent
enough to see the justice in our project. I still believe you are, but you'll
need to shed the master-slave conditioning first. We're not going to do
anything with you. You're at liberty."
Cameron remained on his
feet. "I can go back?"
"To
what?" Willis asked. "You'll be shot down for breaking parole."
He was right, Cameron
reflected. Unless—
"Yes,"
Cameron admitted, while a plan formed in his mind. If he were in a position to
bargain, if he could expose the outlaws, they wouldn't shoot him down. "I
suppose you're right," he said with pretended despair. "I can't go
back, I guess. Well, you say you want me to help overthrow the Centers. How do
you propose to go about it— and when?"
Duvain
and Willis looked steadily at each other. There was tension between them,
conflict. Friendly, yes, but deep and unyielding. Duvain's dark eyes were like
black plastic; Willis', blobs of blue, circled with red.
"We
have a difference of opinion," Duvain answered. "One faction
advocates violence, a quick thrust at the military. But another, headed by
myself, contends that we should merely substitute one evil with another in that
way. I have no definite plan to offer as yet, but I believe there is a way
aside from killing off the opposition."
286 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"Look at Cameron," Willis broke in.
"You can't educate him. Oh, in time you could, perhaps. But there are
millions like him. It would take forever."
Cameron was astonished.
"Who's the boss here, anyway?"
"I
am nominally the president," Duvain answered. "But each member of our
organization has an equal vote."
"That's
appalling!" Cameron exclaimed. "You'll never accomplish anything.
What kind of business do you call that?"
"We call it Democracy,
Cameron."
"Rubbish,"
Cameron said. "Democracy is what we operate under in the Centers."
Both Willis and Duvain
loosed explosive laughter.
"We
have a United States Congress, don't we?" Cameron said. "We have a
council in each Center, don't we? They're elected by the people."
Duvain
rose, a friendly smile on his dark face. "I wish I had time at the moment
to argue the point, but I haven't. I hesitate to leave you with Harvey because
he'll convert you to his creed of violence. But—"
Cameron
interrupted heatedly. "Why will anybody necessarily convert.me to
anything? I'm an individual, the same as you. Aside from theories, though, I
don't believe you could conquer the Centers. You're not strong enough."
"I'll
set you straight on that right now," Duvain snapped. "Within twelve
hours we could be in absolute control of all Centers. We are strong enough.
This island is only our capital, so to speak. There are millions of us on the
mainland, nomadic tribes living between Centers. Oh, we could conquer, all
right."
"Then why don't
you?"
"We have a difference of opinion as to
procedure. But we're in no terrific rush. The Centers will still be there when
we're ready." "You can't break through their Shields."
"We
have. We do. We can." Duvain glanced at the clock again. "I must
go."
"I'd
like to ask one more question," Cameron said. "How do you get
through? How did you know about that shipment of Baltex?"
Duvain
smiled, flicking his eyes at Willis. "Harvey's sister knows about such
things."
"Ann
Willis?" Cameron exclaimed. "So she's the spy! No wonder she was
going to turn me over to the military. But how—"
"She wasn't,"
Willis cut in. "When she reached for the phone she
OVERTHROW 287
was
going to call me. But when you hit her she decided to play unconscious and
give you a chance to get away. You tied her almost too well. I barely made that
plane."
"But what if I'd gone somewhere
else?"
"We had the other ports covered."
Duvain
said impatiently, "Look around, Cameron. See how we live. I'll see you
tonight."
Cameron
looked at Harvey Willis after Duvain was gone. "Well? What do I do
now?"
Willis shrugged. "Whatever you
like."
Cameron
marveled a little at their indifference. In one of the Centers—in Plasdc for
example—he would not have been willing to let a prisoner wander. He thought
again that if the conditions were reversed—if he were the captor and Willis or
Duvain the captive— another death would have been recorded before this.
He
had this nebulous idea of escape. If, he reflected, he could expose Ann Willis,
he might get back his job. He needed more information than he had now, for it
would be his word against hers, and she was an executive. He needed proof of
that destructive screen which he had seen in action.
"So you're the head of the violent
faction?" he asked Willis.
Willis
apparently did not sense that Cameron was merely making conversation. He
treated the question seriously, clasping his hands in that odd manner
necessitated by their twisted condition.
"Yes,
but I admit that I may be wrong. Pier has a great deal on his side."
"Ah?"
"You, for example, friend Cameron."
Cameron frowned. "I don't get it."
Willis
smiled with faint amusement. "You don't see it? You were discharged,
according to the rules and regulations of our culture. But you rebelled."
"I rebelled? Against what?"
"The
master-slave set-up. You didn't take your medicine like a loyal citizen. You
set out to prove your innocence. To that degree, you rebelled against the
culture."
"But the charges were false!"
"Who
believes that, besides you? Haven't you seen others discharged when our
obsolete councils lodged a criticism against them? Haven't you accepted that
procedure as just?"
288 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"Yes, but—"
"But you're different, eh? And so you
are. You rebelled. You were an outlaw from the moment you decided to reinstate
yourself. You are an outlaw." Willis flared twisted
fingers as Cameron formed a hot protest. "Think it over, Cameron. Look
around. Go through our streets. Watch us. Then make up your mind."
The differences Cameron had noted upon
arrival—differences in attitude, architecture, and general feeling—between the
outlaw capital and any Center were more apparent as he walked leisurely along
the green streets which must look like grass from the air.
He
did not enter any of the low, chameleonlike buildings. From some of these came
sounds, as if those inside were manufacturing some article or another. Time to
look into that later. At the moment he was interested in the people.
They
wore a variety of dress, designed apparently to blend into the natural
environment. The patterns were not standard, nor were social classes
discernible as in the Centers. AH walked as equals.
Cameron
was distinctly uncomfortable in this unnatural absence of formality. When he
was greeted pleasantly by some stranger who walked and talked like an
executive, it was with effort that he restrained himself from saluting. He
wanted to get away from this place.
He
did so. He followed one of the streets paved with that strange substance as
hard and smooth as Textile Center's best, which curved along the base of a hill
and came to an abrupt end at the forest edge. A path slanted off from this
point and Cameron followed it into the quiet green gloom.
It
took him through thick trees and between walls of underbrush. As he walked he
pondered his situation. He was conscious of heavy odors and bird movements in
trees about him, and though these were strange and would have been exciting
under other conditions, he kept his eye on the rising path and pulled his brows
together in thought.
Pier
Duvain, he suddenly realized, was the answer to all his problems. If he could
turn the outlaw chief over to constituted authorities, Cameron might ask what
he wished of any Center. Pier Duvain was their big headache. Cure it, Cameron
reflected, and any job he liked was his.
Accomplishment of this project presented
difficulties, to be sure, but was all the more worth consideration. Cameron
doubted his ability to capture the outlaw and return him go the mainland, but
if he,
OVERTHROW 289
Cameron,
could escape by one means or another, he could lead authorities to this
island.
He
marched on, upward, oblivious of the occasional bird he flushed, or the
occasional rabbit that fled into the underbrush, until he reached the top of
the path. He stopped and caught his breath.
A
beach on the eastern side of the island shone in morning sunlight below him.
Moored to a pier, apparently unguarded, were several sleek water craft. Here
was a means of escape!
He stood motionless, examining the pier and
the boats for signs of life. He saw none, heard nothing but rustlings of the
forest, faint slap-slap
of waves against the plastic
pilings. He began the descent along the twisting path.
Every nerve was strained. He strove to detect
life aboard the craft, for it was incredible that they should be unguarded. He
sifted all sound that came to him, and though much of it fell strangely upon
his urban ears his instinct labeled it as strictly natural.
When
he stood at the bottom of the path he searched the curving beach and the hill
behind for watchers. Then he hailed the pier.
"Hello!" he
called. "Anybody home?"
His
shout cut off all bird cries, and an utter, weird stillness fell around him for
a few seconds. Then the normal sounds began again and Cameron decided to make a
run for the pier. If any unseen guard was behind him he might be able to make a
quick escape. If he encountered anyone on the boats or pier he would adapt his
actions to circumstances.
As he struck out through low bushes he
frightened a cottontail rabbit. The little animal streaked ahead of Cameron as
a shout rang out behind him.
"Stop!" a thin
voice cried.
Cameron plunged ahead. He saw the rabbit jump
erratically to one side, then back, and it seemed to him that it cried out in
terror as he rushed toward it. Then it leaped straight for the beach—and vanished
in a small but brilliant flash with a sharp crac\ like an explosion.
Cameron knew what had happened. He remembered
the screen of invisible death into which Captain Jorgeson and the pilot of Fleetfin had plunged. Here was another. He tried to
stop. He dug his heels in the slick grass. He slid. He threw himself to one
side and grabbed a small bush.
This
strained, pulled half out of the ground, but held. He sat up, heart pounding,
and saw that no more than a yard beyond his feet,
290 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
where
beach and vegetation met, was a line of shifting sand. Dancing grains, as if a
million tiny animals burrowed from below.
He
sat quietly, regaining his breath, but almost jumped out of his shorts as a
voice spoke in his ear.
"What's the matter,
sonny? Don't you like it here?"
She
was an old woman. Incredibly old, Cameron thought as he scanned her deeply
lined face. Yet her eyes were bright and she stood erect as a young tree. Her
legs were skinny but straight.
She
began to laugh. It was a high cackle and brought a flush to Cameron's cheeks.
She slapped her hip. She bent double.
"Never
saw anything," she gasped, "like you hanging on to that weed."
Cameron
rose with what dignity he could muster, brushed himself, and stepped back from
the mark which indicated that deadly screen.
"You're
Cameron, I suppose," she said. "Well, you're my prisoner." Her
wrinkled old face, which looked something like a pair of old civilian shorts,
lost its previous amusement. She laid a clawed brown hand on a weapon at her
belt. "I mean it," she said. "You're no use to us as long as
you're against us, so I won't mind killing you like . . . like that poor little
bunny. March up to my shack." She waved toward the forest edge, high on
the rim of the hill.
Cameron
obediently scanned the hillside. The old lady's tone had an edge to it. She
meant what she said. Or so Cameron felt, so strongly that he did not care to
gamble his life on the chance of her bluffing. He looked at the hill.
"I don't see any
shack."
"To the right of the path, about thirty
feet."
He saw it, then, cunningly blended into the
trees, and started toward it. She followed briskly, skinny legs which seemed
to rattle around in her shorts moving with the energy of youth.
"You can call me Gran," she said,
"like the others do. I'm Pier's grandmother, and you probably know about
me saving his father when Jorg was killed."
Cameron
blinked. The revolution had occurred more than a hundred years ago.
"You
can't be," he said. "You'd be a hundred and . . . what. . . . thirty,
fifty . . . years old."
"Hundred
and forty," she said crisply. "But don't get any ideas about escaping
again. Don't let these white hairs—what's left of 'em
OVERTHROW 291
—mislead
you. Fm plenty spry, and Fve seen all the tricks. Used 'em, too. So behave. I
won't fool with you."
Cameron
believed her. He walked carefully along the path to the door of her
"shack." This was of unglazed plastic, rising to a transparent dome
level with treetops. He waited while she blew a two-tone whistle behind him and
the electrosonic door slid upward, and obeyed her command to step inside.
A
gray squirrel chattered angrily at him from a swinging perch and a fat white
cat, curled on a cushion in the far corner, opened one green eye for a second's
scrutiny.
"Oh,
shut up!" Gran Duvain said with fierce tenderness to the squirrel.
"Into the elevator, Cameron. Face the wall."
Cameron
followed instructions. She entered behind him, closed the door, and they rose
to the observation and control room of this sentry shack.
"Sit
there in the corner," she commanded. Cameron sank into the chair, watched
her touch various buttons on the panel below the seaside window.
"Now," she went on, "the screen is between me and you. As long
as you sit still you won't be hurt. But don't get out of the chair. Wait a
minute though. Might as well make it visible."
She
twisted a dial, touched a glowing stud here and there, and a transparent green
curtain formed before Cameron. It hung unsus-pended, not quite touching
ceiling, walls, or floor, but completely hemming him in. Cameron's short hairs
stiffened and a little chill touched the back of his neck. He did not intend to
move.
"I
think you know what will happen," the old lady said pleasantly, "if
you try to jump through that screen. I want you to sit still and listen. Pier
and Harvey vex me now and then. Turning you loose, indeed! They can't imagine
anybody wanting to get away from here. They don't understand your conditioning.
They didn't think you'd make a run for a projection."
"Projection?"
She waved a withered hand
out the window. "Look!"
Cameron
saw the pier, the sleek, shining boats. Her hand moved, touched a stud on the
panel. The boats vanished. Cameron caught his breath.
"Did you think we'd actually anchor
anything out there?" Gran Duvain demanded. "I played a hunch you'd
run for it. Told 'em so. Wish you hadn't flushed that rabbit, though," she
added sadly. "One of my favorite pets."
292 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"If I hadn't," Cameron said,
"I'd be dead now." "But I'd still have my pet," she
countered. "Well, since you're here, might as well make something of you.
Don't interrupt now." "I'm no child!" Cameron protested.
"Are
to me!" she snapped. "At least three times your age. Going to tell
you what's happened in the last two hundred years. Make your own choice then.
Got any brains you'll throw in with us."
"I've
read a lot of history," Cameron said. His tone was resentful. He didn't
like a useless old woman pushing him around.
"Read!"
she scoffed. "Sonny, I've made it.
And watched it, too," she conceded. "I wasn't the only one making it.
When I snatched Pier's father, Jaques, from a firing squad, though, I started
history in motion. You don't know about Jaques. He turned out to be an artist."
That
she would admit such a fact about her son shocked Cameron. His expression must
have indicated his thought for her mouth became an invisible line among the
wrinkles.
"Was
a time," she said fiercely, "when artists were honored. Didn't know
that, huh? Shut up now! Don't care what your views are on anything. Know who
Randolph Williams was?"
Cameron searched his memory. "There was
a General Williams—"
"Right!
First military dictator of the United States. Wasn't there, myself. Don't know
whether it was justified or not. Guess it was, though. Country in a mess after
another world war they managed to stir up every twenty-five years or so. Know
what he told 'em, though? The people, I mean?"
Cameron blinked through the green veil.
"Why, uh—"
"Be still! I'll show you."
She
opened a wall closet, took out spools of film and a projector. She fitted one
into the other with firm and expert hand, and drew a dimensional screen over
the far wall.
The
three-dimensional, four-color image was that of a big man with a jaw, in khaki
and medals. He thrust the jaw forward, put one brown hand on the gaudy chest
display.
"This
is a Democracy," he asserted. "Always has been, always will be.
Martial law, which I declare here and now, is necessitated by an emergency. You
will hear charges of dictatorship flung at me. I will be called Randolph the
First, These charges will be silenced, their makers imprisoned if necessary. I
give you my solemn promise as an officer and a gentleman that as soon as the
present emergency has dis-
OVERTHROW 293
sipated,
the same government will be restored that has guided this nation in her
glorious past. I—"
Gran Duvain stopped the
projector, blanked the screen.
"Rest
of it's the same bunk," she said. "Know what General Graham said? He
was the next, after Williams drunk himself to death one night—or was
poisoned."
"Well—" Cameron
began.
"Same
thing," she interrupted. "And so on down to Jorg. He wasn't dictator
when I married him, but he was headed there. And you know what? He believed all
those others. He thought they meant what they said. And when he stepped in he
started to restore the Democracy, started to return the power of government to
the people where it belonged. Well, you know what happened to him. The Four
Companies got him."
Cameron
frowned but said nothing. Her story did not coincide with history as he had
learned it, but he was silent. There was something about her that commanded
attention.
"You
don't know about them either," she went on. "They began to grow
shortly after the first dictatorship and developed into the Centers, excepting
Luxury. The big power companies merged into one and formed Power Center, from
Canada to Mexico on the east side of the Mississippi. Textile took the east
coast, Plastic west of the Mississippi, south of the Lakes. The farm combines
took the rest, except a little spot on the West coast where they shipped all
the artists."
"May I ask a
question?" Cameron asked.
"Sure,
sure. Maybe you got sense, after all, showing an interest. What is it?"
"You
say the Four Companies got your husband. Wasn't the military in power
then?"
"Then?
Never has been. Isn't now. Who do you think runs the Centers?"
"Why, the courts and—"
"Tosh! Listen, sonny. Let's see, you're
from Plastic. Martin Grue-ter and the other mill owners are Plastic Center." "But they're only executives."
"Only?
Listen. Right after Randolph Williams went in, wasn't long before the Supreme
Court died off or was retired and General This and Colonel That replaced cm.
Same all over the country. The army took over the judiciary and administrative
functions of government. Who do you suppose ordered it?"
294 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"General Williams, I
suppose."
"And
who put him in the saddle? The Big Four. Now wait," she cautioned as
Cameron opened his mouth. "I don't say the emergency didn't justify it.
From all reports the country was in the worst mess in history. But the
emergency passed, three hundred years or so later. But by that time there were
only two classes, and the executives didn't want the government restored to the
people. So they knocked off Jorg and split up into independent Centers. Not so
independent, at that. Each has something the others need, so they got an armed
truce. You got anything to say to all this?"
"Emergencies don't
just pass," Cameron observed.
"You
know what I mean," Gran said impatiently. "The country settled down,
there wasn't any war. But the people had got used to being ordered around. First
thing you knew they figured that was the way things ought to be. They accepted
a rotten condition as natural. Thought they still had Democracy because they
could elect a Congress that did nothing but criticize. Congress don't have any
more to say about conditions than I have. Not as much, because Fm going to
change 'em."
Cameron
sat thinking of what she had told him, searching for a way to use her and the
outlaws to his own advantage. She was quiet, also, looking at the sea and the
rising fog through which could now be seen far peaks on the mainland.
Somewhere
inside the shack a tone sounded. Gran Duvain peered toward the path which led
back to the outlaw capital, vented a short grunt and went to the elevator door.
"Company,"
she said. Then, with a look of diabolical amusement, "Guess you'll stay
put. Yup," she chuckled, "you'll be there when I get back."
"Don't
fall and break a leg," Cameron said with mock alarm. "I'd
starve."
"You can always walk into the
screen," she said lighdy, and shot the elevator down.
One
burning thought was in Cameron's mind: by one means or another, he must get
back to Plastic Center and spread the warning. Pretending to join with the
outlaws was not enough, for he would be merely another member of the band. He
must offer some plan whereby the opportunity he sought would arise.
If
he could take Pier Duvain capdve— He smiled almost rapturously at the thought.
He could name his price for the most wanted
OVERTHROW 295
man
in the nation. If he could also get hold of the mechanism which formed this
death screen—
He
made a careful scrutiny of the laboratory. He tried to remember what Gran
Duvain had done when she made the screen. Her wrinkled old hands had moved
among the maze of studs, dials, and buttons, but there were so many. That
little plastic box atop the panel shelf looked sinister and efficient, but
surely it could not generate enough power. You could hide it pretty effectively
under a jacket.
The weapon
was portable in some degree, he knew, for Pier's plane had one installed.
Therein lay its greatest danger to civilization.
Cameron
shuddered when he pictured the terrible destruction the outlaws could loose
upon the Centers. Not only by the killing at will of any number they chose, but
destruction of the entire cultural structure. By throwing this screen around
each Center, they had only to sit back and name their terms. The Centers must
capitulate eventually, or die, for they were not self-sufficient. Each needed
some product of the others in order to maintain life.
There
lay the weakest point of defense against such a weapon as this, Cameron
reflected. All Centers were dependent upon Food Center, of course. But without
commodities from Power, Plastic and Textile, Food could not operate efficiently
enough even to feed its own citizens.
Yet, the outlaws seemed independent of any.
Their buildings were not from Plastic, their roads not from Textile—and he
didn't know about their food, though he hoped to soon. He was beginning to be
hungry.
Did
they manufacture their own necessities? This control room seemed to indicate
it, for each article differed in varying degrees from its counterpart in
civilized America.
It occurred to him with a slight shock that
the outlaws were dependent, after all, to some extent upon Plastic Center.
They had raided Plastic freight planes for years, taking their cargoes of
Baltex. Why? Perhaps that was an attack point upon them.
He
shook his head in exasperation. So much to know before he could form any plan
of action.
The
elevator's muted hum brought his attention back to his present circumstance.
What was he going to tell Gran when she stepped back into this room ? He felt
certain that he must come to a decision —or appear to. Whatever he decided, he
must sound sincere. The old lady was shrewd.
296 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
It wasn't Gran who stepped out of the elevator.
The legs which extended from a flared tunic of execudve purple were one of
Nature's greatest artistic achievements.
Executive
purple? Rescue? Cameron raised his eyes to the face and gasped as amused eyes,
a slightly darker purple than the uniform, twinkled at him,
"You can't slug me this time," Ann
Willis said. "Hello, Josh."
"Then
you really are the spy," Cameron said. "Somehow, I didn't quite
believe it till now. I'm sorry, incidentally, for hitting you."
She
shrugged compact shoulders. "I didn't expect it. I should have. It was
your only out. But I couldn't play any other role. I had to pretend until I was
sure you were safe."
"Why
didn't you just turn me in? Or, I mean, why wouldn't you? I would have in your
place."
"Two
reasons," she said as she sank into Gran's chair and lit a cigarette.
"Somebody might listen to your story, even after you were arrested,
because of what you'd been. Secondly, we were friends. I don't betray
friends."
"How
about Grueter, and all the citizens in Plastic?" Cameron's question was
not quite a sneer but it cut.
She gave him an amused glance through the
green veil. "I'm not betraying them. I'm solidly with Pier on the question
of conquest without violence. That's why I'm here by the way. When you
disappeared, Grueter started rooting around. You said you'd been discharged on
false evidence, and when he examined the evidence he ran across your statement
that it wasn't you who informed the outlaws. He's busy now examining those who
knew of the shipment. It won't be long before he discovers it was I. So I lit
out. We've got to act quickly."
Cameron
considered this. He must act quickly then. But he needed
information. A plan was full formed in his mind, provided that certain
conditions obtained.
"Ann," he said casually, "this
screen isn't necessary."
She
frowned doubtfully. "Gran said to keep it there till she got back. That
may be hours, though. The High Council is going to decide on a plan of action
and put it to a vote among the membership. That will take time."
"I
won't try to escape," Cameron said easily. "I don't want to
now."
She
narrowed her eyes. She looked at him for several seconds. "Do you mean
that?"
"Honestly."
"I
believe you," she said. She went to the little box, touched a button and
twisted a dial. The screen vanished.
In
the process of adjustment she moved the box an inch or so, and Cameron's
spirits surged. It was portable. It was small enough to steal.
He
and the girl smiled at each other when she was seated again. Cameron was full
of confidence. He saw the way clear.
"Gran
gave me the true facts of history while she had me caged in here," he
said. "It changed many of my views. But I'm not clear on a few points. You
came along before she could answer my questions. Where do the outlaws get their
power?"
"We
make it, the same as Power Center. Gran stole the formula when she lit out with
her son. We pirate a shipment of Baltex now and then and convert it into energy
for our various camps."
"I
see," Cameron said. "That clarifies several things. One more
question. Do you manufacture your own products?"
Ann
Willis' face glowed. "Gran did that, too. She figured out efficient
manufacturing units. They had to be portable because the camps are nomadic.
They're really wonderful. Our roads are easier on your feet than Textile's
best. Our plastic is lighter and stronger than the Center's most
expensive."
"Gran seems to be
quite a gal."
"She made this contrascreen, too,"
Ann said, indicating the little box. "Don't ask me how. It taps our power
beam and reorganizes the atomic structure of a tiny bit of Baltex. Then it
projects a screen of energy which will destroy almost anything that touches
it."
Cameron was ready. His
questions were answered.
"Your council wants a
sure plan of conquest, without violence?"
"Do you have an
idea?" she asked eagerly.
"Listen," Cameron
said.
He
talked for nearly an hour, outlining each step in detail. She listened
tensely, and gradually her face began to glow. When he had finished she was
beaming.
"Josh! It's foolproof.
Hurry! We must tell them!"
"This
is it, Cameron thought. This is the test. If they only believe me I'll be back
in uniform within twelve hours.
She
ran ahead into the elevator. As her back turned to him, Cameron scooped up the
contrascreen box, slipped it under his shirt. He bulged a little, but he
thought that they would be so busy with other things that it would escape
notice.
298 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
They went almost at a run through the forest
to the council chamber.
When they had explained artificial crop
culture to him, Cameron stood at his place on the rim of the council table and
swept the dozen men and women with earnest dark eyes. He willed himself to
think as an outlaw, to believe what he said while he said it. They wouldn't believe
him if he didn't believe himself, and he had to convince them before he could
achieve his ends.
"Your
entire theory," he said, "is based on the proposition that a person
accepts without question what he has learned to live by. All I have ever known
is the culture of the Centers, and I have accepted it. But you, you say, see it
objectively and find certain unacceptable factors. All right, I'll grant that
for the time being."
He
paused for what he felt was the right amount of time to gain their undivided
attention.
"But I can look at your own situation
equally objectively, and I find a certain blind idealism which cannot see
weapons already at hand. Your problem of bloodless conquest is simple to me.
The battle is economic in nature."
They stirred restlessly at this, but Cameron
held up a hand. "Sure, you know that. You've just told me. But let me go
through the project all the way to the end. That's been your trouble. You've
run up against a wall before you reached the end. You've heard the first part
of this a hundred times, but let me say it once more. All right?"
Gran, at the chairman's
seat, nodded shortly.
Cameron
boiled it down as much as he could. He merely stated that the first step was to
break down the centralization of the culture. He did not go into detail, for
they had explained the procedure to him shortly after he and Ann burst into the
meeting.
He
reviewed the details in his mind, however, as he mentioned it, and felt once
more that they advocated sound logic. If Plastic Center had a power unit and
manufacturing units plus the outlaws' secret of artificial crop culture, it
would be completely self-supporting and independent of the other Centers.
Each
Center could be divorced from the others and could be attacked one at a time
and conquered by the outlaw contrascreen. That was the simplest solution. But,
Cameron reflected, thousands, perhaps millions, would die, and the oudaws did
not want that.
"Very well," he said. "It's
simple to break down the general cul-
OVERTHROW 299
ture
and form subsidiary cultures. These will probably become armed camps, each bent
on conquest of the remainder. That is, of course, if we stopped there. You have
stopped there until now."
"Where
else can we go ?" Gran demanded. "How can we take over the
governments and establish a system in which each citizen has an equal
voice—without killing?"
"That,"
Cameron said—with a trace of smugness to make it natural—"is where you've
overlooked your most obvious ally. Before I go into that, though, I'd like to
ask something. You have your own power units, but you need Baltex? Right? You
can't manufacture power otherwise?"
"Right."
"Then the first step in any negotiations
must be a trade with Martin Grueter. The process of Baltex for power and
manufacturing units. We must begin with Plasdc Center before we can offer
Textile and Food independence from Power Center. Right?"
"We know all
that," Gran said impatiently.
"But
you hadn't mentioned your need for Baltex," Cameron said. "I thought
I'd get it clear in my own head. Now. We have the Centers operadng
independently, say. Our problem is to overthrow the dictatorships and
substitute a democracy—without violence. Not without force, but without
violence. Right?"
"Right!" Gran
snapped. "Heaven's sake, sonny, quit stallinV*
"Have you ever
considered the councils?" Cameron asked sofdy.
Blank silence. Brows
furrowed, but nobody said anything.
"I
can see you haven't," Cameron went on. "You've called them useless.
You've said the dictators allowed them and the useless congress to remain so
that the people would believe they had a democracy. They've been weapons of
the dictators to keep down rebellion. They've been allowed to do nothing but
criticize. But remember that power of criticism is powerful. Look what happened
to me," he said with a rueful smile.
They still didn't see it, and Cameron felt an
honest glow of accomplishment on his face. The hell of it is, he reflected,
it'll work. Fd better keep the whip hand.
"What
happens," he asked, "when the council lodges a criticism against the
head of the military? I'll admit that's a rare event, but it has happened and
can happen again. You know what happens. He is demoted to the status of
ordinary citizen, and his subordinate succeeds. Now listen."
300 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
They did. They were barely
breathing.
"Somewhere
along the line of officers we can get to one. Convert him if possible,
otherwise bribe him. His men will obey without question. On The Day, he will
imprison all executives who are not with us and we shall move in. We shall
begin an immediate program of education—by example. All citizens shall be
declared equal. Since the majority are inferiors of a minority, we'll have the
mass support immediately. We'll have Luxury Center broadcast plays
demonstrating the beauties of pure Democracy as compared to the present system.
We'll make speeches. We'll hold elections. We'll establish a merit system of
promotion."
"What happens," Pier Duvain asked,
his dark face still skeptical, "if we have objections?"
Cameron
pounced on this. He'd overlooked the point but the pressure of his arm against
the little box suggested the obvious answer.
"Our
first step, after taking over the government, is to demonstrate the
contrascreen. After that there won't be any objections that can't be mediated.
Now don't tell me that this is government by force, because it need not be. No
government, however powerful, will ever need to use force if it administrates
for the greatest good of the greatest number. I understand that's our
slogan."
"Shut up, all of you!" Gran
snapped. "Of course he's right. Thought maybe he had some brains. We never
thought of using the councils. All we got to do now is figure a way to make the
criticisms stick. Got any suggestions, sonny?"
"That's
simple," Cameron said. "Ann is your executive in Plastic. She can ask
that certain criticisms be lodged."
"On what
grounds?" Ann asked. "We didn't cover that."
"Let's see,"
Cameron pondered.
"I've
got it!" Ann interrupted. "Look. We give the secret of Bal-tex to
Textile Center, and accuse the commanding general of allowing it to be stolen.
Inefficiency. Then, if we don't own his successor, we frame him in the same
way. It's a temporary humiliation, and it's cheating, but they'll be restored
to a political status equal to everyone else, so it won't matter."
"That just about wraps it up,"
Cameron said. "Now I—" "Wait a minute," Pier Duvain put in.
"I'll admit this sounds all right as far as we go. But what about the
other Centers? We can't frame the military there in the same way."
OVERTHROW 30T
"Don't
have to, Pier," Gran said. "Didn't he say Luxury would broadcast
plays? When those conditions are actually in force in Plastic, and other
Centers can see on-the-spot proof of it, what do you think the cidzens will do?
What would you do? You'd hightail it over to Plastic first time you could sneak
through your Center's Shield. So they'll be forced to let us in, or become
depopulated."
So,
Cameron thought, the artist is functional after all. What a laugh!
"Well?" Gran
said. "Are we with him?"
Their
vote was hearty and unanimous. Not a single skeptical face remained in the
circle. These faces were alight. They saw the end of a system they had fled,
and the beginning of one they had conceived. Where no man should call another
master, where all men ranked equally on the sociological scale. This was the
end of their dream, the beginning of their task.
Cameron's
emotions were somewhat mixed. Not that he had any intention of aiding in the
overthrow of civilization as he knew it, but his ruse was so logical, so clear,
and had so many qualities that were desirable
that he was shaken to a certain degree. Not his faith. That was not shaken. But
his belief was not as clear, as strong, as logical.
These
outlaws were merely men and women who considered others as well as themselves.
They were not brutal, they did not eat their young, they were not illiterate
savages. These things he had been taught, had believed. These things were
false. He did not ask himself if other "facts" as he knew them were
also false. He did not want to ask himself that.
"May I make another
suggestion?" he asked.
"Sonny,"
Gran chuckled. "You can do any darn thing you're a mind to."
"I
think it would be sound psychology if I went to Grueter and offered him a power
unit. I'd say I've been captured by outlaws and got away. I was chief of
police, you know. If I turn up with a surefire formula for Plastic Center
independence I'd probably get my job back and be doubly valuable."
"There's sense to
that," Gran said. "What do you want, a plane?"
"No-o, I thought
somebody could take me in. Pier, maybe."
They
thought this over, Cameron cursed himself silently. He must not, must not make
them suspicious.
"You see," he
said glibly, "I'm not a pilot."
302 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
Their faces relaxed.
"Surely," Pier Duvain said. "I'll take you."
"Under
these conditions," Ann said, "I'll go back. There won't be any more
spy hunt. And I'm necessary."
Cameron
dared not object. He didn't want Ann in this for reasons not quite clear to
him. He didn't know why; he only knew that he didn't want her involved. But he
said nothing.
"I
think I'll go, too," Harvey Willis said. "I'd like to watch the
fireworks."
"I'll just go along, too, for the
ride," Gran said. "Well, let's get a vote on this proposition."
She spoke to a young man with a high forehead. "Shoot it to all the
camps. Insist on an immediate vote. Let us know."
Cameron's
jaw dropped. "You mean we may not go through with it?"
"Not if the people don't like it,"
Gran said. "What do you think a democracy is, anyway?"
Inside the long black plane, Cameron took a
secluded chair aft on the excuse that he wanted to study the proposition to
Grueter. Shielded by the seat in front, he examined the contrascreen box.
It's face was covered with clear directions
and a large warning: HANDLE WITH CARE! He found the formula he wanted—how to
form a dome one hundred yards in diameter and fifty feet high. The plane would
fit comfortably inside that. He set the control dial at points indicated by the
formula and slipped the box back into his shirt.
They
were high in the dark night above the channel between the island and mainland,
and Cameron could see nothing through the observation ports but stars and far
lights on the shore which probably indicated Luxury Center.
He
was thankful that the vote had taken so litde time, for Gran had not returned
to her sentry shack after unanimous agreement of outlaw camps had been
announced. Of course, she might have overlooked the absence of the box, but,
on the other hand—
He
strained eager eyes as the plane fled silently through the night. Plastic Prime
was yet three hours away, and these began to drag. Some inner compulsion
prevented his fraternizing with the outlaws, some uneasiness. He did not
attempt to define this. When he became too uncomfortable, he caught Ann's eye
and was made all the more uneasy, but pleasandy so, by the warmth that flooded
him.
OVERTHROW 303
When
the klystron announced Plastic's Shield ahead, Ann called out the collapse
combination to Pier, and they were inside.
Now
it begins, Cameron thought, and paced the floor in an anxiety which brought
sweat to every inch of his body. It couldn't go wrong, of course. His plan was
certain to succeed. Nevertheless, he heaved a great sigh when Pier dropped into
a wide, deserted field at the edge of Plastic Prime.
Two
tasks remained now inside the plane. To get through the good-byes without
incident, and to convince Ann that she should remain aboard. If she insisted
on accompanying him he'd have to slug her again. He didn't want to do that. He
was not even sure he could force himself to it.
She was tractable, however.
"You'd
better let me find out if you're suspect," he said. "Then I'll let
you know."
Her
eyes deepened in color as she shook hands. "Thanks for the thought, Josh.
I'll wait—for you."
"Good luck," they
wished him, and he was off.
He
paced one hundred fifty yards, turned, pressed the activisor on the box and set
it under a small bush out of sight. A tiny streak of flame circled around the
plane as grass tops perished under the contra-screen.
Cameron hailed the plane and Pier Duvain answered.
"I've
set a screen around you," Cameron said. "The dome. You'll be here
when I get back, I think."
Pier
came silently toward Cameron, a slim silhouette in the dark. He stopped ten
yards away.
"What now,
Cameron?"
"I'm going to turn you
over to the authorities, Pier."
Duvain said nothing. The
silence became painful.
"Did
you think I'd stand by and see you destroy what we live by?" Cameron
demanded. "This is my world you want to overturn. I can't let you do
that."
Duvain said nothing.
"Naturally,"
Cameron said, "I feel bad about it on personal grounds. I like you and I
think you're honest. But you're wrong, Pier, So I have no alternative."
The others had joined Pier.
They said nothing.
"I'm
sorry," Cameron said uncomfortably. "I'll make it as easy on you as
possible. But you see, don't you, that I had no choice? It was no
304 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
fault
of mine that I was removed from a position in which I had a great deal of pride. Self-preservation, if nothing else, was a
strong enough motive for my action. But in addition I was fighting for my
world. My fight is as honest as yours, and has the added weight of majority
approval."
Nobody answered him.
"You make me feel like a first-class son
of an actor," Cameron said. "Pardon the profanity. But Fm acting
according to my lights. No man can do more."
When the silence became unbearable, Cameron
wheeled and marched away. Martin Grueter's home was not far, but it was too far
for Cameron, for he didn't like the figures who accompanied him.
These
were four, close packed in the dark, immobile, silent. Ann, Duvain, Harvey and
Gran. They were with him, almost realities. Everywhere he looked he saw them,
motionless, silently accusing him of treachery.
Ann. She didn't betray friends. She proved
it. He had been dangerous to the world she wanted, but she hadn't turned him
in. She'd pretended to be unconscious, so that he could take her coagulator and
a makeshift star. Friends.
Stop it! he commanded himself silendy. You'll
be turning back, first thing you know. You'll be an outlaw, equal under their
code with all men. Their system would work, too, he reflected, but look what it
would do to things as they are. Even an artist would have a vote in civic
affairs.
He hurried, pushing these thoughts away, and
presently stood on Grueter's identification plate. The door slid up, and
Cameron entered.
Martin Grueter, big, square-faced, stood in
the doorway to his bedroom and leveled a coagulator at Cameron.
"I am happy to see you," he said in
level, sneering tones. "May I be of service?"
This, more than anything that happened later,
shocked Cameron. During the few hours he spent with the outlaws, he had
forgotten the formalities of the Centers. Suddenly he found them empty.
"I have Pier Duvain," he said
abruptly. "He is my prisoner."
"Is that so important that you can
dispense with ordinary politeness?" Grueter asked. "Where is
he?"
"Not so fast," Cameron cautioned.
"I want to make a trade."
"Where is he?"
OVERTHROW 305
"I want my job back," Cameron said,
"and a few more things. Then Fll tell you where he is."
"Where—is-he?"
"Do you mean that you
won't trade?"
For
answer Grueter pressed a button on the wall beside him. Cameron became coldly
angry.
"Calling
in soldiers won't make me tell. For Heaven's sake, Martin, I'm doing this
nation a great service. Surely you'll discuss it with me.
"Why
should I dicker with you?" Grueter said shortly. "Give you back your
job? You're not a desirable citizen. You're not even a desirable ordinary
civilian. You refused to accept a judgment passed by your superiors. We don't
want men like you in this nation."
"Then you'll never
take Duvain."
"If
he's inside Plastic Center, and he must be if he's a prisoner, we'll find
him."
'Tes,
you'll find him," Cameron said. "You can practically see him from
here. Look I"
He
pointed through the still-open door. The outlaw plane was barely visible as a
blacker outline against the night.
"He's on there,
captive."
Grueter's eyes narrowed thoughtfully.
"You're telling the truth!" he exclaimed, almost in a whisper.
"On both counts, Martin."
A
plane swooped down at the door and two soldiers in red saluted Grueter. Cameron
smiled wryly at Captain Robert Fane.
Fane
went through an obsequious ritual of greeting which Grueter absently
acknowledged. His eyes were on the plane.
"Guard this man. When
I return you can dispose of him."
"Don't go out there!" Cameron said
as Grueter moved toward the door. "Martin, it's death for you."
Grueter went out into the
night.
Cameron
turned to Captain Fane. "Stop him, captain! He's going to his death."
Captain
Fane's heavy, swart features showed amused indifference. He said nothing, but
it was clear that he didn't care one way or the other about Martin Grueter.
Cameron shrugged. "I
tried. You were witnesses."
He was not yet aware of
what had happened within himself. But
306 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
when the soldiers turned bored eyes to the
doorway through which Grueter had vanished, Cameron had an opportunity to
analyze his feelings.
He was an outlaw.
This
was shocking, but there was pleasure in it. As the outlaws themselves walked
with pride, he now felt equal with these soldiers who ranked next only to
executives on the Center's social scale. He was an oudaw, as good as any man.
He
had refused Martin Grueter's command, had thrown custom and caste aside, had
rebelled in that one act against the culture in which he had been born and
raised. At the moment of rebellion he had felt motivated by a desire to attain
his former eminence. But he realized now that his motive had been deeper,
embedded in a sense of independence which had grown to maturity among the
outlaws.
The
very scheme, he now realized, which he had proposed as a strategic maneuver
against Duvain, had sprung from some basic part of his nature. He believed it.
He had believed when he trapped the outlaws, but long conditioning prevented
him from admitting it.
Yes,
he was an outlaw now in spirit but not in fact. He was a captive. Further, and
more serious, more heartbreaking, he was undoubtedly an outcast. After what he
had done to Duvain and Gran, and Willis and Ann, they could have only contempt
for him.
Ann.
How would she look at him now? Not with deep lights in her purple eyes. On that
occasion in Grueter's office, later in her own, her eyes had been hard, glazed.
He shivered, remembering their coldness. And she had been acting then. How
would she look now when she meant it ?
He twisted an ironic smile when he realized
that he'd probably never know. Eventually, somebody would find that plastic box
and turn off the screen. The outlaws would be helpless before the wave of
attackers that would roll over them. And before that, perhaps, Josh Cameron
himself would be a corpse.
At
least he had a momentary satisfaction knowing that he was no longer subject to
empty codes which made a great mass slaves of a few in purple. He had his
moment, an independence denied most.
At that moment a faint call
came through the door.
"Soldiers! Help!"
Captain Fane sighed. "Come on," he
said to Cameron. "Don't try anything fancy."
Cameron marched between
them across the field, dormant hope
OVERTHROW 307
stirring
faintly within him. Any informal action could create opportunity, and this,
God knew, was informal.
The
outlaw ship loomed larger as they approached, and Cameron could see the group
silhouette of those four he was ashamed, but ached with desire, to face.
Fifteen yards nearer stood Martin Grueter, who urged them with almost
incoherent gibberish.
"Get
'em," he cried. "Give me your coagulator. Shoot the rats. Pier
Duvain's there, the coward. Come on out, you. Fll show you!"
His
voice was almost hysterical and contained a note which Cameron could not
place. Fear? Anger? Insanity?
Grueter
lunged toward them in the darkness and snatched the soldier's weapon from his
belt. The big man whirled, pointed and pressed the activator. With what seemed
to be maniacal fury, he flung the weapon at the group of silent outlaws. A
small flash, a hushed popl
"A fine soldier!" Grueter snarled.
"Useless weapon! Give me yours, captain."
"What's
the difficulty, sir?" Fane inquired, taking his coagulator from its
holster.
"Idiocy.
Contrascreen, indeed! No such thing. Give—me— that—"
Fane presented the coagulator, butt first.
Grueter snatched it, aimed, fired, and hurled it from him. He spoke with
shaking, but controlled fury.
"Both
of you men will be reduced to ordinary citizens for incompetency. Suppose you
had to use those weapons. Capture those four!"
The
soldiers started forward. Cameron took each by an arm. "Wait a
second." They halted, surprised. "Why don't you go in there,
Martin?"
The soldiers gasped at both the familiarity
and at the sneer in Cameron's voice.
"They stopped me, begged me,"
Grueter said. "Told me I would die. Nonsense 1 Attend to you later."
To the soldiers: "Well?"
Cameron's hold tightened as the men surged
forward. He yanked first one, then the other, to a stop. They faced him.
"Don't
try it," Cameron said. "Let him go if he wants to. They saved his
life, but I won't stop him if he isn't afraid. There's no need for you to die,
though. You haven't done anything."
Captain
Fane and his aid said nothing. Cameron could feel their uneasiness.
308 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"Make
Grueter do it," he pressed. "He's the one who wants 'em. Let him go
in after 'em."
"Are
you going to obey?" Grueter snapped. "Or would you rather be
executed?"
They flinched, as if struck
by a whip, and jerked free.
Cameron
swung at Fane's jaw and the soldier's knees buckled. Without waiting to see the
result of his blow, Cameron dived at the other soldier's legs, threw him
sprawling.
Cameron's
world spun as Grueter kicked him behind one ear. His arms went limp, but he rolled
clear of the next kick and struggled to his feet. The soldier was up, too, and
Cameron kicked him in the stomach. The man bent double as Captain Fane hit
Cameron high on the head.
He hit the ground and bounced. He was groggy
but able to rise. In a stumbling rush he leaped after Fane, dragged him down.
When Grueter kicked him again, Cameron rolled to a point where he heard a faint
crackle. Immediately, cries reached him.
"Josh! Be
careful!"
"That was close, Cameron."
"Let 'em come, sonny.
It'll teach 'em a lesson."
Cameron
jumped away from the crackling. Maybe the contra-screen did sound like that
where it met the earth. He didn't want to make sure. He jerked Fane clear,
kicked him in the jaw with every last atom of strength and fell as the other
soldier sped past him, intent on carrying out his master's order.
The flash, the explosion,
brought silence.
"That's
one down," Gran said, after a few seconds. "He'll know better after
this."
Martin Grueter said softly, "What a
weapon! A man could rule—n
His
tone was shrill with fear, but his words were suddenly crisp. "What do you
want for it, Cameron?"
"Shut up!" Cameron said
contemptuously. "Haven't you any feeling?"
He
helped Captain Fane to his feet. "Sorry about your buddy, captain. I
tried."
Fane gripped Cameron's hand, spoke under his
breath. "You can ask me anything . . . anything. I'll do it, I don't care
why." "I'll remember that, captain."
"Well?" Grueter broke in. "You
came here to make a trade. All right, I'll agree. But I'm not as interested in
Duvain as I am in this
OVERTHROW 309
screen.
It may have a certain small value, and I am willing to discuss terms."
"Be quiet!" Cameron snarled.
"I want to think."
"Do you realize who I am?" Grueter
blustered.
"Yes,"
Cameron said wearily. "I didn't until now." He tried to discern the
mottled look which he knew was flooding Grueter's square face. "So shut
up."
Grueter
gasped and Captain Fane shifted uneasily. But Cameron got his moment of quiet.
Presently
he went to the little bush, picked up the plastic box and snapped the switch.
He came back to Grueter.
"I'll dicker with you, Martin."
"Good!" Grueter enthused. "I
like a man who makes quick decisions. We'll get along, Josh, old fellow."
"Get into that plane," Cameron said. "Into—"
"The plane. Quick!" "But—the
screen."
"This is the screen. One false move and
I turn it on you. You're safe, as long as you obey." He turned to Captain
Fane. "Go back to your office, captain."
Fane saluted. "Yes, sir."
With
Grueter walking cautiously, fearfully ahead, Cameron went toward the plane.
When he reached the outlaws, he gave the box to Gran, whispered to Ann:
"You're a prisoner, too. March in there
with him."
She obeyed without question.
"Miss
Willis has already agreed to my proposal," Cameron said later when they
were high in the darkness. "We captured her yesterday, but she finally
agreed. She has the interests of Plastic Center at heart, it seems."
Ann
took her cue. Her dark eyes were anxious. She twisted her long white hands as
she hung on Grueter's reply.
"Independence,"
he mused. "It's desirable, but frankly, old man, I'd rather talk about
that amazing weapon."
He turned avaricious eyes on it and Gran
glared at him.
"You can't have it," Cameron said.
Grueter
shrugged. "Ah, well. All right, I'll give you the Baltex formula for . . .
let's see, what were they . . . power and manufacturing units. Yes," he
mused, "we can soon bring the other Centers to
310 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
terms."
He twinkled jovially. "I don't suppose you jolly oudaws care about
that?"
Pier
Duvain set the robot controls and joined the group. He gave Grueter a dark,
level stare, and said:
"You're
not fooling us, Grueter. We know you'll set all the forces you command after us
as soon as we drop you. You'll give us a phony formula and hope to catch us
before we have a chance to try it. So we're keeping Miss Willis as
hostage."
Cameron
forced down the singing that rose within him. Not to well, for Gran shot him an
amused look.
"Oh,
I say!" Grueter protested. "She's one of the most valuable members of
my staff."
"And,"
Pier Duvain went on, "we're throwing our contrascreen around Plastic Prime
until we've had time to prove your formula bona fide."
"But
that will maroon us, man! It will stop all traffic. We have contracts to
fill."
"That's your problem."
Grueter
was thoughtfully silent. Finally, "What else can I say?" he asked.
"I'm forced to agree."
"Oh,
no," Duvain contradicted. "You can refuse. We're not going to kill
you. We'll deliver you safely and take our proposition to Power Center."
"Oh, my God, man! They'd soon rule the
nation! They have enough Baltex ahead to last a year. No, I'll agree, all
right."
They
returned him, secured the formula and his promise to stop all traffic to and
from Plastic Prime, and were soon headed for their island.
Cameron cut short the impromptu celebration.
"Before I go into a personal matter here is something you don't know. Fane
is grateful enough to lodge a criticism against Grueter for allowing the Baltex
formula to get out of his hands. We can provide Fane with proof. Then Ann can
take care of Fane's superiors until he's in command. Then we can move in. It
shouldn't take long. Now, what are you going to do with me?"
His tone brought stares.
"When I went into Grueter's, I tried to
sell you out." A hardness came into their eyes. They had forgotten, in
their triumph. He looked at them in turn. Pier's eyes were steady, not cold,
OVERTHROW 311
not
warm; Harvey's, red-rimmed, were aloof; Gran's were blank; Ann's wide
with—what? Sadness, anxiety?
Gran broke the silence.
"What caused you to change?"
Cameron
told them. "I believed, I suppose, all along," he added, "but
wouldn't admit it. Anyway, there it is. I tried to betray you. Whatever you
decide, I've got it coming, I guess."
"I
suggest," Duvain said, "that we put you on probation for a suitable
time, that we don't give you any authority until you've proved your sincerity.
After all, even your about-face at Grueter's might be temporary, induced by
anger and a desire to lash out at something which threatened you
personally."
"He
risked his life," Ann pointed out, "to save those soldiers. And
almost lost it. That looks sincere."
"I
agree with Pier," Gran said. "He ought to be watched. We'd better put
a guard over him."
"Absolutely,"
Harvey Willis agreed. "We can't take a chance on his getting away."
Cameron
felt humble. They were giving him another chance. He smiled at Ann. To the
others: "Thank you."
"We'll
keep him safe for you, honey," the old woman said to Ann, "till you
can take over the job."
Cameron
blinked, examined them. They were joking. He looked at Ann. She was suddenly
scarlet.
"Should've
heard her," Gran said to him. "Took on no end when you'd gone. Said
you'd come through all right. Said she'd never—"
"Gran!" Ann
cried. "Don't."
"Safe
to tell him," Gran went on. "I can read signs. You're the only one
for him." She turned to Cameron. "Said she'd never fall for a
rat."
A
strained but pleasant silence fell. Cameron knew he was looking fatuous. He
attempted a grin at Ann. It felt all right, but he imagined that he looked as
if he'd just been promoted. Ann didn't seem to mind.
"If
your first one's a boy," Gran said slyly, "maybe he'll grow up to be
president."
Events
in Mans progress had become cosmic in scope. Victories were won in the great
interstellar wars of 23,000, the first war of the robots in 42,000 and in the final robot wars of 83,000. For 20,000 years of peace the human species pressed on
from galaxy to galaxy. Perhaps, though, the journey to infinity had ended. When
the new crisis came it was recognized soon enough, but the spiral downward into
darkness seemed inevitable.
BARRIER OF DREAD
by Judith Merril
I |
t would have
been a perfect day for the Managing^Director, but his wife spoiled it for him.
Sarise had a way of saying unexpected things; it was half her charm. This time
as they settled into the cushions on the moving ramp that would take them into
the space ship from the great amphitheatre where the ceremonies had been held,
she looked worried. That is to say, she would have looked worried if it were
possible that a mature woman in perfect health of body and mind, with nothing
to desire, could have looked worried.
"It's
too fast," was all she said, but Dangret had lived with her long enough to
know what she meant.
"I
can't quite make up my mind whether you're a throwback or just an incurable
romantic," he told her in a tone that might have been angry had he
understood the nature of anger. But it was as long since humans had had cause
to understand anger, as it was since they had known reason for worry. He was,
however, not joking. Sarise held a greater fascination for Dangret than any of
his earlier wives, because in twenty-five years he had been completely unable
to settle this problem to his own satisfaction.
She was
unperturbed. "It's too fast," she repeated. "No one man should
have the glory of opening two galaxies during his Directorship. It's . .
."
"Certainly this feeling of . . . what
did they call it . . . guilt?
312
BARRIER OF DREAD 313
... in
pleasure or glory is more of an atavism than a romantic notion. Sarise, do you
seriously mean . . ."
"Yes I do, and it's neither atavism nor romanticism," his wife retorted; "it's common sense. I don't
know the figures. That's your business. But I know as well as you do that the
maximum percentage that choose for exploration is lower than the number you'll
be needing if settlement speeds up at the rate it is."
"That
takes care of itself," he told her. "You know the children of
settlers have the highest inclination for exploration. The system works because
these factors do level out."
Sarise
had made up her mind. "Try it on your calkers," she tossed back,
reaching for the portable sensory recorder she always kept near at hand. She
began to finger the controls, making a record of her ideas before she lost
them. "I'm going to do a composition on it, anyhow." She punched a
key vehemently. "And if the images I get out of this set of ideas don't
make a real fear sensation, I'll give up composing for good."
"If
they do," he laughed, "I'll probably ban it. Nobody's done a
successful fear-image in my lifetime,
and I'm not sure it's a good idea for anyone to do it."
Sarise was no longer interested. The section
of the ramp that held their cushions had left the moving carrier and deposited
them in their own quarters on the flagship that would take them back to Earth,
where, tradition decreed, the Director must live—despite its many
inconveniences.
Dangret
was thoughtful as he watched his wife become more absorbed in the machine that
would eventually produce a combination of sound, light, and emotion as
effective as anything else being done in the universe. His eyes wandered over
to the far wall of the room where a huge fresco depicted the underlying pulse
of their age. It wasn't supposed to be scientific; it showed a suited
man—without a helmet—and a lovely woman, without any protection other than the
modern trappings she wore, leaping off the rear tubes of a rocket ship, the
kind that was outmoded in Dangret's grandfather's times. Flames in space surrounded
them, and another ship, apparently burning, could be seen in the background.
There was no fear on the faces of the pair. To Dangret and to the artist who
had done the work, the fresco symbolized the limitless possibilities of human
will, and the endless expansion of human destiny.
He looked back at Sarise;
he had originally made up his mind to
314 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
meet
this woman when he heard her first composition, and he had realized when he
suggested their union that she might leave him physically, at any dme for her
work. Dangret was accustomed to it, and, like others of his day, found the
spectacle of another being absorbed in creative activity second best only to
the sensation of that absorption within his own person.
Now,
however, he was not as much concerned with Sarise or her composition as he was
with the casual remark that had preceded it. It was no serious problem, of
course; it would probably have some use-value as the basis for an effective
image, but it could be solved, if the matter became sufficiently acute, by the
manufacture of explorer-robots. As a matter of fact, the calkers had tabulated
the percentages sometime back, and had automatically begun designing the new
type androids. But her "Too fast, too fast," had moved something in
him— possibly, he thought, amused at his own reaction, an atavism of his own.
He
went to sleep with the thought still on his mind, a nagging little thought
that pulled at him and wouldn't let him be. Sarise's explanation was wrong,
but there was something. It was too
fast. Why, why?
In the morning the little nagging concern had
not left him, nor did it through the day of welcomes and further ceremonies on
Earth. Dangret was a wise man, and two hundred years in his job had taught him
much. He knew better than to ignore or suppress the thought; something was
wrong, somehow, and he had to find out what it was. Too fast . . .
He
tried the sensory images. Some of Sarise's compositions, he had found, could
clear almost all impressions from his conscious mind and leave the subconscious
open for exploration. He had banished this sort of troublesome unresolved
thought before. This time, even the images failed. He tried another method,
something he had not done for many years now, not since he heard the first
Sarise poem.
Human
history had a well-defined logic of its own, a logic not entirely within the
power of the calkers to compute, but sometimes more directly ascertainable by
the natural curves of instinct. When he was younger, and troubled by ideas not
clear enough to hand over to calkers for solution, Dangret had had a
composition created for himself, one that would allow him, in a few hours, to
re-live the path of galactic conquest, empire, bureaucracy, and managership.
The piece was designed to sweep broad outlines at the beginning, and narrow
BARRIER OF DREAD 315
down,
as it proceeded, till at the end it was done in such detail that it was
necessary to add to it yearly to keep it complete.
Now
he had the composition brought to his own room, announced that he would be
unavailable for the next hours, and settled down in the almost-severe
white-painted simplicity of his personal quarters, to review the past, and
discover if he could what factor of the present could menace the future.
It
was a long while since he had sensed the piece, and now he participated almost
physically in its drama. He swept in ridiculously ornate flowing robes beside
the first World Emperor, the man who had bound the Earth into a unit with which
to conquer space. With the early explorers, he suffered the hardships of
unperfected atomics, and landed beside them on the first extra-solar planet. He
followed the search for inhabited planets, and felt the strange combination of
loneliness and power that had spread over Earth as it became clear that life,
as life on Earth was defined, was a galactic freak. Nowhere else had there been
a combination of environmental factors that made large and complex life-forms
an evolutionary desideratum.
But
for the conquering Earthmen, there had to be subjects of conquest—so they
manufactured them. Robots tilled the soil on those planets where it was rich,
dug wealth from the ground where rock and ore prevailed, built fantastically
luxurious palaces for earthmen on the best-suited orbs.
Dangret watched and lived with the triumph of
a world as the empire spread over a galaxy, and stopped. He fought, first with
the robots, ancestors (if the term can be used) of his calkers, and then with
the humans, in the three great revolts. He lived, with other Earthmen, in dread
of a mechanistic mastery of life, when it was finally established that the
robots had learned the secret of "reproduction," and he was present
at the peace treaty, when only the humans' superior will to live and rule won
them the slight edge of victory.
He
was one with the first Bureaucrats, who established the principle of Dynamic
Exchange, and lived with the men who guided each new type of robot, adapted to
work on a particular planet, from the initial slave-labor stage, through the
long haul to self-sufficient technology and self-manufactory. And he was there
when the first calker, the ultimate design of human and robot cooperation,
discovered the trick of crossing inter-galactic space.
The
calkers killed the Bureaucracy; the bureaucrats* own theories of dynamics,
really, killed it, but intergalactic commerce finished it.
316 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
The
last pressure had been removed; the robots had taken from man all the burdens
of unpleasant labor. Earthmen were fed, clothed, housed, and given all their simpler
physical pleasures mechanically. The most complicated of the mechanical aides
were sent out to prepare new territories for their Earth masters, and when,
finally, other galaxies were opened for settlement, there was no need for any
human to be put upon in any way by other humans. The enormous strides in medicine,
and the lessening of the burden of labor had produced a constantly increasing
population, and had the resultant numbers been confined, even in the extent of
a single galaxy, there might still have been cause for strife, jealousy, and
hate.
But
when every man could have his own robot-manned planet if he chose, when all
those who wished to govern and dominate could; all those who loved adventure
and exploration could have it; all those who wanted nothing but creative or
intellectual activity were free to devote themselves to it, and there was no limit—the very nature of man changed. Dangret
traveled with the first crew members to the second galaxy and sank back into
his cushions as he experienced the relief that flooded Earthmen on all the
inhabitable planets as endless space opened up to accompany endless service.
He
himself today had opened the seventh galaxy; as a boy he had known the eighth
Manager, who opened the Fourth Galaxy. The system, by that time, had been
established. Calkers designed new machines, new androids, to fit the new
conditions of each planet, as soon as the first explorers brought back their
reports. Some were to be prepared for human habitation; others would be colonized
by robots, and utilized as sources of raw material. Humanity lived and
prospered on the slight difference between what the robots produced, and what,
in the end, they consumed, and the greater the expansion, the greater the total
sum of that slight difference.
But
the system was benevolent, for anything apart from benevolence was no longer
acceptable to what had been called "human na- -ture." It had become
horribly clear, during the robotic revolutions, that the intangibles that
change a group of men into a mob could change a collection of robots into a
society, with a functioning niind and even emotion-pattern of its own. Men,
happy and satisfied men, ] to whom exploitation was impossible, were faced with
choice of giving * up their robots or keeping them "happy." With the
struggle of those men, Dangret suffered, and with them, he chose the only
possible course: robots in social groupings must be given technology and
BARRIER OF DREAD 317
almost-complete
independence as fast as they demanded it, if they were to be kept working for
humanity.
The system worked; it had worked; there was
no reason why it should not continue to work. Dangret relived the plans for the
ceremonies of the day before, and came gradually back to the day itself • • .
with the nagging thought still pulling at his mind, unresolved.
It
went with him as he sought Sarise in her apartment, to find her locked in her
room, hard at work, and seeing no one, not even him. And it stayed with him
through the next lonely week, aggravated by his enforced separation from his
wife. More and more he found himself staring at the fresco on his wall,
uneasiness growing in him. He tried all the psychological tricks he knew on
himself, did his best to set the problem up for the calkers by tracing his thought
patterns; but when, more than a week later, Sarise sent word that she was
finished, he went to her quarters delighted at the thought that this
troublesome idea might be lost for a time in her company.
He
found her pacing the airfoam floors of her room, thin and vibrant. She would
never take dme to eat when she was working, but always seemed to emerge from
these periods with an inner life that disregarded her abused body. She couldn't
wait for his words or embrace. Shining with excitement, and almost inarticulate,
she pulled him to a spot in the center of the room, best suited for reception,
and waiting only for his indulgent nod of assent, began the projection of her
new piece.
Sarise's work was always basically musical. A
composition, of course, might include, or exclude, any known form of sensory
stimulation, and it might udlize a number of forms in fairly equal proportions—but,
just as the one he had witnessed a week earlier was essentially photographic,
a series of three-dimensional images reinforced by sonics, so this, like all of
Sarise's work, commanded all the senses, but rested primarily upon the
aesthetics of music
Dangret
kept command of himself long enough to reach over and press the levers that
would bring Sarise some food, then he was lost completely in the compelling
experience of his wife's newest work. To describe either what he saw, felt,
tasted, or heard, or the almost too-vivid sensations that welled up in him
would be impossible. Great works of art cannot be discussed; they must be
participated in. Dangret participated to the fullest, and experienced an
emotion he had never known before.
The musical base of the thing modulated to a
theme that seemed
310 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
to
close in around him. Tighter and tighter it pressed, squeezing him, forcing him
in on himself, pushing from all sides, with no escape, no escape. Dangret's
muscles tensed; his heart labored, then beat too fast, labored, pounded again.
His salivary action was insufficient, and his peristaltic action, for the first
time in a long life, proved uncontrollable. A little fear will go a long way
with a perfecdy adjusted man.
As
the last note faded away, and daylight began to stream again through the walls,
he lay back in a torpor of relief, unconscious of his wife, the room, or
anything else but the churning of his own thoughts and emotions. When, finally,
he lifted his head, Sarise was calmly devouring the food he had ordered for
her. She smiled at him.
"I
did it, didn't I?" she demanded. She could never quite get over a
childlike wonder and delight at the things that came out of her. Dangret
nodded, and got up slowly. The experience had been shocking, and shock—another
word that till now had had only a dictionary meaning—was what he had needed. He
was at the door before he spoke, and then it was only to say, "Sarise,
there is something I have to do right now; will you promise to show that to no
one else till I come back?"
The woman stared in amazement, but she was
exceptionally sensitive, and recognized this was not a time for argument or
discussion. She nodded mutely, and watched him go. It was just as well; she
needed food and sleep now more than admiration.
In his office, Dangret began punching
furiously at the great bank of communications keys that covered one entire
wall. It was a matter of moments till he had connected the Council of Physical
Scientists. Men from all over the six civilized galaxies stopped their work,
and concentrated on their com units. A convening of the entire council was a
rare event. Even rarer were Dangret's opening words.
"Scientists
of the world: You know the rights that reside in me as Managing Director. You
know that I have utilized those rights no more than my predecessors. There has
been no need to direct, but only to manage. Now I invoke my emergency power,
for, dependent upon your work, we may soon be faced with a desperate emergency.
I shall not attempt to outline the entire matter; that is a problem for the
Social Scientists, and when you have finished your part, they shall begin
theirs.
"This is secret
information. We are on a closed beam, and no man
BARRIER OF DREAD 319
is
to repeat these instructions until my formal permission is granted. Now: you
are, each of you, to abandon the work you have been doing, and start on . .
."
He
made his instructions specific, assigned units and unit directors, answered
startled queries for several hours, and, finally, flicked off the last open
line on his com set, his mind finally free of the tiny doubt that had plagued
it. The problem was in the hands of the scientists, now, where it belonged.
Dangret tried the private com to Sarise's room, found her asleep, and went in
to wait in the relaxation of her pleasant quarters until she might wake.
They had a rare private supper together late
in the evening, both of them relaxed and happy in achievement. Sarise never
asked questions; it was another of her endearing traits. But this time when
they had finished eating, and Dangret had still said nothing about her composition,
eagerness overcame her sense of delicacy.
She
sat upright on the cushioned floor where they rested, a tense vivid figure,
black hair and rosy lips the more colorful over her white robe. "Dan . . .
you haven't said anything," she fumbled a little. She was not accustomed
to having to ask for criticism. "My piece . . . ?"
"Yes, your piece." He was
thoughtful. "It's the best thing you've ever done, Sarise." His tone
was so sober as to make her a little ashamed to have asked. A faint blush of
something akin to modesty crept over her face, and drained swiftly away as he
went on: "But no one will ever hear it. Sarise, I'm going to exercise a
right no Director has used for five hundred years, and ban your
composition."
"Buy
why ? Why?" The woman was on her feet, pacing half across
the room, and coming back to lean over him with a look of tortured
incomprehension. "Why?"
He
carefully avoided touching her. His hand on hers would have helped, but this
was a matter of Director and artist, not man and wife. "Because it's too
good. Because you did what you set out to do. Because you created fear. And
because there is
something to fear"
She
sank down beside him, defeated. There was no question of unfairness. This was
Dangret's answer, and she knew it must be true. "Something to . . . fear?"
"Yes."
Now he could take her hand. "Listen to me, Sarise. I can't tell you all of
it, now, not until the CPS finds the answers for me. But the problem is similar
with that you outlined in your composition. The fear-reaction you aroused
stems from the concept of com-
320 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
pression
applied to an organism that must expand.
You know the dynamics of the directorship are based on expansion—indefinite,
unlimited expansion. The compression you outlined . . . well," he rose,
abruptly. "That's all I can tell you now, but believe me, no one must hear
that."
She
rose with him. "It's that serious then?" Her tone was awed. "The
dynamics of the directorship ...
?" Then her thoughts went back to her piece. "Banned . . . forever,
Dan ? Perhaps in a few years, perhaps when your problem is solved?"
"Perhaps. Perhaps if my problem is solved." He left her with that.
Because
they were reasonable, adjusted people, both of them put the matter out of their
minds after that evening. The problem was in other hands, and when the answer
came from the scientists, it would be reopened. It was not that they forgot;
rather they compartmented. Dangret checked periodically with the Council on the
progress of the research units; Sarise played her piece from time to time and
made slight revisions here and there. But, recognizing that final acdon would
have to wait on the findings of the CPS, neither of them allowed his own part
of the difficulty to assume emotional proportions.
The
answer was a long time coming. When it did, finally, Dangret took the news
first to Sarise.
She
was walking in the natural garden in front of the official residence, and
greeted him with a small sigh.
"I
think I'll make a trip to Tangerix III," she told him. "I've been
wanting to see the family, and there's something about this poor excuse for
vegetation that makes me half wild!" She pointed to the trees and flowers
of Earth, none of which could compare in any way with the planned landscapes of
robot-constructed homesites on the better planets. Tangerix particularly
boasted garden-spot planets.
"Not
to soon, I hope." Dangret smiled, teasing a little. "You'd like to be
here when your composition is played, wouldn't you?"
She
wheeled to face him, breathless. "When?" It was a sound more than a word.
"Next
week. For the Council of Social Scientists. After that," his words became
more sober, "you can go to Tangerix, and I'll go with you."
"But
. . . how can you? You have Council sessions coming, and . . ."
"And
as of next Tuesday, the Directorship will no longer exist, and your piece will
help finish it." She raised a puzzled face to his.
BARRIER OF DREAD 321
"No,
I can't tell you any more, and I shouldn't have said that much, I . • . well, I
got my answer; it was what I was afraid of,
you see, and it leaves me no alternative but . . ." he stopped abruptly.
"We'll go to Tangerix. You can make plans now if you like." She
followed him into the next room, watched him stand before the fresco. There was
an expression on his face that she had never seen before as he summoned a robot
and set it to remove the painting. "I cannot bear to see it any
longer."
The conclave of social scientists was held on
Earth, at a person-to-person meeting—a rare event—and planned that way for only
one reason: so that Sarise's composition could have an effect it could not possibly
achieve over the other. The Council met early in the morning, and Dangret, in a
few words, informed them that they had been assembled for a purpose. But
before he told them that purpose, he wished to have them review two sensories,
and to contain their curiosity until after the playings.
There was some murmuring of impatience from
younger men who could not understand being called away from important work for
entertainment, but the older heads, who had worked under Dangret for many
years, leaned back in their cushions, and lost themselves in their senses as
the first piece started, the historical review Dangret himself had seen many
months before.
The younger members had not experienced it
before, and the majestic sweep of the epic soon stilled the few murmurs. By the
time it was finished, and Sarise's indescribable composition began to fill
their senses, they were all completely receptive. When it was over, absolute
silence filled the great Council Hall. Dangret himself was almost as much
affected on second hearing as the others were on first reception. He let the
hush prevail for a full minute—and a minute can be long—before he rose from his
seat, and mounted the platform to the bank of microphones.
"Gentlemen and Scientists," he
began, "What you have just experienced is a new sensation to most of you.
To all of you, I think. It is fear. I shall not take time now to describe to
you the background of this composition. As sociologists, you are aware that no
artist could generate fear without a reason for fear existing in the artist's
environment—even a reason, as this one was, that went unexpressed and unheeded
until the artist's crystallization of the emotion forced a search for the
cause.
322 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"Since
I first heard this piece, I have had the CPS, the Council of Physical
Scientists, at work on a difficult problem. Last week I had their answer. I
shall return to that, and explain it in a few moments.
"But
first, I must make an announcement. The findings of the CPS will constitute the
reasons for my decision. Gentlemen, the future is in your hands. The
Directorship is over. I, as the last Director, now, with the information I
hold, have no ethical choice but to resign and leave the resolution of the
problem in your hands. I shall subsequently apply for admission to your ranks,
and hope that I may aid in finding the solution, but the problem is one of
research, not management.
"We
must find a new form of society. If we would keep our comforts and our way of
life, if we would keep our race extant, and above all, if we would maintain our
ethic, it is now incumbent upon us—upon you—to develop a civilization that does
not rely on the laws of dynamics. A static society.
"Our
government and our culture has rested on the unlimited principle of expansion,
on continued dynamic development. The universe is large, large enough surely
for a race so puny in comparison as ours. But not, I must now tell you, for a
civilization constructed like ours.
"Many
hundreds of years ago it was a habit of physicists and what were then known as
metaphysicists to debate the problem of infinity. There were many differing
opinions, and the conclusion in the end, was that the universe was infinite.
"I
discovered, in a Council of the Physical Scientists, some months back, that
this conclusion had never been proved. I set them the task of proving it. The
answer I had last week dictated my actions of today. We must stop; we must
change now, and find a new way of living that can exist without constant
expansion, because, fellow Scientists, our universe has been finally
established to be finite in nature!"
There
was silence, but the expressions on the faces before him changed slowly, and he
recognized feelings similar to his own. Dread! It had been there, submerged,
but now it was out for all to see—the fear of a barrier that none could cross.
To men who had lived their lives believing in the limitless of human expansion,
the very thought of this truth was as deadly as their physically coming upon
the barrier, the limit . . .
"There
is only one alternative to stasis," Dangret said finally; "ancient
philosophers were fond of saying that man was his own worst enemy. This has
been, for many years, an unnecessary, if not a false,
BARRIER OF DREAD 323
truth.
Now we must recognize that man can expand only one further way. The frontiers
are not yet gone, but they are vanishing. We must turn back upon a conquest of
ourselves, or we must learn to live stat-icly. The problem I now leave in your
hands. I hope . . ." and Dangret smiled, because humor, even in this
crisis, was an integral part of his being, "I hope that after a brief
period of personal stasis, I shall be admitted to your Council to help find a
means for the conquests of man by man."
Dangret
left the platform, and walked from the hall, without waidng for the shocked
silence among the sociologists to articulate itself in words. Outside, he went
direcdy to the apartment where Sarise had watched the scene on the com set.
He entered silently, walked over to where she
still sat staring through open set at the hubbub in the hall, and put his hands
gently on her two shoulders. She started slighdy, and smiled wearily up at him.
"So that
was it?"
"Yes." His voice was tender and
rough at the same time. "Yes, that was it. You see what you did. Oh, yes, you did it. You're an artist, and you saw things, knew things I didn't. You
took my Directorship from me, didn't you ? You took this house, and the glory
and pleasure. You took everything I had from me, and you did it by being an
artist. That was what I loved you for at first you know, and now . . ." He
lifted his hands from her shoulders to cup her face. "Now I love you more
than ever. The least
you can do," and he smiled
again, "is take me home to Tangerix III, and let me have a bit of personal
stasis."
Despite
the radical change in Man's policy of expansion in 101,950, his culture continued to thrive. In 312,552 the great robot migration began, ending with their mysterious and entire
disappearance. The human species adjusted to the change gradually and a
peaceful instability occupied them for a million years. By 1,562430 the descendants of Earthmen were again seeding universal dominance—with
Mother Earth forgotten.
METAMORPHOSITE
by Eric
Fran\ Russell
T |
hey let him
pause halfway along the gangway so that his eyes could absorb the imposing
scene. He stood in the middle of the high metal track, his left hand firmly
grasping a side rail, and gazed into the four hundred foot chasm beneath. Then
he studied the immense space vessels lying in adjacent berths, his stare
tracing their gangways to their respective elevator towers behind which stood a
great cluster of buildings whence the spaceport control column soared to the
clouds. The height at which he stood, and the enormous dimensions of his
surroundings, made him a little, doll-like figure, a man dwarfed by the mightiest
works of man.
Watching
him closely, his guards noted that he did not seem especially impressed. His
eyes appeared to discard sheer dimensions while they sought the true meaning
behind it all. His face was quite impassive as he looked around, but all his
glances were swift, intelligent and assured. He comprehended things with that
quick confidence which denotes an agile mind. One feature was prominent in the
mystery enveloping him; it was evident that he was no dope.
Lieutenant
Roka pushed past the two rearmost guards, leaned on the rail beside the silent
watcher, and explained, "This is Madistine Spaceport. There are twenty
others like it upon this planet. There are from two to twenty more on every one
of four thousand other planets, and a few of them considerably bigger. The
Empire is the greatest
324
METAMORPHOSITE 325
thing
ever known or ever likely to be known. Now you see what you're up
against."
"'Numbers
and size,'" quoth the other. He smiled faintly and shrugged. "What of
them?"
"You'll
learn what!" Roka promised. He, too, smiled, his teeth showing white and
clean. "An organization can grow so tremendous that it's far, far bigger
than the men who maintain it. From then on, its condnued growth and development
are well-nigh inevitable. It's an irresistible force with no immovable object
big enough to stop it. It's a juggernaut. It's destiny, or whatever you care to
call it."
"Bigness,"
murmured the other. "How you love bigness." He leaned over the
railing, peered into the chasm. "In all probability down there is an enemy
you've not conquered yet."
"Such as what?"
demanded Roka.
"A
cancer bug." The other's eyes swung up, gazed amusedly into the
lieutenant's. "Eh?" He shrugged again. "Alas, for brief
mortality!"
"Move on," snapped Roka to the
leading guard.
The
procession shuffled on, two guards, then the prisoner, then Roka, then two more
guards. Reaching the tower at the end of the track, the sextet took an elevator
to ground level, found a jet car waiting for them, a long, black sedan with
the Silver Comet of the Empire embossed on its sides. Two men uniformed in
myrtle green occupied its front seats while a third stood by the open door at
rear.
"Lieutenant Roka with the specimen and
appropriate documents," said Roka. He indicated the prisoner with a brief
gesture, then handed the third man a leather dispatch case. After that, he felt
in one pocket, extracted a printed pad, added, "Sign here, please."
The
official signed, returned the pad, tossed the dispatch case into the back of
the car.
"All right," he
said to the prisoner. "Get in."
Sdll
impassive, the other got into the car, relaxed on the rear seat. Roka bent
through the doorway, offered a hand.
"Well,
sorry to see the last of you. We were just getting to know each other, weren't
we? Don't get any funny ideas, will you? You're here under duress, but remember
that you're also somewhat of an ambassador—that'll give you the right angle on
things. Best of luck!"
"Thanks."
The prisoner shook the proffered hand, shifted over as the green uniformed
official clambered in beside him. The door slammed, the jets roared, the car
shot smoothly off. The prisoner smiled faintly as he caught Roka's final wave.
326 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"Nice guy, Roka," offered the
official. "Quite."
"Specimen," the official chuckled.
"Always they call 'em specimens. Whether of human shape or not, any
seemingly high or presumably intelligent form of life imported from any newly
discovered planet is, in bureaucratic jargon, a specimen. So that's what you
are, whether you like it or whether you don't. Mustn't let it worry you,
though. Nearly every worthwhile specimen has grabbed himself a high official
post when his planet has become part of the Empire."
"Nothing worries me," assured the
specimen easily.
"No?"
"No."
The
official became self-conscious. He picked the dispatch case off the floor,
jiggled it aimlessly around, judged its weight, then flopped it on his lap. The
two in front maintained grim silence and scowled steadily through the
windshield as the car swung along a broad avenue.
At
good speed they swooped over a humpback crossing, overtook a couple of highly
colored, streamlined cars, swung left at the end of the avenue. This brought
them up against a huge pair of metal gates set in a great stone wall. The place
would have looked like a jail to the newcomer if he'd known what jails look
like—which he didn't.
The
gates heaved themselves open, revealing a broad drive which ran between
well-tended lawns to the main entrance of a long, low building with a clock
tower at its center. The entrance, another metal job heavy enough to withstand
a howitzer, lay directly beneath the tower. The black sedan curved sidewise
before it, stopped with a faint hiss of air brakes.
"This is it." The official at the
back of the car opened a door, heaved himself out, dragging the case after him.
His prisoner followed, shut the door, and the sedan swooped away.
'You
see," said the man in green uniform. He gestured toward the lawns and the
distant wall. "There's the wall, the gate, and a space from here to there
in which you'd be immediately seen by the patrols. Beyond that wall are a
thousand other hazards of which you know nothing. I'm telling you this because
here's where you'll have your home until matters get settled. I would advise
you not to let your impatience overcome your judgment, as others have done.
It's no use running away when you've nowhere to run."
"Thanks," acknowledged the other.
"I won't run until I've good reason and think I know where I'm
going."
METAMORPHOSITE 327
The
official gave him a sharp look. A rather ordinary fellow, he decided, a little
under Empire average in height, slender, dark, thirty-ish and moderately
good-looking. But possessed of the cockiness of youth. Under examination he'd
probably prove boastful and misleading. He sighed his misgiving. A pity that
they hadn't snatched somebody a good deal older.
"Harumph!" he said apropos of
nothing.
He
approached the door, the other following. The door opened of its own accord,
the pair entered a big hall, were met by another official in myrtle green.
"A
specimen from a new world," said the escort, "for immediate
examination."
The
second official stared curiously at the newcomer, sniffed in disdain, said,
"O.K.—you know where to take him."
Their destination proved to be a large
examination room at one end of a marble corridor. Here, the official handed
over the dispatch case to a man in white, departed without further comment.
There were seven men and one woman in the room, all garbed in white.
They
studied the specimen calculatingly, then the woman asked, "You have
learned our language?"
"Yes."
"Very well, then, you may undress.
Remove all your clothes."
"Not likely!"
said the victim in a level voice.
The
woman didn't change expression. She bent over an official form lying on her
desk, wrote in a neat hand in the proper section: "Sex convention
normal." Then she went out.
When
the door had shut behind her, the clothes came off. The seven got to work on
the prisoner, completing the form as they went along. They did the job quietly,
methodically, as an obvious matter of old-established routine. Height:
four-point-two lineal units. Weight: seventy-seven migrads. Hair: type-S, with
front peaked. No wisdom teeth. All fingers double-jointed. Every piece of data
was accepted as if it were perfectly normal, and jotted down on the official
form. Evi-dendy they were accustomed to dealing with entities differing from
whatever was regarded as the Empire norm.
They
X-rayed his cranium, throat, chest and abdomen from front, back and both sides
and dutifully recorded that something that wasn't an appendix was located where
his appendix ought to be. Down went the details, every one of them. Membraned
epiglottis. Optical astigmatism: left eye point seven, right eye point four.
Lapped glands in
328 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
throat
in lieu of tonsils. Crenated ear lobes. Cerebral serrations complex and deep.
"Satisfied?" he asked when
apparently they'd finished with him. 'You can put on your clothes."
The
head man of the seven studied the almost completed form thoughtfully. He
watched the subject dressing himself, noted the careful, deliberate manner in
which the garments were resumed one by one. He called three of his assistants,
conferred with them in low tones.
Finally
he wrote at the bottom of the form: "Not necessarily a more advanced type,
but definitely a variadon. Possibly dangerous. Should be watched."
Unlocking the dispatch case, he shoved the form in on top of the other papers
it contained, locked the case, gave it to an assistant. "Take him along to
the next stage."
Stage
two was another room almost as large as its predecessor and made to look larger
by virtue of comparative emptiness. Its sole furnishings consisted of an
enormous carpet with pile so heavy it had to be waded through, also a large
desk of glossy plastic and two pneumatic chairs. The walls were of translucite
and the ceiling emitted a frosty glow.
In
the chair behind the desk reposed a swarthy, saturnine individual with lean
features and a hooked nose. His dress was dapper and a jeweled ring ornamented
his left index finger. His black eyes gazed speculatively as the prisoner was
marched the full length of the carpet and seated in the second chair. He
accepted the leather case, unlocked it, spent a long time submitting its
contents to careful examination.
In
the end, he said, "So it took them eight months to get you here even at
supra-spatial speed. Tut
tut, how we growl Life
won't be long enough if this goes on. They've brought you a devil of a
distance, eh? And they taught you our language on the way. Did you have much
difficulty in learning it?"
"None," said the prisoner.
"You have a natural aptitude for
languages, I suppose?" "I wouldn't know."
The
dark man leaned forward, a sudden gleam in his eyes. A faint smell of morocco
leather exuded from him. His speech was smooth.
"Your
answer implies that there is only one language employed on your home
world."
"Does it?" The prisoner stared
blankly at his questioner.
The other sat back again, thought for a
moment, then went on,
METAMORPHOSITE 329
"It
is easy to discern that you are not in the humor to be co-operative. I don't
know why. You've been treated with every courtesy and consideration, or should
have been. Have you any complaint to make on that score?"
"No," said the prisoner bluntly.
"Why
not?" The dark man made no attempt to conceal his surprise. "This is
the point where almost invariably I am treated to an impassioned tirade about
kidnaping. But you don't complain?"
"What good would it do
me?"
"No good
whatever," assured the other.
"See?" The prisoner settled himself
more comfortably in his chair. His smile was grim.
For a while, the dark man contemplated the
jewel in his ring, twisting it this way and that to catch the lights from its
facets. Eventually he wrote upon the form the one word:
"Fatalistic," after which he murmured, "Well, we'll see how far
we can get, anyway." He picked up a paper. "Your name is Harold
Harold-Myra?"
"That's correct."
"Mine's
Helman, by the way. Remember it, because you may need me sometime. Now this Harold-Myra—is
that your family name?"
"It is the compound of
my father's and mother's names."
"Hm-m-m!
I suppose that that's the usual practice on your world?"
"Yes."
"What if you marry a girl named
Betty?"
"My
name would still be Harold-Myra," the prisoner informed. "Hers would
still be the compound of her own parents' names. But our children would be
called Harold-Betty."
"I
see. Now according to this report, you were removed from a satellite after two
of our ships had landed on its parent planet and failed to take off
again."
"I
was certainly removed from a satellite. I know nothing about your ships."
"Do you know why they
failed to take off?"
"How could I? I wasn't
there!"
Helman
frowned, chewed his lower lip, then rasped, "It is I who am supposed to be
putting the questions."
"Go ahead then,"
said Harold Harold-Myra.
"Your
unspoken thought being, 'And a lot of good it may do you/ " put in Helman
shrewdly. He frowned again, added the word:
330 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"Stubborn"
to the form before him. "It seems to me," he went on, "that both
of us are behaving rather childishly. Mutual antagonism profits no one. Why
can't we adopt the right attitude toward each other? Let's be frank, eh?"
He smiled, revealing bright dentures. "I'll put my cards on the table and
you put yours." "Let's see yours."
Helman's
smile vanished as quickly as it had appeared. He looked momentarily pained.
"Distrustful" went down on the form. He spoke, choosing his words
carefully.
"I take it that you learned a lot about
the Empire during your trip here. You know that it is a mighty organization of
various forms of intelligent life, most of them, as it happens, strongly
resembling yours and mine, and all of them owing allegiance to the particular
solar system in which you're now located. You have been told, or should have
been told, that the Empire sprang from here, that throughout many, many
centuries it has spread over four thousand worlds, and that it's still
spreading."
"I've heard all of
that," admitted the other.
"Good! Then you'll be able to understand
that you're no more than a temporary victim of our further growth, but, in many
ways, a lucky man."
"I fail to perceive
the luck."
"You
will, you will," soothed Helman. "All in good time." Mechanically,
his smile had returned, and he was making an attempt at joviality. "Now I
can assure you that an organization so old and so widespread as ours is not
without a modicum of wisdom. Our science has given us incredible powers,
including the power to blow whole worlds apart and desiccate them utterly, but
that doesn't make us disregard caution. After a wealth of experience covering
a multitude of planets we've learned that we're still not too great to be
brought low. Indeed, for all our mighty power, we can err in manner disastrous
to us all. So we step carefully."
"Sounds as if someone once put a scare
into you," commented Harold Harold-Myra.
Helman hesitated, then said, "As a
matter of fact, someone did. I'll tell you about it. Many decades ago we made a
first landing on a new planet. The ship failed to take off. Our exploratory
vessels always travel in threes, so a second vessel went down to the aid of its
fellow. That didn't take off either. But the third ship, waiting in space, got
a
METAMORPHOSITE 331
despairing
message warning that the world held highly intelligent life of an elusive and
parasitic type."
"And
they confiscated the bodies you'd so kindly provided," suggested Harold.
"You
know all about this life form?" Helman asked. His fingers slid toward an
invisible spot on the surface of his desk.
"It's
the first I've heard of them," replied the other. "Confiscation was
logical."
"I
suppose so," Helman admitted with some reluctance. He went on, his keen
eyes on his listener. "They didn't get the chance to take over everyone. A
few men realized their peril in the nick of time, locked themselves in one
vessel away from the parasites and away from their stricken fellows. There
weren't enough of them to take off, so they beamed a warning. The third ship
saw the menace at once; if action wasn't taken swiftly it meant that we'd
handed the keys of the cosmos to unknown powers. They destroyed both ships with
one atomic bomb. Later, a task ship arrived, took the stern action we deemed
necessary, and dropped a planet wrecker. The world dissolved into flashing
gases. It was an exceedingly narrow squeak. The Empire, for all its wealth,
ingenuity and might, could not stand if no citizen knew the real nature of his
neighbor."
"A
sticky situation," admitted Harold Harold-Myra. "I see now where I
come in—I am a sample."
"Precisely."
Helman was jovial again. "All we wish to discover is whether your world is
a safe one."
"Safe for what?"
"For straightforward contact."
"Contact for what?" Harold
persisted.
"Dear
mel I'd have thought a person of your intelligence would see the mutual
advantages to be gained from a meeting of different cultures."
"I
can see the advantages all right. I can also see the consequences."
"To what do you refer?" Helman's amiability began to evaporate.
"Embodiment in your Empire."
"Tut"
said Helman impatiendy.
"Your world would join us only of its own free will. In the second place,
what's wrong with being part of the Empire? In the third, how d'you know that
your opinions coincide with those of your fellows? They may think differently.
They may prove eager to come in."
33^ JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"It looks like it seeing that you've got
two ships stuck there."
"Ah, then you admit
that they're forcibly detained?"
"I admit nothing. For all I know, your
crews may be sitting there congratulating themselves on getting away from the
Empire—while my people are taking steps to throw them out."
Helman's
lean face went a shade darker. His long, slender hands clenched and unclenched
while his disciplined mind exerted itself to suppress the retort which his
emotion strove to voice.
Then he said, "Citizens of the Empire
don't run away from it. Those who do run don't get very far."
"A
denial and an affirmative," commented Harold amusedly. "All in one
breath. You can't have it both ways. Either they run or they don't."
"You
know perfectly well what I meant." Helman, speaking slowly and evenly,
wasn't going to let this specimen bait him. "The desire to flee is as
remote as the uselessness of it is complete."
"The former being due to the
latter?"
"Not at all!" said Helman sharply.
"You damn your ramshackle Empire with
every remark you make," Harold informed. "I reckon I know it better
than you do."
"And
how do you presume to know our Empire?" inquired Helman. His brows arched
in sarcastic interrogation. "On what basis do you consider yourself
competent to judge it?"
"On
the basis of history," Harold told him. "Your people are sufficiently
like us to be like us—and if you can't understand that remark, well, I can't
help it. On my world we're old, incredibly old, and we've learned a lot from a
past which is long and lurid. We've had empires by the dozens, though none as
great as yours. They all went the same way—down the sinkhole. They all vanished
for the same fundamental and inevitable reasons. Empires come and empires go,
but little men go on forever."
"Thanks,"
said Helman quickly. He wrote on the form: "Anarchistic," then,
after further thought, added: "Somewhat of a crackpot."
Harold
Harold-Myra smiled slowly and a little sadly. The writing was not within line
of his vision, but he knew what had been written as surely as if he'd written
it himself. To the people of his ancient planet it was not necessary to look at
things in order to see them.
Pushing
the form to one side, Helman said, "The position is that every time we
make a landing we take the tremendous risk of presenting our secrets of space
conquest to people of unknown abilities and
METAMORPHOSITE 333
doubtful
ambitions. It's a chance that has to be taken. You understand that?" He
noted the other's curt nod, then went on, "As matters stand at present,
your world holds two of our best vessels. Your people, for all we can tell,
may be able to gain a perfect understanding of them, copy them in large
numbers, even improve on them. Your people may take to the cosmos, spreading
ideas that don't coincide with ours. Therefore, in theory, the choice is war or
peace. Actually, the choice for your people will be a simple one: co-operation
or desiccation. I hate to tell you this, but your hostile manner forces me to
do so."
"Uncommunicative
might be a better word than hostile," suggested Harold Harold-Myra.
"Those who're not with us are against
us," retorted Helman. "We're not being dictatorial; merely realistic.
Upon what sort of information we can get out of you depends the action we take
regarding your world. You are, you must understand, the representative of your
kind. We are quite willing to accept that your people resemble you to within
reasonable degree, and from our analysis of you we'll decide whether—"
"We get canonized or vaporized,"
put in Harold.
"If
you like." Helman refused to be disturbed. He'd now acquired the sang-froid of one conscious of mastery. "It is for
you to decide the fate of your planet. It's an enormous responsibility to place
on one man's shoulders, but there it is, and you've got to bear it. And remember,
we've other methods of extracting from you the information we require. Now, for
the last time, are you willing to subject yourself to my cross-examination, or
are you not?"
"The answer is,"
said Harold carefully, "not!"
"Very well then." Helman accepted
it phlegmatically. He pressed the spot on his desk. "You compel me to turn
from friendly interrogation to forcible analysis. I regret it, but it is your
own choice." Two attendants entered, and he said to them, "Take him
to stage three."
The escorting pair left him in this third and
smaller room and he had plenty of time to look around before the three men
engaged therein condescended to notice him. They were all in white, this trio,
but more alert and less automatic than the white-garbed personnel of the medical
examination room. Two of them were young, tall, muscular, and hard of
countenance. The third was short, thickset, middle-aged and had a neady clipped
beard.
334 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
Briskly
they were switching on a huge array of apparatus covering one wall of the
room. The set-up was a mass of plastic panels, dials, meters, buttons, switches,
sockets with corded plugs, and multi-connection pieces. From inside or close
behind this affair came a low, steady hum. Before it, centrally positioned, was
a chair.
Satisfied
that all was in readiness, the bearded man said to Harold, "O.K., be
seated." He signed to his two assistants who stepped forward as if eager
to cope with a refusal.
Harold
smiled, waved a negligent hand, sat himself in the chair. Working swiftly, the
three attached cushioned metal bands to his ankles, calves, thighs, chest,
neck and head. Flexible metal tubes ran from the bands to the middle of the
apparatus while, in addition, the one about his head was connected to a thin,
multicore cable.
They adjusted the controls to give certain
readings on particular meters, after which the bearded one fixed glasses on his
nose, picked up a paper, stared at it myopically. He spoke to the subject in
the chair.
"I am about to ask you a series of questions.
They will be so phrased that the answers may be given as simple negatives or
affirmatives. You can please yourself whether or not you reply vocally—it is a
matter of total indifference to me."
He glanced at Harold and his eyes, distorted
into hugeness behind thick-lensed glasses, were cold and blank. His finger
pressed a button; across the room a camera whirred into action, began to
record the readings on the various meters.
Disregarding
everything else, and keeping his attention wholly on the man in the chair, the
bearded one said, "You were discovered on a satellite—yes or no?"
Harold grinned
reminiscently, did not reply.
"Therefore your people
know how to traverse space?"
No reply.
"In fact they can go further than to a
mere satellite. They can reach neighboring planets—yes or no?" No reply.
"Already they have explored neighboring
planets?" No reply.
"The
truth is that they can do even better than that—they have reached other solar
systems?"
He smiled once more, enigmatically.
"Your world is a world by itself?"
Silence.
"It
is one of an association of worlds?" Silence.
"It
is the outpost world of another Empire?" Silence.
"But
that Empire is smaller than ours?" No response. "Greater than
ours?"
"Heavens,
I've been led to believe that yours is the greatest ever," said Harold
sardonically.
"Be quiet!" One of the young ones
standing at his side gave him an irate thrust on the shoulder.
"Or
what?"
"Or
we'll slap your ears off!"
The
bearded man, who had paused expressionlessly through this brief interlude,
carried on nonchalantly.
"Your kind are the highest form of life
on your planet? There is no other intelligent life thereon? You knew of no
other intelligent life anywhere previous to encountering emissaries of the
Empire?"
The
questioner Was in no way disturbed by his victim's complete
lack of response, and his bearing made that fact clear. Occasionally peering at
the papers in his hand, but mostly favoring his listener with a cold, owlish stare, he ploughed steadily on. The questions reached one
hundred, two hundred, then Harold lost count of them. Some were substitutes or
alternatives for others, some made cross reference with others asked before or
to be asked later, some were obvious traps. All were cogent and pointed. All
met stubborn silence.
They
finished at length, and the bearded one put away his papers with the grumbling
comment, "It's going to take us all night to rationalize this lot!"
He gave Harold a reproving stare. "You might just as well have talked in
the first place. It would have saved us a lot of bother and gained you a lot of
credit."
"Would
it?" Harold was incredulous.
"Take
him away," snapped the bearded man.
One
of the young men looked questioningly at the oldster, who understood the
unspoken query and responded, "No, not there. Not yet, anyway. It mightn't
be necessary. Let's see what we've got first." He took off his glasses,
scratched his beard. "Put him in his apartment. Give him something to
eat." He cackled gratingly. "Let the condemned man eat a hearty
meal."
336 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
The apartment proved to be compact,
well-appointed, comfortable. Three rooms: bathroom, bedroom, sitting room, the
latter with a filled bookcase, a large electric radiator, sunken heating panels
for extra warmth, and a magniscreen television set.
Harold
sprawled at ease in a soft, enveloping chair, watched a short-haired, burly man
wheel in a generous meal. Hungry as he was, his attention didn't turn to the
food. He kept it fixed on the burly man who, unconscious of the persistent
scrutiny, methodically put out the meat, bread, fruit, cakes and coffee.
As the other finished his task, Harold said
casually, "What are those lizardlike things that wear black uniforms with
silver braid?"
"Dranes."
Short-hair turned around, gazed dully at the prisoner. His face was heavy,
muscular, his eyes small, his forehead low. "We calls 'em Dranes."
"Yes, but what are they?"
"Oh,
just another life form, I guess. From some other planet— maybe from one called
Drane. I dunno. I used to know, but Fve forgotten."
"You don't like them, eh?"
suggested Harold.
"Who
does?" He frowned with the unusual strain of thought, his small eyes
shrinking still smaller. "I like to have ideas of my own, see? I don't
care for any lizards reading my mind and telling the world what I'd sooner keep
to myself, see ? A man wants privacy—especially sometimes."
"So they're telepaths!" It was
Harold's turn to frown. "Hm-m-m!" He mused anxiously. The other began
to shove his empty meal trolley toward the door, and Harold went on hurriedly,
"Any of them hereabouts?"
"No, it's too late in the evening. And
there ain't a lot of them on this planet, thank Pete I Only a few here. They do
some sort of official work, I dunno what. A couple of them got important jobs
right in this dump, but they'll be home now. Good riddance, I says!" He
scowled to show his intense dislike of the mysterious Dranes. "A guy can
think what he likes while they're away." He pushed his trolley outside,
followed it and closed the door. The lock clicked quietly, ominously.
Harold got on with his meal while he waited
for angry men to come for him. Beardface and his two assistants had indicated
that nothing more would be done with him before morning, but this last episode
would speed things up considerably. He hastened his eating, vaguely surprised
that he was getting it finished without interruption. They were less quick on
the uptake than he'd anticipated. He employed the time usefully in working out
a plan of campaign.
The
apartment made his problem tough. He'd already given it a thorough scrutiny,
noted that its decorated walls and doors were all of heavy metal. The windows
were of armorglass molded in one piece over metal frames with sturdy, closely
set bars. It was more than an apartment; it was a vault.
There was a very tiny lens cunningly
concealed in the wall high up in one corner. It would have escaped discovery by
anyone with lesser powers of observation. He'd found another mounted on the
stem of the hour hand of the clock. It looked like a jewel. He knew it to be a
scanner of some kind, and suspected that there were others yet to be found.
Where there were scanners there would also be microphones, midget jobs hard to
dig out when you don't want to make a search too obvious. Oh, yes, they'd know
all about his little conversation with Short-hair—and they'd be along.
They
were. The lock clicked open just as he ended his meal. Hel-man came in followed
by a huge fellow in uniform. The latter closed the door, leaned his broad back
against it, pursed his lips in a silent whistle while he studied the room with
obvious boredom. Helman went to a chair, sat in it, crossed his legs, looked
intently at the prisoner. A vein pulsed in his forehead and the effect of it
was menacing.
He said, "I've been on the televox to
Roka. He swears that he's never mentioned the Dranes in your presence. He's
positive that they've never been mentioned or described in your hearing by
anyone on the ship. Nothing was said about them by the guards who brought you
here. You've seen none in this building. So how d'you know about them?"
"Mystifying, isn't it?" commented
Harold pleasantly.
"There
is only one way in which you could have found out about the Dranes,"
Helman went on. "When the examiners finished with you in stage three an
assistant pondered the notion of passing you along to stage four, but the idea
was dropped for the time being. Stage four is operated by the Dranes."
"Really?" said
Harold. He affected polite surprise.
"The
Dranes were never mentioned," persisted Helman, his hard eyes fixed on his
listener, "but they were thought of. You read those thoughts. You are a
telepath!"
"And you're surprised by the
obvious?"
338 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"It
wasn't obvious because it wasn't expected," Helman retorted. "On four
thousand worlds there are only eleven truly telepathic life forms and not one
of them human in shape. You're the first human-oid possessing that power we've
discovered to date."
"Nevertheless,"
persisted Harold, "it should have been obvious. My refusal to
co-operate—or my stubbornness as you insist on calling it—had good reason. I
perceived all the thoughts behind your questions. I didn't like them. I sdll
don't like them."
"Then
you'll like even less the ones I'm thinking now," snapped Helman.
"I don't," Harold agreed.
"You've sent out a call for the Dranes, ordered them to come fast, and you
think they'll be here pretty soon. You expect them to suck me dry. You've great
confidence in their powers even though you can't conceive the full extent of
mine." He stood up, smiled as Helman uncrossed his legs with a look of
sudden alarm. He stared into Helman's black eyes, and his own were sparkling
queerly. "I think," he said, "that this is a good time for us to
go trundle our hoops—don't you?"
"Yes,"
Helman murmured. Clumsily he got to his feet, stood there with an air of
troubled preoccupation. "Yes, sure!"
The
guard at the door straightened up, his big hands held close to his sides. He
looked inquiringly at the vacant Helman. When Helman failed to respond, he
shifted his gaze to the prisoner, kept the gaze fixed while slowly the
alertness faded from his own optics.
Then,
although he'd not been spoken to, he said hoarsely, "O.K., we'll get
along. We'll get a move on." He opened the door.
The
three filed out, the guard leading, Helman in the rear. They moved rapidly
along the corridors, passing other uniformed individuals without challenge or
comment until they reached the main hall. Here, the man in myrtle green, whose
little office held the lever controlling the automatic doors, sat at his desk
and felt disposed to be officious.
"You can't take him out until you've
signed him out, stating where he's being taken, and on whose authority,"
he enunciated flatly.
"On
my authority," said Helman. He voiced the words in suited tones as if he
were a ventriloquist's dummy, but the officious one failed to notice it.
"Oh, all right," he growled. He
shoved a large, heavy tome to one end of his desk. "Sign there. Name in
column one, destination in column two, dme of return in column three." He
looked at the huge
METAMORPHOSITE 339
guard
who was watching dumbly, emitted a resigned sigh, inquired, "I suppose you
need a car ?"
"Yes," said
Helman mechanically.
The
official pressed a button; a sonorous gong clanged somewhere outside the
building. Then he pulled his tiny lever; the great doors swung open. The trio
strolled out with deceptive casualness, waited a moment while the doors closed
behind them. It was fairly dark now, but not completely so, for a powdering of
stars lay across the sky, and a steady glow of light emanated from the
surrounding city.
Presently
a jet car swept around one end of the building, stopped before them. The three
got in. Harold sat at the back between Helman and the big guard, both of whom
were strangely silent, ruminative. The driver turned around, showed them a
face with raised eyebrows.
"Downtown," uttered Helman curtly.
The driver nodded, faced front. The car
rolled toward the gates in the distant wall, reached them, but they remained
closed. Two men in green emerged from the shadow of the wall, focused light
beams on the vehicle's occupants.
One
said, "Inquisitor Helman, one specimen—I guess it's O.K." He waved
his light beam toward the gates which parted slowly and ponderously. Emitting a
roar from its jets, the car swept through.
They
dropped Harold Harold-Myra in the mid-southern section of the city where
buildings grew tallest and crowds swarmed thickest. Helman and the guard got
out of the car, talked with him while the driver waited out of earshot.
"You
will both go home," Harold ordered, "remembering nothing of this and
behaving normally. Your forgetfulness will persist until sunrise. Until you see
the sun you will be quite unable to recall anything which has occurred since
you entered my room. Do you understand?"
"We understand."
Obediently
they got back into the car. They were a pair of automatons. He stood on the
sidewalk, watched their machine merge into the swirl of traffic and disappear.
The sky was quite dark now, but the street was colorful with lights that
shifted and flickered and sent eccentric shadows skittering across the
pavement.
For
a few minutes he stood quietly regarding the shadows and musing within himself.
He was alone—alone against a world. It didn't bother him particularly. His
situation was no different from
340 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
that
of his own people who formed a solitary world on the edge of a great Empire.
He'd one advantage which so far had stood him in good stead: he knew his own
powers. His opponents were ignorant in that respect. On the other hand, he
suffered the disadvantage of being equally ignorant, for although he'd learned
much about the people of the Empire, he still did not know the full extent of
their powers. And theirs were likely to be worthy of respect. Alliance of
varied life forms with varied talents could make a formidable combination. The
batde was to be one oí
homo superior versus homo sapiens plus the Dranes plus other things of unknown
abilities—with the odds much in favor of the combine.
Now that he was foot-loose and fancy-free he
could appreciate that guard's argument that there's no point in being free
unless one knows where to nurse one's freedom. The guard, though, had implied
something and overlooked something else. He'd implied that there were places in
which freedom could be preserved, and he'd forgotten that escapees have a
flair for discovering unadvertised sanctuaries. If his own kind were half as
wise and a quarter as crafty as they ought to be, thought Harold, the tracing
of such a sanctuary should not be difficult.
He shrugged, turned to go, found himself
confronted by a tall, thin fellow in black uniform with silver buttons and
silver braid. The newcomer's features were gaunt and tough, and they changed
color from gold to blood-red as the light from a nearby electric sign flickered
over it.
Harold
could hear the other's mind murmuring, "Queer, outlandish clothes this fellow's wearing. Evidently a
recent importee—maybe a specimen on the lam!' even as the thinker's mouth opened and he said audibly, "Let me see your identity
card!"
"Why?" asked Harold, stalling for
time. Curse the clothes-— he'd not had time to do anything about them yet.
"It's the regulation," the other
returned irritably. "You should know that every citizen must produce his
card when called upon to do so by the police." His eyes narrowed, his mind
spoke silently but dis-cernibly. "Ah, he hesitates. It must be that he doesn't possess a card. This
loo\s bad!" He
took a step forward.
Harold's
eyes flamed with an odd glow. "You don't really want to see my card?"
he said gently. "Do you?"
The
policeman had a momentary struggle with himself before he answered, "No ... no ... of course
not!"
METAMORPHOSITE 341
"It was just your mistake?"
"Just
my mistake 1" admitted the other slowly. His mind was now completely
muddled. A random thought, "He's dangerous!" fled wildly through the cerebral maze, pursued, outshouted and finally
silenced by other, violently imposed thoughts saying, "Silly mistake. Of course he's got a
card. I interfere too much"
With
shocking suddenness, another thought broke in, registering clearly and
succintly despite the telepathic hubbub of a hundred surrounding minds. "By the Blue Sun, did you catch that,
Gaeta? A fragment of hypnotic projection! Something about a card. Turn the car
round I"
A
cold sweat beaded on Harold's spine, he closed his mind like a trap, sent his
sharp gaze along the road. There was too great a flood of cars and too many
swiftly changing lights to enable him to pick out any one vehicle turning in
the distance. But he'd know that car if it came charging down upon him. Its
driver might be of human shape, but its passengers would be lizardlike.
Machines whirled past him four, five and
somedmes six abreast. The eerie voice which had faded suddenly came back, waxed
strong, faded away again.
It said, "I might be wrong, of course. But I'm
sure the amplitude was sufficient for hypnosis. No, it's gone now—I can't pic\
it up at all. All these people mafe too much of a jumble on the neural
band!"
Another thought, a new one, answered
impatiently, "Oh,
let it pass, you're not on duty now. If we don't—" It waned to indiscerni-bility.
Then
the policeman's mind came back, saying, "Well, why am I standing here life a dummy? Why was I picfeng on
this guy? It must've been for something! I didn't stop him for the fun of
it—unless Vm scatty!"
Harold
said quickly and sharply, "You didn't stop me. I stopped you. Intelligence
Service—remember?"
"Eh?" The cop
opened his mouth, closed it, looked confused.
"Wait a moment," added Harold, a
strong note of authority in his voice. He strained his perception anxiously. A
river of surrounding thoughts flowed through his mind, but none with the power
and clarity of the invisible Gaeta and his alert companion. Could they, too,
close their minds? There wasn't any way of telling!
He gave it up, returned his attention to the
cop, and said, "Intelli-
342 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
gence
Service. I showed you my official warrant. Good heavens, man, have you
forgotten it already?"
"No."
The man in black was disconcerted by this unexpected aggressiveness. The reference
to a nonexistent Intelligence Service warrant made his confusion worse
confounded. "No," he protested, "I haven't forgotten."
Then, in weak effort to make some sort of a come-back. "But you started to say something, and I'm waiting to hear the rest."
Harold smiled, took him by the arm.
"Look, I'm authorized to call upon you for assistance whenever needed. You
know that, don't you?" "Yes, sure, but—"
"What I want you to do is very simple.
It's necessary that I change attire with a certain suspected individual and
that he be kept out of circulation overnight. I'll point him out to you when
he comes along. You're to tell him that you're taking him in for interrogation.
You'll then conduct us somewhere where we can change clothes, preferably your
own apartment if you've got one. I'll give you further instructions when we
get there."
"All right," agreed the cop. He
blinked as he tried to rationalize his mind. Thoughts gyrated bafflingly in his
cranium. "Not
for you to reason why. Do your duty and as\ no questions. Let higher-ups take
the responsibility. This guy's got all the authority in the world— and he \nows what
he's doing!' There
was something not quite right about those thoughts. They seemed to condense
inward instead of expanding outward, as thoughts ought to do. But they were
powerful enough, sensible enough, and he wasn't able to give birth to any contrary
ideas, "All right," he repeated.
Studying the passers-by, Harold picked a man
of his own height and build. Of all the apparel streaming past, this fellow's
looked made to fit
him to a nicety. He nudged the cop.
"That's the man."
The officer strode majestically forward,
stopped the victim, said, "Police! I'm taking you in for
interrogation."
"Me?" The man was dumfounded.
"I've done nothing!" "Then what've you got to worry about?"
"Nothing," hastily assured the
other. He scowled with annoyance. "I guess I'll have to go. But it's a
waste of time and a nuisance."
"So
you think the Empire's business is a nuisance?" inquired Harold, joining
the cop.
The victim favored him with a look of intense
dislike, and com-
METAMORPHOSITE 343
plained, "Go on, try making a case
against me. Having it stick will be something else!" "Well see!"
Cutting
down a side street, the trio hit a broad avenue at its farther end. No cars
here; it was solely for pedestrians. The road was divided into six moving
strips, three traveling in each direction, slowest on the outsides, fastest in
the middle. Small groups of people, some chatting volubly, some plunged in
boredom, glided swiftly along the road and shrank in the distance. A steady
rumbling sound came from beneath the rubbery surface of the road.
The
three skipped onto an outer slow strip, thence to the medium fast strip, finally
to the Central rapid strip. The road bore them ten blocks before they left it.
Harold could see it rolling on for at least ten blocks more.
The cop's apartment proved to be a
modernistic, three-roomed bachelor flat on the second floor of a tall, graystone
building. Here, the captive started to renew his protests, looked at Harold,
found his opinions changing even as he formed them. He waxed co-operative,
though in a manner more stupefied than willing. Emptying the contents of his
pockets on a table, he exchanged clothes.
Now
dressed in formal, less outlandish manner, Harold said to the police officer,
"Take off your jacket and make yourself at home. No need to be formal on
this job. We may be here some time yet. Get us a drink while I tell this fellow
what's afoot." He waited until the cop had vanished into an adjoining
room, then his eyes flamed at the vaguely disgruntled victim.
"Sleep!" he commanded, "sleep!"
The
man stirred in futile opposition, closed his eyes, let his head hang forward.
His whole body slumped wearily in its chair. Raking rapidly through the
personal possessions on the table, Harold found the fellow's identity card.
Although he'd never seen such a document before, he wasted no time examining
it, neither did he keep it. With quick dexterity, he dug the cop's wallet out
of his discarded jacket, extracted the police identity card, substituted the
other, replaced the wallet. The police card he put in his own pocket. Way back
on the home planet it was an ancient adage that double moves are more confusing
that single ones.
He
was barely in time. The cop returned with a bottle of pink, oily liquid, sat
down, looked dully at the sleeper, said, "Huh?" and transferred his
lackluster stare to Harold. Then he blinked several times, each time more
slowly than before, as if striving to keep his
344 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
eyes
open against an irresistible urge to keep them shut. He failed* Imitating his
captive, he hung his head—and began to snore.
"Sleep,"
murmured Harold, "sleep on toward the dawn. Then you may awake. But not
before I"
Leaning
forward, he lifted a small, highly polished instrument from its leather case
beneath the policeman's armpit. A weapon of some sort. Pointing it toward the
window, he pressed the stud set in its butt. There was a sharp, hard crack, but
no recoil. A perfect disk of glassite vanished from the center of the window.
Cold air came in through the gap, bringing with it a smell like that of roasted
resin. Giving the weapon a grim look, he shoved it back into its holster,
dusted his fingers distastefully.
"So,"
he murmured, "discipline may be enforced by death. Verily, I'm back in
the dark ages!"
Ignoring the sleepers, he made swift search
of the room. The more he knew about the Empire's ordinary, everyday citizens
the better it'd be for him. Knowledge—the right knowledge—was a powerful arm
in its own right. His people understood the value of intangibles.
Finished, he was about to leave when a tiny
bell whirred somewhere within the wall. He traced the sound as emanating from
behind a panel, debated the matter before investigating further. Potential danger
lurked here; but nothing ventured, nothing gained. He slid the panel aside,
found himself facing a tiny loudspeaker, a microphone, a lens, and a small,
circular screen.
The screen was alive and vivid with color,
and a stern, heavily jowled face posed in sharp focus within its frame. The
caller raked the room with one quick, comprehending glance, switched his attention
to Harold.
"So the missing Guarda is indisposed," he growled. "He slumbers before a bottle. He
awaits three charges: absent from duty, improperly dressed, and drunk! We'll
deal with this at once." He thinned his lips. "What is your name and
the number of your identity card, citizen?"
"Find
out," suggested Harold. He slammed the panel before the tiny scanner could
make a permanent record of his features—if he had not done so already.
That was an unfortunate episode: it cut down
his self-donated hours of grace to a few minutes. They'd be on their way
already, and he'd have to move out fast.
He was out of the apartment
and the building in a trice. A pass-
METAMORPHOSITE 345
ing
car stopped of its own accord and took him downtown. Its driver was blissfully
unaware of the helplessness of his own helpfulness.
Here,
the city seemed brighter than ever mostly because the deeper darkness of the
sky enhanced the multitude of lights. A few stars still shone, and a string of
colored balls drifted high against the backdrop where some unidentifiable
vessel drove into space.
He merged with the crowds still thronging the
sidewalks. There was safety in numbers. It's hard to pick one guy out of the
mob, especially when he's dressed like the mob, behaves like the mob. For some
time he moved around with the human swarm though his movements were not as
aimless. He was listening to thoughts, seeking either of two thought-forms, one
no more than slightly helpful, the other important. He found the former, not
the latter.
A
fat man wandered past him and broadcast the pleasurable notion of food shared
in large company. He turned and followed the fat man, tracking him along three
streets and another moving avenue. The fat man entered a huge restaurant with
Harold at his heels. They took an unoccupied table together.
Plenty
of active thoughts here. In fact the trouble was that there were far too many.
They made a constant roar right across the telepathic band; it was difficult
to separate one from another, still more difficult to determine who was
emanating which. Nevertheless, he persisted in his effort to sort out
individual broadcasts, taking his food slowly to justify remaining there as
long as possible. Long after the fat man had left he was still seated there,
listening, listening. There were many thoughts he found interesting, some
revealing, some making near approach to the notions he sought, but none quite
on the mark, not one.
In the end, he gave it up, took his check
from the waiter. It was readily apparent what the waiter had on his mind,
namely, this crazy stuff called money. Roka had told him a lot about money,
even showing him samples of the junk. He remembered that Roka had been dumfounded
by his ignorance concerning a common medium of exchange. With amusing
superiority, the worthy lieutenant had assumed that Harold's people had yet to
discover what they'd long since forgotten.
There
had been some of this money—he didn't know just how much—in the pockets of this
suit, but he'd left it all with the suit's hapless donor. There wasn't any
point in snatching someone else's
346 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
tokens.
Besides, having managed without it all his life he wasn't going to become a
slave to it now.
He
paid the waiter with nothing, putting it into the fellow's hand with the lordly
air of one dispensing a sizable sum. The waiter gratefully accepted nothing,
put nothing into his pocket, initialed the check, bowed obsequiously. Then he
rubbed his forehead, looked vague and confused, but said nothing. Harold went
out.
It was on the sidewalk Harold made the
contact he was seeking, though not in the manner he'd expected. He was looking
for a mutinous thinker who might lead him to the underworld of mutinous
thinkers. Instead, he found a friend.
The fellow was twenty yards away and walking
toward him with a peculiarly loose-jointed gait. He was humanoid in all
respects but one—his skin was reptilian. It was a smooth but scaly skin of
silvery gray in which shone an underlying sheen of metallic blue. The pupils of
his eyes were a very light gray, alert, intelligent.
Those
eyes looked straight into Harold's as they came abreast, a flood of amity
poured invisibly from them as he smiled and said in an undertone, "Come
with me." He walked straight on, without a pause. He didn't look back to
see whether Harold followed.
Harold didn't wait to consider the matter.
This was a time for quick decision. Swiveling on one heel he trailed along
behind the speaker. And as he trod warily after the other, his mind was active
with thoughts, and his thinking was done within a mental shell through which
nothing could probe.
Evidently
the scaly man was an outsider, a product of some other world. His queer skin
was proof of that. There were other factors, too. He hadn't read Harold's
mind—Harold was positive of that— yet in some strange, inexplicable way he'd
recognized a kinship between them and had acknowledged it without hesitation.
Moreover, he was strolling along with his mind wide open, but Harold was totally
unable to analyze his thoughts. Those thoughts, in all probability, were straightforward
and logical enough, but they oscillated in and out of the extreme edge of the
neural band. Picking them up was like trying to get frequency modulation on a
receiver designed for amplitude modulation. Those thought-forms might be
normal, but their wave-forms were weird.
Still
not looking back, the subject of his speculations turned into an apartment
building took a levitator to the tenth floor. Here he un-
METAMORPHOSITE 347
locked
a door, gazed around for the first time, smiled again at his follower,
motioned him inside.
Harold went in. The other closed the door
after him. There were two similar entities in the apartment. One sat on the
edge of a table idly swinging his legs; the other lounged on a settee and was
absorbed in a magazine.
"Oh,
Melor, there's a—" began the
one on the settee. He glanced up, saw the visitor, grinned in friendly fashion.
Then his expression changed to one of surprise, and he said, "By the
everlasting light, it's you I Where did you find him, Melor?"
This
one's mind was fully as baffling and Harold found himself unable to get
anything out of it. The same applied to the being perched upon the table: his
thoughts wavered in and out of the borderline of detection.
"I
found him on the street," replied the one called Melor, "and I
invited him along. He has a most attractive smell." He sat down, invited
Harold to do likewise. Looking at the one on the settee, he went on, "What
did you mean by, 'Oh, it's you'? D'you
know him?"
"No."
The other switched on a teleset at his side. "They broadcast a call for
him a few minutes ago. He's wanted—badly." He moved a second switch.
"Here's the recording. Watch!"
The
set's big screen lit up. A sour-faced man in flamboyant uniform appeared on
the screen, spoke with official ponderousness.
"All
citizens are warned to keep watch for and, if possible, apprehend an escaped
specimen recendy brought from the Frontier. Name: Harold Harold-Myra.
Description—" He went on at great
length, giving everything in minute detail, then finished, "His attire is
noticeably unconventional and he has not yet been provided with an identity
card. Citizens should bear in mind that he may possess attributes not familiar
to Empire races and that he is wanted alive. In case of necessity, call Police
Emergency on Stud Four. Here is his likeness."
The
screen went blank, lit up again, showed Harold's features in full color. He
recognized part of his former prison in the background. Those midget scanners
had done their job!
"Tush
I" scoffed the being on the settee. He switched
off, turned to Harold. "Well, you're in good hands. That's something. We
wouldn't give anyone in authority a magni-belt to hold up his pants. My name's
Tor. The one industriously doing nothing on the table is Vern. The one who
brought you here is Melor. Our other names don't
348 journey
to infinity
matter
much. As maybe you've guessed, we aren't of this lousy, over-organized world.
We're from Linga, a planet which is a devil of a long ] way off, too far away
for my liking. The more I think of it, the farther it seems."
"It's
no farther than my own world," said Harold. He leaned forward.
"Look, can you read my mind?"
"Not a possibility of it," Tor
answered. "You're like the local breed in that respect—you think
pulsatingly and much too far down for us. Can you read ours?"
"I can't. You wobble in and out of my
limit." He frowned. "What beats me is what made Melor pick me out if
he can't read my thoughts."
"I smelled you,"
Melor put in.
"Huh?"
"That's
not strictly correct, but it's the best way I can explain it. Most of the
Empire's peoples have some peculiar faculty they call a sense of smell. We
don't possess it. They talk about bad odors and sweet ones, which is gibberish
to us. But we can sense affinities and ] oppositions, we can sort of 'smell'
friends and enemies, instantly, in-; fallibly. Don't ask me how we do it, for
how can I tell you?"
"I see the
difficulty," agreed Harold. ,
"On
our world," Melor continued, "most life forms have this sense i which seems peculiar to Linga. We've no tame animals and no wild
ones—they're tame if you like them, wild if you don't. None would be"
driven by curiosity to make close approach to a hunter, none would flee timidly
from someone anxious to pet them. Instinctively they i. know which is friend and which is enemy. They know it as certainly as
you know black from white or night from day."
Tor
put in, "Which is an additional reason why we're not very; popular. Skin
trouble's the basic one, d'you understand? So among i an appalling mixture of hostile smells we welcome an occasional'
friendly one—as yours is."
"Do the Dranes smell
friendly?"
Tor
pulled a face. "They stink!" he said with much emphasis.) Gazing
ruminatively at the blank television screen, he went on, "Well,J the powers-that-be are after your earthly body, and I'm afraid we^ can't
offer you much encouragement though we're willing to give you t all the help we can. Something like twenty specimens have escaped in {
the last ten or twelve years. All of them broke loose by suddenly displaying
long-concealed and quite unexpected powers which caught
METAMORPHOSITE 349
their
captors by surprise. But none stayed free. One by one they were roped in, some
sooner than others. You can't use your strength without revealing what you've
got, and once the authorities know what you've got they take steps to cope with
it. Sooner or later the fugitive makes a try for his home planet-—and finds the
trappers waiting."
'They're going to have a long, long
wait," Harold told him, "for I'm not contemplating a return to my
home world. Leastways, not yet. What's the use of coming all the way here just
to go all the way back again?"
"We took it that you hadn't much choice
about the coming," said Tor.
"Nor
had I. Circumstances made it necessary for me to come. Circumstances make it
necessary for me to stay awhile."
The three were mildly surprised
by this phlegmatic attitude.
"I'm more of a nuisance here,"
Harold pointed out. "This is the Empire's key planet. Whoever bosses this
world bosses the Empire. It may be one man, it may be a small clique, but on
this planet is the mind or minds which make the Empire tick. I'd like to retime
that tick."
"You've some hopes!" opined Tor gloomily. "The Big Noise is Burkinshaw
Three, the Lord of Terror. You've got to have forty-two permits, signed and
countersigned, plus an armed escort, to get within sight of him. He's
exclusive!"
"That's tough, but the situation is
tougher." He relaxed in his chair and thought awhile. "There's a Lord
of Terror on every planet, isn't there? It's a cockeyed title for the bosses of
imperial freedom!"
"Terror means greatness, superior
wisdom, intellect of godlike quality," explained Tor.
"Oh,
does it? My mistake! We use the same-sounding word on my planet, and there it
means fear." Suddenly a strange expression came into his face. He
ejaculated, "Burkinshaw! Burkinshaw! Ye gods!"
"What's the matter?" Melor
inquired.
"Nothing much. It's only that evidence
is piling up on top of a theory. It should help. Yes, it ought to help
a lot." Getting up, he paced the room restlessly. "Is there an
underground independence movement on Linga?" he asked.
Tor
grinned with relish, and said, "I'd not be far from the truth if I guessed
that there's such a movement on every planet excepting this one. Imperially
speaking, we're all in the same adolescent condition:
350 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
not
quite ripe for self-government. Well all get independence tomorrow, but not
today." He heaved a resigned sigh. "Linga's been getting it tomorrow
for the last seven hundred years."
"As
I thought," Harold commented. "The same old set-up. The same old stresses,
strains and inherent weaknesses. The same blindness and procrastination. We've
known it all before—it's an old, old tale to us."
"What is?" persisted the curious
Melor.
"History," Harold told him.
Melor looked puzzled.
"There's an ancient saying," Harold
continued, "to the effect that the bigger they come the harder they fall.
The more ponderous and top-heavy a structure the riper it is for
toppling." He rubbed his chin, studied his listeners with a peculiarly
elfish gaze. "So the problem is whether we can shove hard enough to make
it teeter."
"Never!"
exclaimed Tor. "Nor a thousand either. It's been tried times without
number. The triers got buried—whenever there was enough to bury."
"Which
means that they tried in the wrong way, and/or at the wrong time. It's up to us
to push in the right way at the right time."
"How can you tell the right time?"
"I can't. I can choose only the time
which, when everything's taken into account, seems the most favorable—and then
hope that it's the right time. It'll be just my hard luck if I'm wrong."
He reflected a moment, then went on, "The best time ought to be nine days
hence. If you can help me to keep under cover that long, I'll promise not to
involve you in anything risky in the meanwhile. Can you keep me nine
days?"
"Sure we can." Tor regarded him
levelly. "But what do we get out of it other than the prospect of
premature burial?"
"Nothing
except the satisfaction of having had a finger in the pie." "Is that
all?" Tor asked.
"That's all," declared Harold
positively. "You Lingans must fight your way as we're fighting ours. If
ever my people help you, it will be for the sake of mutual benefit or our own
satisfaction. It won't be by way of reward."
"That
suits me." Tor said flady. "I like good, plain talk, with no frills.
We're tired of worthless promises. Count us with you to the base of the
scaffold, but not up the steps—we'd like to indulge second thoughts before we
mount those!"
METAMORPHOSITE 35I
"Thanks
a lot," acknowledged Harold gratefully. "Now here are some ideas I've
got which—"
He
stopped as the television set emitted a loud chime. Tor reached over, switched
on the apparatus. Its screen came to life, depicting the same uniformed
sourpuss as before.
The official rumbled, "Urgent call I
Citizens are warned that'the escaped specimen Harold Harold-Myra, for whom a
call was broadcast half an hour ago, is now known to be a telepath, a mesman,
a seer and a recorder. It is possible that he may also possess telekinetic powers
of unknown extent. Facts recently brought to light suggest that he's a decoy
and therefore doubly dangerous. Study his likeness; he must be brought in as
soon as possible."
The screen blanked, lit up again, showed
Harold's face for a full minute. Then the telecast cut off.
"What
does he mean, a seer and a recorder?" inquired Harold, mystified.
"A
seer is one who makes moves in anticipation of two, three, four or more of his
opponent's moves. A chessmaster is a seer."
"Heavens, do they play
chess here, too?"
"Chess is popular all
over the Empire. What of it?"
"Never
mind," said Harold. "We'll stick the fact on top of the pile. Go
on."
"A recorder," explained Tor,
"is someone with a photographic memory. He doesn't write anything down. He
remembers it all, accurately, in full detail."
"Humph!
I don't think there's anything extraordinary about that."
"We
Lingans can't do it. In fact, we know of only four life forms that can."
Respect crept into Tor's snake-skinned face. "And do you really have
telekinetic power as well?"
"No.
It's a false conclusion to which they've jumped. They appear to think I'm a
poltergeist or something—goodness only knows why." He mused a moment.
"Maybe it's because of that analysis in stage three. I can control my
heart beats, my blood pressure, my thoughts, and I made their analytical
apparatus go haywire. They can get out of it nothing but contradictory
nonsense. Evidently they suspect that I sabotaged its innards by some form of
remote control."
"Oh!" Tor was
openly disappointed.
Before
any of them could venture further remark, the television set called for
attention and Sourpuss appeared for the third time.
35* JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"All nonnative citizens will observe a curfew tonight from mid* night until one hour after dawn," he droned. "During this period tfai police may call at certain apartments. Any nonnative citizens found absent from their apartments and unable to give satisfactory reason therefor, or any nonnative citizens who obstruct the police in the cxo* cution of their duty, will be dealt with in accordance with pan-piano* tary law." He paused, stared out of the screen. He looked bellicose* "The fugitive, Harold Harold-Myra, is in possession of identity card number AMB 307-40781, entered in the name of Robertus Bron. Thai is all."
"Bron," echoed Harold. "Bron . . . Burkinshaw . . . chessma* ters. Dear me I"
The three Lingans were apprehensive, and Melor ventured, "You can see their moves. One: they're satisfied that by now you've found a hiding place. Two: they know you're hiding with outsiders and not with natives. Since there aren't more than sixty thousands of outsiders on this planet, sharing one third that number of apartments, it's not impossible to pounce on the lot at one go." His forehead wrinkled with thought. "It's no use you fleeing elsewhere because this curfew is planet-wide. It covers everywhere. I reckon your easiest way out would be to hypnotize a native and stay in his apartment overnight. If, as they say, you're a mesman, it should be easy."
"Except for one thing."
"What is that ?"
"It's what they expect me to do. In fact, it's what they're trying to make me do."
"Even so," persisted Melor, "what's to stop you ?"
"The routine. A master race always has a routine. It's drilled into them; it's part of their education. Having been warned that a badly
wanted specimen is on the loose and about to bolt, they will take the officially prescribed precautions." He grinned at them reassuringly, but they didn't derive much comfort from it. "I can only guess what that routine will be, but I reckon it'll include some method of adver* tising my presence in a native's apartment even though its occupant is helpless. Scanners coupled to the Police Emergency system and switched in by the opening of a door, or something like that. When I take risks, I pick my own. It's asking for trouble to let the opposition pick 'em for you."
"Maybe
you're right," agreed Melon "We do know that local peo» pie have certain facilities denied to outsiders."
METAMORPHOSITE 353
"Now
if a couple of cops come along to give this place a look over, and I take
control of their minds and send them away convinced that I'm just another
Lingan, the powers-that-be will have been fooled, won't they?"
"I
hadn't thought of that," put in Tor. He was disgusted with his own lack of
imagination. "It was so obvious that I didn't see it."
"So
obvious," Harold pointed out, "that the authorities know that's just
what would occur should they find me here."
"Then why the curfew
and the search?"
"Bluff!"
defined Harold. "They hope to make me move or, failing that, put scare
into those harboring me. They're banging on the walls hoping the rat will run.
I won't run! With your kind permission, I'll sit tight."
"You're welcome to stay," Tor
assured. "We can find you a spare bed, and if you—"
"Thanks!" Harold interrupted,
"but I don't need one. I don't sleep."
"You don't!" They
were dumfounded.
"Never slept a wink in my life. It's a
habit we've abandoned." He walked around the room, studying its fitdngs.
"Impatience is the curse of plotters. Nothing bores me more than waiting
for time to ripen. I've simply got to wait nine days. Are you really willing to
put up with me that long or, if not, can you find me some place else?"
"Stay here," said Tor. "You
repay us with your company. We can talk to each other of homes beyond reach. We
can talk about the freedom of subject peoples and of things it is not wise to
discuss outside. It is sweet to dream dreams. It is good to play with notions of what one might do if only one could find a
way to do it."
"You're a little pessimistic,"
gibed Harold.
On the fourth day his idleness became too
much to bear. He went out, strolled along the streets of the city. Two more
irate broadcasts had advertised his extended liberty, but the last of them had
been three days before. Since then, silence.
His
trust reposed in the inability of the public to remember that morning's
broadcast, let alone the details of the twentieth one before it, and his
confidence was not misplaced. People wandered past him with vacant expressions
and preoccupied minds. In most cases, their eyes looked at him without seeing
him. In a few cases, his features reg-
354 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
istered,
but no significance registered with them. The farther he walked, the safer he
felt.
Downtown he found a smart, modernistic store
well stocked with scientific instruments. This simplified matters. He'd been
trying to solve the problem of how to get Melor to shop for him without using
this silly stuff called money. The Lingan's respect for it equalled his own
contempt for it, therefore he couldn't ask his hosts to spend their own on his
behalf. Instinct rather than deliberate reasoning had made him recognize this
simple ethic of a moneyed world.
Boldly
entering the store, he examined its stock. Here were some things he wanted,
others capable of ready adaption to what he desired. Different cultures evolved
differing modes of manufacture. Conventional jobs would need alteration to
become conventional according to his other-worldly notions, but the simplest
tools would enable him to deal with these. Making a list of his requirements,
he prowled around until it was complete, handed it to a salesman.
The latter, a shrewd individual, looked the
list over, said sharply, "This stuff is for microwave radiation."
"I know it," said
Harold blandly.
"It is not for sale to the public except
on production of an official permit," he went on. Then, stiffly,
"Have you such a permit? May I see your identity card?"
Harold showed him the card.
"Ah!" mouthed the salesman, his
manner changing, "the police!" His laugh was apologetic and forced.
"Well, you didn't catch me disregarding regulations!"
"I'm
not trying to catch you. I've come to get some necessary equipment. Pack it up
and lot me have it. I'm on urgent business and in a hurry."
"Certainly,
certainly." Bustling to and fro, anxious to placate, the salesman
collected the equipment, packaged it. Then he made careful note of the name and
number on Harold's identity card "We charge this to the Police Department,
as usual?"
"No,"
Harold contradicted. "Charge it to the Analysis Division of the
Immigration Department, Stage Three."
He
had a satisfied smile as he went out. When the Bearded One got the bill he
could stick it in his analyzer and watch the meters whirl. Which reminded him
now that he came to think of it—there didn't seem to be an overmuch sense of
humor on this world.
Safely back in the Lingans' apartment, he
unloaded his loot, got
METAMORPHOSITE 355
started
on it. His hosts were out. He kept the door locked, concentrated on his task
and progressed with speed and dexterity which would have astounded his former
captors. When he'd been at work an hour the set in the corner chimed urgently,
but he ignored it and was still engrossed in his task when the Lingans came in some
time later.
Carefully closing and fastening the door,
Melor said, "Well, they've got worried about you again." "Have
they?"
"Didn't you catch the recent
broadcast?" "I was too busy," explained Harold.
"They've discovered that you've got a
police card and not the card they first announced. They broadcast a correction
and a further warning. The announcer was somewhat annoyed."
"So'd I be," said Harold, "if
I were Sourpuss."
Melor's eyes, which had been staring absently
at the litter of stuff on which Harold was working, suddenly realized what they
saw.
"Hey,
where did you get all that?" he asked, with alarm. "Have you been
outdoors?"
"Sure!
I had to get this junk somehow or other and I couldn't think of how to get it
any other way. I couldn't wish it into existence. We've not progressed quite that far—yet!" He glanced at the uneasy Lingan. "Take it easy.
There's nothing to worry about. I was out for less than a couple of hours, and
I might have been born and bred in this city for all the notice anyone took of
me."
"Maybe so." Melor flopped into a
chair, massaged his scaly chin. Ripples of underlying blueness ran through it
as his skin moved. "But if you do it too often you'll meet a cop, or a
spaceman, or a Drane. Cops are too inquisitive. Spacemen recognize outsiders
and rarely forget a face. Dranes know too much and can divine too much. It's
risky." He looked again at the litter of apparatus. "What're you making,
anyway?"
"A simple contactor."
"What's that for?"
"Making contact with someone else."
Harold wangled an electric iron into the heart of the mess, deftly inserted a
condenser smaller than a button, linked it into the circuit with two dabs of
solder. "If two people, uncertain of each other's whereabouts, are seeking
each other within the limits of the same horizon, they can trace each other
with contactors."
356 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"I
see," said Melor, not seeing at all. "Why not make mental contact?"
"Because
the telepathic range is far too short. Thoughts fade swifdy within distance,
especially when blanketed by obstacles."
The
three were still watching him curiously when he finished the job shortly before
midnight. Now he had a small transmitter-receiver fitted with three antennae,
one being a short, vertical rod, the second a tiny silver loop rotatable through
its horizontal plane, the third a short silver tube, slightly curved, also
rotatable horizontally.
"Now to tune it
up," he told them.
Connecting
the set-up to the power supplies, he let it warm through before he started
tuning it with a glassite screwdriver. It was a tricky job. The oscillatory
circuit had to be steered a delicate margin past peak so that it would swing
dead on to resonance when hand-capacity was removed. And, strangely enough,
hand-capacity was greater on this planet. The correct margin had to be
discovered by trial and error, by delicate adjustment and readjustment.
He
manipulated the tuning with fingers as firm and sensitive as any surgeon's. His
jawbone ached. Tuning the set onward, he took his hand away. The circuit swung
short. He tried again and again. Eventually he stood away from the apparatus,
rubbed his aching jaw in which dull pain was throbbing, switched off the power.
"That'll do," he
remarked.
"Aren't you going to use it now?"
Melor inquired. "I can't. Nobody's looking for me yet."
"Oh!"
The trio were more puzzled than ever. They gave it up and went to bed.
Putting
away his apparatus, Harold dug a book on ancient history out of the Lingans'
small but excellent library, settled himself down to the fourth successive
night of self-education. There was dynamite in these books for those who had
eyes to see. No Lord of Terror had seen diem in the light in which he saw them!
The ninth day dawned in manner no different
from any other. The sun came up and the Empire's boss city stirred to
officially conducted life.
When Melor appeared, Harold said to him,
"I believe that this is your free day. Have you any plans for it?"
"Nothing important. Why?"
METAMORPHOSITE 357
"The fun starts today, or ought to start
if my calculations are correct. I could do with your help.'* "In what
way?"
"You're going to be mighty useful if I
come up against someone who can control his thoughts or shield them entirely.
Hatred or animosity aren't thoughts—they're emotions of which antagonistic
thoughts are born. You Lingans respond to such emotions. You can go on reading
the heart long after the mind is closed to me."
"I get the point but
not the purpose," confessed Melor.
"Look,"
said Harold patiently, "when I say the fun starts I don't mean that
there's going to be wholesale violence. We've found better ways. It's possible,
for instance, to talk oneself into anything or out of anything provided one
says the right things to the right person at the right time. The waving blade
hasn't half the potency of the wagging tongue. And the tongue isn't
messy." He smiled grimly. "My people
have had more than their fill of messy methods. We don't bother with them these
days. We're grown up."
"So?" prompted
Melor.
"So
I need you to tell me how I'm doing if, mayhap, I'm working on someone with a
closed mind."
"That's
easy. I could tell you when hatred, fear or friendliness intensifies or
lessens by one degree."
"Just
what I need," enthused Harold. "My form of life has its shortcomings
as well as its talents, and we don't let ourselves forget it. Last time some of
us forgot it, the forgetters thought themselves a collective form of God. The
delusion bred death!"
His tongue gently explored a back tooth as
his gaze went to the transmitter-receiver waiting at one side of the room.
Nothing happened until midday. The two kept
company through the morning, the fugitive expectant and alert, his host uneasy
and silently speculative. At noon the television set chimed and Melor switched
it on.
Helman came on the screen. He stared straight
at the watching pair in manner suggesting that he saw them as clearly as they
saw him. His dark features were surly.
"This is a personal broadcast for the
benefit of the specimen known at Harold Harold-Myra," Helman enunciated,
"or to any citizen illegally maintaining contact with him. Be it known,
Harold Harold-Myra, that a summary of all the available data on your world
358 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
type
has been laid before the Council of Acdon, which Council, after due
consideration thereof, has decided that it is to the essential interest of the
Empire that your life form be exterminated with the minimum of delay. By
midday tomorrow an order will be sent to appropriate war vessels requiring
them to vaporize your native planet— unless, in the meantime, you have
surrendered yourself and provided new evidence which may persuade the Council
of Action to reconsider its decision."
Helman stopped, licked his lips. His air was
that of one still nursing a severe reprimand.
He went on, "This notification will be
rebroadcast in one hour's time. Watchers in touch with the fugitive are advised
to bring it to his attention as this will be the last warning." His
surliness increased as he finished, "In the event of his prompt surrender,
the Council of Action will extend gracious pardon to those who have been
harboring this specimen."
The screen blanked.
"Mate in one move," said Melor
glumly. "We told you that it was a waste of time to sit and plot. They get
'em all, one way or another.
"It's check—and your move."
"All right then—what's your move?"
"I
don't know yet. We've still got to wait. If you sit by the chimney long
enough, Santa Claus comes down."
"In
the name of the Blue Sun, who is Santa Claus?" asked Melor peevishly.
"The man with a
million lollies."
"Lollies?"
"Things you
lick."
"Oh,
cosmos!" said Melor. "What madman wants to own a million things to
lick? Is this anything to do with your sermon about wagging tongues? If so, we're licked!"
"Forget it,"
Harold advised. "I talk in riddles to pass the time."
A
pain suddenly pulsed in his jawbone. It brought an exclamation from him which
stirred the nervous Melor. Putting two fingers into his mouth, Harold unscrewed
the crown of a back molar, took it out, put it on the table. A tiny splinter of
crystal glittered within the base of the crown. The crystal was fluorescent.
Melor gaped at it fascinatedly.
Swiftly powering the transmitter-receiver,
Harold let it warm up.
METAMORPHOSITE 359
A
faint, high-pitched whistle crept into its litde phone. He swung the loop
slowly while the whistle strengthened, then weakened, finally faded out.
Slightly offsetting the loop to bring back the signal, he pressed a stud. The
note grew stronger.
"That
side," he murmured, indicating the face of the loop nearest to the
watching Melor.
Returning
the loop to fade-out position, he switched in the transmitter, swung its
curved tube antenna until it paralleled the direction faced by the receiver's
loop. Again he offset the loop, and the signal returned. He waited expectantly.
In a little while, the signal broke into three short pips then resumed its
steady note. He flipped his transmitter switch three times.
For half an hour the two sat and waited while
the whistle maintained itself and gave triple pips at regular intervals. Then,
suddenly, it soared up in power and gave one pip.
Carefully, Harold repeated all the rigmarole
with the antenna, this time obtaining a different direction. Three pips came as
his reward, and again he switched his transmitter in acknowledgment. Another
long wait. Then, slowly, weakly and distantly, a voice crept into his mind.
"A blue car. A blue
car."
Going to the window, he looked down into the
street. From his height of ten floors he had a clear view extending several
blocks in both directions. He found a score of automobiles on the street, half
a dozen of them blue.
"Stop, step out, get in again," he thought. He repeated the mental impulse,
driving it outward with maximum intensity.
A
car stopped, a human shape got out, looked around, stepped back into the
vehicle. It was a blue car.
Harold crossed the room, disconnected the
contactor, and returned to the window. Looking downward, he thought
powerfully.
'7 believe
I've got you. Drive on slowly . . . slowly . . . here you are . . . stop there!
The building Immediately on your right. Ten floors up."
He continued to keep watch as the car pulled
in by the opposite sidewalk. Two men emerged from it, crossed the road with
casual nonchalance, disappeared beneath him. No other cars halted, nobody
followed the men into the building.
A voice reached him
strongly, "Are
we dragging anything?"
"Not that I can
see."
360 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"Goodl"
Melor said plaintively, "I know that
you're communicating with someone. Santa Claus, I presume? How you can read
each other's toothache is a mystery to me."
"Our throbs are no
worse than your wobbles."
"You
bounce around," said Melor, "and, according to you, we dither. Some
day we'll come across some other life form which spins around in circles, like
a mental dervish. Or even an endty capable of logical reasoning without thought
at all; a sort of Bohr-thinker who skips straight from premise to conclusion
without covering the intervening distance." His eyes found the crystal
still on the table, noted that it had ceased to glow. "Better plant your
key-frequency back in your face before somebody sets it in a ring."
Harold
smiled, took up the crystal, screwed it back into place. Opening the door, he
looked out just as the pair from the car arrived on the landing. He beckoned
them in, locked the door behind them, introduced them to the Lingan.
"This is Melor, a friend from Linga.
Melor, meet George Richard-Eve and Burt Ken-Claudette."
Melor looked askance at the newcomers' neat
space uniforms and the silver comet insignia glittering on their epaulettes. He
commented, "Well, they smell as good as they look bad. You'll produce a
pally Drane next!"
"Not likely!" Harold assured.
Burt sat down, said to Harold, "You know
the locals by now. Are they crafty enough to have drawn a bead on that
transmission and, if so, how long d'you think they'll give us ? If time's
short, we can beat it in the car and delay matters a little."
"They
know how I got the stuff, where I got it, and its purpose, and they're not too
dopey to listen out," Harold replied. "As I guess, I give them half
an hour."
"That'll do."
Melor put in, "Talk
mentally if it suits you better. I don't mind."
"You're
in this," Harold told him, "so we'll talk vocally. You're entitled to
listen." He turned to Burt. "What's cooking?"
"There's fun and games on four out of
the five. The fifth proved useless for our purpose: it held nothing but a few
time-serving bureaucrats on high pay. But four should do, I reckon."
"Go on."
METAMORPHOSITE 361
"All the appointed ones have gone beyond
and the first of them ought to have reached their destinations by now. It's six
days to the nearest system, so they've a good margin." He smoothed his
dark hair, looked reminiscent. "Nemo is
due to pop off any moment now. That was a tough job! We took forty people off
it, but had to scour the place from end to end to find the last pair of them.
We got 'em, though. They've been dumped in safety."
"Good!"
"This has been an education," Burt
went on. "Better than going to the zoo. There's an underground message
system on number three, for instance, which has to be seen to be believed. By
'underground* they mean ten thousand feet up! How d'you think they do it?"
"I've no idea," said Harold.
"With
birds! Among the minority life forms there is one which is beaked and
feathered. They talk with birds. They chirrup and squawk at them, and every
bird understands what's said."
"Orniths,"
informed Melor. "They came originally from Gronat, the Empire's eight
hundredth conquest. They're scattered around and there are a few of them here,
maybe a dozen or so. When you've had time to tour the Empire you'll find it contains
even stranger forms. And the humanoids don't even dislike them all."
"It
would seem that the humanoids don't even like each other much," Burt
commented. "To most of them, a brother from a neighboring planet is a
foreigner."
"Still in the
schoolkid stage," said Harold. "Rah-rah and all that."
Burt
nodded and continued, "As you know, we've had to move too fast in too
little time to put over anything really drastic, but what's been done ought to
be enough to show what could be done—which is all that matters." A faraway
look came into his eyes. "When we triumphantly cast our bread upon the
waters we little thought it'd come back—all wet."
"So you've found confirmation of
that?"
"Plenty," Burt
replied. "Have you?"
"Any amount of it." Harold went to
the bookshelf, selected a heavy tome titled "The Imperial Elect." He
skimmed through its pages, found an illustration, showed it to Burt.
"Look!"
"PW" said Burt.
"The
Budding Cross," breathed George, looking over Burt's shoulder. "And
the Circle of Infinity!"
362 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"That
shelf is crammed with stuff," Harold told them as he replaced the book,
"I've been going through it like a man in a strange dream." He came
back, sat down. "Anything more to report?"
"Not
much. Jon has stayed on number three. He had a stroke of luck and got at the
Lord, a fat personage named Amilcare. Temporarily, His Eminence doesn't know
which shoe is on which foot."
Harold
opened his mouth to comment, closed it without saying anything. His mental
perception perked up, listened intently. Burt and George listened likewise.
Melor began to fidget. For the first time, Harold noticed that a fringe of fine
hairs lay along the rims of the Lin-gan's ears, and that these hairs were now
fully extended and quivering.
"There's
a stink of hostility," complained Melor uneasily. In his lithe,
loose-jointed gait, he went to the window.
A hubbub lay across the ether, a confused
mixture of thoughts from which it was impossible to extract more than odd,
disjointed phrases.
"Line 'em across that end . . . rumble,
rumble . . . yes, ta\e the ground floor . . . rumble, buzz, buzz . . . wor\
upward . . . rumble . . . ten of you . . . loo\ out for . . . rumble . . . they
may be ... "
"I
expect visitors," remarked George, easily. He joined Melor at the window.
The
others followed, and the four looked down at the street. It was a hive of
activity. A dozen cars were drawn across one end, blocking it completely.
Another dozen jockeyed for position to block the opposite end. Cars plugged the
three side streets in between. Something invisible droned steadily overhead;
it sounded like a squadron of helicopters. More than two hundred black-uniformed
men were scattered along the sidewalk in litde groups.
"Their
bearings must have been rough." Burt pulled a face at the cohort below.
"It got them this section of the street but not the building. I'd be
ashamed of such a sloppy job."
"It's
good enough," Harold answered. He filtered the telepathic surge once
again. It was entirely human, involuntary and nonrecep-tive. "We could go
down and save them some bother, but I'm a bit curious about those butterfly
minds down there. Surely they'd have brought something potent along with
them."
"Test it,"
suggested Burt.
Dropping their mental shields, the three let
their thoughts flow forth bearing a perfect picture of their location.
Instantly the hubbub
METAMORPHOSITE 363
was
overwhelmed by an alien mind which imposed itself upon the ether. It was clear,
sharp, penetrating, and of remarkable strength.
"They're
in that building there! Ten floors high! Three of them and a Lingan. They
contemplate no resistance!"
"A Drane!" said
Harold.
It was impossible to locate the creature amid
the mass of men and automobiles beneath, neither could he sense its general
direction for, having said all it considered essential, it had closed its mind
and its powerful impulse was gone.
"Judging
by the throb, there was a Drane down there," offered Melor belatedly.
"Did you hear it? I couldn't understand what it said."
"It got us fixed. It identified your
erratic thought-flow and said that a Lingan was with us."
"And
what are we going to do about it ? Do we stand like sheep and wait to be taken
away?"
*Tes," Harold informed.
Melor's
face registered approaching martyrdom, but he offered no further remark.
There
wasn't an immediate response to the Drane's revelation. For reasons unknown to
the watchers, a short time-lag intervened. It ended when a car roared along the
street with a silver-spangled official bawling orders from its side window. As
one man, the uniformed clusters made a determined rush for the front entrance
of the building.
It
was Melor who opened the door and admitted a police captain and six men. All
seven wore the strained expressions of people called upon to deal with things
unimaginable, and all seven were armed. Little blasters, similar to the one
Harold had found so objectionable, were ready in their hands.
The captain, a big, burly man, but pale of
face, entered the room with his blaster held forward, and gabbled hastily
through his prepared speech.
"Listen
to me, you four, before you try any tricks. We've reversed the controls on
these guns. They stay safe while they're gripped but go off immediately our
hands loosen—and hypnosis causes involuntary relaxation of the muscles which
you can't prevent I" He
swallowed hard. "Any clever stunts will do no more than turn this place
into a shambles. In addition, there are more men outside, more on every floor,
more in the street. You can't cope with the lot!"
Smiling
amiably, Harold said, "You tempt us to persuade you to toss those toys out
of the window, and your pants after them. But we
364 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
want
to talk to the Council of Action and have no time for amusement. Let's
go."
The
captain didn't know whether to scowl or look relieved. Cautiously he stood to
one side, his gun held level, as the four filed out through the door. The escorts
were equally leery. They surrounded the quartet, but not too closely, bearing
themselves with the air of men compelled to nurse vipers to their bosoms.
As
they marched along the landing toward the levitators Burt nudged the nearest
guard and demanded, "What's your name?"
The
fellow, a lanky, beetle-browed individual, was startled and apprehensive as he
answered, "Walt Bron."
"Tut!" said Burt.
The guard didn't like that "tut." His brows came down, his small eyes held a
stupefied expression as his mind said to itself, "Why should he want my name? Why pic\ on me? I ain't done him any harm. What's he up to
now?"
Burt smiled broadly and his own mind reached
out to George's and Harold's, saying, "Something has got them worried, though the higher-ups aren't lively to have told them much"
"Yes—it
lool^s as if there's irritation in influential circles and the cops got bawled
out in consequence. Evidently news is coming through." Pause. "Did you feel any probe?"
"No."
"Neither did we. That Drane must have
gone" Pause.
"Pity we can't tal\
with Melor this way. He's walking behind li\e a fatalist pacing to certain
death." Pause.
"Got plenty of guts,
the way he's ta\en us on trust"
"Yes—but we'll loo\ after him!"
They
reached the levitators. The entire landing was now solid with armed police and
a number of them were pressing eagerly into the deserted apartment, intent on
thorough search.
Herded
into a levitator, the captured quartet and their escort of seven crammed it to
capacity. The glassite doors slid shut. The burly captain pressed a
"button and the levitator soared smoothly upward while its occupants
watched the rising indicator with offhand interest. They stopped at the
twenty-seventh floor.
The
captain didn't permit the doors to open. He stood with his attention fixed upon
the indicator while slowly his beefy face changed color. Suddenly, he rammed
his big thumb on the ground-level button and the levitator shot downward.
METAMORPHOSITE 365
Harold: "Who did that?"
Burt: "Me. I couldn't resist it" Then, vocally, and loudly, "I didn't notice any guns go off. Did you?"
The
other captives grinned. The captain glared at the up-flying shaft but said
nothing. The escort's uneasiness registered more openly on their faces.
A veritable guard of honor had lined up
between the front entrance and the waiting car. About sixty guns were held in
readiness on either side—in flat disregard of the fact that one had only to
start something and let the fire of one rank bring down half the opposite rank,
thus providing plentiful company in death.
The
four got into the car, and its driver, a thin featured, pessimistic
individual, looked even less happy for their arrival. He had a cop for company
in front. The car blew its jets and started off with half a dozen cars leading
and a full dozen following. It was a cavalcade worthy of the year's best
burial, and its pace was suitably funereal as it wended its way through a
succession of side streets to the outskirts of the city. A thousand feet above
them a helicopter and two gyros drifted along, carefully following every bend
and turn on their route.
The
destination proved to be an immense, needlelike skyscraper, tall, slender,
graceful. It soared majestically from spacious, well-tended grounds around
which stood a high wall surmounted by the spidery wiring of a photoelectric
telltale system. As they swept through the great gateway, the prisoners caught
a glimpse of the telltale marker-board in the granite lodge and a group of
heavily armed guards lounging behind the gates.
"The
palace of the Council," Melor informed. "This is where they make worlds
and break them—or so they claim."
"Be
quiet!" snapped the cop in front. Then, in a high, squeaky voice, he
added, "There are fairies at the bottom of my garden!"
"Indeed?" said
Burt, affecting polite surprise.
The cop's sour face whitened. His grip tightened
on his blaster, forgetting in his emotion that a stronger hold was supposed to
be ineffective.
"Let him alone, Burtl" thought Harold.
"ƒ don't li\e him," Burt came back. "His
ears stic\ out"
"How he smells of fury!" criticized
Melor, openly.
Conversation
ended as the procession halted in front of the skyscraper's ornate entrance.
The quartet climbed out, paraded through another wary guard of honor, entered
the building. Here, more black-
366 journey to infinity
uniformed
men conducted them two levels below ground, ushered them into an apartment
which, ominously, had a beryllium-steel grille in lieu of a door. The last man
out turned a monster key in the grille and departed.
Before
the inmates had time thoroughly to examine their new prison, an attendant
appeared, thrust packaged foods through the bars of the grille, and told them,
"I haven't got the key and don't know who has. Neither can I find out. If
you want anything, call for me, but don't think you can make me open up. I
couldn't do it even if I wanted —which I don't!"
"Dear me," said Burt, "that's
unkind of you." Going to the grille, he swung it open, looked out at the
astounded attendant and continued, "Tell the Council that we are very
comfortable and appreciate their forethought. We shall be pleased to call upon
them shortly."
The
attendant's scattered wits came together. He took to his heels as if the breath
of death was on his neck.
"How did you do that?" demanded
Melor, his eyes wide. He ambled loose-jointedly to the grille, looked at its
lock, swung it to and fro on its hinges.
"The gentleman with the key locked it,
then unlocked it, and wandered away satisfied that duty had been done,"
Burt released a sigh. "Life is full of delusions." Opening a packet,
he examined its contents. "Calorbix!" he said disgustedly, and tossed
the package on a table.
"Here they come," George announced.
A
horde arrived. They locked the grille, put two heavy chains around its end
post, padlocked those. The four watched in amused silence. A pompous little
man, with much silver braid strewn over his chest, then tried the grille,
shaking it furiously. Satisfied, he scowled at the four, went away, the horde
following.
Burt
mooched restlessly around the room. "There are scanners watching us,
microphones listening to us and, for all I know, some cockeyed gadget tasting
us. I'm fed up with this. Let's go see the Council."
"Yes, it's about time we did,"
George agreed. "The sooner the better," added Harold.
Melor
offered no comment. The conversation of his friends, he decided, was oft
confusing and seemingly illogical. They had a habit of going off at the
queerest slants. So he contented himself with staring at the grille through
which nothing but some liquid form of life could pass, while he wondered
whether Tor and Vern had yet been dragged
METAMORPHOSITE 367
into
the net. He hoped not. It was better to execute one Lingan than three.
A
minute later the man with the keys came back accompanied by two guards and a
tall, gray-haired official clad in myrtle green. The badge of the Silver Comet
glittered on the latter's shoulder straps. His keen gaze rested on the warden
as that worthy surlily unlocked the padlocks, withdrew the chains, freed the
grille.
Then
he said to the four, "Most remarkable1" He waited for a response, but
none came, so he carried on. "This warder hasn't the least notion of what
he's doing. As the Council expected, you influenced him to return and unlock
the gate. We kept him under observation. It has been an interesting
demonstration of what hypnosis can achieve." His smile was amiable.
"But you didn't expect him to return accompanied, eh?"
"What
does it matter?" Harold answered. "Your brain advertises that the
Council is ready to deal with us."
"I
waste my breath talking." The official made a gesture of futility.
"All right. Come with me."
The Council looked small. Its strength a mere
eight, all but two of them human. They sat at a long table, the six humans in
the middle, a nonhuman at each end. The thing on the extreme right had a head
like a purple globe, smooth, shining, hairless, possessing no features except a
pair of retractable eyes. Below was a cloaked shapelessness suggesting no
shoulders and no arms. It was as repulsive as the sample on the left was
beautiful. The one on the left had a flat, circular, golden face surrounded by
golden petals, large and glossy. The head was supported by a short, fibrous
green neck from the knot of which depended long, delicate arms terminating in
five tentacles. Two black-knobbed stamens jutted from the face, and a wide,
mobile mouth was visible beneath them. It was lovely, like a flower.
Between
this table and the staring captives hung a barrier of wire. Harold, Burt and
George could see that it was loaded, and their perceptions
examined it gingerly. They diagnosed its purpose simultaneously : it bore an
alternating current imposed upon a pulsing potential. Two hundred cycles per
second, with a minimum pressure of four thousand volts rising to peak points of
seven thousand every tenth cycle.
"Hypnocast jammer!" reported Burt. He was
puzzled. "But
368 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
that
doesn't blank neural sprays. They're different bands. Can you hear what they're
thinking?"
"Not
a thing," answered Harold. "Neither could I get your thoughts while
you were speaking."
"I've
lost contact, too," put in George. "Something which isn't that screen
is droning out a bass beat note that makes a mess of the telepathic band."
Sniffing
with distaste, Melor said, "This is where I come in. I know what's the
matter. There's a Drane in the room. He's doing it."
"Are you sure of that?"
"I
can sense him." He pointed at the flowerlike being on the left.
"Furthermore, Dranes can't speak. They've no vocal cords. The Flo-rans
function as their interpreters—that's why this one's here."
One
of the humans on the Council, a bull-headed, heavily jowled man, leaned
forward, fixed glittering eyes on the four. His voice was harsh.
"The Lingan is right. Since we are not
assembled to be entertained by your alien antics, nor to listen to your lies,
but solely for the purpose of weighing fresh truths with justice and with
wisdom, we find it necessary to employ a Drane."
So saying, he made a dramatic gesture. The Floran reached a tentacled hand down behind the
table, lifted the hidden Drane, placed it on the polished surface.
Mental visualization, Harold realized, had proved
correct with regard to shape and appearance but had misled him in the matter of
size. He'd taken it for granted that a Drane possessed bulk comparable with
his own. But this creature was no larger than his fist. Its very smallness
shocked him.
It was lizardlike, but not so completely as
first appeared, and now that he could see it closely, its tiny but perfect
uniform looked absurd. While they regarded it, the thing sat there and stared
at them with eyes like pin points of flaming crimson, and as it stared the
strange beat note disappeared, a psychic flood poured through the screen and
lapped around their minds.
But already the three shields were up, while
the fourth—the Lingan—felt the force only as an acute throb. The pressure went
up and up; it was amazing that such a midget brain could emit so mighty a
mental flow of power. It felt and probed and thrust and stabbed, its violence
increasing without abate.
Perspiration beaded the features of the trio
as they gazed fixedly
METAMORPHOSITE 369
at the
same spot on the Drane's jacket while maintaining their shields against its
invisible assault. Melor sat down, cradled his head in his arms, began to rock
slowly from side to side. The Council watched impassively. The Drane's optics
were jewels of fire.
"Keep it up," whispered Harold.
"It's almost on the boil."
Like
the lizards it resembled, the Drane's pose was fixed, unmov-ing. It had
remained as motionless as a carved ornament since it had reached the table, and
its baleful eyes had never blinked. Sdll its psychic output went up.
Then,
suddenly, it pawed at its jacket, snatched the paw away. A thin whisp of smoke
crawled out of the cloth. The next instant, the creature had fled from the
table, the mental pressure collapsing as its source disappeared. Its sharp,
peaky voice came into their minds as the thing snaked through a dny door, fled
along the outer passage. The voice faded with distance.
"Burning . . . burning . . .
burning!"
The
Council member who had spoken originally, now sat staring through the screen at
the prisoners. His hand was on the table, and his fingers rapped its surface
nervously. The other members maintained blank expressions. He turned his head,
looked at the Floran.
"What happened?"
"The Drane said he was burning,"
enunciated the mouth in the flowerlike head. Its tones were weak, but precise.
"His mind was very agitated. The peril destroyed his ability to
concentrate, and he had to flee lest worse befall."
"Pyroticsl" said the Council member
incredulously. "There are legends of such." His attention returned to
the captives. "So you're pyrotics—fire-raisers!"
"Some
of your people can do it—but don't know it themselves," Harold told him.
"They've caused most of any seemingly inexplicable fires you've
experienced." He made a gesture of impadence. "Now that we've got rid
of that Drane how about giving way to what's on your mind? We can read what is
written there, and we know the next move: you're to call Burkinshaw, Helman and
Roka, after which the parley will start."
Frowning,
but making no retort, the Council member pressed a red button on his desk. His
attitude was one of expectancy.
In
short time, Helman and Roka entered the room, took seats at the table. The
former's bearing was surly and disgrunded. The latter grinned sheepishly at the
quartet, even nodded amiably to Harold.
370 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
One minute after them, Burkinshaw Three, the Supreme
Lord, came in and took the center seat. His awesome name and imposing title
fitted him like somebody else's glove, for he was a small, thin man,
round-shouldered, narrow-chested, with a pale, lined face. His balding head had
wisps of gray hair at the sides, and his eyes peered myopically through rimless
pince-nez. His whole appearance was that of a mild and perpetually preoccupied
professor—but his mind was cold, cold.
That mind was now wide open to the three. It
was a punctilious mind, clear and sharp in form, operating deliberately and
calculatingly through the mixed output of the other humans at the Council
table.
Arranging
some papers before him, and keeping his gaze fixed upon the top sheets,
Burkinshaw spoke in measured, unhurried tones, saying, "I don't doubt that
you can read my mind and are reading it now, but in justice to the Lingan, who
cannot do so, and for the benefit of my fellows who are not telepathic either,
I must use ordinary speech." He adjusted the pince-nez, turned over a
sheet of paper and continued.
"We, of the Imperial Council of Action,
have decided that the safety of the Empire demands that we obliterate the
planet known to us as KX-724 together
with any adjacent planets, satellites or asteroids harboring its dominant life
form. We are now met to consider this life form's final plea for preservation,
and it is the duty of each of us to listen carefully to what new evidence may
be offered, weighing it not with favor or with prejudice, but with
justice."
Having
thus spoken, the Supreme Lord removed his pince-nez, polished each lens,
clipped them carefully on his nose, stared owlishly over their tops at the
prisoners. His eyes were a very pale blue, looked weak, but were not weak.
"Have you chosen your
spokesman?"
Their minds conferred
swiftly, then Harold said, "I shall speak."
"Very
well then." Burkinshaw relaxed in his seat. "Before you commence it
is necessary to warn you that our grave decision concerning the fate of your
people is neither frivolous nor heartless. In fact, it was reached with the
greatest reluctance. We were driven to it by the weight of evidence and, I
regret to say, additional data which we've recently gained is of a nature
calculated to support our judgment. Bluntly, your kind of life is a menace to
our kind. The responsibility now rests with you to prove otherwise—to our
satisfaction."
"And if I can't?"
queried Harold.
"We shall destroy you
utterly."
METAMORPHOSITE 371
"If you can,"
said Harold.
The
assembled minds reacted promptly. He could hear them, aggressive and fuming.
The purple thing exuded no thoughts but did give out a queer suggestion of
imbecilic amusement. The Floran's attitude was one of mild surprise mixed with
interest.
Burkinshaw
wasn't fazed. "If we can," he agreed blandly, while his brain held
little doubt that they could. "Proceed in your own way," he invited.
"You have about fourteen hours in which to convince us that our decision
was wrong, or impracticable."
"You've
tempted us into giving minor demonstrations of our powers," Harold began.
"The Drane was planted here for a similar purpose: you used him as a
yardstick with which to measure our mental abilities. From your viewpoint, I
guess, the results have strengthened your case and weakened ours. Only the
yardstick wasn't long enough."
Burkinshaw
refused to rise to the bait. Placing his fingertips together as if about to
pray, he stared absently at the ceiling, said nothing. His mind was well
disciplined, for it registered no more than the comment, "A negative point."
"Let
it pass," Harold went on, "while I talk about coincidences. On my world, a coincidence is a purely
fortuitous lining-up of circumstances and either is isolated or recurs
haphazardly. But when a seeming coincidence repeats itself often enough, it
ceases to be a coincidence. You know that, too—or ought to know it. For
example, let's take the once-alleged coincidence of meteoric phenomena
appearing simultaneously with earthquakes. It occurred so frequently that
eventally one of your scientists became curious, investigated the matter,
discovered solar-dynamic space-strain, the very force which since has been
utilized to boost your astrovessels to supra-spatial speeds. The lesson, of
course, is that one just can't dismiss coincidences as such when there are too
many of them."
"A thrust—toward where?" mused the Floran.
"No point yet
apparent" thought
Burkinshaw.
"I
don't li\e the way he
gabbles" said
Helman's mind uneasily. "He's tal\ing to gain time. Maybe the three of them are trying to
push something through that screen. They burned the Drane through it, didn't
they?" He
fidgeted in his seat. "I
don't share B's faith in that screen. Curses on Ro%a and all the rest of the
pioneering crowd—they'll be the end of us yetl"
372 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
Smiling
to himself, Harold continued, "We've found out that the game of chess is
generally known all over the Empire."
"Pshaw!"
burst out the harsh-voiced man seated on Burkinshaw's left. "That's no
coincidence. It spread from a central source as anyone with a modicum of
intelligence should have deduced."
"Be quiet,
Dykstra," reproved Burkinshaw.
"Which source?"
Harold asked him.
Dykstra looked peeved as he replied,
"Us! We spread it around. What of it?"
"We had it long before you contacted
us," Harold told him.
Dykstra
opened his mouth, glanced at Burkinshaw, closed his mouth and swallowed hard.
Burkinshaw continued to survey the ceiling.
Harold pursued, "We've had it so long
that we don't know how long. The same board, same pieces, same moves, same
rules. If you work it out, you'll find that that involves a very large number
of coincidences."
They
didn't comment vocally, but he got their reactions. Four of the Council were
confused. "Surprising,
but possible," mused
the Floran. "What
of it, anyway?" inquired
Dykstra's mind. "No
point yet apparent," thought Burkinshaw coolly. The purple thing's brain emitted a giggle.
"Bron,"
said Harold. "Walt Bron, Robertus Bron and umpteen other Brons. Your
directory of citizens is full of them. My world, likewise, is full of them,
always coupled with the other parent's name, of course, and occasionally
spelled Brown, but pronounced the same. We've also got Roberts and
Walters." He looked at Helman. "I know four men named Hillman."
He shifted his gaze to the Supreme Lord. "And among our minor musicians is
one named Theodore Burkin-shaw-May."
Burkinshaw removed his stare from the ceiling
and concentrated on the wall. "I see where he's going. Reserve judgment until he arrives."
"The vessel which brought us here was
named the Fenix,
in characters resembling
those of our own alphabet," Harold continued. "And in days long gone
by, when we had warships, there was one named the Phoenix. We found your language amazingly easy to
learn. Why? Because one-fifth of your vocabulary is identical with ours.
Another fifth is composed of perversions of our words. The remainder consists
METAMORPHosrre 373
of
words which you have changed beyond all recognition or words you've acquired from the peoples you've conquered. But, basically, your language is ours. Have you had enough coincidences?"
"Nonsense!"
exclaimed Dykstra loudly.
"Impossible!"
Burkinshaw
turned and looked at Dykstra with eyes that were
reproving behind
their lenses. "Nothing
is impossible," he contradicted mildly.
"Continue," he ordered Harold,
while his thoughts
ran on, "The pleader is making the inevitable
point—too late"
"So you can see where I'm going,"
Harold remarked to him. "Just for one final coincidence, let me say I was stupid enough to misunderstand
the imperial title. I thought they called themselves
Lords of Terror. A silly
mistake." His voice slowed down. "Their title is a mystic one rooted
deep in your past. They call themselves Lords of Terra!"
"Dear me," said
Dykstra, "isn't that nice!"
Ignoring him, Harold spoke to Roka.
"You're awake by now. Last night something clicked in your mind and you
found yourself remembering things you didn't know you'd forgotten.
Do you remember what my people call their parent planet?"
"Terra,"
Roka responded prompdy. "I reported it to the Supreme Lord this morning. You call
yourselves Terrestrials."
Dykstra's
heavy face went dark red,
and accusations of blasphemy were welling within his mind when Burkinshaw beat him to it.
"This morning's revised report of Lieutenant Roka and certain survivors of
his crew now lies before the
Council." He indicated the papers on
the table. "It has already
been analyzed by the police commissioner,
Inquisitor Helman and myself. We now believe that
the pleader's assertions are founded in truth and
that in discovering
KX-724 we have
discovered our long-lost point of origin. We have found
our mother planet. The Fenix,
unknown to any of us, was
homeward bound!"
Half the Council were dumfounded. The purple creature was
not; it registered that human
rediscoveries were
of little consequence to purple things. The Floran thought similarly. Dykstra's mind was a turmoil of
confusion.
"A difference of three light-years has separated
us for two thousand centuries," Harold told them quietly. "In that tremendous past we'd grown great and venturesome. We
sent several convoys of colonists to the nearest system four and
a half light-years away. We never knew what happened to them, for then
followed the
final atomic war which reduced us to wandering tribes sunk lower than savages.
We've
374 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
been
climbing back ever since. The path of our climb has been very different from
yours, for roving particles had done strange things to us. Some of those things
died out, some were rooted out, others persisted and made us what we are
today."
"What are you?"
inquired the member next to Roka.
"Humanity
metamorphosed," Burkinshaw answered for him.
"In
the awful struggle for life on new and hostile worlds, you, too, sank,"
Harold continued. "But you climbed again, and once more reached for the
stars. Naturally, you sought the nearest system one and a half light-years
away, for you had forgotten the location of your home which was spoken of only
in ancient legends. We were three light-years farther away than your nearest
neighboring system. Logically, you picked that—and went away from us. You sank
again, climbed again, went on again, and you never came back until you'd built
a mighty Empire on the rim of which we waited, and changed, and changed."
Now they were all staring at him
fascinatedly. Even Dykstra was silent, his mind full of the mighty argosy
across the ages. Half of it was school-book stuff to him, but not when
presented in this new light.
"Those
of you who are of the Brotherhood of the Budding Cross know that this is
true—that you have completed the circle and reached the Seat of Sol." He
made a swift and peculiar sign. Two of his audience responded automatically.
"It's
of little use," Burt's
thought came over strongly. "They're too factual"
"Wait!"
The Council was silent a long time, and
eventually the Floran said, "All this is very touching—but how touching
will it be when they take over our Empire?" To which its mind added, "And we Florans swap one master for
another. I am against it. Better the devil you \now than the devil you
don't."
Resdng
his thin arms on the table, Burkinshaw Three blinked apologetically at the
Terrans and spoke smoothly. "If they knew what we know, the Empire's
sentimentalists might be against your destruction. However, the fabric of our
cosmic edifice cannot be sustained by anything so soft as sentiment. Moreover,
the prodigal sons have no intention of presenting this fatted calf to their
long-lost fathers. Your removal from the scheme of things appears to me as
necessary as ever—perhaps even more necessary—and that it will be patricide
makes no difference to the fact." His thin, ascetic face held an ingra-
METAMORPHOSITE 375
tiating
wish to please. "I feel sure that you understand our position. Have you
anything more to say?"
"No
luck," whispered Melor. "The hatred has gone—to be replaced by
fear."
Harold
grimaced, said to the Supreme Lord, "Yes, I'd like to say that you can
blast Terra out of existence, and its system along with it, but it'll do you no
good."
"We
are not under the delusion that it will do us any good," declared
Burkinshaw. "Nor would we sanction so drastic an act for such a
purpose." He removed his pince-nez, screwed up his eyes as he looked at
his listeners. "The modve is more reasonable and more urgent—it is to
prevent harm."
"It won't do that,
either."
"Why not?"
"Because you're too late."
"I
feared you'd say that." Burkinshaw leaned back in his seat, tapped his
glasses on a thumbnail. "If he can't satisfy me that his claim is well-based, I shall
advance the hour!" Then
he said, "You'll have to prove that."
"There's
trouble on four out of the five other planets in this system. You've just had
news of it. Nothing serious, merely some absenteeism, sabotage, demonstrations,
but no violence. It's trouble all the same— and it could be worse."
"There's always trouble on one planet or
another," put in Helman sourly. "When you're nursing four thousand of
them, you get used to unrest."
"You
overlook the significance of coincidences, I fear. Normal troubles pop up here
and there, haphazardly. These have come together. They've kept an appointment
in time!"
"We'll deal with
them," Helman snapped.
"I
don't doubt it," said Harold evenly. "You'll also deal with an uproar
in the next system when you get news of it soon. You'll deal with four planets
simultaneously, or forty planets—simultaneously. But four hundred
planets—simultaneously—and then four thousand! Somewhere is the number that'll
prove too much for even the best of organizations."
"It's
not possible," Helman asserted stubbornly. "Only two dozen of you
Terrans got here. Roka told us that. You took over his ship, substituted two
dozen Terrestrials for part of his crew, impressed false memories on his and
the others' minds causing them to suspect noth-
376 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
ing until their true memories suddenly
returned." He scowled. The pulse in his forehead was beating visibly.
"Very clever of you. Very, very clever. But twenty-four aren't enough."
"We
know it. Irrespective of relative powers, some numbers are needed to deal with
numbers." Harold's sharp-eyed gaze went from Helman to Burkinshaw.
"If you people are no more and no less human than you were two hundred
thousand years ago—and I think that your expansive path has kept you much the same—I'd say that your bureaucrats still live in
water-tight compartments. So long as supposedly missing ships fail to observe
the officially prescribed rigmarole for reporting, it's taken that they're still
missing. And, ten to one, your Department of Commerce doesn't even know that
the Navy has mislaid anything."
It was a tribute to the Supreme Lord's
quick-wittedness that his mind was way ahead of his confreres', for he acted
while they were still stewing it over. He switched on the televisor set in the
wall on one side.
Looking at its scanner, he said sharply,
"Get me the Department of Commerce, Movements Section."
The screen colored, a fat man in civilian
attire appeared. An expression of intense respect covered his ample features
as he identified his caller.
"Yes, your
excellency?"
"The Navy has reported two vessels
immobilized beyond the Frontier. They're the Callan and the Mathra.
Have they been recorded
recently in any movements bulletins?"
"A
moment, your excellency." The fat man disappeared. After some time, he
came back, a puzzled frown on his face. "Your excellency, we have those
two ships recorded as obsolete war vessels functioning as freighters. Their
conversion was assumed by us, since they are transporting passengers and
tonnage. The Callan
has cleared four ports in
the Frontier Zone, Sector B, in the last eight days. The Mathra departed from the system of Hyperion after landing passengers and
freight on each of its nine planets. Its destination was given as external to
the Frontier Zone, Sector-J."
"Inform
the Navy Department," Burkinshaw ordered, and switched off. He was the least
disturbed individual at the table. His manner was calm, unruffled as he spoke
to Harold. "So they're busily bringing in Terrans or Terrestrials or
whatever you call yourselves.
METAMORPHOSITE 377
The
logical play is to have those two vessels blown out of existence. Can it be
done?"
"I'm
afraid not. It depends largely upon whether the ships getting such an order
have or have not already come under our control. The trouble with warships and
atom bombs and planet-wreckers is that they're useful only when they work when
and where you want them to work. Otherwise, they're liabilities." He
gestured to indicate Burt and George. "According to my friends, the bomb
allocated to Terra is on the ship Warcat clearing
from your third neighbor. Ask Amilcare about it."
It required some minutes to get the third
planet's Lord on the screen, and then his image was cloudy with static.
"Where's the Warcat?"
rasped Burkinshaw.
The image moved, clouded still more, then
cleared slightly. "Gone," said Amilcare jovially. "I don't know
where." "On whose authority?"
"Mine,"
Amilcare answered. His chuckle was oily and a litde crazy. "Jon wanted it
so I told him to take it. I couldn't think of anything you'd find more
gratifying. Don't you worry about Jon—I'm looking after him for you."
Burkinshaw cut him off.
"This Jon is a Terran, I suppose?"
"A Terrestrial,"
Harold corrected.
"Put a call out for him," urged
Dykstra irefully. "The police won't all be bereft of their senses even if
Amilcare is."
"Let me handle this," Burkinshaw
said. Then, to Harold, "What has he done with the Warcat?"
"He'll have put somebody on it to
control the crew and they'll be giving you a demonstration of what a nuisance
planet-wreckers can be when they drop where they shouldn't."
"So
your defense is attack? The bloodshed has started? In that case, the war is on,
and we're all wasting our—"
"There
will be no bloodshed," Harold interrupted. "We're not so infantile as
that. None's been shed so far, and none will be shed if it can be avoided.
That's what we're here for—to avoid it. The fact that we'd inevitably win any
knock-down and drag-out affair you care to start hasn't blinded us to the fact
that losers can lose very bloodily." He waved a hand toward the televisor.
"Check up with your watertight bureaucrats. Ask your astronomers whether
that refueling asteroid of yours is still circling."
378 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
Burkinshaw
resorted to the televisor for the third time. All eyes were on its screen as he
said, "Where is Nemo
now?"
"Nemo?
Well, your excellency, at
the present moment it is approaching alignment with the last planet Drufa and about twenty hours farther out."
"I'm
not asking where it ought to be! I want to know whether it's actually
there!"
"Pardon
me, your excellency." The figure slid off the screen and was gone a long
time. When it returned, its voice crept out of the speaker hushed and
frightened. "Your excellency, it would seem that some strange disaster has
overtaken the body. I cannot explain why we've failed to observe—"
"Is it there?"
rapped Burkinshaw impatiently.
"Yes, your excellency. But it is in
gaseous condition. One would almost believe that a planet-wrecker had—"
"Enough!" Without
waiting to hear the rest, he switched off.
Lying
back in his chair, he brooded in complete disregard of the fact that his mind
was wide open to some even though not to all. He didn't care who picked up his
impressions.
"We
may be too late. Possibly we were already too late the day Ro\a came bac\. At
long last we've fallen into the trap we've always feared, the trap we avoided
when we vaporized that world of parasites. Nevertheless, we can still destroy
Terra—they cant possibly have ta\en over every world and every ship and we can
still wipe her out. But to what avail? Revenge is sweet only when it's
profitable. Will it profit us? It all depends on how many of these people have
snea\ed into our ran\s, and how many more can get in before we destroy their
base."
Helman
thought, "This
is it! Any fool could tell it had to come sooner or later. Every new world is a
risfe We've been lucfy to get through four thousand of them without getting in bad. Well, the end could have been
worse. At least, these are our own t\ind and should favor us above all other shapes"
Melor
murmured, "Their hate has weakened, and their fear turns to personal
worry. Excepting the Purple One and the Floran. The Purple One, who was amused,
is now angry. The Floran, who was interested and amiable, now fears."
"That's
because we're not of their shape. Racial antagonisms and color antagonisms are
as nothing to the mutual distrust between different shapes. There lies the
Empire's weak spot. Every shape desires
METAMORPHOSITE 379
mastery
of its own territory. So far as we're concerned, they can have it," Harold
commented.
Putting
his glasses back on his nose, Burkinshaw sighed and said, "Since you
intend to take over the Empire, our only remaining move is to issue a general
order for the immediate destruction of Terra. No matter how many confiscated
ships try to thwart my purpose, obedience by one loyal vessel will
suffice." His hand reached out toward the televisor switch.
"We
aren't taking over your Empire," Harold told him swifdy. "Neither do
we wish to do so. We're concerned only that you don't take over our world. All
we want is a pact of noninterference in each other's affairs, and the
appointment of a few Lingans to act as ambassadors through whom we can
maintain such contact as suits us. We want to go our own way along our own
path, we've the ability to defend our right to do so, and the present
situation is our way of demonstrating the fact. No more than that. If,
peevishly, you destroy our world, then, vengefully, we shall disrupt your
ramshackle collection of worlds, not with our own strength, but by judiciously
utilizing yours! Leave us in peace and we shall leave you in peace."
"Where's
our guarantee of that?" asked Burkinshaw cynically. "How do we know
that a century of incidious penetration will not follow such a pact?" He
stared at the four, his blue eyes shrewd and calculating to a degree not
apparent before. "In dealing with us you've been able to use an advantage
you possess which Florans, Lingans, Rethrans and others have not got, namely,
you know us as surely as you know your own kith and kin." He bent forward.
"Likewise, we know you! If
you're of sound and sane mind you'll absorb gradually what you can't gulp down
in one lump. That's the way we acquired the Empire, and that's the way you'll
get it!"
"We've
proved to you that we can take it over," Harold agreed evenly, "and
that is our protection. Your distrust is the measure of ours. You'll never know
how many of us are within your Empire and you'll never find out—but
obliteration of our parent world will no longer obliterate our life form. We
have made our own guarantee. Get it into your head, there is no winner in this
game. It's stalemate!" He watched interestedly as Burkinshaw's forefinger
rested light on the switch. "You're too late, much too late. We don't want
your Empire because we're in the same fix—we're too late."
Burkinshaw's eyes narrowed and he said,
"I don't see why it's too late for you to do what you've been so anxious
to prove you can do."
380 JOURNEY TO INFINITY
"The
desire doesn't exist. We've greater desires. It's because we have wended our way through a hell of our own
creation that we have changed, and our ambitions have changed with us. Why should we care
about territorial conquests when we face prospects infinitely greater? Why
should we gallivant in spaceships around the petty limits of a galaxy when some
day we shall range unhampered through infinity? How d'you think we knew you
were coming, and prepared for you, even though we were uncertain of your shape
and unsure of your intentions?"
"I'm
listening," observed Burkinshaw, his fingers still toying with the switch,
"but all I hear is words. Despite your many differences from us, which I
acknowledge, the ancient law holds good: that shape runs true to shape."
Harold
glanced at Burt and George. There was swift communion between them.
Then
he said, "Time has been long, and the little angle between the paths of
our fathers has opened to a mighty span. Our changes have been violent and
many. A world of hard radiation has molded us anew, has made us what you cannot
conceive, and you see us in a guise temporarily suitable for our purpose."
Without warning, his eyes glowed at the Purple One. "Even that creature,
which lives on life force and has been sucking steadily at us all this time,
would now be dead had he succeeded in drawing one thin beam of what he
craves!"
Burkinshaw didn't bother to look at the
purple thing, but commented boredly, "The Rethran was an experiment that
failed. If he was of any use, he'd have got you long before now." He
rubbed his gray side-hairs, kept his hand on the switch. "I grow tired of
meaningless noises. You are now hinting that you are no longer of our shape. I
prefer to believe the evidence of my eyes." His optics sought the miniature
time-recorder set in a ring on his finger. "If I switch on, it may mean
the end of us all, but you cannot hypnotize a scanner, and the scene registered
in this room will be equivalent to my unspoken order—death to Terra! I suspect
you of playing for time. We can ill afford further time. I give you one minute
to prove that you are now as different from us as is this Floran or this
Rethran or that Lingan. If you do so, we'll deal with this matter sensibly and
make a pact such as you desire. If not"—he waggled the switch
suggestively—"the slaughter starts. We may lose—or we may not. It's a
chance we've got to take."
METAMORPHOSITE 381
The three Terrestrials made no reply. Their
minds were in complete accord and their response was simultaneous.
Dykstra
sobbed, "Look! Oh, eternity, lookl" then sank to his knees and began
to gabble. The purple creature withdrew its eyes right into its head so that it
could not see. Burkinshaw's hand came away from the switch; his glasses fell to
the floor and lay there, shattered, unheeded. Roka and Helman and the other
humans on the Council covered their faces with their hands which slowly took on
a tropical tan.
Only the Floran came upright. It arose to
full height, its golden petals completely extended, its greenish arms trembling
with ecstasy. All flowers love the sun.
Adventures in Science Fiction Series
JOURNEY to
INFINITY
Adventures in
Science Fiction
JOURNEY
to
INFINIT
Series
Edited by MARTIN
GREENBERG
Introduced
by FLETCHER PRATT
C. L. MOORE FRITZ LEIBER
ISAAC ASIMOV JUDITH MERRIL FREDRIC BROWN CLEVE CARTMILL JACK WILLIAMSON ERIC
FRANK RUSSELL THEODORE STURGEON JOHN D. MAC DONALD A. BERTRAM CHANDLER EDWARD
E. SMITH, PH.D.
ANTHOLOGY
Arranged as a Story Of the Imaginative History of
Mankind
EDITED
BY Martin Greenberg INTRODUCED BY Fletcher Pratt
GNOME PRESS
CAW If
$3.50
JOURNEY
TO INFINITY
Edited by MARTIN GREENBERG
Introduction
by FLETCHER PRATT
This
is an unusual book. It tells the greatest adventure story in the Universe— the
story of Mankind. Stretching from the mysterious past to the mysterious future,
no other subject has more fascination for reader or writer.
Twelve
stories have been assembled here in a unique pattern. By careful selection,
these stories by the foremost authors of science fiction relate an imaginative
history of Man. Forgotten events and future deeds are fitted together for an
exciting and fantastic account of speculation and prophecy in human life.
The first anthology to develop this idea of a
unifying theme was MEN AGAINST THE STARS, the first in the series of Adventures
in Science Fiction. Opinion was unanimous in accepting it as an outstanding
success among science fiction anthologies. This latest book is a worthy
successor.
The
book begins its imaginative history with False Dawn, by A. Bertram Chandler. This is an echo of
the forgotten past, when early men built themselves a civilization as modern as
today's. In the second story, Atlantis, by
Edward E. Smith, Ph.D., another great culture is created out of savagery. But
technician though Man is, he has yet to conquer his own mad desires. A pattern
in progress is now evident and
(continued on back flap)
Jacket Design by Edd Cartier
(continued from front flap)
Letter
to a Phoenix, by Fredric Brown, reveals its amazing extent
and complexity.
At
last, on the verge of conquering space, twentieth century Man overcomes his
greatest obstacle to his way of life— himself. Unite and Conquer, by Theodore Sturgeon, prepares Mankind for
the space frontiers of the Solar System. With the planets colonized, Breakdown, by Jack Williamson, tells what happens in the
twenty-first century when the spacemen's union is the most influential force in
the interplanetary community. Spaceships now head out into interstellar
regions, brought about by the irresistible appeal in Dance of a
New World, by
John D. MacDonald. The Golden Age, however, produced another crisis and the
Solar Empire began to crumble. The colonists forsake Mother Earth, by Isaac Asimov, and marauders appear. When
the last terrestrial patrols in the last outposts are recalled, it is obvious
that There Shall Be
Darkness, by
C. L. Moore.
The
reign of terror finally receded and Mankind, in Taboo, by Fritz Leiber, began to rebuild from the ashes of the past. The cycle
was completed again by world unity created with the Overthrow, by Cleve Cartmill.
The
journey to infinity, now cosmic in scope, faced a strange termination. Barrier of
Dread, by Judith Merril,
confronts Mankind with the latest problem and a difficult choice. Man at last
adapts himself to a peaceful instability until the final drive for universal
dominance. Metamorphosite. by
Eric Frank Russell, ends the future history with a fascinating story about the
re-discovery of the forgotten inheritance of Mankind.
GNOME PRESS NEW YORK
M GNOME PRESS means
rf^l OUTSTANDING SCIENCE FICTION BOOKS
'THE ROBOT & THE MAN, An anthology ................................ .................................. J2.95
TRAVELERS OF SPACE, An anthology...................................................................... 3-95
JOURNEY TO INFINITY, An anthology ............................................... ....................... 3.50
MEN AGAINST THE STARS, An anthology ............................... 2.95
FIVE SCIENCE FICTION NOVELS, An anthology ................................................... 3.50
KING CONAN, by Robert E. Howard............................ ............................................... 3.00
SWORD OF CONAN, by Robert E. Howard ...................................... ......................... 2.75
CONAN THE CONQUEROR by Robert E. Howard .................................................. 2.75
SECOND FOUNDATION, by Isaac Asimov ............................................................. 2.75
FOUNDATION & EMPIRE, by Isaac Asimov .................................... 2.75
FOUNDATION, by Isaac Asimov ............................................................................. 2.75
1 ROBOT, by Isaac Asimov ......................................................................... ................. 2.50
AGAINST THE FALL OF NIGHT, by Arthur C. Clarke 2.75
SANDS OF MARS, by Arthur C. Clarke ..................................................................... 2.75
ICEWORLD, by Hal Clement ..................................................................................... 2.50
CHILDREN OF THE ATOM, by Wilmar H. Shiras ............................... 2.75
JUDGMENT NIGHT, by C. L. Moore .......................................................................... 3.50
THE STARMEN, by Leigh Brackett ............................................................................ 2.75
THE MIXED MEN, by A. E. van Vogt ......................................................................... 2.75
ROBOTS HAVE NO TAILS, by Lewis Padgett .......................................................... 2.75
THE FAIRY CHESSMAN and TOMORROW AND TOMORROW,
by Lewis Padgett 2.75
CITY, by Clifford D. Simak ......................................................................................... 2.75
COSMIC ENGINEERS, by Clifford D. Simak ............................................................. 2.50
SIXTH COLUMN, by R. A. Heinlein ............................................................................ 2.50
PATTERN FOR CONQUEST, by George O. Smith .................................................... .. 2.50
THE CASTLE OF IRON, de Camp & Pratt ................................................................ .. 2.50
THE CARNELIAN CUBE, de Camp & Pratt ............................................................. .. 3.00
RENAISSANCE, by R. F. Jones ................................................................................... .. 2.75
TYPEWRITER IN THE SKY AND FEAR, by L. Ron Hubbard .................................... .. 2.75
MINMONS OF THE MOON, by W. G. Beyer .............................................................. 2.50
AT
YOUR FAVORITE BOOK STORE
The Gnome Press, Inc.
80 East 11 th St., N. Y. 3